xref: /netbsd-src/external/gpl3/gdb.old/dist/gdb/doc/gdb.texinfo (revision bdc22b2e01993381dcefeff2bc9b56ca75a4235c)
1\input texinfo      @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3@c
4@c %**start of header
5@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6@c of @set vars.  However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7@setfilename gdb.info
8@c
9@c man begin INCLUDE
10@include gdb-cfg.texi
11@c man end
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24@c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25@c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26@c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27@syncodeindex ky fn
28@syncodeindex tp fn
29
30@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32@syncodeindex vr fn
33
34@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35@c This is updated by GNU Press.
36@set EDITION Tenth
37
38@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39@set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44@c manuals to an info tree.
45@dircategory Software development
46@direntry
47* Gdb: (gdb).                     The GNU debugger.
48* gdbserver: (gdb) Server.        The GNU debugging server.
49@end direntry
50
51@copying
52@c man begin COPYRIGHT
53Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63this GNU Manual.  Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65@c man end
66@end copying
67
68@ifnottex
69This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75@end ifset
76Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78@insertcopying
79@end ifnottex
80
81@titlepage
82@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84@sp 1
85@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87@sp 1
88@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89@end ifset
90@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91@page
92@tex
93{\parskip=0pt
94\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97}
98@end tex
99
100@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
10251 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106@insertcopying
107@end titlepage
108@page
109
110@ifnottex
111@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120@end ifset
121Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126Fish.  Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127software in general.  We will miss him.
128
129@menu
130* Summary::                     Summary of @value{GDBN}
131* Sample Session::              A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133* Invocation::                  Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134* Commands::                    @value{GDBN} commands
135* Running::                     Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136* Stopping::                    Stopping and continuing
137* Reverse Execution::           Running programs backward
138* Process Record and Replay::   Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139* Stack::                       Examining the stack
140* Source::                      Examining source files
141* Data::                        Examining data
142* Optimized Code::              Debugging optimized code
143* Macros::                      Preprocessor Macros
144* Tracepoints::                 Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145* Overlays::                    Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147* Languages::                   Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149* Symbols::                     Examining the symbol table
150* Altering::                    Altering execution
151* GDB Files::                   @value{GDBN} files
152* Targets::                     Specifying a debugging target
153* Remote Debugging::            Debugging remote programs
154* Configurations::              Configuration-specific information
155* Controlling GDB::             Controlling @value{GDBN}
156* Extending GDB::               Extending @value{GDBN}
157* Interpreters::		Command Interpreters
158* TUI::                         @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159* Emacs::                       Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160* GDB/MI::                      @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161* Annotations::                 @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162* JIT Interface::               Using the JIT debugging interface.
163* In-Process Agent::            In-Process Agent
164
165* GDB Bugs::                    Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168* Command Line Editing: (rluserman).         Command Line Editing
169* Using History Interactively: (history).    Using History Interactively
170@end ifset
171@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172* Command Line Editing::        Command Line Editing
173* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174@end ifclear
175* In Memoriam::                 In Memoriam
176* Formatting Documentation::    How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177* Installing GDB::              Installing GDB
178* Maintenance Commands::        Maintenance Commands
179* Remote Protocol::             GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180* Agent Expressions::           The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181* Target Descriptions::         How targets can describe themselves to
182                                @value{GDBN}
183* Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184                                 the operating system
185* Trace File Format::		GDB trace file format
186* Index Section Format::        .gdb_index section format
187* Man Pages::			Manual pages
188* Copying::			GNU General Public License says
189                                how you can copy and share GDB
190* GNU Free Documentation License::  The license for this documentation
191* Concept Index::               Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192* Command and Variable Index::  Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193                                  functions, and Python data types
194@end menu
195
196@end ifnottex
197
198@contents
199
200@node Summary
201@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210@itemize @bullet
211@item
212Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214@item
215Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217@item
218Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220@item
221Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223@end itemize
224
225You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229Support for D is partial.  For information on D, see
230@ref{D,,D}.
231
232@cindex Modula-2
233Support for Modula-2 is partial.  For information on Modula-2, see
234@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236Support for OpenCL C is partial.  For information on OpenCL C, see
237@ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239@cindex Pascal
240Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241nested functions does not currently work.  @value{GDBN} does not support
242entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243syntax.
244
245@cindex Fortran
246@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248underscore.
249
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253@menu
254* Free Software::               Freely redistributable software
255* Free Documentation::          Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256* Contributors::                Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
259@node Free Software
260@unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263General Public License
264(GPL).  The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
275@node Free Documentation
276@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280include with the free software.  Many of our most important
281programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282texts.  Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283when an important free software package does not come with a free
284manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap.  We have many such
285gaps today.
286
287Consider Perl, for instance.  The tutorial manuals that people
288normally use are non-free.  How did this come about?  Because the
289authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291them from the free software world.
292
293That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294from the last.  Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297contract to make it non-free.
298
299Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300price.  The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine.  (The Free
302Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.)  The
303problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual.  Free manuals
304are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305modify.  Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308free software.  Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program.  A
316manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318community.
319
320Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321acceptable.  For example, requirements to preserve the original
322author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323authors, are ok.  It is also no problem to require modified versions
324to include notice that they were modified.  Even entire sections that
325may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326with nontechnical topics (like this one).  These kinds of restrictions
327are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328of the manual.
329
330However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332media, through all the usual channels.  Otherwise, the restrictions
333obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334manual to replace it.
335
336Please spread the word about this issue.  Our community continues to
337lose manuals to proprietary publishing.  If we spread the word that
338free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341the free software community.
342
343If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345license.  Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346don't have to let the publisher decide.  Some commercial publishers
347will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349what you want.  If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350try other publishers.  If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356improvements.  Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357at all.  Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363published by other publishers, at
364@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366@node Contributors
367@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370other @sc{gnu} programs.  Many others have contributed to its
371development.  This section attempts to credit major contributors.  One
372of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here.  The
374file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375blow-by-blow account.
376
377Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379@quotation
380@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome.  If you
381or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383@end quotation
384
385So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387releases:
388Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403Bothner and Daniel Berlin.  James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404demangler.  Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418support.
419Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439libraries.
440
441Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442about several machine instruction sets.
443
444Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445remote debugging.  Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450command-line editing and command history.
451
452Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457symbols.
458
459Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465processors.
466
467Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474watchpoints.
475
476Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni.  Kim Haase
489provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495development since 1991.  Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni.  In
501addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514Hat.
515
516Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector.  Many
517people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame.  Mark
526Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528trad unwinders.  The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534Weigand.
535
536Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors.  Others
538who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544@node Sample Session
545@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549debugger.  This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551@iftex
552In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554@end iftex
555
556@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562definition within another stop working.  In the following short @code{m4}
563session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565same thing.  However, when we change the open quote string to
566@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569@smallexample
570$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571$ @b{./m4}
572@b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574@b{foo}
5750000
576@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578@b{bar}
5790000
580@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583@b{baz}
584@b{Ctrl-d}
585m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586@end smallexample
587
588@noindent
589Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591@smallexample
592$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594@c FIXME... format to come out better.
595@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602(@value{GDBP})
603@end smallexample
604
605@noindent
606@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609that examples fit in this manual.
610
611@smallexample
612(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613@end smallexample
614
615@noindent
616We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619@code{break} command.
620
621@smallexample
622(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624@end smallexample
625
626@noindent
627Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631@smallexample
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634@b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636@b{foo}
6370000
638@end smallexample
639
640@noindent
641To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}.  @value{GDBN}
642suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643context where it stops.
644
645@smallexample
646@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649    at builtin.c:879
650879         if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651@end smallexample
652
653@noindent
654Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655the next line of the current function.
656
657@smallexample
658(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659882         set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661@end smallexample
662
663@noindent
664@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine.  We can go into it
665by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669@smallexample
670(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672    at input.c:530
673530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
674@end smallexample
675
676@noindent
677The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display.  It
679shows a summary of the stack.  We can use the @code{backtrace}
680command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687    at input.c:530
688#1  0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689    at builtin.c:882
690#2  0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691#3  0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692    at macro.c:71
693#4  0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694#5  0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695@end smallexample
696
697@noindent
698We step through a few more lines to see what happens.  The first two
699times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702@smallexample
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
7040x3b5c  532         if (rquote != def_rquote)
705(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
7060x3b80  535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ?  \
707def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713@end smallexample
714
715@noindent
716The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718and right quotes we specified.  We use the command @code{p}
719(@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721@smallexample
722(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726@end smallexample
727
728@noindent
729@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733@smallexample
734(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735533             xfree(rquote);
736534
737535         lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739536         rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741537
742538         len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744540     @}
745541
746542     void
747@end smallexample
748
749@noindent
750Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753@smallexample
754(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755539         len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757540     @}
758(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759$3 = 9
760(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761$4 = 7
762@end smallexample
763
764@noindent
765That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767@code{rquote} respectively.  We can set them to better values using
768the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770assignments.
771
772@smallexample
773(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774$5 = 7
775(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776$6 = 9
777@end smallexample
778
779@noindent
780Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}?  We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783example that caused trouble initially:
784
785@smallexample
786(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787Continuing.
788
789@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791baz
7920000
793@end smallexample
794
795@noindent
796Success!  The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones.  The
797problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798lengths.  We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800@smallexample
801@b{Ctrl-d}
802Program exited normally.
803@end smallexample
804
805@noindent
806The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807indicates @code{m4} has finished executing.  We can end our @value{GDBN}
808session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810@smallexample
811(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812@end smallexample
813
814@node Invocation
815@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818The essentials are:
819@itemize @bullet
820@item
821type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822@item
823type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824@end itemize
825
826@menu
827* Invoking GDB::                How to start @value{GDBN}
828* Quitting GDB::                How to quit @value{GDBN}
829* Shell Commands::              How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830* Logging Output::              How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831@end menu
832
833@node Invoking GDB
834@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}.  Once started,
837@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842The command-line options described here are designed
843to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847specifying an executable program:
848
849@smallexample
850@value{GDBP} @var{program}
851@end smallexample
852
853@noindent
854You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855specified:
856
857@smallexample
858@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859@end smallexample
860
861You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862to debug a running process:
863
864@smallexample
865@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866@end smallexample
867
868@noindent
869would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump.  @value{GDBN}
876will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}.  This option stops
880option processing.
881@smallexample
882@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883@end smallexample
884This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889(or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891@smallexample
892@value{GDBP} --silent
893@end smallexample
894
895@noindent
896You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897options.  @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899@noindent
900Type
901
902@smallexample
903@value{GDBP} -help
904@end smallexample
905
906@noindent
907to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911in sequential order.  The order makes a difference when the
912@samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915@menu
916* File Options::                Choosing files
917* Mode Options::                Choosing modes
918* Startup::                     What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919@end menu
920
921@node File Options
922@subsection Choosing Files
923
924When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID).  This is
926the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively.  (@value{GDBN} reads the
928first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934to open it as a corefile.  If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940argument and ignore it.
941
942Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943following list.  @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE.  This
949@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950@c it.
951
952@table @code
953@item -symbols @var{file}
954@itemx -s @var{file}
955@cindex @code{--symbols}
956@cindex @code{-s}
957Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959@item -exec @var{file}
960@itemx -e @var{file}
961@cindex @code{--exec}
962@cindex @code{-e}
963Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966@item -se @var{file}
967@cindex @code{--se}
968Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969file.
970
971@item -core @var{file}
972@itemx -c @var{file}
973@cindex @code{--core}
974@cindex @code{-c}
975Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977@item -pid @var{number}
978@itemx -p @var{number}
979@cindex @code{--pid}
980@cindex @code{-p}
981Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983@item -command @var{file}
984@itemx -x @var{file}
985@cindex @code{--command}
986@cindex @code{-x}
987Execute commands from file @var{file}.  The contents of this file is
988evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991@item -eval-command @var{command}
992@itemx -ex @var{command}
993@cindex @code{--eval-command}
994@cindex @code{-ex}
995Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands.  It may
998also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000@smallexample
1001@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002   -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003@end smallexample
1004
1005@item -init-command @var{file}
1006@itemx -ix @var{file}
1007@cindex @code{--init-command}
1008@cindex @code{-ix}
1009Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010after loading gdbinit files).
1011@xref{Startup}.
1012
1013@item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014@itemx -iex @var{command}
1015@cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016@cindex @code{-iex}
1017Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018after loading gdbinit files).
1019@xref{Startup}.
1020
1021@item -directory @var{directory}
1022@itemx -d @var{directory}
1023@cindex @code{--directory}
1024@cindex @code{-d}
1025Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027@item -r
1028@itemx -readnow
1029@cindex @code{--readnow}
1030@cindex @code{-r}
1031Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035@end table
1036
1037@node Mode Options
1038@subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043@table @code
1044@anchor{-nx}
1045@item -nx
1046@itemx -n
1047@cindex @code{--nx}
1048@cindex @code{-n}
1049Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052@table @code
1053@item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054This is the system-wide init file.
1055Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058have been processed.
1059@item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060This is the init file in your home directory.
1061It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062command options have been processed.
1063@item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064This is the init file in the current directory.
1065It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066@code{-ex} have been processed.  Command line options @code{-x} and
1067@code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068@end table
1069
1070For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071For documentation on how to write command files,
1072@xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074@anchor{-nh}
1075@item -nh
1076@cindex @code{--nh}
1077Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078in your home directory.
1079@xref{Startup}.
1080
1081@item -quiet
1082@itemx -silent
1083@itemx -q
1084@cindex @code{--quiet}
1085@cindex @code{--silent}
1086@cindex @code{-q}
1087``Quiet''.  Do not print the introductory and copyright messages.  These
1088messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090@item -batch
1091@cindex @code{--batch}
1092Run in batch mode.  Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}).  Exit with
1095nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096in the command files.  Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102make this more useful, the message
1103
1104@smallexample
1105Program exited normally.
1106@end smallexample
1107
1108@noindent
1109(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111mode.
1112
1113@item -batch-silent
1114@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently.  All
1116@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117unaffected).  This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118for an interactive session.
1119
1120This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121messages, for example.
1122
1123Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126@item -return-child-result
1127@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131@itemize @bullet
1132@item
1133@value{GDBN} exits abnormally.  E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134internal error.  In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136@item
1137The user quits with an explicit value.  E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138@item
1139The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140the exit code will be -1.
1141@end itemize
1142
1143This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145interface.
1146
1147@item -nowindows
1148@itemx -nw
1149@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150@cindex @code{-nw}
1151``No windows''.  If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153interface.  If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155@item -windows
1156@itemx -w
1157@cindex @code{--windows}
1158@cindex @code{-w}
1159If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160used if possible.
1161
1162@item -cd @var{directory}
1163@cindex @code{--cd}
1164Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165instead of the current directory.
1166
1167@item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168@itemx -D @var{directory}
1169@cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170@cindex @code{-D}
1171Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173auxiliary files.  @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175@item -fullname
1176@itemx -f
1177@cindex @code{--fullname}
1178@cindex @code{-f}
1179@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180subprocess.  It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182displayed (which includes each time your program stops).  This
1183recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185and a newline.  The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187frame.
1188
1189@item -annotate @var{level}
1190@cindex @code{--annotate}
1191This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}.  Its
1192effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193(@pxref{Annotations}).  The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195expressions, source lines, and other types of output.  Level 0 is the
1196normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203@item --args
1204@cindex @code{--args}
1205Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207This option stops option processing.
1208
1209@item -baud @var{bps}
1210@itemx -b @var{bps}
1211@cindex @code{--baud}
1212@cindex @code{-b}
1213Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216@item -l @var{timeout}
1217@cindex @code{-l}
1218Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219for remote debugging.
1220
1221@item -tty @var{device}
1222@itemx -t @var{device}
1223@cindex @code{--tty}
1224@cindex @code{-t}
1225Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty.  Investigate.
1227
1228@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229@item -tui
1230@cindex @code{--tui}
1231Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting.  The Text User
1232Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).  Do not use this
1235option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241program or device.  This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0.  The
1248previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated.  Earlier
1250@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252@item -write
1253@cindex @code{--write}
1254Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing.  This
1255is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256(@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258@item -statistics
1259@cindex @code{--statistics}
1260This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263@item -version
1264@cindex @code{--version}
1265This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268@item -configuration
1269@cindex @code{--configuration}
1270This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271configuration parameters, and then exit.  These details can be
1272important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274@end table
1275
1276@node Startup
1277@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282@enumerate
1283@item
1284Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287@item
1288@cindex init file
1289Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292that file.
1293
1294@anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295@item
1296Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299that file.
1300
1301@anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302@item
1303Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304@samp{-ix} options in their specified order.  Usually you should use the
1305@samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307gets loaded.
1308
1309@item
1310Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312@anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313@item
1314Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316@samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317This is only done if the current directory is
1318different from your home directory.  Thus, you can have more than one
1319init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321@value{GDBN}.
1322
1323@item
1324If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327@xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330you must do something like the following:
1331
1332@smallexample
1333$ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334@end smallexample
1335
1336Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337off too late.
1338
1339@item
1340Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341@samp{-x} options in their specified order.  @xref{Command Files}, for
1342more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344@item
1345Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348@end enumerate
1349
1350Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way.  The init
1352file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354and operands.  Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360@cindex init file name
1361@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.  The Windows
1366port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367@file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371@node Quitting GDB
1372@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376@table @code
1377@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380@itemx q
1381To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}).  If you
1383do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385error code.
1386@end table
1387
1388@cindex interrupt
1389An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391returns to @value{GDBN} command level.  It is safe to type the interrupt
1392character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399@node Shell Commands
1400@section Shell Commands
1401
1402If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406@table @code
1407@kindex shell
1408@kindex !
1409@cindex shell escape
1410@item shell @var{command-string}
1411@itemx !@var{command-string}
1412Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415shell to run.  Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417@end table
1418
1419The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421@value{GDBN}:
1422
1423@table @code
1424@kindex make
1425@cindex calling make
1426@item make @var{make-args}
1427Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428arguments.  This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429@end table
1430
1431@node Logging Output
1432@section Logging Output
1433@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439@table @code
1440@kindex set logging
1441@item set logging on
1442Enable logging.
1443@item set logging off
1444Disable logging.
1445@cindex logging file name
1446@item set logging file @var{file}
1447Change the name of the current logfile.  The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile.  Set @code{overwrite} if
1450you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454@kindex show logging
1455@item show logging
1456Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457@end table
1458
1459@node Commands
1460@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}.  You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468@menu
1469* Command Syntax::              How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470* Completion::                  Command completion
1471* Help::                        How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472@end menu
1473
1474@node Command Syntax
1475@section Command Syntax
1476
1477A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input.  There is no limit on
1478how long it can be.  It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479arguments whose meaning depends on the command name.  For example, the
1480command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481step, as in @samp{step 5}.  You can also use the @code{step} command
1482with no arguments.  Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484@cindex abbreviation
1485@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486unambiguous.  Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487documentation for individual commands.  In some cases, even ambiguous
1488abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490names start with @code{s}.  You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493@cindex repeating commands
1494@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496repeat the previous command.  Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499repeat.  User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504exactly as typed.  This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}).  Since it is easy to press one
1509@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513@cindex comment
1514Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515nothing.  This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518@cindex repeating command sequences
1519@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521commands.  This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523for editing.
1524
1525@node Completion
1526@section Command Completion
1527
1528@cindex completion
1529@cindex word completion
1530@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532are for the next word in a command, at any time.  This works for @value{GDBN}
1533commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536of a word.  If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538enter it).  For example, if you type
1539
1540@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544@smallexample
1545(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546@end smallexample
1547
1548@noindent
1549@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552@smallexample
1553(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554@end smallexample
1555
1556@noindent
1557You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected.  (If you
1560were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell.  You can either supply more
1566characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word.  For
1568example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570just sounds the bell.  Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572example:
1573
1574@smallexample
1575(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577make_a_section_from_file     make_environ
1578make_abs_section             make_function_type
1579make_blockvector             make_pointer_type
1580make_cleanup                 make_reference_type
1581make_command                 make_symbol_completion_list
1582(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583@end smallexample
1584
1585@noindent
1586After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588command.
1589
1590If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice.  @kbd{M-?}
1592means @kbd{@key{META} ?}.  You can type this either by holding down a
1593key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600@smallexample
1601(@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602main
1603<... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604*** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605(@value{GDBP}) b m
1606@end smallexample
1607
1608@noindent
1609This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611@table @code
1612@kindex set max-completions
1613@item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614@itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615Set the maximum number of completion candidates.  @value{GDBN} will
1616stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619The default value is 200.  A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621completion slow.
1622@kindex show max-completions
1623@item show max-completions
1624Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625during completion.
1626@end table
1627
1628@cindex quotes in commands
1629@cindex completion of quoted strings
1630Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632its notion of a word.  To permit word completion to work in this
1633situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634@value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637name of a C@t{++} function.  This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639by argument type).  For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.  To use the
1643word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644@code{'} at the beginning of the function name.  This alerts
1645@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648@smallexample
1649(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650bubble(double,double)    bubble(int,int)
1651(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652@end smallexample
1653
1654In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655quotes.  When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657place:
1658
1659@smallexample
1660(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663@end smallexample
1664
1665@noindent
1666In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}.  You can use the command @code{set
1672overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675@cindex completion of structure field names
1676@cindex structure field name completion
1677@cindex completion of union field names
1678@cindex union field name completion
1679When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions.  Also, it only
1682examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684left-hand-side:
1685
1686@smallexample
1687(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688magic                to_fputs             to_rewind
1689to_data              to_isatty            to_write
1690to_delete            to_put               to_write_async_safe
1691to_flush             to_read
1692@end smallexample
1693
1694@noindent
1695This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697follows:
1698
1699@smallexample
1700struct ui_file
1701@{
1702   int *magic;
1703   ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704   ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705   ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706   ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707   ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708   ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709   ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710   ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711   ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712   void *to_data;
1713@}
1714@end smallexample
1715
1716
1717@node Help
1718@section Getting Help
1719@cindex online documentation
1720@kindex help
1721
1722You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725@table @code
1726@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727@item help
1728@itemx h
1729You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732@smallexample
1733(@value{GDBP}) help
1734List of classes of commands:
1735
1736aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738data -- Examining data
1739files -- Specifying and examining files
1740internals -- Maintenance commands
1741obscure -- Obscure features
1742running -- Running the program
1743stack -- Examining the stack
1744status -- Status inquiries
1745support -- Support facilities
1746tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747               stopping the program
1748user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751commands in that class.
1752Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753documentation.
1754Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755(@value{GDBP})
1756@end smallexample
1757@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759@item help @var{class}
1760Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761list of the individual commands in that class.  For example, here is the
1762help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764@smallexample
1765(@value{GDBP}) help status
1766Status inquiries.
1767
1768List of commands:
1769
1770@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772info -- Generic command for showing things
1773        about the program being debugged
1774show -- Generic command for showing things
1775        about the debugger
1776
1777Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778documentation.
1779Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780(@value{GDBP})
1781@end smallexample
1782
1783@item help @var{command}
1784With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787@kindex apropos
1788@item apropos @var{args}
1789The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791@var{args}.  It prints out all matches found.  For example:
1792
1793@smallexample
1794apropos alias
1795@end smallexample
1796
1797@noindent
1798results in:
1799
1800@smallexample
1801@c @group
1802alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807@c @end group
1808@end smallexample
1809
1810@kindex complete
1811@item complete @var{args}
1812The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813for the beginning of a command.  Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814command you want completed.  For example:
1815
1816@smallexample
1817complete i
1818@end smallexample
1819
1820@noindent results in:
1821
1822@smallexample
1823@group
1824if
1825ignore
1826info
1827inspect
1828@end group
1829@end smallexample
1830
1831@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832@end table
1833
1834In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836of @value{GDBN} itself.  Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context.  The listings
1838under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839Function Index point to all the sub-commands.  @xref{Command and Variable
1840Index}.
1841
1842@c @group
1843@table @code
1844@kindex info
1845@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846@item info
1847This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848program.  For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852@w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854@kindex set
1855@item set
1856You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857@code{set}.  For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858@code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860@kindex show
1861@item show
1862In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863@value{GDBN} itself.
1864You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869@kindex info set
1870To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872@code{info set}.  Both commands produce the same display.
1873@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874@c FIXME...program.  Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876@end table
1877@c @end group
1878
1879Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882@table @code
1883@kindex show version
1884@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885@item show version
1886Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running.  You should include this
1887information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports.  If multiple versions of
1888@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away.  Also, many
1891system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894@value{GDBN}.
1895
1896@kindex show copying
1897@kindex info copying
1898@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899@item show copying
1900@itemx info copying
1901Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903@kindex show warranty
1904@kindex info warranty
1905@item show warranty
1906@itemx info warranty
1907Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910@kindex show configuration
1911@item show configuration
1912Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913when it was built.  This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914@file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915automatically by @command{configure}.  When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917your report.
1918
1919@end table
1920
1921@node Running
1922@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928of your choice.  If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930kill a child process.
1931
1932@menu
1933* Compilation::                 Compiling for debugging
1934* Starting::                    Starting your program
1935* Arguments::                   Your program's arguments
1936* Environment::                 Your program's environment
1937
1938* Working Directory::           Your program's working directory
1939* Input/Output::                Your program's input and output
1940* Attach::                      Debugging an already-running process
1941* Kill Process::                Killing the child process
1942
1943* Inferiors and Programs::      Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944* Threads::                     Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945* Forks::                       Debugging forks
1946* Checkpoint/Restart::          Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947@end menu
1948
1949@node Compilation
1950@section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953debugging information when you compile it.  This debugging information
1954is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959the compiler.
1960
1961Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option.  However, some
1963compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964together.  Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code.  We
1969recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970program.  You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971in pushing your luck.  For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information.  @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978expansion (@pxref{Macros}).  Most compilers do not include information
1979about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980the @option{-g} flag alone.  Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993@need 2000
1994@node Starting
1995@section Starting your Program
1996@cindex starting
1997@cindex running
1998
1999@table @code
2000@kindex run
2001@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002@item run
2003@itemx r
2004Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006@value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010@end table
2011
2012If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014that process run your program.  In some environments without processes,
2015@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.  Other targets,
2016like @samp{remote}, are always running.  If you get an error
2017message like this one:
2018
2019@smallexample
2020The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021Try "help target" or "continue".
2022@end smallexample
2023
2024@noindent
2025then use @code{continue} to run your program.  You may need @code{load}
2026first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029receives from its superior.  @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program.  (You
2031can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032your program the next time you start it.)  This information may be
2033divided into four categories:
2034
2035@table @asis
2036@item The @emph{arguments.}
2037Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038@code{run} command.  If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041the arguments.
2042In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043@code{SHELL} environment variable.  If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044@value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}).  You can disable
2045use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046below for details).
2047
2048@item The @emph{environment.}
2049Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052your program.  @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054@item The @emph{working directory.}
2055Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}.  You can set
2056the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061standard output as @value{GDBN} is using.  You can redirect input and output
2062in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063set a different device for your program.
2064@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066@cindex pipes
2067@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070wrong program.
2071@end table
2072
2073When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074immediately.  @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075of how to arrange for your program to stop.  Once your program has
2076stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077or @code{call} commands.  @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081table, and reads it again.  When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082your current breakpoints.
2083
2084@table @code
2085@kindex start
2086@item start
2087@cindex run to main procedure
2088The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091main procedure.  The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099@cindex elaboration phase
2100Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101executed before the main procedure is called.  This depends on the
2102languages used to write your program.  In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104@code{main} is called.  It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105before reaching the main procedure.  However, the temporary breakpoint
2106will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109@samp{start} command.  These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110underlying @samp{run} command.  Note that the same arguments will be
2111reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration.  In
2115these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117elaboration phase.  Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120@anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121@kindex set exec-wrapper
2122@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123@itemx show exec-wrapper
2124@itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126launch programs for debugging.  @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128@var{program}}.  Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130appropriate for your shell.  The wrapper runs until it executes
2131your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134its arguments as a wrapper.  Several standard Unix utilities do
2135this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}.  Any Unix shell script ending
2136with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140environment:
2141
2142@smallexample
2143(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144(@value{GDBP}) run
2145@end smallexample
2146
2147This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150@kindex set startup-with-shell
2151@item set startup-with-shell
2152@itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153@itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154@itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156@value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program.  Arguments of the
2157@code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159I/O.  In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161startup failures such as:
2162
2163@smallexample
2164(@value{GDBP}) run
2165Starting program: ./a.out
2166During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167@end smallexample
2168
2169@noindent
2170which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171@samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program.  Most often, this is
2172caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174$@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175@samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177@anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178@kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179@item set auto-connect-native-target
2180@itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181@itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182@itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185@code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine.  If you're
2187sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198@smallexample
2199(@value{GDBP}) run
2200Don't know how to run.  Try "help target".
2201@end smallexample
2202
2203If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207@code{target native} command.  For example,
2208
2209@smallexample
2210(@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211(@value{GDBP}) run
2212Don't know how to run.  Try "help target".
2213(@value{GDBP}) target native
2214(@value{GDBP}) run
2215Starting program: ./a.out
2216[Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217@end smallexample
2218
2219In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220@value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221the next @code{run} command.  Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222disconnect.
2223
2224Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225@code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228@kindex set disable-randomization
2229@item set disable-randomization
2230@itemx set disable-randomization on
2231This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232randomization of the virtual address space of the started program.  This option
2233is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239@smallexample
2240(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241@end smallexample
2242
2243@item set disable-randomization off
2244Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged.  Some bugs rear their
2245ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses.  If your bug
2246disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs.  Use @kbd{set
2249disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks.  In these
2253cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254code.  Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259having just unprivileged access at the target system.  Reading the shared
2260library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261misusing it.  Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263startup.  Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268a randomly chosen address upon startup.  PIE executables always load even
2269already prelinked shared libraries at a random address.  You can build such
2270executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273(as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275@item show disable-randomization
2276Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279@end table
2280
2281@node Arguments
2282@section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284@cindex arguments (to your program)
2285The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286@code{run} command.
2287They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program.  Your
2289@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290@value{GDBN} uses.  If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301@table @code
2302@kindex set args
2303@item set args
2304Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run.  If
2305@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306with no arguments.  Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308it again without arguments.
2309
2310@kindex show args
2311@item show args
2312Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313@end table
2314
2315@node Environment
2316@section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318@cindex environment (of your program)
2319The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320their values.  Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322path for programs to run.  Usually you set up environment variables with
2323the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run.  When
2324debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327@table @code
2328@kindex path
2329@item path @var{directory}
2330Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335MS-DOS and MS-Windows).  If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path.  If you
2340use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341@code{path} command.  @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343@var{directory} to the search path.
2344@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347@kindex show paths
2348@item show paths
2349Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350environment variable).
2351
2352@kindex show environment
2353@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355your program when it starts.  If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357your program.  You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359@kindex set environment
2360@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}.  The value
2362changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363it), not for @value{GDBN} itself.  The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365interpretation is supplied by your program itself.  The @var{value}
2366parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367null value.
2368@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371For example, this command:
2372
2373@smallexample
2374set env USER = foo
2375@end smallexample
2376
2377@noindent
2378tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379@samp{foo}.  (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380are not actually required.)
2381
2382Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}.  @xref{set
2386exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388@kindex unset environment
2389@item unset environment @var{varname}
2390Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391program.  This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394@end table
2395
2396@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not).  If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403affect your program.  You may wish to move setting of environment
2404variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405@file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407@node Working Directory
2408@section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410@cindex working directory (of your program)
2411Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419Specify Files}.
2420
2421@table @code
2422@kindex cd
2423@cindex change working directory
2424@item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.  If not
2426given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428@kindex pwd
2429@item pwd
2430Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431@end table
2432
2433It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435during its run).  If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440@node Input/Output
2441@section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443@cindex redirection
2444@cindex i/o
2445@cindex terminal
2446By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses.  @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450running your program.
2451
2452@table @code
2453@kindex info terminal
2454@item info terminal
2455Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456program is using.
2457@end table
2458
2459You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460redirection with the @code{run} command.  For example,
2461
2462@smallexample
2463run > outfile
2464@end smallexample
2465
2466@noindent
2467starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469@kindex tty
2470@cindex controlling terminal
2471Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472with the @code{tty} command.  This command accepts a file name as
2473argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474commands.  It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475process, for future @code{run} commands.  For example,
2476
2477@smallexample
2478tty /dev/ttyb
2479@end smallexample
2480
2481@noindent
2482directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488terminal.
2489
2490When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected.  The input
2492for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.  @code{tty} is an alias
2493for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495@cindex inferior tty
2496@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499program.
2500
2501@table @code
2502@item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2503@kindex set inferior-tty
2504Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}.  Omitting @var{tty}
2505restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2506@value{GDBN}.
2507
2508@item show inferior-tty
2509@kindex show inferior-tty
2510Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2511@end table
2512
2513@node Attach
2514@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2515@kindex attach
2516@cindex attach
2517
2518@table @code
2519@item attach @var{process-id}
2520This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2521outside @value{GDBN}.  (@code{info files} shows your active
2522targets.)  The command takes as argument a process ID.  The usual way to
2523find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2524or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2525
2526@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2527executing the command.
2528@end table
2529
2530To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2531which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2532programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system.  You must
2533also have permission to send the process a signal.
2534
2535When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2536the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2537the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2538(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}).  You can also use
2539the @code{file} command to load the program.  @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2540Specify Files}.
2541
2542The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2543process is to stop it.  You can examine and modify an attached process
2544with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2545you start processes with @code{run}.  You can insert breakpoints; you
2546can step and continue; you can modify storage.  If you would rather the
2547process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2548attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2549
2550@table @code
2551@kindex detach
2552@item detach
2553When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2554@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.  Detaching
2555the process continues its execution.  After the @code{detach} command,
2556that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2557are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2558@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2559executing the command.
2560@end table
2561
2562If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2563that process.  If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2564By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2565things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2566@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2567Messages}).
2568
2569@node Kill Process
2570@section Killing the Child Process
2571
2572@table @code
2573@kindex kill
2574@item kill
2575Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2576@end table
2577
2578This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2579running process.  @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2580is running.
2581
2582On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2583while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}.  You can use the
2584@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2585outside the debugger.
2586
2587The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2588relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2589executable file while it is running in a process.  In this case, when you
2590next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2591reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2592breakpoint settings).
2593
2594@node Inferiors and Programs
2595@section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2596
2597@value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2598session.  In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2599several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2600before starting another).  In the most general case, you can have
2601multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2602from multiple executables.
2603
2604@cindex inferior
2605@value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2606object called an @dfn{inferior}.  An inferior typically corresponds to
2607a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2608have processes.  Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2609may be retained after a process exits.  Inferiors have unique
2610identifiers that are different from process ids.  Usually each
2611inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2612embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2613of a single address space.  Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2614threads running in it.
2615
2616To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2617inferiors}}:
2618
2619@table @code
2620@kindex info inferiors
2621@item info inferiors
2622Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2623
2624@value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2625
2626@enumerate
2627@item
2628the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2629
2630@item
2631the target system's inferior identifier
2632
2633@item
2634the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2635
2636@end enumerate
2637
2638@noindent
2639An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2640indicates the current inferior.
2641
2642For example,
2643@end table
2644@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2645
2646@smallexample
2647(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2648  Num  Description       Executable
2649  2    process 2307      hello
2650* 1    process 3401      goodbye
2651@end smallexample
2652
2653To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2654
2655@table @code
2656@kindex inferior @var{infno}
2657@item inferior @var{infno}
2658Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior.  The argument
2659@var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2660in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2661@end table
2662
2663@vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2664The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2665number of the current inferior.  You may find this useful in writing
2666breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2667@xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2668information on convenience variables.
2669
2670You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2671@code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands.  On some
2672systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2673automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}.  To
2674remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2675@w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2676
2677@table @code
2678@kindex add-inferior
2679@item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2680Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2681executable; @var{n} defaults to 1.  If no executable is specified,
2682the inferiors begins empty, with no program.  You can still assign or
2683change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2684@code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2685
2686@kindex clone-inferior
2687@item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2688Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2689@var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2690number of the current inferior.  This is a convenient command when you
2691want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2692
2693@smallexample
2694(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2695  Num  Description       Executable
2696* 1    process 29964     helloworld
2697(@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2698Added inferior 2.
26991 inferiors added.
2700(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2701  Num  Description       Executable
2702  2    <null>            helloworld
2703* 1    process 29964     helloworld
2704@end smallexample
2705
2706You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2707
2708@kindex remove-inferiors
2709@item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2710Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}.  It is not
2711possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command.  For
2712those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2713
2714@end table
2715
2716To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2717inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2718inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2719using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2720
2721@table @code
2722@kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723@item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2724Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2725inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}.  Note that the inferior's entry
2726still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2727but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2728
2729@kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2730@item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2731Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2732number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}.  Note that the inferior's entry still
2733stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2734Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2735@end table
2736
2737After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2738@code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2739a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2740@code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2741
2742
2743To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2744control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2745
2746@table @code
2747@kindex set print inferior-events
2748@cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2749@item set print inferior-events
2750@itemx set print inferior-events on
2751@itemx set print inferior-events off
2752The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2753disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2754inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2755detached.  By default, these messages will not be printed.
2756
2757@kindex show print inferior-events
2758@item show print inferior-events
2759Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2760inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2761@end table
2762
2763Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2764single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2765value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2766
2767
2768Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2769get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2770spaces in a debug session.  You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2771info program-spaces}} command.
2772
2773@table @code
2774@kindex maint info program-spaces
2775@item maint info program-spaces
2776Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2777@value{GDBN}.
2778
2779@value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2780
2781@enumerate
2782@item
2783the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2784
2785@item
2786the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2787the @code{file} command.
2788
2789@end enumerate
2790
2791@noindent
2792An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2793indicates the current program space.
2794
2795In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2796information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form.  For
2797example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2798
2799@smallexample
2800(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2801  Id   Executable
2802* 1    hello
2803  2    goodbye
2804        Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2805@end smallexample
2806
2807Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2808while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}.  On
2809some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2810same program space.  The most common example is that of debugging both
2811the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call.  For example,
2812
2813@smallexample
2814(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2815  Id   Executable
2816* 1    vfork-test
2817        Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2818@end smallexample
2819
2820Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2821space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2822@end table
2823
2824@node Threads
2825@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2826
2827@cindex threads of execution
2828@cindex multiple threads
2829@cindex switching threads
2830In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2831may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution.  The precise semantics
2832of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2833the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2834that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2835modify the same variables).  On the other hand, each thread has its own
2836registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2837
2838@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2839programs:
2840
2841@itemize @bullet
2842@item automatic notification of new threads
2843@item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2844@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2845@item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2846a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2847@item thread-specific breakpoints
2848@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2849messages on thread start and exit.
2850@item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2851the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2852isn't compatible with the program.
2853@end itemize
2854
2855@cindex focus of debugging
2856@cindex current thread
2857The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2858threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2859control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2860This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}.  Debugging commands show
2861program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2862
2863@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2864@cindex thread identifier (system)
2865@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2866@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2867@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2868Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2869the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2870form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2871whose form varies depending on the particular system.  For example, on
2872@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2873
2874@smallexample
2875[New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2876@end smallexample
2877
2878@noindent
2879when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.  In contrast, on other systems,
2880the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2881further qualifier.
2882
2883@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2884@c         thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2885@c         second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2886@c         program?
2887@c         (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always?  Or do some
2888@c         multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2889@c         threads ab initio?
2890
2891@anchor{thread numbers}
2892@cindex thread number, per inferior
2893@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2894For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2895---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior.  This
2896number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2897between threads of different inferiors.
2898
2899@cindex qualified thread ID
2900You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2901@var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2902@dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2903number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2904inferior.  For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2905inferior 2.  If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2906then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2907inferior.
2908
2909Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
2910@var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
2911the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
2912of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
2913
2914@anchor{thread ID lists}
2915@cindex thread ID lists
2916Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
2917argument.  A list element can be:
2918
2919@enumerate
2920@item
2921A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
2922display, with or without an inferior qualifier.  E.g., @samp{2.1} or
2923@samp{1}.
2924
2925@item
2926A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
2927qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
2928@var{thr1}-@var{thr2}.  E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
2929
2930@item
2931All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
2932without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
2933@samp{1.*}) or @code{*}.  The former refers to all threads of the
2934given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
2935refers to all threads of the current inferior.
2936
2937@end enumerate
2938
2939For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
2940thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
2941includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
29427 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7.  That is, in
2943expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
29447.1}.
2945
2946
2947@anchor{global thread numbers}
2948@cindex global thread number
2949@cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
2950In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
2951assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
2952thread ID}, a single integer.  Unlike the thread number component of
2953the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
2954you're debugging multiple inferiors.
2955
2956From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2957thread.  In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2958program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2959
2960@vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2961@vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
2962The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
2963@samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
2964and the global thread number of the current thread.  You may find this
2965useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
2966and so forth.  @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
2967general information on convenience variables.
2968
2969If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
2970usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
2971the thread that hit the breakpoint.
2972
2973@smallexample
2974Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
2975@end smallexample
2976
2977Likewise when the program receives a signal:
2978
2979@smallexample
2980Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
2981@end smallexample
2982
2983@table @code
2984@kindex info threads
2985@item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
2986
2987Display information about one or more threads.  With no arguments
2988displays information about all threads.  You can specify the list of
2989threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
2990(@pxref{thread ID lists}).
2991
2992@value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2993
2994@enumerate
2995@item
2996the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2997
2998@item
2999the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3000option was specified
3001
3002@item
3003the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3004
3005@item
3006the thread's name, if one is known.  A thread can either be named by
3007the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3008program itself.
3009
3010@item
3011the current stack frame summary for that thread
3012@end enumerate
3013
3014@noindent
3015An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3016indicates the current thread.
3017
3018For example,
3019@end table
3020@c end table here to get a little more width for example
3021
3022@smallexample
3023(@value{GDBP}) info threads
3024  Id   Target Id         Frame
3025* 1    process 35 thread 13  main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3026  2    process 35 thread 23  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3027  3    process 35 thread 27  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3028    at threadtest.c:68
3029@end smallexample
3030
3031If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3032IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3033Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3034
3035If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3036indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3037
3038@smallexample
3039(@value{GDBP}) info threads
3040  Id   GId  Target Id             Frame
3041  1.1  1    process 35 thread 13  main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3042  1.2  3    process 35 thread 23  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3043  1.3  4    process 35 thread 27  0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3044* 2.1  2    process 65 thread 1   main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3045@end smallexample
3046
3047On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3048Solaris-specific command:
3049
3050@table @code
3051@item maint info sol-threads
3052@kindex maint info sol-threads
3053@cindex thread info (Solaris)
3054Display info on Solaris user threads.
3055@end table
3056
3057@table @code
3058@kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3059@item thread @var{thread-id}
3060Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread.  The command
3061argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3062the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3063inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3064
3065@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3066thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3067
3068@smallexample
3069(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3070[Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3071#0  some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
30728	    printf ("hello\n");
3073@end smallexample
3074
3075@noindent
3076As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3077@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3078threads.
3079
3080@kindex thread apply
3081@cindex apply command to several threads
3082@item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3083The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3084@var{command} to one or more threads.  Specify the threads that you
3085want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3086lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads.  To apply a
3087command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3088@var{command}}.  To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3089type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3090
3091
3092@kindex thread name
3093@cindex name a thread
3094@item thread name [@var{name}]
3095This command assigns a name to the current thread.  If no argument is
3096given, any existing user-specified name is removed.  The thread name
3097appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3098
3099On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3100determine the name of the thread as given by the OS.  On these
3101systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3102system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3103@value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3104
3105@kindex thread find
3106@cindex search for a thread
3107@item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3108Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3109matches the supplied regular expression.
3110
3111As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3112this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3113@var{systag}.  For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3114is the LWP id.
3115
3116@smallexample
3117(@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3118Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3119(@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3120  Id   Target Id         Frame
3121  4    Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3122@end smallexample
3123
3124@kindex set print thread-events
3125@cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3126@item set print thread-events
3127@itemx set print thread-events on
3128@itemx set print thread-events off
3129The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3130disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3131started or that threads have exited.  By default, these messages will
3132be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3133Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3134
3135@kindex show print thread-events
3136@item show print thread-events
3137Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3138have started and exited.
3139@end table
3140
3141@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3142more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3143programs with multiple threads.
3144
3145@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3146watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3147
3148@anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3149@table @code
3150@kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3151@cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3152@item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3153If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3154directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3155If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3156its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3157Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3158macro.
3159
3160On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3161@code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3162inferior process.  @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3163to find @code{libthread_db}.  @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3164specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3165by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3166
3167A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3168refers to the default system directories that are
3169normally searched for loading shared libraries.  The @samp{$sdir} entry
3170is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3171(@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3172
3173A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3174refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3175was loaded in the inferior process.
3176
3177For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3178@value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3179If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3180mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3181will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3182If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3183@value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3184
3185Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3186only on some platforms.
3187
3188@kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3189@item show libthread-db-search-path
3190Display current libthread_db search path.
3191
3192@kindex set debug libthread-db
3193@kindex show debug libthread-db
3194@cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3195@item set debug libthread-db
3196@itemx show debug libthread-db
3197Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3198Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3199@end table
3200
3201@node Forks
3202@section Debugging Forks
3203
3204@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3205@cindex multiple processes
3206@cindex processes, multiple
3207On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3208programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3209function.  When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3210parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.  If you have
3211set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3212will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3213will cause it to terminate.
3214
3215However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3216which isn't too painful.  Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3217the child process executes after the fork.  It may be useful to sleep
3218only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3219so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3220on the child.  While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3221get its process ID.  Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3222@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3223the child process (@pxref{Attach}).  From that point on you can debug
3224the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3225
3226On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3227that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3228functions.  On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3229with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3230
3231The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3232connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3233@code{target extended-remote} mode.
3234
3235By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3236the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3237
3238If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3239use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3240
3241@table @code
3242@kindex set follow-fork-mode
3243@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3244Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3245@code{vfork}.  A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3246process.  The @var{mode} argument can be:
3247
3248@table @code
3249@item parent
3250The original process is debugged after a fork.  The child process runs
3251unimpeded.  This is the default.
3252
3253@item child
3254The new process is debugged after a fork.  The parent process runs
3255unimpeded.
3256
3257@end table
3258
3259@kindex show follow-fork-mode
3260@item show follow-fork-mode
3261Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3262@end table
3263
3264@cindex debugging multiple processes
3265On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3266command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3267
3268@table @code
3269@kindex set detach-on-fork
3270@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3271Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3272retain debugger control over them both.
3273
3274@table @code
3275@item on
3276The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3277@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3278independently.  This is the default.
3279
3280@item off
3281Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3282One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3283@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3284is held suspended.
3285
3286@end table
3287
3288@kindex show detach-on-fork
3289@item show detach-on-fork
3290Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3291@end table
3292
3293If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3294will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3295You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3296using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3297to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3298Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3299
3300To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3301from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3302to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3303command.  @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3304and Programs}.
3305
3306If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3307@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3308breakpoint in the new target.  If you have a breakpoint set on
3309@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3310the child process's @code{main}.
3311
3312On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3313cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3314
3315If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3316call executes, the new target restarts.  To restart the parent
3317process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3318as its argument.  By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3319@value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3320You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3321command.
3322
3323@table @code
3324@kindex set follow-exec-mode
3325@item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3326
3327Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}.  An
3328@code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3329
3330@code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3331
3332@table @code
3333@item new
3334@value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3335new inferior.  The program the process was running before the
3336@code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3337original inferior.
3338
3339For example:
3340
3341@smallexample
3342(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3343(gdb) info inferior
3344  Id   Description   Executable
3345* 1    <null>        prog1
3346(@value{GDBP}) run
3347process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3348Program exited normally.
3349(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3350  Id   Description   Executable
3351  1    <null>        prog1
3352* 2    <null>        prog2
3353@end smallexample
3354
3355@item same
3356@value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior.  The new
3357executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3358inferior.  Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3359e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3360running after the @code{exec} call.  This is the default mode.
3361
3362For example:
3363
3364@smallexample
3365(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3366  Id   Description   Executable
3367* 1    <null>        prog1
3368(@value{GDBP}) run
3369process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3370Program exited normally.
3371(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3372  Id   Description   Executable
3373* 1    <null>        prog2
3374@end smallexample
3375
3376@end table
3377@end table
3378
3379@code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3380@code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3383a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made.  @xref{Set
3384Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3385
3386@node Checkpoint/Restart
3387@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3388
3389@cindex checkpoint
3390@cindex restart
3391@cindex bookmark
3392@cindex snapshot of a process
3393@cindex rewind program state
3394
3395On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3396@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3397program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3398later.
3399
3400Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3401happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved.  This
3402includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3403system state.  Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3404moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3405
3406Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3407getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3408a checkpoint.  Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3409the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3410from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3411start again from there.
3412
3413This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3414steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3415
3416To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3417
3418@table @code
3419@kindex checkpoint
3420@item checkpoint
3421Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3422The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3423is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3424
3425@kindex info checkpoints
3426@item info checkpoints
3427List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3428session.  For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3429listed:
3430
3431@table @code
3432@item Checkpoint ID
3433@item Process ID
3434@item Code Address
3435@item Source line, or label
3436@end table
3437
3438@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3439@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3440Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3441@var{checkpoint-id}.  All program variables, registers, stack frames
3442etc.@:  will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3443was saved.  In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3444in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3445
3446Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3447are not affected by restoring a checkpoint.  In general, a checkpoint
3448only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3449the debugger.
3450
3451@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3452@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3453Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3454
3455@end table
3456
3457Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3458of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3459(OS) state, including file pointers.  It won't ``un-write'' data from
3460a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3461so that the previously written data can be overwritten.  For files
3462opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3463previously read data can be read again.
3464
3465Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3466external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3467from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3468but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3469be received again.  Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3470been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3471
3472However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3473program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3474again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3475different execution path this time.
3476
3477@cindex checkpoints and process id
3478Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3479different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3480id.  Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3481and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3482If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3483potentially pose a problem.
3484
3485@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3486
3487On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3488is performed on new processes for security reasons.  This makes it
3489difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3490absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3491absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3492next.
3493
3494A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3495Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3496and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3497process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3498your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3499
3500@node Stopping
3501@chapter Stopping and Continuing
3502
3503The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3504program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3505trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3506
3507Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3508such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3509@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}.  You may then examine and
3510change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3511continue execution.  Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3512ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3513explicitly request this information at any time.
3514
3515@table @code
3516@kindex info program
3517@item info program
3518Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3519running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3520@end table
3521
3522@menu
3523* Breakpoints::                 Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3524* Continuing and Stepping::     Resuming execution
3525* Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3526                                Skipping over functions and files
3527* Signals::                     Signals
3528* Thread Stops::                Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3529@end menu
3530
3531@node Breakpoints
3532@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3533
3534@cindex breakpoints
3535A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3536the program is reached.  For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3537control in finer detail whether your program stops.  You can set
3538breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3539Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3540should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3541program.
3542
3543On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3544the executable is run.
3545
3546@cindex watchpoints
3547@cindex data breakpoints
3548@cindex memory tracing
3549@cindex breakpoint on memory address
3550@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3551A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3552when the value of an expression changes.  The expression may be a value
3553of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3554combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}.  This is sometimes called
3555@dfn{data breakpoints}.  You must use a different command to set
3556watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3557from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3558enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3559same commands.
3560
3561You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3562whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint.  @xref{Auto Display,,
3563Automatic Display}.
3564
3565@cindex catchpoints
3566@cindex breakpoint on events
3567A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3568when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3569exception or the loading of a library.  As with watchpoints, you use a
3570different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3571Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3572other breakpoint.  (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3573@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3574
3575@cindex breakpoint numbers
3576@cindex numbers for breakpoints
3577@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3578catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3579starting with one.  In many of the commands for controlling various
3580features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3581breakpoint you want to change.  Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3582@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3583enable it again.
3584
3585@cindex breakpoint ranges
3586@cindex ranges of breakpoints
3587Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3588operate.  A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3589@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3590hyphen, like @samp{5-7}.  When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3591all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3592
3593@menu
3594* Set Breaks::                  Setting breakpoints
3595* Set Watchpoints::             Setting watchpoints
3596* Set Catchpoints::             Setting catchpoints
3597* Delete Breaks::               Deleting breakpoints
3598* Disabling::                   Disabling breakpoints
3599* Conditions::                  Break conditions
3600* Break Commands::              Breakpoint command lists
3601* Dynamic Printf::              Dynamic printf
3602* Save Breakpoints::            How to save breakpoints in a file
3603* Static Probe Points::         Listing static probe points
3604* Error in Breakpoints::        ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3605* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3606@end menu
3607
3608@node Set Breaks
3609@subsection Setting Breakpoints
3610
3611@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3612@c       consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3613@c
3614@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3615
3616@kindex break
3617@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3618@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3619@cindex latest breakpoint
3620Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3621@code{b}).  The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3622number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3623Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3624convenience variables.
3625
3626@table @code
3627@item break @var{location}
3628Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3629function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3630(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3631specify a @var{location}.)  The breakpoint will stop your program just
3632before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3633
3634When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3635C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3636@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3637that situation.
3638
3639It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3640only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3641or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3642
3643@item break
3644When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3645the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3646(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}).  In any selected frame but the
3647innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3648returns to that frame.  This is similar to the effect of a
3649@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3650that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint.  If you use
3651@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3652the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3653inside loops.
3654
3655@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3656least one instruction has been executed.  If it did not do this, you
3657would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3658breakpoint.  This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3659existed when your program stopped.
3660
3661@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3662Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3663@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3664value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3665@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3666above (or no argument) specifying where to break.  @xref{Conditions,
3667,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3668
3669@kindex tbreak
3670@item tbreak @var{args}
3671Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  The @var{args} are the
3672same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3673way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3674program stops there.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3675
3676@kindex hbreak
3677@cindex hardware breakpoints
3678@item hbreak @var{args}
3679Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint.  The @var{args} are the same as for the
3680@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3681breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3682have this support.  The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3683debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3684changing the instruction.  This can be used with the new trap-generation
3685provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets.  These targets
3686will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3687address that is assigned to the debug registers.  However the hardware
3688breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints.  For
3689example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3690@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used.  Delete
3691or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3692(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3693@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3694For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3695breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3696hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3697
3698@kindex thbreak
3699@item thbreak @var{args}
3700Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop.  The @var{args}
3701are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3702the same way.  However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3703the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3704first time your program stops there.  Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3705command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3706may not have this support.  @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3707See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3708
3709@kindex rbreak
3710@cindex regular expression
3711@cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3712@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3713@item rbreak @var{regex}
3714Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3715@var{regex}.  This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3716matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set.  Once these
3717breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3718the @code{break} command.  You can delete them, disable them, or make
3719them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3720
3721The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3722like @file{grep}.  Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3723shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3724an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s.  There is an implicit
3725@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3726match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3727
3728@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3729When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3730breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3731classes.
3732
3733@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3734The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3735@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3736
3737@smallexample
3738(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3739@end smallexample
3740
3741@item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3742If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3743the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3744specified @var{file}.  This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3745every function in a given file:
3746
3747@smallexample
3748(@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3749@end smallexample
3750
3751The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3752optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3753
3754@kindex info breakpoints
3755@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3756@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3757@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3758Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3759not deleted.  Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3760about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3761For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3762
3763@table @emph
3764@item Breakpoint Numbers
3765@item Type
3766Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3767@item Disposition
3768Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3769@item Enabled or Disabled
3770Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}.  @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3771that are not enabled.
3772@item Address
3773Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.  For a
3774pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3775contain @samp{<PENDING>}.  Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3776library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3777See below for details.  A breakpoint with several locations will
3778have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3779@item What
3780Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3781line number.  For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3782the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3783the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3784@end table
3785
3786@noindent
3787If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3788``target''.  If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3789@value{GDBN} on the host's side.  If it is ``target'', then the condition
3790is evaluated by the target.  The @code{info break} command shows
3791the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3792its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3793
3794Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that.  A pending breakpoint is
3795allowed to have a condition specified for it.  The condition is not parsed for
3796validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3797breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3798
3799@noindent
3800@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3801number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint.  The
3802convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3803the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3804listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3805
3806@noindent
3807@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3808has been hit.  This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3809@code{ignore} command.  You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3810hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3811was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number.  This
3812will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3813
3814@noindent
3815For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3816@code{info break} also displays that count.
3817
3818@end table
3819
3820@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3821your program.  There is nothing silly or meaningless about this.  When
3822the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3823(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3824
3825@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3826@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3827It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3828in your program.  Examples of this situation are:
3829
3830@itemize @bullet
3831@item
3832Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3833
3834@item
3835For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3836instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3837
3838@item
3839For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3840correspond to any number of instantiations.
3841
3842@item
3843For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3844several places where that function is inlined.
3845@end itemize
3846
3847In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3848the relevant locations.
3849
3850A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3851table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3852each breakpoint location.  The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3853address column.  The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3854addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3855locations belong.  The number column for a location is of the form
3856@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3857
3858For example:
3859
3860@smallexample
3861Num     Type           Disp Enb  Address    What
38621       breakpoint     keep y    <MULTIPLE>
3863        stop only if i==1
3864        breakpoint already hit 1 time
38651.1                         y    0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
38661.2                         y    0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3867@end smallexample
3868
3869Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3870@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3871@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands.  Note that you cannot
3872delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3873entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3874the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3875the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example).  Disabling or enabling
3876the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3877that belong to that breakpoint.
3878
3879@cindex pending breakpoints
3880It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3881Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3882and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed.  To support
3883this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3884any shared library is loaded or unloaded.  Typically, you would
3885set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3886debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3887symbols from the library are not available.  When you try to set
3888breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3889a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3890is not yet resolved.
3891
3892After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3893@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints.  When a newly loaded
3894shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3895pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3896ordinary breakpoint.  When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3897that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3898
3899This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too.  For
3900example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3901a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3902a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3903
3904Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3905differ from regular breakpoints.  You can set conditions or commands,
3906enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3907
3908@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3909happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3910address specification to an address:
3911
3912@kindex set breakpoint pending
3913@kindex show breakpoint pending
3914@table @code
3915@item set breakpoint pending auto
3916This is the default behavior.  When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3917location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3918
3919@item set breakpoint pending on
3920This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3921result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3922
3923@item set breakpoint pending off
3924This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created.  Any
3925unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error.  This setting does
3926not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3927
3928@item show breakpoint pending
3929Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3930@end table
3931
3932The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3933variants.  Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3934as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3935
3936@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3937For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3938software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3939breakpoint address is read-only or read-write.  This applies to
3940breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3941breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}.  For
3942breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3943breakpoints.
3944
3945You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3946
3947@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3948@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3949@table @code
3950@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3951This is the default behavior.  When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3952will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3953breakpoint must be used.
3954
3955@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3956This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3957type.  If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3958trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3959@end table
3960
3961@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3962at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3963executed, given control to the debugger.  By default, the program
3964code is so modified only when the program is resumed.  As soon as
3965the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions.  This
3966behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3967target should gdb abrubptly disconnect.  However, with slow remote
3968targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3969This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3970
3971@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3972@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3973@table @code
3974@item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3975All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3976the target only when the target is resumed.  All breakpoints are
3977removed from the target when it stops.  This is the default mode.
3978
3979@item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3980Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times.  If
3981the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3982breakpoints in the target are updated immediately.  A breakpoint is
3983removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3984@end table
3985
3986@value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3987when a breakpoint breaks.  If the condition is true, then the process being
3988debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3989
3990If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3991download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3992
3993This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3994
3995@kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3996@kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3997@table @code
3998@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3999This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4000conditions on the host's side.  Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4001the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4002for condition evaluation.  This is the standard evaluation mode.
4003
4004@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4005This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4006to the target at the moment of their insertion.  The target
4007is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4008breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4009is true.  Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4010cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4011that is only known to the host.  Examples include
4012conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4013that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4014that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4015target is a remote system.  In these cases, the conditions will be
4016evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4017
4018@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4019This is the default mode.  If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4020conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4021the target (limitations mentioned previously apply).  If the target does
4022not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4023to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4024@end table
4025
4026
4027@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4028@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4029@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4030special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4031programs).  These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4032starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4033You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4034@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4035
4036
4037@node Set Watchpoints
4038@subsection Setting Watchpoints
4039
4040@cindex setting watchpoints
4041You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4042expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4043this may happen.  (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4044The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4045as complex as many variables combined by operators.  Examples include:
4046
4047@itemize @bullet
4048@item
4049A reference to the value of a single variable.
4050
4051@item
4052An address cast to an appropriate data type.  For example,
4053@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4054address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4055
4056@item
4057An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}.  The
4058expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4059language (@pxref{Languages}).
4060@end itemize
4061
4062You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4063not be evaluated yet.  For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4064@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4065@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4066the expression produces a valid value.  If the expression becomes
4067valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4068pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4069@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4070the expression changes.
4071
4072@cindex software watchpoints
4073@cindex hardware watchpoints
4074Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4075hardware.  @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4076program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4077times slower than normal execution.  (But this may still be worth it, to
4078catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4079culprit.)
4080
4081On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4082@value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4083slow down the running of your program.
4084
4085@table @code
4086@kindex watch
4087@item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4088Set a watchpoint for an expression.  @value{GDBN} will break when the
4089expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4090changes.  The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4091to watch the value of a single variable:
4092
4093@smallexample
4094(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4095@end smallexample
4096
4097If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4098argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4099@var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}.  If any other threads
4100change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break.  Note
4101that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4102with Hardware Watchpoints.
4103
4104Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4105(see below).  The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4106instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}.  In this case,
4107@value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4108and watch the memory at that address.  The type of the result is used
4109to determine the size of the watched memory.  If the expression's
4110result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4111error.
4112
4113The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4114of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4115feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4116Embedded}.)  A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4117to an address to watch.  The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4118(the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4119the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4120Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4121addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4122watchpoint address.  The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4123Examples:
4124
4125@smallexample
4126(@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4127(@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4128@end smallexample
4129
4130@kindex rwatch
4131@item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4132Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4133by the program.
4134
4135@kindex awatch
4136@item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4137Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4138or written into by the program.
4139
4140@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4141@item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4142This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4143@code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4144@end table
4145
4146If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4147dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4148never change.  @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4149a never-changing value:
4150
4151@smallexample
4152(@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4153Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4154(@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4155Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4156@end smallexample
4157
4158@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible.  Hardware
4159watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4160value at the exact instruction where the change occurs.  If @value{GDBN}
4161cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4162executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4163@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4164
4165@cindex use only software watchpoints
4166You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4167@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command.  With this variable set to
4168zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4169the underlying system supports them.  (Note that hardware-assisted
4170watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4171@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4172mechanism of watching expression values.)
4173
4174@table @code
4175@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4176@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4177Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4178
4179@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4180@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4181Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4182@end table
4183
4184For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4185watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4186hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4187
4188When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4189
4190@smallexample
4191Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4192@end smallexample
4193
4194@noindent
4195if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4196
4197Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4198hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4199value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4200every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4201that currently.  If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4202hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4203will print a message like this:
4204
4205@smallexample
4206Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4207@end smallexample
4208
4209Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4210data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4211watchpoint on the target machine can handle.  For example, some systems
4212can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4213cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4214double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4215wide).  As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4216into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4217
4218If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4219to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4220Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4221time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4222able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4223warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4224
4225@smallexample
4226Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4227@end smallexample
4228
4229@noindent
4230If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4231
4232Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4233exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4234That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4235expression with separately allocated resources.
4236
4237If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4238any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4239kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4240
4241@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4242(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4243they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4244which these variables were defined.  In particular, when the program
4245being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4246and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set.  If you
4247rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again.  One
4248way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4249@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4250
4251@cindex watchpoints and threads
4252@cindex threads and watchpoints
4253In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4254watched expression from every thread.
4255
4256@quotation
4257@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4258have only limited usefulness.  If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4259watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4260single thread}.  If you are confident that the expression can only
4261change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4262confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4263software watchpoints as usual.  However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4264when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression.  (Hardware
4265watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4266@end quotation
4267
4268@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4269
4270@node Set Catchpoints
4271@subsection Setting Catchpoints
4272@cindex catchpoints, setting
4273@cindex exception handlers
4274@cindex event handling
4275
4276You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4277kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4278shared library.  Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4279
4280@table @code
4281@kindex catch
4282@item catch @var{event}
4283Stop when @var{event} occurs.  The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4284
4285@table @code
4286@item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4287@itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4288@itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4289@kindex catch throw
4290@kindex catch rethrow
4291@kindex catch catch
4292@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4293The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4294
4295If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4296regular expression will be caught.
4297
4298@vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4299The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4300exception-related catchpoint, on some systems.  This holds the
4301exception being thrown.
4302
4303There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4304@value{GDBN}:
4305
4306@itemize @bullet
4307@item
4308The support for these commands is system-dependent.  Currently, only
4309systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4310supported.
4311
4312@item
4313The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4314variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4315If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4316These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4317or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4318built.
4319
4320@item
4321The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4322instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4323
4324@item
4325When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4326location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4327support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}.  You can use @code{up}
4328(@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4329
4330@item
4331If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4332control to you when the function has finished executing.  If the call
4333raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4334returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4335simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4336that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits.  This is the case even if
4337you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4338disabled within interactive calls.  @xref{Calling}, for information on
4339controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4340
4341@item
4342You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4343
4344@item
4345You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4346@end itemize
4347
4348@item exception
4349@kindex catch exception
4350@cindex Ada exception catching
4351@cindex catch Ada exceptions
4352An Ada exception being raised.  If an exception name is specified
4353at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4354the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4355Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4356
4357When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4358name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4359fully qualified name must be used as the exception name.  Otherwise,
4360@value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4361rather than the user-defined one.  For instance, assuming an exception
4362called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4363the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4364Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4365
4366@item exception unhandled
4367@kindex catch exception unhandled
4368An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4369
4370@item assert
4371@kindex catch assert
4372A failed Ada assertion.
4373
4374@item exec
4375@kindex catch exec
4376@cindex break on fork/exec
4377A call to @code{exec}.
4378
4379@item syscall
4380@itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4381@kindex catch syscall
4382@cindex break on a system call.
4383A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}.  A
4384syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4385from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4386@value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4387debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall.  If no
4388argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4389will be caught.
4390
4391@var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4392underlying OS.  Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS.  On
4393GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4394names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4395
4396@c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4397@c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4398@c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4399@c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4400
4401Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4402each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4403facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4404available choices.
4405
4406You may also specify the system call numerically.  A syscall's
4407number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4408identify the requested service.  When you specify the syscall by its
4409name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4410into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4411may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4412list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4413behind the OS upgrades).
4414
4415You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4416the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent).  For
4417instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4418network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4419to @code{catch syscall}.  Note that not all syscall groups are
4420available in every system.  You can use the command completion
4421facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4422syscall groups available on your environment.
4423
4424The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4425arguments to it:
4426
4427@smallexample
4428(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4429Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4430(@value{GDBP}) r
4431Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4432
4433Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4434	   0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4435(@value{GDBP}) c
4436Continuing.
4437
4438Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4439	0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4440(@value{GDBP})
4441@end smallexample
4442
4443Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4444
4445@smallexample
4446(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4447Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4448(@value{GDBP}) r
4449Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4450
4451Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4452		   0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4453(@value{GDBP}) c
4454Continuing.
4455
4456Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4457	0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4458(@value{GDBP})
4459@end smallexample
4460
4461An example of specifying a system call numerically.  In the case
4462below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4463file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4464
4465@smallexample
4466(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4467Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4468(@value{GDBP}) r
4469Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4470
4471Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4472		   0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4473(@value{GDBP}) c
4474Continuing.
4475
4476Program exited normally.
4477(@value{GDBP})
4478@end smallexample
4479
4480Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4481
4482@smallexample
4483(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4484Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4485'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4486'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4487(@value{GDBP}) r
4488Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4489
4490Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4491   from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4492
4493(@value{GDBP}) c
4494Continuing.
4495@end smallexample
4496
4497However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4498in XML file for that syscall number.  In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4499a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4500but the catchpoint will be set anyway.  See the example below:
4501
4502@smallexample
4503(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4504warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4505Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4506(@value{GDBP})
4507@end smallexample
4508
4509If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4510it will not be able to display syscall names.  Also, if your
4511architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4512you will not be able to see the syscall names.  It is important to
4513notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4514name database.  In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4515
4516@smallexample
4517(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4518warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4519warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4520GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4521Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4522(@value{GDBP})
4523@end smallexample
4524
4525Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4526
4527Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4528number.  In this case, you would see something like:
4529
4530@smallexample
4531(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4532Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4533@end smallexample
4534
4535Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4536
4537@item fork
4538@kindex catch fork
4539A call to @code{fork}.
4540
4541@item vfork
4542@kindex catch vfork
4543A call to @code{vfork}.
4544
4545@item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4546@itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4547@kindex catch load
4548@kindex catch unload
4549The loading or unloading of a shared library.  If @var{regexp} is
4550given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4551matches one of the affected libraries.
4552
4553@item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4554@kindex catch signal
4555The delivery of a signal.
4556
4557With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4558used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4559@samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4560
4561With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4562@value{GDBN}, will be caught.  This argument cannot be used with other
4563signal names.
4564
4565Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4566@code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}).  Only signals specified in this list
4567will be caught.
4568
4569One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4570@code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4571catchpoint.
4572
4573When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4574@code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4575However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4576on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4577commands.
4578
4579@end table
4580
4581@item tcatch @var{event}
4582@kindex tcatch
4583Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop.  The catchpoint is
4584automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4585
4586@end table
4587
4588Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4589
4590
4591@node Delete Breaks
4592@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4593
4594@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4595@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4596It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4597catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4598to stop there.  This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint.  A
4599breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4600
4601With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4602where they are in your program.  With the @code{delete} command you can
4603delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4604their breakpoint numbers.
4605
4606It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it.  @value{GDBN}
4607automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4608when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4609
4610@table @code
4611@kindex clear
4612@item clear
4613Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4614selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}).  When
4615the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4616breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4617
4618@item clear @var{location}
4619Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4620@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4621most useful ones are listed below:
4622
4623@table @code
4624@item clear @var{function}
4625@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4626Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4627
4628@item clear @var{linenum}
4629@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4630Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4631@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4632@end table
4633
4634@cindex delete breakpoints
4635@kindex delete
4636@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4637@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4638Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4639ranges specified as arguments.  If no argument is specified, delete all
4640breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4641confirm off}).  You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4642@end table
4643
4644@node Disabling
4645@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4646
4647@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4648Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4649prefer to @dfn{disable} it.  This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4650it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4651that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4652
4653You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4654the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4655one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments.  Use @code{info break} to
4656print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4657do not know which numbers to use.
4658
4659Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4660affects all of its locations.
4661
4662A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4663different states of enablement:
4664
4665@itemize @bullet
4666@item
4667Enabled.  The breakpoint stops your program.  A breakpoint set
4668with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4669@item
4670Disabled.  The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4671@item
4672Enabled once.  The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4673disabled.
4674@item
4675Enabled for a count.  The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4676N times, then becomes disabled.
4677@item
4678Enabled for deletion.  The breakpoint stops your program, but
4679immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently.  A breakpoint
4680set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4681@end itemize
4682
4683You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4684watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4685
4686@table @code
4687@kindex disable
4688@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4689@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4690Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4691listed.  A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten.  All
4692options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4693case the breakpoint is enabled again later.  You may abbreviate
4694@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4695
4696@kindex enable
4697@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4698Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints).  They
4699become effective once again in stopping your program.
4700
4701@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4702Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily.  @value{GDBN} disables any
4703of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4704
4705@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4706Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily.  @value{GDBN} records
4707@var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4708breakpoint's count when it is hit.  When any count reaches 0,
4709@value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint.  If a breakpoint has an ignore
4710count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4711decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4712
4713@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4714Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die.  @value{GDBN}
4715deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4716Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4717@end table
4718
4719@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4720@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4721Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4722,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4723subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4724the commands above.  (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4725breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4726breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4727Stepping}.)
4728
4729@node Conditions
4730@subsection Break Conditions
4731@cindex conditional breakpoints
4732@cindex breakpoint conditions
4733
4734@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr?  Context where wanted?
4735@c      in particular for a watchpoint?
4736The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4737specified place.  You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4738breakpoint.  A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4739programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  A breakpoint with
4740a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4741and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4742
4743This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4744situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4745when the condition is false.  In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4746by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4747@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4748
4749Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4750since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4751it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4752and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4753one.
4754
4755Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4756your program.  This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4757that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4758format special data structures.  The effects are completely predictable
4759unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address.  (In
4760that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4761program without checking the condition of this one.)  Note that
4762breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4763conditions for the
4764purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4765(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4766
4767Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4768the target supports it.  Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4769@value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4770(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4771independently of @value{GDBN}.  Global variables become raw memory
4772locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4773
4774In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4775when its condition evaluates to true.  This mechanism may provide faster
4776response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4777since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4778every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4779
4780Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4781@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command.  @xref{Set
4782Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.  They can also be changed at any time
4783with the @code{condition} command.
4784
4785You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4786The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4787@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4788catchpoint.
4789
4790@table @code
4791@kindex condition
4792@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4793Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4794watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}.  After you set a condition,
4795breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4796@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C).  When you use
4797@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4798syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4799referents in the context of your breakpoint.  If @var{expression} uses
4800symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4801prints an error message:
4802
4803@smallexample
4804No symbol "foo" in current context.
4805@end smallexample
4806
4807@noindent
4808@value{GDBN} does
4809not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4810command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4811@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4812
4813@item condition @var{bnum}
4814Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}.  It becomes
4815an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4816@end table
4817
4818@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4819A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4820breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times.  This is so
4821useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4822count} of the breakpoint.  Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4823is an integer.  Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4824therefore has no effect.  But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4825ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4826the ignore count by one and continues.  As a result, if the ignore count
4827value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4828your program reaches it.
4829
4830@table @code
4831@kindex ignore
4832@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4833Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4834The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4835execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4836takes no action.
4837
4838To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4839a count of zero.
4840
4841When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4842breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4843@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}.  @xref{Continuing and
4844Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4845
4846If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4847condition is not checked.  Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4848@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4849
4850You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4851as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4852is decremented each time.  @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4853Variables}.
4854@end table
4855
4856Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4857
4858
4859@node Break Commands
4860@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4861
4862@cindex breakpoint commands
4863You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4864commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint.  For
4865example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4866enable other breakpoints.
4867
4868@table @code
4869@kindex commands
4870@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4871@item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4872@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4873@itemx end
4874Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints.  The commands
4875themselves appear on the following lines.  Type a line containing just
4876@code{end} to terminate the commands.
4877
4878To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4879follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4880
4881With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4882watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4883encountered).  If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4884command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4885set by that command.  This applies to breakpoints set by
4886@code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4887creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4888Expressions}).
4889@end table
4890
4891Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4892disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4893
4894You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again.  Simply
4895use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4896that resumes execution.
4897
4898Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4899execution, are ignored.  This is because any time you resume execution
4900(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4901another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4902ambiguities about which list to execute.
4903
4904@kindex silent
4905If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4906usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed.  This may
4907be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4908then continue.  If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4909see no sign that the breakpoint was reached.  @code{silent} is
4910meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4911
4912The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4913print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4914breakpoints.  @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4915
4916For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4917value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4918
4919@smallexample
4920break foo if x>0
4921commands
4922silent
4923printf "x is %d\n",x
4924cont
4925end
4926@end smallexample
4927
4928One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4929you can test for another.  Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4930of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4931erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4932to any variables that need them.  End with the @code{continue} command
4933so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4934command so that no output is produced.  Here is an example:
4935
4936@smallexample
4937break 403
4938commands
4939silent
4940set x = y + 4
4941cont
4942end
4943@end smallexample
4944
4945@node Dynamic Printf
4946@subsection Dynamic Printf
4947
4948@cindex dynamic printf
4949@cindex dprintf
4950The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4951formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4952inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4953having to recompile it.
4954
4955In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console.  However,
4956you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4957For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4958program's @code{printf} function.  This has the advantage that the
4959characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4960redirects to files and so forth.
4961
4962If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4963ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent.  In addition to
4964ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4965with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4966the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4967target.  Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4968everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4969
4970@table @code
4971@kindex dprintf
4972@item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4973Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4974more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4975To print several values, separate them with commas.
4976
4977@item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4978Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4979styles enumerated below.  A change of style affects all existing
4980dynamic printfs immediately.  (If you need individual control over the
4981print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4982explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4983
4984@item gdb
4985@kindex dprintf-style gdb
4986Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4987
4988@item call
4989@kindex dprintf-style call
4990Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4991@code{printf}).
4992
4993@item agent
4994@kindex dprintf-style agent
4995Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4996the output itself.  This style is only available for agents that
4997support running commands on the target.
4998
4999@item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5000Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}.  By
5001default its value is @code{printf}.  You may set it to any expression.
5002that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5003command.
5004
5005@item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5006Set a ``channel'' for dprintf.  If set to a non-empty value,
5007@value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5008a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5009@code{fprintf} and similar functions.  Otherwise, the dprintf format
5010string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5011
5012As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5013that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5014you could do the following:
5015
5016@example
5017(gdb) set dprintf-style call
5018(gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5019(gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5020(gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5021Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5022(gdb) info break
50231       dprintf        keep y   0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5024        call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5025        continue
5026(gdb)
5027@end example
5028
5029Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5030as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5031the variable settings.
5032
5033@item set disconnected-dprintf on
5034@itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5035@kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5036Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5037@value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target.  This only applies
5038if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5039
5040@item show disconnected-dprintf off
5041@kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5042Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5043
5044@end table
5045
5046@value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5047relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5048in which they are being used.  For instance, the function and channel
5049may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5050all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5051those locals.  If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5052
5053@node Save Breakpoints
5054@subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5055
5056To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5057breakpoints}} command.
5058
5059@table @code
5060@kindex save breakpoints
5061@cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5062@item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5063This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5064their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5065suitable for use in a later debugging session.  This includes all
5066types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5067tracepoints).  To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5068@code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}).  Note that watchpoints
5069with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5070because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5071watchpoint is valid anymore.  Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5072are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5073breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5074and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5075that can no longer be recreated.
5076@end table
5077
5078@node Static Probe Points
5079@subsection Static Probe Points
5080
5081@cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5082@cindex static probe point, DTrace
5083@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code.  @acronym{SDT} stands
5084for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5085runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5086
5087Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5088ELF-compatible systems:
5089
5090@itemize @bullet
5091
5092@item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5093@acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5094@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5095for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5096probes in your applications.}.  @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5097from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5098@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5099for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5100
5101@item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5102@acronym{USDT} probes.  @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5103C@t{++} languages.
5104@end itemize
5105
5106@cindex semaphores on static probe points
5107Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5108for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5109using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file.  If your probe has a semaphore,
5110@value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5111breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation.  But, if you put a
5112breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5113@code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5114the semaphore.  @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5115
5116You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5117probes}, with optional arguments:
5118
5119@table @code
5120@kindex info probes
5121@item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5122If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5123@code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5124probes.  If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5125
5126If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5127names when selecting which probes to list.  If omitted, probes by all
5128probes from all providers are listed.
5129
5130If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5131when selecting which probes to list.  If omitted, probe names are not
5132considered when deciding whether to display them.
5133
5134If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5135object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine.  If not
5136given, all object files are considered.
5137
5138@item info probes all
5139List the available static probes, from all types.
5140@end table
5141
5142@cindex enabling and disabling probes
5143Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled.  The effect of
5144enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5145handled.  Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5146disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5147
5148You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5149commands, with optional arguments:
5150
5151@table @code
5152@kindex enable probes
5153@item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5154If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5155provider names when selecting which probes to enable.  If omitted,
5156all probes from all providers are enabled.
5157
5158If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5159names when selecting which probes to enable.  If omitted, probe names
5160are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5161
5162If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5163object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine.  If not
5164given, all object files are considered.
5165
5166@kindex disable probes
5167@item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5168See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5169optional arguments accepted by this command.
5170@end table
5171
5172@vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5173A probe may specify up to twelve arguments.  These are available at the
5174point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5175at the probe's location.  The arguments are available using the
5176convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5177@code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}.  In @code{SystemTap}
5178probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5179types are not preserved.  In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5180provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5181the value of the probe argument will be a long integer.  The
5182convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5183at the current probe point.
5184
5185These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5186any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5187an error message.
5188
5189
5190@c  @ifclear BARETARGET
5191@node Error in Breakpoints
5192@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5193
5194If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5195watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5196
5197@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5198@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5199@smallexample
5200Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5201You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5202@end smallexample
5203
5204@noindent
5205This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5206only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5207watchpoints it needs to insert.
5208
5209When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5210hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5211
5212@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5213@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5214@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5215
5216Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5217which breakpoints may be placed.  For architectures thus constrained,
5218@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5219with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5220
5221One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V.  The FR-V is
5222a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5223bundled together for parallel execution.  The FR-V architecture
5224constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5225bundle to the instruction with the lowest address.  @value{GDBN}
5226honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5227first in the bundle.
5228
5229It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5230instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5231a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5232another.  Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5233breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5234printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5235is hit.
5236
5237A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5238that's been subject to address adjustment:
5239
5240@smallexample
5241warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5242@end smallexample
5243
5244Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5245internal breakpoints.  If you see one of these warnings, you should
5246verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5247desired affect.  If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5248other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5249E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5250instruction.  A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5251cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5252
5253@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5254adjusted breakpoints:
5255
5256@smallexample
5257warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5258to 0x00010410.
5259@end smallexample
5260
5261When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5262action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5263frequently than expected.
5264
5265@node Continuing and Stepping
5266@section Continuing and Stepping
5267
5268@cindex stepping
5269@cindex continuing
5270@cindex resuming execution
5271@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5272completes normally.  In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5273one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5274line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5275particular command you use).  Either when continuing or when stepping,
5276your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal.  (If
5277it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5278@samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5279or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5280handlers}).)
5281
5282@table @code
5283@kindex continue
5284@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5285@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5286@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5287@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5288@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5289Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5290any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed.  The optional argument
5291@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5292ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5293@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5294
5295The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5296stopped due to a breakpoint.  At other times, the argument to
5297@code{continue} is ignored.
5298
5299The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5300debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5301purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5302@code{continue}.
5303@end table
5304
5305To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5306(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5307calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5308Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5309
5310A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5311(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5312beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5313is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5314and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5315interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5316
5317@table @code
5318@kindex step
5319@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5320@item step
5321Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5322line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}.  This command is
5323abbreviated @code{s}.
5324
5325@quotation
5326@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5327@c numbers in the debugging information".  (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5328@c not line numbers).  But it seems complex to try to make that
5329@c distinction here.
5330@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5331within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5332execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5333debugging information.  Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5334is compiled without debugging information.  To step through functions
5335without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5336below.
5337@end quotation
5338
5339The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5340line.  This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5341@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.  @code{step} continues
5342to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5343the line.  In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5344called within the line.
5345
5346Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5347number information for the function.  Otherwise it acts like the
5348@code{next} command.  This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5349on @acronym{MIPS} machines.  Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5350was any debugging information about the routine.
5351
5352@item step @var{count}
5353Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times.  If a
5354breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5355@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5356
5357@kindex next
5358@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5359@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5360Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5361This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5362the line of code are executed without stopping.  Execution stops when
5363control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5364that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command.  This command
5365is abbreviated @code{n}.
5366
5367An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5368
5369
5370@c  FIX ME!!  Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5371@c  the following paragraph?   ---  Vctoria
5372@c
5373@c  @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5374@c  @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5375@c  function are executed without stopping.
5376
5377The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5378source line.  This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5379@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5380
5381@kindex set step-mode
5382@item set step-mode
5383@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5384@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5385@itemx set step-mode on
5386The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5387stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5388information rather than stepping over it.
5389
5390This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5391machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5392want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5393
5394@item set step-mode off
5395Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5396debug information.  This is the default.
5397
5398@item show step-mode
5399Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5400source line debug information.
5401
5402@kindex finish
5403@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5404@item finish
5405Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5406returns.  Print the returned value (if any).  This command can be
5407abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5408
5409Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5410,Returning from a Function}).
5411
5412@kindex until
5413@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5414@cindex run until specified location
5415@item until
5416@itemx u
5417Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5418current stack frame, is reached.  This command is used to avoid single
5419stepping through a loop more than once.  It is like the @code{next}
5420command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5421automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5422than the address of the jump.
5423
5424This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5425though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5426exits the loop.  In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5427simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5428through the next iteration.
5429
5430@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5431stack frame.
5432
5433@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5434of machine code does not match the order of the source lines.  For
5435example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5436(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5437@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5438
5439@smallexample
5440(@value{GDBP}) f
5441#0  main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5442206                 expand_input();
5443(@value{GDBP}) until
5444195             for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5445@end smallexample
5446
5447This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5448generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5449start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5450written before the body of the loop.  The @code{until} command appeared
5451to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5452expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5453statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5454
5455@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5456instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5457argument.
5458
5459@item until @var{location}
5460@itemx u @var{location}
5461Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5462reached, or the current stack frame returns.  The location is any of
5463the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5464This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5465hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.  The specified
5466location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame.  This
5467implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5468invocations.  For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5469line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5470line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5471invocations have returned.
5472
5473@smallexample
547494	int factorial (int value)
547595	@{
547696	    if (value > 1) @{
547797            value *= factorial (value - 1);
547898	    @}
547999	    return (value);
5480100     @}
5481@end smallexample
5482
5483
5484@kindex advance @var{location}
5485@item advance @var{location}
5486Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}.  An argument is
5487required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5488@ref{Specify Location}.
5489Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5490frame.  This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5491not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5492have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5493
5494
5495@kindex stepi
5496@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5497@item stepi
5498@itemx stepi @var{arg}
5499@itemx si
5500Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5501
5502It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5503instructions.  This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5504instruction to be executed, each time your program stops.  @xref{Auto
5505Display,, Automatic Display}.
5506
5507An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5508
5509@need 750
5510@kindex nexti
5511@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5512@item nexti
5513@itemx nexti @var{arg}
5514@itemx ni
5515Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5516proceed until the function returns.
5517
5518An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5519
5520@end table
5521
5522@anchor{range stepping}
5523@cindex range stepping
5524@cindex target-assisted range stepping
5525By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5526target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}.  In other words, whenever you
5527use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5528tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5529addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps.  This speeds up
5530line stepping, particularly for remote targets.  Ideally, there should
5531be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off.  However, it's
5532possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5533remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5534stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5535enabled.  You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5536if necessary:
5537
5538@table @code
5539@kindex set range-stepping
5540@kindex show range-stepping
5541@item set range-stepping
5542@itemx show range-stepping
5543Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5544
5545If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5546target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5547multiple single-steps.  If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5548single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target.  The
5549default is @code{on}.
5550
5551@end table
5552
5553@node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5554@section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5555@cindex skipping over functions and files
5556
5557The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5558uninteresting to debug.  The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5559skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5560a particular file when stepping.
5561
5562For example, consider the following C function:
5563
5564@smallexample
5565101     int func()
5566102     @{
5567103         foo(boring());
5568104         bar(boring());
5569105     @}
5570@end smallexample
5571
5572@noindent
5573Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5574are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}.  If you run @code{step}
5575at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5576step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5577
5578One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5579command to immediately exit it.  But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5580is called from many places.
5581
5582A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}.  This instructs
5583@value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}.  Now when you execute
5584@code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5585@code{foo}.
5586
5587Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5588(@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5589name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5590
5591On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5592``Extended Regular Expressions''.  See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5593on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems.  On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5594expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5595the underlying system.
5596See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5597description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5598
5599@table @code
5600@kindex skip
5601@item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5602The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5603that specify what to skip.
5604The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5605
5606@table @code
5607@item -file @var{file}
5608@itemx -fi @var{file}
5609Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5610
5611@item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5612@itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5613@cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5614Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5615over when stepping.
5616
5617@smallexample
5618(gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5619@end smallexample
5620
5621@item -function @var{linespec}
5622@itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5623Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5624named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5625@xref{Specify Location}.
5626
5627@item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5628@itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5629@cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5630Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5631
5632This form is useful for complex function names.
5633For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5634constructors or destructors.  Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5635write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5636the template arguments are.  Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5637regular expression makes this easier.
5638
5639@smallexample
5640(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5641@end smallexample
5642
5643If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5644in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5645
5646@smallexample
5647(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5648@end smallexample
5649@end table
5650
5651If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5652will be skipped.
5653
5654@kindex skip function
5655@item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5656After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5657function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5658stepping.  @xref{Specify Location}.
5659
5660If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5661will be skipped.
5662
5663(If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5664@kbd{skip function file}.)
5665
5666@kindex skip file
5667@item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5668After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5669will be skipped over when stepping.
5670
5671@smallexample
5672(gdb) skip file boring.c
5673File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5674@end smallexample
5675
5676If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5677you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5678@end table
5679
5680Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5681These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5682
5683@table @code
5684@kindex info skip
5685@item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5686Print details about the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified,
5687print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5688@code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5689
5690@table @emph
5691@item Identifier
5692A number identifying this skip.
5693@item Enabled or Disabled
5694Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5695Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5696@item Glob
5697If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5698Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5699@item File
5700The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5701If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5702@item RE
5703If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5704Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5705@item Function
5706The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5707If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5708@end table
5709
5710@kindex skip delete
5711@item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5712Delete the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5713skips.
5714
5715@kindex skip enable
5716@item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5717Enable the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5718skips.
5719
5720@kindex skip disable
5721@item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5722Disable the specified skip(s).  If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5723skips.
5724
5725@end table
5726
5727@node Signals
5728@section Signals
5729@cindex signals
5730
5731A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program.  The
5732operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5733kind a name and a number.  For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5734signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5735@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5736memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5737the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5738requested an alarm).
5739
5740@cindex fatal signals
5741Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5742functioning of your program.  Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5743errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5744program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5745@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5746fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5747
5748@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5749program.  You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5750signal.
5751
5752@cindex handling signals
5753Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5754@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5755(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5756but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5757You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5758
5759@table @code
5760@kindex info signals
5761@kindex info handle
5762@item info signals
5763@itemx info handle
5764Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5765handle each one.  You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5766the defined types of signals.
5767
5768@item info signals @var{sig}
5769Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5770
5771@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5772
5773@item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5774Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals.  @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5775for details about this command.
5776
5777@kindex handle
5778@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5779Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}.  The @var{signal}
5780can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5781@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5782@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5783known signals.  Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5784say what change to make.
5785@end table
5786
5787@c @group
5788The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5789Their full names are:
5790
5791@table @code
5792@item nostop
5793@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens.  It may
5794still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5795
5796@item stop
5797@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens.  This implies
5798the @code{print} keyword as well.
5799
5800@item print
5801@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5802
5803@item noprint
5804@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all.  This
5805implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5806
5807@item pass
5808@itemx noignore
5809@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5810can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5811and not handled.  @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5812
5813@item nopass
5814@itemx ignore
5815@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5816@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5817@end table
5818@c @end group
5819
5820When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5821program until you
5822continue.  Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5823effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}.  In other words,
5824after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5825command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5826program sees that signal when you continue.
5827
5828The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5829non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5830@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5831erroneous signals.
5832
5833You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5834seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5835or to give it any signal at any time.  For example, if your program stopped
5836due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5837values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5838execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5839a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal.  To prevent this,
5840you can continue with @samp{signal 0}.  @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5841Program a Signal}.
5842
5843@cindex stepping and signal handlers
5844@anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5845
5846@value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code.  If a signal
5847that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5848a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5849in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5850stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns.  In other
5851words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler.  This prevents
5852signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5853nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly.  Note that
5854the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5855signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5856that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner.  Also
5857note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5858signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5859
5860@anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5861
5862If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5863handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5864or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5865step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5866
5867Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5868to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5869resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5870stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5871
5872Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5873of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5874
5875@smallexample
5876(@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5877Signal        Stop      Print   Pass to program Description
5878SIGUSR1       Yes       Yes     Yes             User defined signal 1
5879(@value{GDBP}) c
5880Continuing.
5881
5882Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5883main () sigusr1.c:28
588428        p = 0;
5885(@value{GDBP}) si
5886sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
58879       @{
5888@end smallexample
5889
5890The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5891program to receive the signal first:
5892
5893@smallexample
5894(@value{GDBP}) n
589528        p = 0;
5896(@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5897(@value{GDBP}) si
5898sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
58999       @{
5900(@value{GDBP})
5901@end smallexample
5902
5903@cindex extra signal information
5904@anchor{extra signal information}
5905
5906On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5907associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5908delivered to the program being debugged.  This information is exported
5909by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5910that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5911receipt of a signal.  The data type of the information itself is
5912target dependent.  You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5913$_siginfo} command.  On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5914standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5915system header.
5916
5917Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5918referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5919
5920@smallexample
5921@group
5922(@value{GDBP}) continue
5923Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
59240x0000000000400766 in main ()
592569        *(int *)p = 0;
5926(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5927type = struct @{
5928    int si_signo;
5929    int si_errno;
5930    int si_code;
5931    union @{
5932        int _pad[28];
5933        struct @{...@} _kill;
5934        struct @{...@} _timer;
5935        struct @{...@} _rt;
5936        struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5937        struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5938        struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5939    @} _sifields;
5940@}
5941(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5942type = struct @{
5943    void *si_addr;
5944@}
5945(@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5946$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5947@end group
5948@end smallexample
5949
5950Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5951
5952@cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
5953@cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
5954On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
5955violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
5956In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
5957depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
5958With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
5959kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
5960bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
5961information is displayed.
5962
5963The usual output of a segfault is:
5964@smallexample
5965Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
59660x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
596768        value = *(p + len);
5968@end smallexample
5969
5970While a bound violation is presented as:
5971@smallexample
5972Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
5973Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
5974Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
59750x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
597668        value = *(p + len);
5977@end smallexample
5978
5979@node Thread Stops
5980@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5981
5982@cindex stopped threads
5983@cindex threads, stopped
5984
5985@cindex continuing threads
5986@cindex threads, continuing
5987
5988@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5989(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}).  There
5990are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5991debugger.  In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5992when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5993or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5994@value{GDBN}.  On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5995@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5996you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5997
5998@menu
5999* All-Stop Mode::		All threads stop when GDB takes control
6000* Non-Stop Mode::		Other threads continue to execute
6001* Background Execution::	Running your program asynchronously
6002* Thread-Specific Breakpoints::	Controlling breakpoints
6003* Interrupted System Calls::	GDB may interfere with system calls
6004* Observer Mode::               GDB does not alter program behavior
6005@end menu
6006
6007@node All-Stop Mode
6008@subsection All-Stop Mode
6009
6010@cindex all-stop mode
6011
6012In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6013@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread.  This
6014allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6015switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6016underfoot.
6017
6018Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6019executing.  @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6020like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6021
6022In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6023Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6024system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6025execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6026single step.  Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6027statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6028stops.
6029
6030You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6031continuing or even single-stepping.  This happens whenever some other
6032thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6033first thread completes whatever you requested.
6034
6035@cindex automatic thread selection
6036@cindex switching threads automatically
6037@cindex threads, automatic switching
6038Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6039signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6040signal happened.  @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6041message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6042thread.
6043
6044On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6045locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6046
6047@table @code
6048@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6049@cindex scheduler locking mode
6050@cindex lock scheduler
6051Set the scheduler locking mode.  It applies to normal execution,
6052record mode, and replay mode.  If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6053locking and any thread may run at any time.  If @code{on}, then only
6054the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed.  The
6055@code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6056threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6057that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.  Other
6058threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6059completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6060@samp{until}, or @samp{finish}.  However, unless another thread hits a
6061breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6062current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.  The
6063@code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6064@code{on} in replay mode.
6065
6066@item show scheduler-locking
6067Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6068@end table
6069
6070@cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6071By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6072@code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6073threads of the current inferior to run.  For example, if @value{GDBN}
6074is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6075@code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6076inferior.  This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6077forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6078it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child.  In other
6079situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6080of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6081to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit.  In the latter case,
6082you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6083inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6084
6085@table @code
6086@kindex set schedule-multiple
6087@item set schedule-multiple
6088Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6089when an execution command is issued.  When @code{on}, all threads of
6090all processes are allowed to run.  When @code{off}, only the threads
6091of the current process are resumed.  The default is @code{off}.  The
6092@code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6093or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6094
6095@item show schedule-multiple
6096Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6097multiple processes.
6098@end table
6099
6100@node Non-Stop Mode
6101@subsection Non-Stop Mode
6102
6103@cindex non-stop mode
6104
6105@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6106@c with more details.
6107
6108For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6109mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6110the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely.  This
6111minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6112where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6113respond to external events.  This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6114
6115In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6116@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6117threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior.  Additionally,
6118execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6119only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6120in all-stop mode.  This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6121ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6122one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6123one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6124independently and simultaneously.
6125
6126To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6127or attach to your program:
6128
6129@smallexample
6130# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6131set pagination off
6132
6133# Finally, turn it on!
6134set non-stop on
6135@end smallexample
6136
6137You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6138
6139@table @code
6140@kindex set non-stop
6141@item set non-stop on
6142Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6143@item set non-stop off
6144Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6145@kindex show non-stop
6146@item show non-stop
6147Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6148@end table
6149
6150Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6151not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6152In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6153@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6154not possible to switch modes once debugging has started.  Furthermore,
6155since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6156non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6157default.
6158
6159In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6160by default.  That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6161To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6162
6163You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6164(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6165while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6166The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6167always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6168
6169Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6170running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6171In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6172but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6173To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6174
6175Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6176
6177In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6178that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode.  This is because the
6179thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6180command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6181changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6182previously current thread.
6183
6184@node Background Execution
6185@subsection Background Execution
6186
6187@cindex foreground execution
6188@cindex background execution
6189@cindex asynchronous execution
6190@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6191
6192@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants:  the normal
6193foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6194(asynchronous) behavior.  In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6195the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6196another command.  In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6197a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6198
6199If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6200message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6201
6202To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command.  For example,
6203the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6204just @code{c&}.  The execution commands that accept background execution
6205are:
6206
6207@table @code
6208@kindex run&
6209@item run
6210@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6211
6212@item attach
6213@kindex attach&
6214@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6215
6216@item step
6217@kindex step&
6218@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6219
6220@item stepi
6221@kindex stepi&
6222@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6223
6224@item next
6225@kindex next&
6226@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6227
6228@item nexti
6229@kindex nexti&
6230@xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6231
6232@item continue
6233@kindex continue&
6234@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6235
6236@item finish
6237@kindex finish&
6238@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6239
6240@item until
6241@kindex until&
6242@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6243
6244@end table
6245
6246Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6247mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6248However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6249the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6250previous one finishes.  Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6251mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6252
6253You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6254using the @code{interrupt} command.
6255
6256@table @code
6257@kindex interrupt
6258@item interrupt
6259@itemx interrupt -a
6260
6261Suspend execution of the running program.  In all-stop mode,
6262@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6263only the current thread.  To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6264use @code{interrupt -a}.
6265@end table
6266
6267@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6268@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6269
6270When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6271Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6272breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6273
6274@table @code
6275@cindex breakpoints and threads
6276@cindex thread breakpoints
6277@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6278@item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6279@itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6280@var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6281writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6282specify some source line.
6283
6284Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6285to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6286particular thread reaches this breakpoint.  The @var{thread-id} specifier
6287is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6288in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6289
6290If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6291breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6292program.
6293
6294You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6295well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6296after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6297
6298@smallexample
6299(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6300@end smallexample
6301
6302@end table
6303
6304Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6305@value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6306thread list.  For example:
6307
6308@smallexample
6309(@value{GDBP}) c
6310Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6311@end smallexample
6312
6313There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6314thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6315@code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6316Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6317(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc.  Note that with some targets,
6318@value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6319explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6320command.
6321
6322@node Interrupted System Calls
6323@subsection Interrupted System Calls
6324
6325@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6326@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6327@cindex premature return from system calls
6328There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6329multi-threaded programs.  If one thread stops for a
6330breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6331system call, then the system call may return prematurely.  This is a
6332consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6333that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6334stop execution.
6335
6336To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6337each system call and react appropriately.  This is good programming
6338style anyways.
6339
6340For example, do not write code like this:
6341
6342@smallexample
6343  sleep (10);
6344@end smallexample
6345
6346The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6347at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6348
6349Instead, write this:
6350
6351@smallexample
6352  int unslept = 10;
6353  while (unslept > 0)
6354    unslept = sleep (unslept);
6355@end smallexample
6356
6357A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6358conforming to its specification.  But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6359multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6360@value{GDBN}.
6361
6362Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6363monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6364When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6365prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6366
6367@node Observer Mode
6368@subsection Observer Mode
6369
6370If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6371without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6372variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6373whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc.  These operate
6374at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6375
6376When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6377be @dfn{observer mode}.  As a convenience, the variable
6378@code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6379mode.
6380
6381Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6382combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6383@code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6384then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6385stream will still not be able to be placed.
6386
6387@table @code
6388
6389@kindex observer
6390@item set observer on
6391@itemx set observer off
6392When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6393below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6394non-stop debugging.  Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6395normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6396
6397@item show observer
6398Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6399
6400@kindex may-write-registers
6401@item set may-write-registers on
6402@itemx set may-write-registers off
6403This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6404registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6405@code{jump} command.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6406
6407@item show may-write-registers
6408Show the current permission to write registers.
6409
6410@kindex may-write-memory
6411@item set may-write-memory on
6412@itemx set may-write-memory off
6413This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6414of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}.  It
6415defaults to @code{on}.
6416
6417@item show may-write-memory
6418Show the current permission to write memory.
6419
6420@kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6421@item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6422@itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6423This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6424This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6425by @value{GDBN}.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6426
6427@item show may-insert-breakpoints
6428Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6429
6430@kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6431@item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6432@itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6433This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6434tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment.  It affects only
6435non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6436@code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6437
6438@item show may-insert-tracepoints
6439Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6440
6441@kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6442@item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6443@itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6444This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6445tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment.  It affects only
6446fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6447control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}.  It defaults to @code{on}.
6448
6449@item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6450Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6451
6452@kindex may-interrupt
6453@item set may-interrupt on
6454@itemx set may-interrupt off
6455This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6456program execution.  When this variable is @code{off}, the
6457@code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6458@kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6459
6460@item show may-interrupt
6461Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6462
6463@end table
6464
6465@node Reverse Execution
6466@chapter Running programs backward
6467@cindex reverse execution
6468@cindex running programs backward
6469
6470When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6471you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6472If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6473``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6474
6475A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6476to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6477program was executing normally.  Variables, registers etc.@: should
6478revert to their previous values.  Obviously this requires a great
6479deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6480all target environments can support reverse execution.
6481
6482When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6483have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6484order.  The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6485thread of execution in reverse.  As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6486the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6487instruction are reverted to their previous states.  After executing
6488a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6489should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6490prior values@footnote{
6491Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others.  For instance,
6492memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard.  Some
6493targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6494
6495The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6496requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6497@value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6498results back to @value{GDBN}.  Whatever the target reports back to
6499@value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user.  @value{GDBN}
6500assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6501consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6502}.
6503
6504If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6505reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6506
6507@table @code
6508@kindex reverse-continue
6509@kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6510@item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6511@itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6512Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6513in reverse.  Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6514exceptions (signals), just like normal execution.  Behavior of
6515asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6516
6517@kindex reverse-step
6518@kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6519@item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6520Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6521different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6522
6523Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6524at the beginning of a source line.  It ``un-executes'' the previously
6525executed source line.  If the previous source line included calls to
6526debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6527the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6528statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6529
6530Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6531called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6532
6533@kindex reverse-stepi
6534@kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6535@item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6536Reverse-execute one machine instruction.  Note that the instruction
6537to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6538counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one.  For instance,
6539if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6540back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6541
6542@kindex reverse-next
6543@kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6544@item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6545Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6546the current (innermost) stack frame.  If the line contains function
6547calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping.  Starting from
6548the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6549to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6550just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6551line of a function back to its return to its caller
6552@footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6553
6554@kindex reverse-nexti
6555@kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6556@item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6557Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6558in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6559That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6560another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6561in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6562frame) is reached.
6563
6564@kindex reverse-finish
6565@item reverse-finish
6566Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6567current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6568where it was called.  Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6569function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6570
6571@kindex set exec-direction
6572@item set exec-direction
6573Set the direction of target execution.
6574@item set exec-direction reverse
6575@cindex execute forward or backward in time
6576@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6577exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''.  Affected commands include
6578@code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}.  The @code{return}
6579command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6580@item set exec-direction forward
6581@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6582This is the default.
6583@end table
6584
6585
6586@node Process Record and Replay
6587@chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6588@cindex process record and replay
6589@cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6590
6591On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6592and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6593replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6594
6595@cindex replay mode
6596When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6597for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6598mode}.  In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6599instructions.  Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6600code execution are taken from the execution log.  While code is not
6601really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6602program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6603changed as they normally would.  Their contents are taken from the
6604execution log.
6605
6606@cindex record mode
6607If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6608@value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}.  In this mode, the
6609inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6610for future replay.
6611
6612The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6613(@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6614inferior runs does not.  However, the reverse execution is limited in
6615this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6616log.  In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6617support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6618
6619When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6620replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6621previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6622platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6623
6624For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6625@value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6626
6627@table @code
6628@kindex target record
6629@kindex target record-full
6630@kindex target record-btrace
6631@kindex record
6632@kindex record full
6633@kindex record btrace
6634@kindex record btrace bts
6635@kindex record btrace pt
6636@kindex record bts
6637@kindex record pt
6638@kindex rec
6639@kindex rec full
6640@kindex rec btrace
6641@kindex rec btrace bts
6642@kindex rec btrace pt
6643@kindex rec bts
6644@kindex rec pt
6645@item record @var{method}
6646This command starts the process record and replay target.  The
6647recording method can be specified as parameter.  Without a parameter
6648the command uses the @code{full} recording method.  The following
6649recording methods are available:
6650
6651@table @code
6652@item full
6653Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6654replay implementation.  This method allows replaying and reverse
6655execution.
6656
6657@item btrace @var{format}
6658Hardware-supported instruction recording.  This method does not record
6659data.  Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6660be overwritten when the buffer is full.  It allows limited reverse
6661execution.  Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6662execution.  In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6663Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting.  The recording may
6664be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6665
6666The recording format can be specified as parameter.  Without a parameter
6667the command chooses the recording format.  The following recording
6668formats are available:
6669
6670@table @code
6671@item bts
6672@cindex branch trace store
6673Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format.  In
6674this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6675branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6676
6677@item pt
6678@cindex Intel Processor Trace
6679Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format.  In this
6680format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6681that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6682
6683The trace can be recorded with very low overhead.  The compressed
6684trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6685number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6686
6687Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6688expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace.  This is mostly due to the
6689increased number of instructions to process.  You should increase the
6690buffer-size with care.
6691@end table
6692
6693Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6694@end table
6695
6696The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6697already running.  Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6698the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6699with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6700
6701@cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6702Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6703will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6704is started.  That's because the process record and replay target
6705doesn't support displaced stepping.
6706
6707@cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6708@cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6709If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6710the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6711all recording methods are available.  The @code{full} recording method
6712does not support these two modes.
6713
6714@kindex record stop
6715@kindex rec s
6716@item record stop
6717Stop the process record and replay target.  When process record and
6718replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6719inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6720
6721When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6722the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6723next instruction that would have been recorded.  In other words, if
6724you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6725will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6726
6727On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6728while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6729but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6730at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6731usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6732
6733When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6734process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6735
6736@kindex record goto
6737@item record goto
6738Go to a specific location in the execution log.  There are several
6739ways to specify the location to go to:
6740
6741@table @code
6742@item record goto begin
6743@itemx record goto start
6744Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6745
6746@item record goto end
6747Go to the end of the execution log.
6748
6749@item record goto @var{n}
6750Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6751@end table
6752
6753@kindex record save
6754@item record save @var{filename}
6755Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6756Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6757@var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6758
6759This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6760
6761@kindex record restore
6762@item record restore @var{filename}
6763Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6764File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6765
6766@kindex set record full
6767@item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6768@itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6769Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6770recording method.  Default value is 200000.
6771
6772If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6773deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6774instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}.  For every new recorded
6775instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6776instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6777(Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6778lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6779the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6780
6781If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6782delete recorded instructions from the execution log.  The number of
6783recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6784
6785@kindex show record full
6786@item show record full insn-number-max
6787Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6788recording method.
6789
6790@item set record full stop-at-limit
6791Control the behavior of the  @code{full} recording method when the
6792number of recorded instructions reaches the limit.  If ON (the
6793default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6794first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6795continue running it and recording the execution log.  If you decide
6796to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6797oldest one to be deleted.
6798
6799If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6800oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6801
6802@item show record full stop-at-limit
6803Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6804
6805@item set record full memory-query
6806Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6807changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6808If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6809case.
6810
6811If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6812ignore the effect of such instructions on memory.  Later, when
6813@value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6814instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6815results.
6816
6817@item show record full memory-query
6818Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6819
6820@kindex set record btrace
6821The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data.  As a
6822convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6823the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6824read-only areas don't change.  This for example makes it possible to
6825disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6826In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6827You can use the following command for that:
6828
6829@item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6830Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6831accessing memory during replay.  If @code{read-only} (the default),
6832@value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6833If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6834and to read-write memory.  Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6835to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6836position.
6837
6838@kindex show record btrace
6839@item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6840Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6841
6842@kindex set record btrace bts
6843@item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6844@itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6845Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6846format.  Default is 64KB.
6847
6848If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6849allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6850that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6851The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6852@var{size}.  Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6853buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6854the @acronym{BTS} format.
6855
6856If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6857allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6858
6859Bigger buffers mean longer traces.  On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6860also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6861
6862@item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6863Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6864tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6865
6866@kindex set record btrace pt
6867@item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6868@itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6869Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6870Processor Trace format.  Default is 16KB.
6871
6872If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6873allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6874that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6875format.  The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6876requested @var{size}.  Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6877actual buffer size for each thread.
6878
6879If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6880allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6881
6882Bigger buffers mean longer traces.  On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6883also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6884
6885@item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6886Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6887tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6888
6889@kindex info record
6890@item info record
6891Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6892method:
6893
6894@table @code
6895@item full
6896For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6897record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6898
6899@itemize @bullet
6900@item
6901Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6902@item
6903Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6904@item
6905Highest recorded instruction number.
6906@item
6907Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6908@item
6909Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6910@item
6911Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6912@end itemize
6913
6914@item btrace
6915For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6916
6917@itemize @bullet
6918@item
6919Recording format.
6920@item
6921Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6922@item
6923Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6924instructions.
6925@item
6926Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6927@end itemize
6928
6929For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6930@itemize @bullet
6931@item
6932Size of the perf ring buffer.
6933@end itemize
6934
6935For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6936@itemize @bullet
6937@item
6938Size of the perf ring buffer.
6939@end itemize
6940@end table
6941
6942@kindex record delete
6943@kindex rec del
6944@item record delete
6945When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6946subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6947from the current address.  This means you will abandon the previously
6948recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6949
6950@kindex record instruction-history
6951@kindex rec instruction-history
6952@item record instruction-history
6953Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log.  By
6954default, ten instructions are disassembled.  This can be changed using
6955the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command.  Instructions
6956are printed in execution order.
6957
6958It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6959@code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6960as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6961
6962The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6963current program counter value.  This instruction can appear multiple
6964times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6965every time.  To omit the current position marker, specify the
6966@code{/p} modifier.
6967
6968To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6969instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6970omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6971
6972Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}.  This
6973feature is not available for all recording formats.
6974
6975There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6976disassemble:
6977
6978@table @code
6979@item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6980Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6981@var{insn}.
6982
6983@item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6984Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6985@var{insn}.  If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6986@var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}.  If
6987@var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6988instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6989
6990@item record instruction-history
6991Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6992
6993@item record instruction-history -
6994Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6995
6996@item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6997Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6998@var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}.  The instruction
6999number @var{end} is included.
7000@end table
7001
7002This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7003
7004@kindex set record
7005@item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7006@itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7007Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7008instruction-history} command.  The default value is 10.
7009A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7010
7011@kindex show record
7012@item show record instruction-history-size
7013Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7014instruction-history} command.
7015
7016@kindex record function-call-history
7017@kindex rec function-call-history
7018@item record function-call-history
7019Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7020line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7021function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7022for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7023specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7024the @code{/i} modifier is specified).  The function names are indented
7025to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7026specified.  The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7027given together.
7028
7029@smallexample
7030(@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
70311   void foo (void)
70322   @{
70333   @}
70344
70355   void bar (void)
70366   @{
70377     ...
70388     foo ();
70399     ...
704010  @}
7041(@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
70421  bar     inst 1,4     at foo.c:6,8
70432    foo   inst 5,10    at foo.c:2,3
70443  bar     inst 11,13   at foo.c:9,10
7045@end smallexample
7046
7047By default, ten lines are printed.  This can be changed using the
7048@code{set record function-call-history-size} command.  Functions are
7049printed in execution order.  There are several ways to specify what
7050to print:
7051
7052@table @code
7053@item record function-call-history @var{func}
7054Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7055
7056@item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7057Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}.  If
7058@var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7059function number @var{func}.  If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7060prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7061
7062@item record function-call-history
7063Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7064
7065@item record function-call-history -
7066Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7067
7068@item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7069Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7070function number @var{end}.  The function number @var{end} is included.
7071@end table
7072
7073This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7074
7075@item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7076@itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7077Define how many lines to print in the
7078@code{record function-call-history} command.  The default value is 10.
7079A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7080
7081@item show record function-call-history-size
7082Show how many lines to print in the
7083@code{record function-call-history} command.
7084@end table
7085
7086
7087@node Stack
7088@chapter Examining the Stack
7089
7090When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7091stopped and how it got there.
7092
7093@cindex call stack
7094Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7095is generated.
7096That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7097the arguments of the call,
7098and the local variables of the function being called.
7099The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7100The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7101stack}.
7102
7103When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7104stack allow you to see all of this information.
7105
7106@cindex selected frame
7107One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7108@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame.  In
7109particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7110your program, the value is found in the selected frame.  There are
7111special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7112interested in.  @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7113
7114When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7115currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7116@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7117
7118@menu
7119* Frames::                      Stack frames
7120* Backtrace::                   Backtraces
7121* Selection::                   Selecting a frame
7122* Frame Info::                  Information on a frame
7123* Frame Filter Management::     Managing frame filters
7124
7125@end menu
7126
7127@node Frames
7128@section Stack Frames
7129
7130@cindex frame, definition
7131@cindex stack frame
7132The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7133frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7134with one call to one function.  The frame contains the arguments given
7135to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7136which the function is executing.
7137
7138@cindex initial frame
7139@cindex outermost frame
7140@cindex innermost frame
7141When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7142function @code{main}.  This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7143@dfn{outermost} frame.  Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7144made.  Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7145is eliminated.  If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7146the same function.  The frame for the function in which execution is
7147actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame.  This is the most
7148recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7149
7150@cindex frame pointer
7151Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses.  A
7152stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7153kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7154address serves as the address of the frame.  Usually this address is kept
7155in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7156(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7157
7158@cindex frame number
7159@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7160zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7161and so on upward.  These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7162they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7163frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7164
7165@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7166@c underflow problems.
7167@cindex frameless execution
7168Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7169without stack frames.  (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7170@smallexample
7171@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7172@end smallexample
7173generates functions without a frame.)
7174This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7175the frame setup time.  @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7176with these function invocations.  If the innermost function invocation
7177has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7178it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7179correct tracing of the function call chain.  However, @value{GDBN} has
7180no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7181
7182@node Backtrace
7183@section Backtraces
7184
7185@cindex traceback
7186@cindex call stack traces
7187A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is.  It shows one
7188line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7189frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7190stack.
7191
7192@anchor{backtrace-command}
7193@table @code
7194@kindex backtrace
7195@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7196@item backtrace
7197@itemx bt
7198Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
7199frames in the stack.
7200
7201You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
7202character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7203
7204@item backtrace @var{n}
7205@itemx bt @var{n}
7206Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
7207
7208@item backtrace -@var{n}
7209@itemx bt -@var{n}
7210Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
7211
7212@item backtrace full
7213@itemx bt full
7214@itemx bt full @var{n}
7215@itemx bt full -@var{n}
7216Print the values of the local variables also.  As described above,
7217@var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
7218
7219@item backtrace no-filters
7220@itemx bt no-filters
7221@itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
7222@itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
7223@itemx bt no-filters full
7224@itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
7225@itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
7226Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace.  @xref{Frame
7227Filter API}, for more information.  Additionally use @ref{disable
7228frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters.  This is only
7229relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7230support.
7231@end table
7232
7233@kindex where
7234@kindex info stack
7235The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7236are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7237
7238@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7239In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7240backtrace only for the current thread.  To display the backtrace for
7241several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7242(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}).  For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7243apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7244the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7245multi-threaded program.
7246
7247Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7248The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7249print address off}.  The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7250line number, as well as the arguments to the function.  The program
7251counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7252line number.
7253
7254Here is an example of a backtrace.  It was made with the command
7255@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7256
7257@smallexample
7258@group
7259#0  m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7260    at builtin.c:993
7261#1  0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7262#2  0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7263    at macro.c:71
7264(More stack frames follow...)
7265@end group
7266@end smallexample
7267
7268@noindent
7269The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7270value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7271code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7272
7273@noindent
7274The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7275@code{@dots{}}.  By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7276only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc).  See command
7277@kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7278on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7279
7280@cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7281@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7282If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7283optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7284never used after the call.  Such optimizations generate code that
7285passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7286in the stack frame.  @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7287arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one.  Here's what
7288such a backtrace might look like:
7289
7290@smallexample
7291@group
7292#0  m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7293    at builtin.c:993
7294#1  0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7295#2  0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7296    at macro.c:71
7297(More stack frames follow...)
7298@end group
7299@end smallexample
7300
7301@noindent
7302The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7303shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7304
7305If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7306either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7307you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7308
7309@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7310@cindex program entry point
7311@cindex startup code, and backtrace
7312Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7313libraries and startup code transition into user code.  For C this is
7314@code{main}@footnote{
7315Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7316environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7317entry point.  They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7318When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7319it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7320system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7321
7322If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7323in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7324
7325@table @code
7326@item set backtrace past-main
7327@itemx set backtrace past-main on
7328@kindex set backtrace
7329Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7330
7331@item set backtrace past-main off
7332Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point.  This is the
7333default.
7334
7335@item show backtrace past-main
7336@kindex show backtrace
7337Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7338
7339@item set backtrace past-entry
7340@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7341Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7342This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7343and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7344
7345@item set backtrace past-entry off
7346Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7347application.  This is the default.
7348
7349@item show backtrace past-entry
7350Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7351
7352@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7353@itemx set backtrace limit 0
7354@itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7355@cindex backtrace limit
7356Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels.  A value of @code{unlimited}
7357or zero means unlimited levels.
7358
7359@item show backtrace limit
7360Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7361@end table
7362
7363You can control how file names are displayed.
7364
7365@table @code
7366@item set filename-display
7367@itemx set filename-display relative
7368@cindex filename-display
7369Display file names relative to the compilation directory.  This is the default.
7370
7371@item set filename-display basename
7372Display only basename of a filename.
7373
7374@item set filename-display absolute
7375Display an absolute filename.
7376
7377@item show filename-display
7378Show the current way to display filenames.
7379@end table
7380
7381@node Selection
7382@section Selecting a Frame
7383
7384Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7385whichever stack frame is selected at the moment.  Here are the commands for
7386selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7387of the stack frame just selected.
7388
7389@table @code
7390@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7391@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7392@item frame @var{n}
7393@itemx f @var{n}
7394Select frame number @var{n}.  Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7395(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7396innermost one, and so on.  The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7397@code{main}.
7398
7399@item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7400@itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7401Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}.  This is useful mainly if the
7402chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7403impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames.  In
7404addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7405switches between them.  The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7406specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7407
7408@kindex up
7409@item up @var{n}
7410Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1.  For positive
7411numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7412frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7413
7414@kindex down
7415@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7416@item down @var{n}
7417Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1.  For
7418positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7419lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7420You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7421@end table
7422
7423All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7424frame.  The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7425arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7426frame.  The second line shows the text of that source line.
7427
7428@need 1000
7429For example:
7430
7431@smallexample
7432@group
7433(@value{GDBP}) up
7434#1  0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7435    at env.c:10
743610              read_input_file (argv[i]);
7437@end group
7438@end smallexample
7439
7440After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7441prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7442You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7443editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7444@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7445for details.
7446
7447@table @code
7448@kindex select-frame
7449@item select-frame
7450The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7451not display the new frame after selecting it.  This command is
7452intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7453output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7454
7455@kindex down-silently
7456@kindex up-silently
7457@item up-silently @var{n}
7458@itemx down-silently @var{n}
7459These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7460respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7461causing display of the new frame.  They are intended primarily for use
7462in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7463distracting.
7464@end table
7465
7466@node Frame Info
7467@section Information About a Frame
7468
7469There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7470stack frame.
7471
7472@table @code
7473@item frame
7474@itemx f
7475When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7476frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7477selected stack frame.  It can be abbreviated @code{f}.  With an
7478argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7479@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7480
7481@kindex info frame
7482@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7483@item info frame
7484@itemx info f
7485This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7486including:
7487
7488@itemize @bullet
7489@item
7490the address of the frame
7491@item
7492the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7493@item
7494the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7495@item
7496the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7497@item
7498the address of the frame's arguments
7499@item
7500the address of the frame's local variables
7501@item
7502the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7503@item
7504which registers were saved in the frame
7505@end itemize
7506
7507@noindent The verbose description is useful when
7508something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7509the usual conventions.
7510
7511@item info frame @var{addr}
7512@itemx info f @var{addr}
7513Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7514selecting that frame.  The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7515command.  This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7516architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7517@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7518
7519@kindex info args
7520@item info args
7521Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7522
7523@item info locals
7524@kindex info locals
7525Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7526line.  These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7527accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7528
7529@end table
7530
7531@node Frame Filter Management
7532@section Management of Frame Filters.
7533@cindex managing frame filters
7534
7535Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7536output of frames.  @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7537
7538Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7539within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7540
7541@table @code
7542@kindex info frame-filter
7543@item info frame-filter
7544Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7545their name, priority and enabled status.
7546
7547@kindex disable frame-filter
7548@anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7549@item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7550Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7551@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}.  The
7552@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7553@code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7554dictionary resides.  When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7555across all dictionaries are disabled.  The @var{filter-name} is the name
7556of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7557@var{filter-dictionary}.  A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7558may be enabled again later.
7559
7560@kindex enable frame-filter
7561@item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7562Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7563@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}.  The
7564@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7565@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7566dictionary resides.  When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7567all dictionaries are enabled.  The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7568filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7569@var{filter-dictionary}.
7570
7571Example:
7572
7573@smallexample
7574(gdb) info frame-filter
7575
7576global frame-filters:
7577  Priority  Enabled  Name
7578  1000      No       PrimaryFunctionFilter
7579  100       Yes      Reverse
7580
7581progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7582  Priority  Enabled  Name
7583  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7584
7585objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7586  Priority  Enabled  Name
7587  999       Yes      BuildProgra Filter
7588
7589(gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7590(gdb) info frame-filter
7591
7592global frame-filters:
7593  Priority  Enabled  Name
7594  1000      No       PrimaryFunctionFilter
7595  100       Yes      Reverse
7596
7597progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7598  Priority  Enabled  Name
7599  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7600
7601objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7602  Priority  Enabled  Name
7603  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7604
7605(gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7606(gdb) info frame-filter
7607
7608global frame-filters:
7609  Priority  Enabled  Name
7610  1000      Yes      PrimaryFunctionFilter
7611  100       Yes      Reverse
7612
7613progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7614  Priority  Enabled  Name
7615  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7616
7617objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7618  Priority  Enabled  Name
7619  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7620@end smallexample
7621
7622@kindex set frame-filter priority
7623@item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7624Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7625@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7626@var{filter-name}.  The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7627@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7628dictionary resides.  The @var{priority} is an integer.
7629
7630@kindex show frame-filter priority
7631@item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7632Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7633@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7634@var{filter-name}.  The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7635@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7636dictionary resides.
7637
7638Example:
7639
7640@smallexample
7641(gdb) info frame-filter
7642
7643global frame-filters:
7644  Priority  Enabled  Name
7645  1000      Yes      PrimaryFunctionFilter
7646  100       Yes      Reverse
7647
7648progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7649  Priority  Enabled  Name
7650  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7651
7652objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7653  Priority  Enabled  Name
7654  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7655
7656(gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7657(gdb) info frame-filter
7658
7659global frame-filters:
7660  Priority  Enabled  Name
7661  1000      Yes      PrimaryFunctionFilter
7662  50        Yes      Reverse
7663
7664progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7665  Priority  Enabled  Name
7666  100       Yes      ProgspaceFilter
7667
7668objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7669  Priority  Enabled  Name
7670  999       No       BuildProgramFilter
7671@end smallexample
7672@end table
7673
7674@node Source
7675@chapter Examining Source Files
7676
7677@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7678information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7679used to build it.  When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7680the line where it stopped.  Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7681(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7682execution in that frame has stopped.  You can print other portions of
7683source files by explicit command.
7684
7685If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7686prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7687@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7688
7689@menu
7690* List::                        Printing source lines
7691* Specify Location::            How to specify code locations
7692* Edit::                        Editing source files
7693* Search::                      Searching source files
7694* Source Path::                 Specifying source directories
7695* Machine Code::                Source and machine code
7696@end menu
7697
7698@node List
7699@section Printing Source Lines
7700
7701@kindex list
7702@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7703To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7704(abbreviated @code{l}).  By default, ten lines are printed.
7705There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7706print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7707
7708Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7709
7710@table @code
7711@item list @var{linenum}
7712Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7713current source file.
7714
7715@item list @var{function}
7716Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7717@var{function}.
7718
7719@item list
7720Print more lines.  If the last lines printed were printed with a
7721@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7722printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7723as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7724Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7725
7726@item list -
7727Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7728@end table
7729
7730@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7731By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7732the @code{list} command.  You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7733
7734@table @code
7735@kindex set listsize
7736@item set listsize @var{count}
7737@itemx set listsize unlimited
7738Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7739the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7740Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7741
7742@kindex show listsize
7743@item show listsize
7744Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7745@end table
7746
7747Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7748so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}.  This is more useful
7749than listing the same lines again.  An exception is made for an
7750argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7751each repetition moves up in the source file.
7752
7753In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7754@dfn{locations}.  Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7755of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7756to specify some source line.
7757
7758Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7759
7760@table @code
7761@item list @var{location}
7762Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7763
7764@item list @var{first},@var{last}
7765Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}.  Both arguments are
7766locations.  When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7767source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7768the same source file as the first location.
7769
7770@item list ,@var{last}
7771Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7772
7773@item list @var{first},
7774Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7775
7776@item list +
7777Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7778
7779@item list -
7780Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7781
7782@item list
7783As described in the preceding table.
7784@end table
7785
7786@node Specify Location
7787@section Specifying a Location
7788@cindex specifying location
7789@cindex location
7790@cindex source location
7791
7792@menu
7793* Linespec Locations::                Linespec locations
7794* Explicit Locations::                Explicit locations
7795* Address Locations::                 Address locations
7796@end menu
7797
7798Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7799of your program's code.  Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7800debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7801Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7802linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7803
7804@node Linespec Locations
7805@subsection Linespec Locations
7806@cindex linespec locations
7807
7808A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7809as file name, function name, etc.  Here are all the different ways of
7810specifying a linespec:
7811
7812@table @code
7813@item @var{linenum}
7814Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7815
7816@item -@var{offset}
7817@itemx +@var{offset}
7818Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7819line}.  For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7820printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7821execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7822(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)  When
7823used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7824this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7825linespec.
7826
7827@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7828Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7829If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7830source file name with the same trailing components.  For example, if
7831@var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7832name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7833@file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7834
7835@item @var{function}
7836Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7837For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7838
7839@item @var{function}:@var{label}
7840Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7841
7842@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7843Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7844in the file @var{filename}.  You only need the file name with a
7845function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7846functions in different source files.
7847
7848@item @var{label}
7849Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7850in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7851If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7852is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7853
7854@cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7855@item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7856The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7857applications to embed static probes.  @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7858information on finding and using static probes.  This form of linespec
7859specifies the location of such a static probe.
7860
7861If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7862or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7863If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7864If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7865each one of those probes.
7866@end table
7867
7868@node Explicit Locations
7869@subsection Explicit Locations
7870@cindex explicit locations
7871
7872@dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7873location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7874
7875Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7876file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7877sources.  In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7878line you meant more accurately and unambiguously.  Also, using
7879explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7880
7881For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7882defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7883named @code{foo}.  @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7884the symbol table to know.
7885
7886The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7887following table:
7888
7889@table @code
7890@item -source @var{filename}
7891The value specifies the source file name.  To differentiate between
7892files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7893to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}.  Otherwise
7894@value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7895name.   This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7896
7897@item -function @var{function}
7898The value specifies the name of a function.  Operations
7899on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7900or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7901In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7902
7903@item -label @var{label}
7904The value specifies the name of a label.  When the function
7905name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7906selected stack frame.
7907
7908@item -line @var{number}
7909The value specifies a line offset for the location.  The offset may either
7910be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7911the command.  When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7912relative to the current line.
7913@end table
7914
7915Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7916trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7917
7918@node Address Locations
7919@subsection Address Locations
7920@cindex address locations
7921
7922@dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address.  They have
7923the generalized form *@var{address}.
7924
7925For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7926specifies a source line that contains @var{address}.  For @code{break} and
7927other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7928parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7929source files.
7930
7931Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7932language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7933address.  In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7934semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7935that frequently occur during debugging.  Here are the various forms
7936of @var{address}:
7937
7938@table @code
7939@item @var{expression}
7940Any expression valid in the current working language.
7941
7942@item @var{funcaddr}
7943An address of a function or procedure derived from its name.  In C,
7944C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7945simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7946of a valid expression).  In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7947@code{&@var{function}}.  In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7948(although the Pascal form also works).
7949
7950This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7951before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7952
7953@item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7954Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7955file explicitly.  This is useful if the name of the function does not
7956specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7957functions with identical names in different source files.
7958@end table
7959
7960@node Edit
7961@section Editing Source Files
7962@cindex editing source files
7963
7964@kindex edit
7965@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7966To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7967The editing program of your choice
7968is invoked with the current line set to
7969the active line in the program.
7970Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7971want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7972
7973@table @code
7974@item edit @var{location}
7975Edit the source file specified by @code{location}.  Editing starts at
7976that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7977specified file.  @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7978of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7979command most commonly used:
7980
7981@table @code
7982@item edit @var{number}
7983Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7984
7985@item edit @var{function}
7986Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7987@end table
7988
7989@end table
7990
7991@subsection Choosing your Editor
7992You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7993@footnote{
7994The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7995following command-line syntax:
7996@smallexample
7997ex +@var{number} file
7998@end smallexample
7999The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8000the file where to start editing.}.
8001By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8002by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8003@value{GDBN}.  For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8004@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8005@smallexample
8006EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8007export EDITOR
8008gdb @dots{}
8009@end smallexample
8010or in the @code{csh} shell,
8011@smallexample
8012setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8013gdb @dots{}
8014@end smallexample
8015
8016@node Search
8017@section Searching Source Files
8018@cindex searching source files
8019
8020There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8021regular expression.
8022
8023@table @code
8024@kindex search
8025@kindex forward-search
8026@kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8027@item forward-search @var{regexp}
8028@itemx search @var{regexp}
8029The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8030starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8031@var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can use the
8032synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8033@code{fo}.
8034
8035@kindex reverse-search
8036@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8037The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8038with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8039for @var{regexp}.  It lists the line that is found.  You can abbreviate
8040this command as @code{rev}.
8041@end table
8042
8043@node Source Path
8044@section Specifying Source Directories
8045
8046@cindex source path
8047@cindex directories for source files
8048Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8049files from which they were compiled, just the names.  Even when they do,
8050the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8051session.  @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8052this is called the @dfn{source path}.  Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8053it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8054in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8055
8056For example, suppose an executable references the file
8057@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8058@file{/mnt/cross}.  The file is first looked up literally; if this
8059fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8060fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8061message is printed.  @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8062source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8063Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8064the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8065@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8066@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8067
8068Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8069names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8070instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8071is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8072@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8073that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8074
8075Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8076source files.
8077
8078Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8079any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8080each line is in the file.
8081
8082@kindex directory
8083@kindex dir
8084When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8085and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8086To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8087
8088The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8089script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8090
8091In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8092that manage a list of source path substitution rules.  A @dfn{substitution
8093rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8094debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8095directory between compilation and debugging.  A rule is made of
8096two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8097the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8098In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8099@var{to} respectively.  @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8100of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8101source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8102name to look up the sources.
8103
8104Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8105moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8106@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8107@file{/mnt/cross}.  The first lookup will then be
8108@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8109of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.  To define a source path
8110substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8111(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8112
8113To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8114@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8115For instance, a rule substituting  @file{/usr/source} into
8116@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8117not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}.  And because the substitution
8118is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8119not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8120
8121In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8122command.  However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8123the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8124subdirectories.  With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8125subdirectory of your project.  If you moved the entire tree while
8126preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8127allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8128command.
8129
8130@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8131The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8132longer exists.  On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8133the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead.  So, if
8134for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8135located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8136method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8137
8138@cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8139@cindex default source path substitution
8140You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8141configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8142@samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option.  The @var{dir}
8143should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8144prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8145directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8146automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8147location.  This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8148with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8149together.
8150
8151@table @code
8152@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8153@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8154Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path.  Several
8155directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8156(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8157part of absolute file names) or
8158whitespace.  You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8159path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8160
8161@kindex cdir
8162@kindex cwd
8163@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8164@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8165@cindex compilation directory
8166@cindex current directory
8167@cindex working directory
8168@cindex directory, current
8169@cindex directory, compilation
8170You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8171directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8172working directory.  @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8173tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8174session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8175directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8176
8177@item directory
8178Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems).  This requires confirmation.
8179
8180@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8181@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that.  (thanks to RMS)
8182
8183@item set directories @var{path-list}
8184@kindex set directories
8185Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8186@samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8187
8188@item show directories
8189@kindex show directories
8190Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8191
8192@anchor{set substitute-path}
8193@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8194@kindex set substitute-path
8195Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8196current list of existing substitution rules.  If a rule with the same
8197@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8198
8199For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8200@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8201
8202@smallexample
8203(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8204@end smallexample
8205
8206@noindent
8207will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8208@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8209@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8210
8211In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8212the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8213defined.  The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8214the substitution.
8215
8216For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8217
8218@smallexample
8219(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8220(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8221@end smallexample
8222
8223@noindent
8224@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8225@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule.  However, it would
8226use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8227@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8228
8229
8230@item unset substitute-path [path]
8231@kindex unset substitute-path
8232If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8233for a rule that would rewrite that path.  Delete that rule if found.
8234A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8235
8236If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8237
8238@item show substitute-path [path]
8239@kindex show substitute-path
8240If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8241which would rewrite that path, if any.
8242
8243If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8244rules.
8245
8246@end table
8247
8248If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8249interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8250versions of source.  You can correct the situation as follows:
8251
8252@enumerate
8253@item
8254Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8255
8256@item
8257Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8258directories you want in the source path.  You can add all the
8259directories in one command.
8260@end enumerate
8261
8262@node Machine Code
8263@section Source and Machine Code
8264@cindex source line and its code address
8265
8266You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8267addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8268a range of addresses as machine instructions.  You can use the command
8269@code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8270source line when execution stops.  When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8271mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8272line specified.  Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8273well as hex.
8274
8275@table @code
8276@kindex info line
8277@item info line @var{location}
8278Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8279source line @var{location}.  You can specify source lines in any of
8280the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8281@end table
8282
8283For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8284the object code for the first line of function
8285@code{m4_changequote}:
8286
8287@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8288@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8289@smallexample
8290(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8291Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8292@end smallexample
8293
8294@noindent
8295@cindex code address and its source line
8296We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8297@var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8298@smallexample
8299(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8300Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8301@end smallexample
8302
8303@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8304@cindex @code{x} command, default address
8305@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8306After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8307is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8308sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8309,Examining Memory}).  Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8310convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8311Variables}).
8312
8313@table @code
8314@kindex disassemble
8315@cindex assembly instructions
8316@cindex instructions, assembly
8317@cindex machine instructions
8318@cindex listing machine instructions
8319@item disassemble
8320@itemx disassemble /m
8321@itemx disassemble /s
8322@itemx disassemble /r
8323This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8324instructions.  It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8325the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8326as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8327The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8328program counter of the selected frame.  A single argument to this
8329command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8330surrounding this value.  When two arguments are given, they should
8331be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace.  The
8332arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8333
8334@table @code
8335@item @var{start},@var{end}
8336the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8337@item @var{start},+@var{length}
8338the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8339@code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8340@end table
8341
8342@noindent
8343When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8344printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8345
8346The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8347@samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8348
8349If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8350the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8351@end table
8352
8353The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8354HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8355
8356@smallexample
8357(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8358Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8359   0x32c4 <main+204>:      addil 0,dp
8360   0x32c8 <main+208>:      ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8361   0x32cc <main+212>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
8362   0x32d0 <main+216>:      ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8363   0x32d4 <main+220>:      ldo 0(r31),rp
8364   0x32d8 <main+224>:      addil -0x800,dp
8365   0x32dc <main+228>:      ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8366   0x32e0 <main+232>:      ldil 0x3000,r31
8367End of assembler dump.
8368@end smallexample
8369
8370Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8371with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8372function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8373
8374@smallexample
8375(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8376Dump of assembler code for function main:
83775       @{
8378   0x08048330 <+0>:    push   %ebp
8379   0x08048331 <+1>:    mov    %esp,%ebp
8380   0x08048333 <+3>:    sub    $0x8,%esp
8381   0x08048336 <+6>:    and    $0xfffffff0,%esp
8382   0x08048339 <+9>:    sub    $0x10,%esp
8383
83846         printf ("Hello.\n");
8385=> 0x0804833c <+12>:   movl   $0x8048440,(%esp)
8386   0x08048343 <+19>:   call   0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8387
83887         return 0;
83898       @}
8390   0x08048348 <+24>:   mov    $0x0,%eax
8391   0x0804834d <+29>:   leave
8392   0x0804834e <+30>:   ret
8393
8394End of assembler dump.
8395@end smallexample
8396
8397The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8398there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8399The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8400Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8401@code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8402This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8403and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8404Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8405several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8406
8407@file{foo.h}:
8408
8409@smallexample
8410int
8411foo (int a)
8412@{
8413  if (a < 0)
8414    return a * 2;
8415  if (a == 0)
8416    return 1;
8417  return a + 10;
8418@}
8419@end smallexample
8420
8421@file{foo.c}:
8422
8423@smallexample
8424#include "foo.h"
8425volatile int x, y;
8426int
8427main ()
8428@{
8429  x = foo (y);
8430  return 0;
8431@}
8432@end smallexample
8433
8434@smallexample
8435(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8436Dump of assembler code for function main:
84375	@{
8438
84396	  x = foo (y);
8440   0x0000000000400400 <+0>:	mov    0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8441   0x0000000000400417 <+23>:	mov    %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8442
84437	  return 0;
84448	@}
8445   0x000000000040041d <+29>:	xor    %eax,%eax
8446   0x000000000040041f <+31>:	retq
8447   0x0000000000400420 <+32>:	add    %eax,%eax
8448   0x0000000000400422 <+34>:	jmp    0x400417 <main+23>
8449
8450End of assembler dump.
8451(@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8452Dump of assembler code for function main:
8453foo.c:
84545	@{
84556	  x = foo (y);
8456   0x0000000000400400 <+0>:	mov    0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8457
8458foo.h:
84594	  if (a < 0)
8460   0x0000000000400406 <+6>:	test   %eax,%eax
8461   0x0000000000400408 <+8>:	js     0x400420 <main+32>
8462
84636	  if (a == 0)
84647	    return 1;
84658	  return a + 10;
8466   0x000000000040040a <+10>:	lea    0xa(%rax),%edx
8467   0x000000000040040d <+13>:	test   %eax,%eax
8468   0x000000000040040f <+15>:	mov    $0x1,%eax
8469   0x0000000000400414 <+20>:	cmovne %edx,%eax
8470
8471foo.c:
84726	  x = foo (y);
8473   0x0000000000400417 <+23>:	mov    %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8474
84757	  return 0;
84768	@}
8477   0x000000000040041d <+29>:	xor    %eax,%eax
8478   0x000000000040041f <+31>:	retq
8479
8480foo.h:
84815	    return a * 2;
8482   0x0000000000400420 <+32>:	add    %eax,%eax
8483   0x0000000000400422 <+34>:	jmp    0x400417 <main+23>
8484End of assembler dump.
8485@end smallexample
8486
8487Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8488
8489@smallexample
8490(gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8491Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8492   0x0000000000400281:  38 36  cmp    %dh,(%rsi)
8493   0x0000000000400283:  2d 36 34 2e 73 sub    $0x732e3436,%eax
8494   0x0000000000400288:  6f     outsl  %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8495   0x0000000000400289:  2e 32 00       xor    %cs:(%rax),%al
8496End of assembler dump.
8497@end smallexample
8498
8499Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8500So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8501in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8502and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8503
8504Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8505mnemonics or other syntax.
8506
8507For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8508instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8509libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8510location of the relocation table.  On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8511might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8512
8513@table @code
8514@kindex set disassembly-flavor
8515@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8516@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8517@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8518Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8519program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8520
8521Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family.  You
8522can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8523The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8524assemblers for x86-based targets.
8525
8526@kindex show disassembly-flavor
8527@item show disassembly-flavor
8528Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8529@end table
8530
8531@table @code
8532@kindex set disassemble-next-line
8533@kindex show disassemble-next-line
8534@item set disassemble-next-line
8535@itemx show disassemble-next-line
8536Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8537line or instruction when execution stops.  If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8538display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8539program being debugged stops.  This is @emph{in addition} to
8540displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8541possible.  If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8542(e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8543info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8544next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line.  If
8545AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8546if the source line cannot be displayed.  This setting causes
8547@value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8548with no line info or whose source file is unavailable.  The default is
8549OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8550instruction.
8551@end table
8552
8553
8554@node Data
8555@chapter Examining Data
8556
8557@cindex printing data
8558@cindex examining data
8559@kindex print
8560@kindex inspect
8561The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8562command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}.  It
8563evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8564program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8565Different Languages}).  It may also print the expression using a
8566Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8567
8568@table @code
8569@item print @var{expr}
8570@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8571@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language).  By default the
8572value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8573you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8574@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8575Formats}.
8576
8577@item print
8578@itemx print /@var{f}
8579@cindex reprint the last value
8580If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8581@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}).  This allows you to
8582conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8583@end table
8584
8585A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8586It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8587specified format.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8588
8589If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8590fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8591command rather than @code{print}.  @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8592Table}.
8593
8594@cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8595@kindex explore
8596Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8597through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8598the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}).  It
8599offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8600abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8601itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8602embedded in the higher level data types.
8603
8604@table @code
8605@item explore @var{arg}
8606@var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8607visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8608@end table
8609
8610The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8611example.  If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8612C program as
8613
8614@smallexample
8615struct SimpleStruct
8616@{
8617  int i;
8618  double d;
8619@};
8620
8621struct ComplexStruct
8622@{
8623  struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8624  int arr[10];
8625@};
8626@end smallexample
8627
8628@noindent
8629followed by variable declarations as
8630
8631@smallexample
8632struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8633struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8634@end smallexample
8635
8636@noindent
8637then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8638@code{explore} command as follows.
8639
8640@smallexample
8641(gdb) explore cs
8642The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8643the following fields:
8644
8645  ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8646   arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8647
8648Enter the field number of choice:
8649@end smallexample
8650
8651@noindent
8652Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8653prompted to chose the field you want to explore.  Let's say you choose
8654the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}.  Then, since this field is a
8655pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value.  From
8656the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8657value, hence you enter @code{y}.  If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8658be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8659field will be explored as if it were an array.
8660
8661@smallexample
8662`cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8663Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8664The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8665SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8666
8667  i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8668  d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8669
8670Press enter to return to parent value:
8671@end smallexample
8672
8673@noindent
8674If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8675entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8676prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8677to explore.
8678
8679@smallexample
8680`cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8681Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8682
8683`(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8684
8685(cs.arr)[5] = 4
8686
8687Press enter to return to parent value:
8688@end smallexample
8689
8690In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8691leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8692return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8693level data structure).
8694
8695Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8696explore types.  Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8697variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8698program being debugged), you specify a type name.  If you consider the
8699same example as above, your can explore the type
8700@code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8701@code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8702
8703@smallexample
8704(gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8705@end smallexample
8706
8707@noindent
8708By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8709session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8710manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8711example.
8712
8713The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8714@code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8715a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8716being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8717exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8718
8719@table @code
8720@item explore value @var{expr}
8721@cindex explore value
8722This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8723expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8724current context of the program being debugged).  The behavior of this
8725command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8726command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8727
8728@item explore type @var{arg}
8729@cindex explore type
8730This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8731@var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8732debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8733is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8734debugged).  If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8735identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8736argument @var{arg}.  If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8737this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8738being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8739@end table
8740
8741@menu
8742* Expressions::                 Expressions
8743* Ambiguous Expressions::       Ambiguous Expressions
8744* Variables::                   Program variables
8745* Arrays::                      Artificial arrays
8746* Output Formats::              Output formats
8747* Memory::                      Examining memory
8748* Auto Display::                Automatic display
8749* Print Settings::              Print settings
8750* Pretty Printing::             Python pretty printing
8751* Value History::               Value history
8752* Convenience Vars::            Convenience variables
8753* Convenience Funs::            Convenience functions
8754* Registers::                   Registers
8755* Floating Point Hardware::     Floating point hardware
8756* Vector Unit::                 Vector Unit
8757* OS Information::              Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8758* Memory Region Attributes::    Memory region attributes
8759* Dump/Restore Files::          Copy between memory and a file
8760* Core File Generation::        Cause a program dump its core
8761* Character Sets::              Debugging programs that use a different
8762                                character set than GDB does
8763* Caching Target Data::         Data caching for targets
8764* Searching Memory::            Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8765* Value Sizes::                 Managing memory allocated for values
8766@end menu
8767
8768@node Expressions
8769@section Expressions
8770
8771@cindex expressions
8772@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8773compute its value.  Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8774by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8775@value{GDBN}.  This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8776casts, and string constants.  It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8777you compiled your program to include this information; see
8778@ref{Compilation}.
8779
8780@cindex arrays in expressions
8781@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8782the user.  The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}.  For example,
8783you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8784of three integers.  If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8785to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8786is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8787
8788Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8789this manual are in C.  @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8790Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8791languages.
8792
8793In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8794expressions regardless of your programming language.
8795
8796@cindex casts, in expressions
8797Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8798useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8799at that address in memory.
8800@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8801
8802@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8803to programming languages:
8804
8805@table @code
8806@item @@
8807@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8808@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8809
8810@item ::
8811@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8812function where it is defined.  @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8813
8814@cindex @{@var{type}@}
8815@cindex type casting memory
8816@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8817@cindex casts, to view memory
8818@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8819Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8820memory.  The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8821an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8822operators, just as in a cast).  This construct is allowed regardless
8823of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8824@end table
8825
8826@node Ambiguous Expressions
8827@section Ambiguous Expressions
8828@cindex ambiguous expressions
8829
8830Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements.  For instance,
8831some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8832a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8833different contexts.  This is called @dfn{overloading}.  Another example
8834involving Ada is generics.  A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8835templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8836the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8837
8838In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8839the expression to remove the ambiguity.  For instance in C@t{++}, you
8840can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8841@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}.  In Ada, using the fully
8842qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8843as well.
8844
8845When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8846has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8847possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8848The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8849aborts the current command.  If the command in which the expression was
8850used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8851menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8852choices.
8853
8854For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8855breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8856We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8857
8858@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8859@smallexample
8860@group
8861(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8862[0] cancel
8863[1] all
8864[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8865[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8866[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8867[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8868[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8869[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8870> 2 4 6
8871Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8872Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8873Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8874Multiple breakpoints were set.
8875Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8876 breakpoints.
8877(@value{GDBP})
8878@end group
8879@end smallexample
8880
8881@table @code
8882@kindex set multiple-symbols
8883@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8884@cindex multiple-symbols menu
8885
8886This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8887is ambiguous.
8888
8889By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}.  If the command with which
8890the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8891automatically selects all possible choices.  For instance, inserting
8892a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8893inserted on each possible match.  However, if a unique choice must be made,
8894then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8895For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8896in the use of the menu.
8897
8898When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8899when an ambiguity is detected.
8900
8901Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8902an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8903
8904@kindex show multiple-symbols
8905@item show multiple-symbols
8906Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8907@end table
8908
8909@node Variables
8910@section Program Variables
8911
8912The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8913in your program.
8914
8915Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8916(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8917
8918@itemize @bullet
8919@item
8920global (or file-static)
8921@end itemize
8922
8923@noindent or
8924
8925@itemize @bullet
8926@item
8927visible according to the scope rules of the
8928programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8929@end itemize
8930
8931@noindent This means that in the function
8932
8933@smallexample
8934foo (a)
8935     int a;
8936@{
8937  bar (a);
8938  @{
8939    int b = test ();
8940    bar (b);
8941  @}
8942@}
8943@end smallexample
8944
8945@noindent
8946you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8947executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8948examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8949the block where @code{b} is declared.
8950
8951@cindex variable name conflict
8952There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8953scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8954in this file.  But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8955function with the same name (in different source files).  If that
8956happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects.  If you wish,
8957you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8958using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8959
8960@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8961@ifnotinfo
8962@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8963@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8964@end ifnotinfo
8965@smallexample
8966@var{file}::@var{variable}
8967@var{function}::@var{variable}
8968@end smallexample
8969
8970@noindent
8971Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8972static @var{variable}.  In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8973make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8974to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8975
8976@smallexample
8977(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8978@end smallexample
8979
8980The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8981static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8982in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8983simple name of the variable.  However, you may also use this notation
8984to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8985
8986@smallexample
8987void
8988foo (int a)
8989@{
8990  if (a < 10)
8991    bar (a);
8992  else
8993    process (a);    /* Stop here */
8994@}
8995
8996int
8997bar (int a)
8998@{
8999  foo (a + 5);
9000@}
9001@end smallexample
9002
9003@noindent
9004For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9005here is what you might see
9006when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9007
9008@smallexample
9009(@value{GDBP}) p a
9010$1 = 10
9011(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9012$2 = 5
9013(@value{GDBP}) up 2
9014#2  0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9015(@value{GDBP}) p a
9016$3 = 5
9017(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9018$4 = 0
9019@end smallexample
9020
9021@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9022These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9023similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}.  When they are in
9024conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9025overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9026
9027For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9028that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9029include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9030@code{some_global}.
9031
9032@smallexample
9033(@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9034$1 = 23
9035(@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9036A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9037(@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9038$2 = 27
9039@end smallexample
9040
9041@cindex wrong values
9042@cindex variable values, wrong
9043@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9044@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9045@quotation
9046@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9047wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9048scope, and just before exit.
9049@end quotation
9050You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9051This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9052set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9053stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9054values until the stack frame is completely built.  On exit, it usually
9055also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9056after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9057variable definitions may be gone.
9058
9059This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9060To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9061when compiling.
9062
9063@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9064Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9065unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9066opposed to memory addresses).  Depending on the support for such cases
9067offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9068might not be able to display values for such local variables.  If that
9069happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9070
9071@smallexample
9072No symbol "foo" in current context.
9073@end smallexample
9074
9075To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9076different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9077formats.  @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9078options.  @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9079info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9080
9081If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9082@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9083by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9084type>}.  @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9085
9086If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9087value at the time the function got called.  If the value is not available an
9088error message is printed.  Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9089Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9090to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9091
9092@smallexample
9093Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
909429	  i++;
9095(gdb) next
909630	  e (i);
9097(gdb) print i
9098$1 = 31
9099(gdb) print i@@entry
9100$2 = 30
9101@end smallexample
9102
9103Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9104signedness.  Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9105printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers.  @code{-fsigned-char} or
9106@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9107defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9108For program code
9109
9110@smallexample
9111char var0[] = "A";
9112signed char var1[] = "A";
9113@end smallexample
9114
9115You get during debugging
9116@smallexample
9117(gdb) print var0
9118$1 = "A"
9119(gdb) print var1
9120$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9121@end smallexample
9122
9123@node Arrays
9124@section Artificial Arrays
9125
9126@cindex artificial array
9127@cindex arrays
9128@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9129It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9130same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9131dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9132program.
9133
9134You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9135@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}.  The left
9136operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9137and be an individual object.  The right operand should be the desired length
9138of the array.  The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9139the type of the left argument.  The first element is actually the left
9140argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9141following those that hold the first element, and so on.  Here is an
9142example.  If a program says
9143
9144@smallexample
9145int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9146@end smallexample
9147
9148@noindent
9149you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9150
9151@smallexample
9152p *array@@len
9153@end smallexample
9154
9155The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory.  Array values made
9156with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9157subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9158Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9159(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9160
9161Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9162This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9163The value need not be in memory:
9164@smallexample
9165(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9166$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9167@end smallexample
9168
9169As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9170@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9171the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9172@smallexample
9173(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9174$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9175@end smallexample
9176
9177Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9178moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9179actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9180of pointers in an array.  One useful work-around in this situation is
9181to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9182Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9183interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}.  For
9184instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9185structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9186in each structure.  Here is an example of what you might type:
9187
9188@smallexample
9189set $i = 0
9190p dtab[$i++]->fv
9191@key{RET}
9192@key{RET}
9193@dots{}
9194@end smallexample
9195
9196@node Output Formats
9197@section Output Formats
9198
9199@cindex formatted output
9200@cindex output formats
9201By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type.  Sometimes
9202this is not what you want.  For example, you might want to print a number
9203in hex, or a pointer in decimal.  Or you might want to view data in memory
9204at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction.  To do
9205these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9206
9207The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9208already computed.  This is done by starting the arguments of the
9209@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter.  The format
9210letters supported are:
9211
9212@table @code
9213@item x
9214Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9215hexadecimal.
9216
9217@item d
9218Print as integer in signed decimal.
9219
9220@item u
9221Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9222
9223@item o
9224Print as integer in octal.
9225
9226@item t
9227Print as integer in binary.  The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9228@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9229used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9230see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9231
9232@item a
9233@cindex unknown address, locating
9234@cindex locate address
9235Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9236the nearest preceding symbol.  You can use this format used to discover
9237where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9238
9239@smallexample
9240(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9241$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9242@end smallexample
9243
9244@noindent
9245The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9246@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9247
9248@item c
9249Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.  This
9250prints both the numerical value and its character representation.  The
9251character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9252for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9253
9254Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9255@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9256constants.  Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9257data.
9258
9259@item f
9260Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9261using typical floating point syntax.
9262
9263@item s
9264@cindex printing strings
9265@cindex printing byte arrays
9266Regard as a string, if possible.  With this format, pointers to single-byte
9267data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9268are displayed as fixed-length strings.  Other values are displayed in their
9269natural types.
9270
9271Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9272@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9273strings.  Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9274array.
9275
9276@item z
9277Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9278printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9279to the size of the integer type.
9280
9281@item r
9282@cindex raw printing
9283Print using the @samp{raw} formatting.  By default, @value{GDBN} will
9284use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9285Printing}).  This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9286value's contents.  The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9287pretty-printer which might exist.
9288@end table
9289
9290For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9291
9292@smallexample
9293p/x $pc
9294@end smallexample
9295
9296@noindent
9297Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9298names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9299
9300To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9301you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9302expression.  For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9303
9304@node Memory
9305@section Examining Memory
9306
9307You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9308any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9309
9310@cindex examining memory
9311@table @code
9312@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9313@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9314@itemx x @var{addr}
9315@itemx x
9316Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9317@end table
9318
9319@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9320much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9321expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9322If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9323Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9324
9325@table @r
9326@item @var{n}, the repeat count
9327The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1.  It specifies
9328how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.  If a negative
9329number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9330@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9331@c 4.1.2.
9332
9333@item @var{f}, the display format
9334The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9335(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9336@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9337The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.  The default changes
9338each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9339
9340@item @var{u}, the unit size
9341The unit size is any of
9342
9343@table @code
9344@item b
9345Bytes.
9346@item h
9347Halfwords (two bytes).
9348@item w
9349Words (four bytes).  This is the initial default.
9350@item g
9351Giant words (eight bytes).
9352@end table
9353
9354Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9355default unit the next time you use @code{x}.  For the @samp{i} format,
9356the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.  For the @samp{s} format,
9357the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9358Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
935932-bit strings.  The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9360Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9361current compilation unit.  If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9362modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9363UTF-32.  The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9364be altered.
9365
9366@item @var{addr}, starting display address
9367@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9368memory.  The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9369it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9370@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions.  The default for
9371@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9372other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9373the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9374starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9375a value from memory).
9376@end table
9377
9378For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9379(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9380starting at address @code{0x54320}.  @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9381words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9382@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9383
9384You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9385from the given address.  For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9386halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9387
9388Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9389letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9390unit size or format comes first; either order works.  The output
9391specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9392(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9393
9394Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9395and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9396@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9397including any operands.  For convenience, especially when used with
9398the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9399slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9400follow the last instruction that is within the count.  The command
9401@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9402instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9403
9404If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9405the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9406address as many as the absolute value of the given number.  For the @samp{i}
9407format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9408instruction boundaries while disassembling backward.  If line info is not
9409available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9410
9411All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9412easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9413you use @code{x}.  For example, after you have inspected three machine
9414instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9415with just @samp{x/7}.  If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9416the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9417for successive uses of @code{x}.
9418
9419When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9420counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9421
9422@smallexample
9423(@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9424   0x804837f <main+11>: mov    %esp,%ebp
9425   0x8048381 <main+13>: push   %ecx
9426   0x8048382 <main+14>: sub    $0x4,%esp
9427=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl   $0x8048460,(%esp)
9428   0x804838c <main+24>: call   0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9429@end smallexample
9430
9431@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9432The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9433in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9434would get in the way.  Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9435subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9436@code{$_} and @code{$__}.  After an @code{x} command, the last address
9437examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9438@code{$_}.  The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9439the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9440
9441If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9442are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9443address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9444
9445@anchor{addressable memory unit}
9446@cindex addressable memory unit
9447Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits.  This means
9448that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data.  Some
9449targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9450Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9451@dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9452when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size.  The word
9453@dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9454the addressable memory unit size of the target.  For most systems,
9455addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9456
9457@cindex remote memory comparison
9458@cindex target memory comparison
9459@cindex verify remote memory image
9460@cindex verify target memory image
9461When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9462(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9463in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9464downloaded to the target.  Or, on any target, you may want to check
9465whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections.  The
9466@code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9467
9468@table @code
9469@kindex compare-sections
9470@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9471Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9472executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9473the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches.  With no
9474arguments, compares all loadable sections.  With an argument of
9475@code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9476
9477Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9478target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9479(@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9480@end table
9481
9482@node Auto Display
9483@section Automatic Display
9484@cindex automatic display
9485@cindex display of expressions
9486
9487If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9488(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9489display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9490Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9491to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9492The automatic display looks like this:
9493
9494@smallexample
94952: foo = 38
94963: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9497@end smallexample
9498
9499@noindent
9500This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values.  As with
9501displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9502specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9503whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9504specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9505or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9506
9507@table @code
9508@kindex display
9509@item display @var{expr}
9510Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9511each time your program stops.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9512
9513@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9514
9515@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9516For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9517count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9518arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9519@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9520
9521@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9522For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9523number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9524be examined each time your program stops.  Examining means in effect
9525doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}.  @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9526@end table
9527
9528For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9529instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9530is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9531
9532@table @code
9533@kindex delete display
9534@kindex undisplay
9535@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9536@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9537Remove items from the list of expressions to display.  Specify the
9538numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9539argument @var{dnums}.  It can be a single display number, one of the
9540numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9541or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9542
9543@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9544(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9545
9546@kindex disable display
9547@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9548Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  A disabled display
9549item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten.  It may be
9550enabled again later.  Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9551want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}.  It can be a
9552single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9553the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9554numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9555
9556@kindex enable display
9557@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9558Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}.  It becomes effective once
9559again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9560Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9561command argument @var{dnums}.  It can be a single display number, one
9562of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9563display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9564
9565@item display
9566Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9567done when your program stops.
9568
9569@kindex info display
9570@item info display
9571Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9572automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9573values.  This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9574It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9575because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9576@end table
9577
9578@cindex display disabled out of scope
9579If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9580sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up.  Such an
9581expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9582variables is not defined.  For example, if you give the command
9583@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9584@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9585continues to stop inside that function.  When it stops elsewhere---where
9586there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9587automatically.  The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9588is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9589
9590@node Print Settings
9591@section Print Settings
9592
9593@cindex format options
9594@cindex print settings
9595@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9596and symbols are printed.
9597
9598@noindent
9599These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9600
9601@table @code
9602@kindex set print
9603@item set print address
9604@itemx set print address on
9605@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9606@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9607traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9608even when it also displays the contents of those addresses.  The default
9609is @code{on}.  For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9610@code{set print address on}:
9611
9612@smallexample
9613@group
9614(@value{GDBP}) f
9615#0  set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9616    at input.c:530
9617530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
9618@end group
9619@end smallexample
9620
9621@item set print address off
9622Do not print addresses when displaying their contents.  For example,
9623this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9624
9625@smallexample
9626@group
9627(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9628(@value{GDBP}) f
9629#0  set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9630530         if (lquote != def_lquote)
9631@end group
9632@end smallexample
9633
9634You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9635dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface.  For example, with
9636@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9637all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9638
9639@kindex show print
9640@item show print address
9641Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9642@end table
9643
9644When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9645closest earlier symbol plus an offset.  If that symbol does not uniquely
9646identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9647source file), you may need to clarify.  One way to do this is with
9648@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}.  Alternately,
9649you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9650it prints a symbolic address:
9651
9652@table @code
9653@item set print symbol-filename on
9654@cindex source file and line of a symbol
9655@cindex symbol, source file and line
9656Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9657symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9658
9659@item set print symbol-filename off
9660Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol.  This is the
9661default.
9662
9663@item show print symbol-filename
9664Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9665line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9666@end table
9667
9668Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9669numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9670number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9671
9672Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9673printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9674
9675@table @code
9676@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9677@itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9678@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9679Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9680offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9681@var{max-offset}.  The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9682to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9683it.  Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9684
9685@item show print max-symbolic-offset
9686Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9687symbolic address.
9688@end table
9689
9690@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9691@cindex pointer, finding referent
9692If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9693@samp{set print symbol-filename on}.  Then you can determine the name
9694and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9695@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}.  This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9696For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9697at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9698
9699@smallexample
9700(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9701(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9702$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9703@end smallexample
9704
9705@quotation
9706@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9707does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9708the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9709@end quotation
9710
9711You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9712@samp{set print symbol on}:
9713
9714@table @code
9715@item set print symbol on
9716Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9717one exists.
9718
9719@item set print symbol off
9720Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9721address.  In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9722corresponding to pointers to functions.  This is the default.
9723
9724@item show print symbol
9725Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9726address.
9727@end table
9728
9729Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9730
9731@table @code
9732@item set print array
9733@itemx set print array on
9734@cindex pretty print arrays
9735Pretty print arrays.  This format is more convenient to read,
9736but uses more space.  The default is off.
9737
9738@item set print array off
9739Return to compressed format for arrays.
9740
9741@item show print array
9742Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9743arrays.
9744
9745@cindex print array indexes
9746@item set print array-indexes
9747@itemx set print array-indexes on
9748Print the index of each element when displaying arrays.  May be more
9749convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9750index of a given element in that printed array.  The default is off.
9751
9752@item set print array-indexes off
9753Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9754
9755@item show print array-indexes
9756Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9757arrays.
9758
9759@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9760@itemx set print elements unlimited
9761@cindex number of array elements to print
9762@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9763Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9764If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9765printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9766This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9767When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9768Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9769that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9770
9771@item show print elements
9772Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9773If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9774
9775@item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9776@kindex set print frame-arguments
9777@cindex printing frame argument values
9778@cindex print all frame argument values
9779@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9780@cindex do not print frame argument values
9781This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9782when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}).  The possible
9783values are:
9784
9785@table @code
9786@item all
9787The values of all arguments are printed.
9788
9789@item scalars
9790Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar.  The value of more
9791complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9792by @code{@dots{}}.  This is the default.  Here is an example where
9793only scalar arguments are shown:
9794
9795@smallexample
9796#1  0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9797  at frame-args.c:23
9798@end smallexample
9799
9800@item none
9801None of the argument values are printed.  Instead, the value of each argument
9802is replaced by @code{@dots{}}.  In this case, the example above now becomes:
9803
9804@smallexample
9805#1  0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9806  at frame-args.c:23
9807@end smallexample
9808@end table
9809
9810By default, only scalar arguments are printed.  This command can be used
9811to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9812of their type.  However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9813of more complex parameters.  For instance, it reduces the amount of
9814information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9815Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9816the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9817especially in large applications.  Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9818to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9819thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9820
9821@item show print frame-arguments
9822Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9823
9824@item set print raw frame-arguments on
9825Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9826
9827@item set print raw frame-arguments off
9828Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9829for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9830otherwise print the value in raw form.
9831This is the default.
9832
9833@item show print raw frame-arguments
9834Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9835
9836@anchor{set print entry-values}
9837@item set print entry-values @var{value}
9838@kindex set print entry-values
9839Set printing of frame argument values at function entry.  In some cases
9840@value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9841the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9842and therefore is different.  With optimized code, the current value could be
9843unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9844
9845The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description).  Older
9846@value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}.  Compilers not supporting
9847this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9848@code{no} setting.
9849
9850This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9851the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags.  With
9852@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9853this information.
9854
9855The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9856
9857@table @code
9858@item no
9859Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9860point.
9861@smallexample
9862#0  equal (val=5)
9863#0  different (val=6)
9864#0  lost (val=<optimized out>)
9865#0  born (val=10)
9866#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9867@end smallexample
9868
9869@item only
9870Print only parameter values from function entry point.  The actual parameter
9871values are never printed.
9872@smallexample
9873#0  equal (val@@entry=5)
9874#0  different (val@@entry=5)
9875#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9876#0  born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9877#0  invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9878@end smallexample
9879
9880@item preferred
9881Print only parameter values from function entry point.  If value from function
9882entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9883value for such parameter.
9884@smallexample
9885#0  equal (val@@entry=5)
9886#0  different (val@@entry=5)
9887#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9888#0  born (val=10)
9889#0  invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9890@end smallexample
9891
9892@item if-needed
9893Print actual parameter values.  If actual parameter value is not known while
9894value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9895parameter.
9896@smallexample
9897#0  equal (val=5)
9898#0  different (val=6)
9899#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9900#0  born (val=10)
9901#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9902@end smallexample
9903
9904@item both
9905Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9906point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9907optimizations.
9908@smallexample
9909#0  equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9910#0  different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9911#0  lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9912#0  born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9913#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9914@end smallexample
9915
9916@item compact
9917Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9918function entry point if it is known.  If neither is known, print for the actual
9919value @code{<optimized out>}.  If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9920values are known and identical, print the shortened
9921@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9922@smallexample
9923#0  equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9924#0  different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9925#0  lost (val@@entry=5)
9926#0  born (val=10)
9927#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9928@end smallexample
9929
9930@item default
9931Always print the actual parameter value.  Print also its value from function
9932entry point, but only if it is known.  If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9933if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9934@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9935@smallexample
9936#0  equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9937#0  different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9938#0  lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9939#0  born (val=10)
9940#0  invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9941@end smallexample
9942@end table
9943
9944For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9945entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9946
9947@item show print entry-values
9948Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9949entry.
9950
9951@item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9952@itemx set print repeats unlimited
9953@cindex repeated array elements
9954Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9955elements.  When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9956array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9957@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9958identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9959themselves.  Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9960cause all elements to be individually printed.  The default threshold
9961is 10.
9962
9963@item show print repeats
9964Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9965elements.
9966
9967@item set print null-stop
9968@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9969Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9970@sc{null} is encountered.  This is useful when large arrays actually
9971contain only short strings.
9972The default is off.
9973
9974@item show print null-stop
9975Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9976@sc{null} character.
9977
9978@item set print pretty on
9979@cindex print structures in indented form
9980@cindex indentation in structure display
9981Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9982per line, like this:
9983
9984@smallexample
9985@group
9986$1 = @{
9987  next = 0x0,
9988  flags = @{
9989    sweet = 1,
9990    sour = 1
9991  @},
9992  meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9993@}
9994@end group
9995@end smallexample
9996
9997@item set print pretty off
9998Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9999
10000@smallexample
10001@group
10002$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10003meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10004@end group
10005@end smallexample
10006
10007@noindent
10008This is the default format.
10009
10010@item show print pretty
10011Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10012
10013@item set print sevenbit-strings on
10014@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10015@cindex octal escapes in strings
10016Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10017@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10018character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}.  This setting is
10019best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10020high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10021
10022@item set print sevenbit-strings off
10023Print full eight-bit characters.  This allows the use of more
10024international character sets, and is the default.
10025
10026@item show print sevenbit-strings
10027Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10028
10029@item set print union on
10030@cindex unions in structures, printing
10031Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10032and other unions.  This is the default setting.
10033
10034@item set print union off
10035Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10036structures and other unions.  @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10037instead.
10038
10039@item show print union
10040Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10041structures and other unions.
10042
10043For example, given the declarations
10044
10045@smallexample
10046typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10047typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10048typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10049              Bug_forms;
10050
10051struct thing @{
10052  Species it;
10053  union @{
10054    Tree_forms tree;
10055    Bug_forms bug;
10056  @} form;
10057@};
10058
10059struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10060@end smallexample
10061
10062@noindent
10063with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10064
10065@smallexample
10066$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10067@end smallexample
10068
10069@noindent
10070and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10071
10072@smallexample
10073$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10074@end smallexample
10075
10076@noindent
10077@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10078and in Pascal.
10079@end table
10080
10081@need 1000
10082@noindent
10083These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10084
10085@table @code
10086@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10087@item set print demangle
10088@itemx set print demangle on
10089Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10090(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10091linkage.  The default is on.
10092
10093@item show print demangle
10094Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10095
10096@item set print asm-demangle
10097@itemx set print asm-demangle on
10098Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10099in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10100The default is off.
10101
10102@item show print asm-demangle
10103Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10104or demangled form.
10105
10106@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10107@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10108@kindex set demangle-style
10109@item set demangle-style @var{style}
10110Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10111represent C@t{++} names.  The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10112
10113@table @code
10114@item auto
10115Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10116This is the default.
10117
10118@item gnu
10119Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10120
10121@item hp
10122Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10123
10124@item lucid
10125Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10126
10127@item arm
10128Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10129@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10130debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables.  @value{GDBN} would
10131require further enhancement to permit that.
10132
10133@end table
10134If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10135
10136@item show demangle-style
10137Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10138
10139@item set print object
10140@itemx set print object on
10141@cindex derived type of an object, printing
10142@cindex display derived types
10143When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10144(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10145the virtual function table.  Note that the virtual function table is
10146required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10147type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10148type is sufficient.  Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10149working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10150
10151@item set print object off
10152Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10153virtual function table.  This is the default setting.
10154
10155@item show print object
10156Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10157
10158@item set print static-members
10159@itemx set print static-members on
10160@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10161Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.  The default is on.
10162
10163@item set print static-members off
10164Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10165
10166@item show print static-members
10167Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10168
10169@item set print pascal_static-members
10170@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10171@cindex static members of Pascal objects
10172@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10173Print static members when displaying a Pascal object.  The default is on.
10174
10175@item set print pascal_static-members off
10176Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10177
10178@item show print pascal_static-members
10179Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10180
10181@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10182@item set print vtbl
10183@itemx set print vtbl on
10184@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10185@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10186@cindex VTBL display
10187Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.  The default is off.
10188(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10189ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10190
10191@item set print vtbl off
10192Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10193
10194@item show print vtbl
10195Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10196@end table
10197
10198@node Pretty Printing
10199@section Pretty Printing
10200
10201@value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10202Python code.  It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects.  This
10203mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10204
10205@menu
10206* Pretty-Printer Introduction::  Introduction to pretty-printers
10207* Pretty-Printer Example::       An example pretty-printer
10208* Pretty-Printer Commands::      Pretty-printer commands
10209@end menu
10210
10211@node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10212@subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10213
10214When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10215registered for the value.  If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10216pretty-printer to print the value.  Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10217
10218Pretty-printers are normally named.  This makes them easy to manage.
10219The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10220pretty-printers with their names.
10221If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10222@dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10223Each such subprinter has its own name.
10224The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10225
10226Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10227Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10228debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10229do anything special.
10230
10231There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10232
10233@itemize @bullet
10234@item
10235Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10236all inferiors.
10237
10238@item
10239Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10240when debugging that program.
10241@xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10242
10243@item
10244Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10245with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10246@xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10247@end itemize
10248
10249@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10250pretty-printers are selected,
10251
10252@xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10253for new types.
10254
10255@node Pretty-Printer Example
10256@subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10257
10258Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10259
10260@smallexample
10261(@value{GDBP}) print s
10262$1 = @{
10263  static npos = 4294967295,
10264  _M_dataplus = @{
10265    <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10266      <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10267        <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10268      @},
10269    members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10270      std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10271    _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10272  @}
10273@}
10274@end smallexample
10275
10276With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10277
10278@smallexample
10279(@value{GDBP}) print s
10280$2 = "abcd"
10281@end smallexample
10282
10283@node Pretty-Printer Commands
10284@subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10285@cindex pretty-printer commands
10286
10287@table @code
10288@kindex info pretty-printer
10289@item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10290Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10291This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10292
10293@var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10294whose pretty-printers to list.
10295Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10296(@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10297and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10298@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10299looks up a printer from these three objects.
10300
10301@var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10302to list.
10303
10304@kindex disable pretty-printer
10305@item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10306Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10307A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10308
10309@kindex enable pretty-printer
10310@item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10311Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10312@end table
10313
10314Example:
10315
10316Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10317named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10318another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10319@code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10320
10321@smallexample
10322(gdb) info pretty-printer
10323library1.so:
10324  foo
10325library2.so:
10326  bar
10327    bar1
10328    bar2
10329(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10330library2.so:
10331  bar
10332    bar1
10333    bar2
10334(gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
103351 printer disabled
103362 of 3 printers enabled
10337(gdb) info pretty-printer
10338library1.so:
10339  foo [disabled]
10340library2.so:
10341  bar
10342    bar1
10343    bar2
10344(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
103451 printer disabled
103461 of 3 printers enabled
10347(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10348library1.so:
10349  foo [disabled]
10350library2.so:
10351  bar
10352    bar1 [disabled]
10353    bar2
10354(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
103551 printer disabled
103560 of 3 printers enabled
10357(gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10358library1.so:
10359  foo [disabled]
10360library2.so:
10361  bar [disabled]
10362    bar1 [disabled]
10363    bar2
10364@end smallexample
10365
10366Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10367as can each individual subprinter.
10368
10369@node Value History
10370@section Value History
10371
10372@cindex value history
10373@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10374Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10375@dfn{value history}.  This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10376Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10377(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10378When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10379since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10380symbol table.
10381
10382@cindex @code{$}
10383@cindex @code{$$}
10384@cindex history number
10385The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10386refer to them.  These are successive integers starting with one.
10387@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10388printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10389history number.
10390
10391To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10392history number.  The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10393remind you of this.  Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10394the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10395@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10396is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10397@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10398
10399For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10400want to see the contents of the structure.  It suffices to type
10401
10402@smallexample
10403p *$
10404@end smallexample
10405
10406If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10407to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10408
10409@smallexample
10410p *$.next
10411@end smallexample
10412
10413@noindent
10414You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10415command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10416
10417Note that the history records values, not expressions.  If the value of
10418@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10419
10420@smallexample
10421print x
10422set x=5
10423@end smallexample
10424
10425@noindent
10426then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10427remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10428
10429@table @code
10430@kindex show values
10431@item show values
10432Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10433This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10434values} does not change the history.
10435
10436@item show values @var{n}
10437Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10438
10439@item show values +
10440Print ten history values just after the values last printed.  If no more
10441values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10442@end table
10443
10444Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10445same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10446
10447@node Convenience Vars
10448@section Convenience Variables
10449
10450@cindex convenience variables
10451@cindex user-defined variables
10452@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10453@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later.  These variables
10454exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10455setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10456of your program.  That is why you can use them freely.
10457
10458Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}.  Any name preceded by
10459@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10460the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10461(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10462by @samp{$}.  @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10463
10464You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10465expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10466For example:
10467
10468@smallexample
10469set $foo = *object_ptr
10470@end smallexample
10471
10472@noindent
10473would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10474@code{object_ptr}.
10475
10476Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10477value is @code{void} until you assign a new value.  You can alter the
10478value with another assignment at any time.
10479
10480Convenience variables have no fixed types.  You can assign a convenience
10481variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10482that variable already has a value of a different type.  The convenience
10483variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10484
10485@table @code
10486@kindex show convenience
10487@cindex show all user variables and functions
10488@item show convenience
10489Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10490as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10491Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10492
10493@kindex init-if-undefined
10494@cindex convenience variables, initializing
10495@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10496Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set.  This is useful
10497for user-defined commands that keep some state.  It is similar, in concept,
10498to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10499convenience variables are global).  It can also be used to allow users to
10500override default values used in a command script.
10501
10502If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10503any side-effects do not occur.
10504@end table
10505
10506One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10507incremented or a pointer to be advanced.  For example, to print
10508a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10509
10510@smallexample
10511set $i = 0
10512print bar[$i++]->contents
10513@end smallexample
10514
10515@noindent
10516Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10517
10518Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10519values likely to be useful.
10520
10521@table @code
10522@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10523@item $_
10524The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10525the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).  Other
10526commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10527set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10528and @code{info breakpoint}.  The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10529except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10530to the type of @code{$__}.
10531
10532@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10533@item $__
10534The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10535to the value found in the last address examined.  Its type is chosen
10536to match the format in which the data was printed.
10537
10538@item $_exitcode
10539@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10540When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10541automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10542resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10543
10544@item $_exitsignal
10545@vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10546When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10547@value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10548and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10549
10550To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10551(i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10552@code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10553@code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10554Functions}).  For example, considering the following source code:
10555
10556@smallexample
10557#include <signal.h>
10558
10559int
10560main (int argc, char *argv[])
10561@{
10562  raise (SIGALRM);
10563  return 0;
10564@}
10565@end smallexample
10566
10567A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10568or signalled would be:
10569
10570@smallexample
10571(@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10572Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10573End with a line saying just ``end''.
10574>if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10575 >echo The program has exited\n
10576 >else
10577 >echo The program has signalled\n
10578 >end
10579>end
10580(@value{GDBP}) run
10581Starting program:
10582
10583Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10584The program no longer exists.
10585(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10586The program has signalled
10587@end smallexample
10588
10589As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10590debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10591@code{SIGALRM} signal.  If the program being debugged had not called
10592@code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10593
10594@smallexample
10595(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10596The program has exited
10597@end smallexample
10598
10599@item $_exception
10600The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10601thrown at an exception-related catchpoint.  @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10602
10603@item $_probe_argc
10604@itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10605Arguments to a static probe.  @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10606
10607@item $_sdata
10608@vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10609The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10610data.  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.  Note that
10611@code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10612if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10613
10614@item $_siginfo
10615@vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10616The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10617(@pxref{extra signal information}).  Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10618could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10619For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10620
10621@item $_tlb
10622@vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10623The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10624applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10625gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10626@xref{General Query Packets}.
10627This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10628
10629@item $_inferior
10630The number of the current inferior.  @xref{Inferiors and
10631Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10632
10633@item $_thread
10634The thread number of the current thread.  @xref{thread numbers}.
10635
10636@item $_gthread
10637The global number of the current thread.  @xref{global thread numbers}.
10638
10639@end table
10640
10641@node Convenience Funs
10642@section Convenience Functions
10643
10644@cindex convenience functions
10645@value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}.  These
10646have a syntax similar to convenience variables.  A convenience
10647function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10648however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10649@value{GDBN}.
10650
10651These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10652@code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10653
10654@table @code
10655
10656@item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10657@findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10658Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}.  Otherwise it
10659returns zero.
10660
10661A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10662is @code{void}.  For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10663(see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10664it is @code{void}:
10665
10666@smallexample
10667(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10668$1 = void
10669(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10670$2 = 1
10671(@value{GDBP}) run
10672Starting program: ./a.out
10673[Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10674(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10675$3 = 0
10676(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10677$4 = 0
10678@end smallexample
10679
10680In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10681@code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10682program being debugged.  Before the execution there is no exit code to
10683be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}.  After the
10684execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10685@code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10686anymore.
10687
10688The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10689program being debugged.  For example, given the following function:
10690
10691@smallexample
10692void
10693foo (void)
10694@{
10695@}
10696@end smallexample
10697
10698The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10699
10700@smallexample
10701(@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10702$1 = void
10703(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10704$2 = 1
10705(@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10706(@value{GDBP}) print $v
10707$3 = void
10708(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10709$4 = 1
10710@end smallexample
10711
10712@end table
10713
10714These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10715@code{Python} support.
10716
10717@table @code
10718
10719@item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10720@findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10721Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10722@var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10723Otherwise it returns zero.
10724
10725@item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10726@findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10727Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10728@var{regex}.  Otherwise it returns zero.
10729The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10730regular expression support.
10731
10732@item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10733@findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10734Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10735Otherwise it returns zero.
10736
10737@item $_strlen(@var{str})
10738@findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10739Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10740
10741@item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10742@findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10743Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10744Otherwise it returns zero.
10745
10746If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10747it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10748The default is 1.
10749
10750Example:
10751
10752@smallexample
10753(gdb) backtrace
10754#0  bottom_func ()
10755    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10756#1  0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10757    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10758#2  0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10759    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10760#3  0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10761    at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10762(gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10763$1 = 1
10764(gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10765$1 = 1
10766@end smallexample
10767
10768@item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10769@findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10770Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10771@var{regexp}.  Otherwise it returns zero.
10772
10773If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10774it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10775The default is 1.
10776
10777@item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10778@findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10779Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10780Otherwise it returns zero.
10781
10782If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10783it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10784The default is 1.
10785
10786This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10787checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10788by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10789frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10790
10791@item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10792@findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10793Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10794@var{regexp}.  Otherwise it returns zero.
10795
10796If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10797it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10798The default is 1.
10799
10800This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10801checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10802by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10803frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10804
10805@item $_as_string(@var{value})
10806@findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
10807Return the string representation of @var{value}.
10808
10809This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
10810enumeration value.  For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
10811an enumerated type:
10812
10813@smallexample
10814(gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
10815Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
10816@end smallexample
10817
10818@end table
10819
10820@value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10821convenience functions.
10822
10823@table @code
10824@item help function
10825@kindex help function
10826@cindex show all convenience functions
10827Print a list of all convenience functions.
10828@end table
10829
10830@node Registers
10831@section Registers
10832
10833@cindex registers
10834You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10835with names starting with @samp{$}.  The names of registers are different
10836for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10837your machine.
10838
10839@table @code
10840@kindex info registers
10841@item info registers
10842Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10843and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10844
10845@kindex info all-registers
10846@cindex floating point registers
10847@item info all-registers
10848Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10849and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10850
10851@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10852Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10853As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10854the selected stack frame.  The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10855the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10856@end table
10857
10858@anchor{standard registers}
10859@cindex stack pointer register
10860@cindex program counter register
10861@cindex process status register
10862@cindex frame pointer register
10863@cindex standard registers
10864@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10865expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10866architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers.  The register names
10867@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10868the stack pointer.  @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10869pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10870register that contains the processor status.  For example,
10871you could print the program counter in hex with
10872
10873@smallexample
10874p/x $pc
10875@end smallexample
10876
10877@noindent
10878or print the instruction to be executed next with
10879
10880@smallexample
10881x/i $pc
10882@end smallexample
10883
10884@noindent
10885or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10886one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10887memory (most machines, nowadays).  This assumes that the innermost
10888stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10889stack frames are selected.  To pop entire frames off the stack,
10890regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10891see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10892
10893@smallexample
10894set $sp += 4
10895@end smallexample
10896
10897Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10898your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10899so long as there is no conflict.  The @code{info registers} command
10900shows the canonical names.  For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10901registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10902can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10903is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10904
10905@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10906integer when the register is examined in this way.  Some machines have
10907special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10908registers are considered to have floating point values.  There is no way
10909to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10910(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10911@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10912
10913Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats.  This
10914means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10915the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10916sees.  For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10917coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10918programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format.  In such
10919cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10920that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10921prints the data in both formats.
10922
10923@cindex SSE registers (x86)
10924@cindex MMX registers (x86)
10925Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10926in several different ways.  For example, modern x86-based machines
10927have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10928together in several different formats.  @value{GDBN} refers to such
10929registers in @code{struct} notation:
10930
10931@smallexample
10932(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10933$1 = @{
10934  v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10935  v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10936  v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10937  v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10938  v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10939  v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10940  uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10941@}
10942@end smallexample
10943
10944@noindent
10945To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10946view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10947value to a @code{struct} member:
10948
10949@smallexample
10950 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10951@end smallexample
10952
10953Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10954(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}).  This means that you get the
10955value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10956were exited and their saved registers restored.  In order to see the
10957true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10958frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10959
10960@cindex caller-saved registers
10961@cindex call-clobbered registers
10962@cindex volatile registers
10963@cindex <not saved> values
10964Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10965callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10966registers).  It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10967the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10968frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10969@value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10970(``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10971machine code generated by your compiler.  If some register is not
10972saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10973its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10974explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10975displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value.  With targets
10976that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10977if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10978in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10979This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10980the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10981call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about.  Note,
10982however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10983may also be affecting the inner frame.  Also, the more ``outer'' the
10984frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10985register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10986represent the value the register had just before the call.
10987
10988@node Floating Point Hardware
10989@section Floating Point Hardware
10990@cindex floating point
10991
10992Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10993you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10994
10995@table @code
10996@kindex info float
10997@item info float
10998Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10999point unit.  The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11000floating point chip.  Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11001the ARM and x86 machines.
11002@end table
11003
11004@node Vector Unit
11005@section Vector Unit
11006@cindex vector unit
11007
11008Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11009more information about the status of the vector unit.
11010
11011@table @code
11012@kindex info vector
11013@item info vector
11014Display information about the vector unit.  The exact contents and
11015layout vary depending on the hardware.
11016@end table
11017
11018@node OS Information
11019@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11020@cindex OS information
11021
11022@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11023you debug your program.
11024
11025@cindex auxiliary vector
11026@cindex vector, auxiliary
11027Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11028startup.  This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11029specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11030binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11031hardware, operating system, and process.  Each value's purpose is
11032identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11033Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11034@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information.  For remote
11035targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11036support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11037@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11038
11039@table @code
11040@kindex info auxv
11041@item info auxv
11042Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11043live process or a core dump file.  @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11044numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11045tags.  Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11046pointers to strings or other data.  @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11047most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11048an unrecognized tag.
11049@end table
11050
11051On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11052information and show it to you.  The types of information available
11053will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11054target.  The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11055@ref{Operating System Information}.  For remote targets, this
11056functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11057@samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11058
11059@table @code
11060@kindex info os
11061@item info os @var{infotype}
11062
11063Display OS information of the requested type.
11064
11065On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11066
11067@anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11068@table @code
11069@kindex info os cpus
11070@item cpus
11071Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11072the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11073different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11074CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11075kernel initialization.
11076
11077@kindex info os files
11078@item files
11079Display the list of open file descriptors on the target.  For each
11080file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11081owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11082of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11083
11084@kindex info os modules
11085@item modules
11086Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target.  For each
11087module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11088bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11089module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11090in memory.
11091
11092@kindex info os msg
11093@item msg
11094Display the list of all System V message queues on the target.  For each
11095message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11096queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11097on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11098that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11099of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11100message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11101the message queue was last changed.
11102
11103@kindex info os processes
11104@item processes
11105Display the list of processes on the target.  For each process,
11106@value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11107command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11108that the process is currently running on.  (To understand what these
11109properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11110the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11111
11112@kindex info os procgroups
11113@item procgroups
11114Display the list of process groups on the target.  For each process,
11115@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11116to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11117identifier, and the command line of the process.  The list is sorted
11118first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11119so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11120and the process group leader is listed first.
11121
11122@kindex info os semaphores
11123@item semaphores
11124Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target.  For each
11125semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11126set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11127set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11128and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11129
11130@kindex info os shm
11131@item shm
11132Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11133For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11134the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11135region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11136attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11137attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11138attached to, detach from, and changed.
11139
11140@kindex info os sockets
11141@item sockets
11142Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target.  For each
11143socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11144remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11145the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11146connection.
11147
11148@kindex info os threads
11149@item threads
11150Display the list of threads running on the target.  For each thread,
11151@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11152belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11153processor core that it is currently running on.  The main thread of a
11154process is not listed.
11155@end table
11156
11157@item info os
11158If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11159@var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11160@var{infotype}.  If the target does not return a list of possible
11161types, this command will report an error.
11162@end table
11163
11164@node Memory Region Attributes
11165@section Memory Region Attributes
11166@cindex memory region attributes
11167
11168@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11169required by regions of your target's memory.  @value{GDBN} uses
11170attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11171accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11172target memory.  By default the description of memory regions is
11173fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11174user can override the fetched regions.
11175
11176Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled.  When a
11177memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11178accessing memory in that region.  Similarly, if no memory regions have
11179been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11180all memory.
11181
11182When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11183to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11184
11185@table @code
11186@kindex mem
11187@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11188Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11189attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11190monitored by @value{GDBN}.  Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11191case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11192(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11193
11194@item mem auto
11195Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11196regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11197
11198@kindex delete mem
11199@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11200Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11201monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11202
11203@kindex disable mem
11204@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11205Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11206A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11207It may be enabled again later.
11208
11209@kindex enable mem
11210@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11211Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11212
11213@kindex info mem
11214@item info mem
11215Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11216for each region:
11217
11218@table @emph
11219@item Memory Region Number
11220@item Enabled or Disabled.
11221Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11222Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11223
11224@item Lo Address
11225The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11226
11227@item Hi Address
11228The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11229
11230@item Attributes
11231The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11232@end table
11233@end table
11234
11235
11236@subsection Attributes
11237
11238@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11239The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11240write accesses to a memory region.
11241
11242While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11243memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11244etc.@: from accessing memory.
11245
11246@table @code
11247@item ro
11248Memory is read only.
11249@item wo
11250Memory is write only.
11251@item rw
11252Memory is read/write.  This is the default.
11253@end table
11254
11255@subsubsection Memory Access Size
11256The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11257accesses in the memory region.  Often memory mapped device registers
11258require specific sized accesses.  If no access size attribute is
11259specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11260
11261@table @code
11262@item 8
11263Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11264@item 16
11265Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11266@item 32
11267Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11268@item 64
11269Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11270@end table
11271
11272@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11273@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11274@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11275@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11276@c
11277@c @table @code
11278@c @item hwbreak
11279@c Always use hardware breakpoints
11280@c @item swbreak (default)
11281@c @end table
11282
11283@subsubsection Data Cache
11284The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11285memory.  While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11286protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11287does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11288registers.
11289
11290@table @code
11291@item cache
11292Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11293@item nocache
11294Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.  This is the default.
11295@end table
11296
11297@subsection Memory Access Checking
11298@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11299not explicitly described.  This can be useful if accessing such
11300regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11301better error checking.  The following commands control this behaviour.
11302
11303@table @code
11304@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11305@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11306If @code{on} is specified, make  @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11307explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11308to such memory.  The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11309memory range defined.  If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11310treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11311The default value is @code{on}.
11312@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11313@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11314Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11315@end table
11316
11317
11318@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11319@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11320@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11321@c
11322@c @table @code
11323@c @item verify
11324@c @item noverify (default)
11325@c @end table
11326
11327@node Dump/Restore Files
11328@section Copy Between Memory and a File
11329@cindex dump/restore files
11330@cindex append data to a file
11331@cindex dump data to a file
11332@cindex restore data from a file
11333
11334You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11335@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file.  The
11336@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11337@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11338memory.  Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11339Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11340append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11341
11342@table @code
11343
11344@kindex dump
11345@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11346@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11347Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11348or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11349
11350The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11351@table @code
11352@item binary
11353Raw binary form.
11354@item ihex
11355Intel hex format.
11356@item srec
11357Motorola S-record format.
11358@item tekhex
11359Tektronix Hex format.
11360@item verilog
11361Verilog Hex format.
11362@end table
11363
11364@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11365@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}.  If
11366@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11367form.
11368
11369@kindex append
11370@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11371@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11372Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11373or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11374(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11375
11376@kindex restore
11377@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11378Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory.  The
11379@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11380file format, except for raw binary.  To restore a raw binary file you
11381must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11382
11383If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11384contained in the file.  Binary files always start at address zero, so
11385they will be restored at address @var{bias}.  Other bfd files have
11386a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11387from that location.
11388
11389If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11390file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11391These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11392the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11393
11394@end table
11395
11396@node Core File Generation
11397@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11398@cindex dump core from inferior
11399
11400A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11401image of a running process and its process status (register values
11402etc.).  Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11403crashed while it ran outside a debugger.  A program that crashes
11404automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11405the user.  @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11406the post-mortem debugging mode.
11407
11408Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11409are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11410@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11411
11412@table @code
11413@kindex gcore
11414@kindex generate-core-file
11415@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11416@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11417Produce a core dump of the inferior process.  The optional argument
11418@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.  If not
11419specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11420@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11421
11422Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11423this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11424
11425On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11426file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11427dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11428
11429@kindex set use-coredump-filter
11430@anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11431@item set use-coredump-filter on
11432@itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11433Enable or disable the use of the file
11434@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11435files.  This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11436memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11437file.  @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11438
11439To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11440@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11441which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types.  If a bit
11442is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11443types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored.  This
11444configuration is inherited by child processes.  For more information
11445about the bits that can be set in the
11446@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11447manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11448
11449By default, this option is @code{on}.  If this option is turned
11450@code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11451and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11452to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file.  This
11453value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11454(anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11455@code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11456This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11457@end table
11458
11459@node Character Sets
11460@section Character Sets
11461@cindex character sets
11462@cindex charset
11463@cindex translating between character sets
11464@cindex host character set
11465@cindex target character set
11466
11467If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11468represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11469@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11470you.  The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11471character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11472@dfn{target character set}.
11473
11474For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11475uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11476remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11477running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11478then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11479@sc{ebcdic}.  If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11480target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11481@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11482character and string literals in expressions.
11483
11484@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11485the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11486target-charset} command, described below.
11487
11488Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11489support:
11490
11491@table @code
11492@item set target-charset @var{charset}
11493@kindex set target-charset
11494Set the current target character set to @var{charset}.  To display the
11495list of supported target character sets, type
11496@kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11497
11498@item set host-charset @var{charset}
11499@kindex set host-charset
11500Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11501
11502By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11503system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11504@code{set host-charset} command.  On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11505automatically determine the appropriate host character set.  In this
11506case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11507
11508@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11509set.  If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11510@value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11511
11512@item set charset @var{charset}
11513@kindex set charset
11514Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}.  As
11515above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11516@value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11517for both host and target.
11518
11519@item show charset
11520@kindex show charset
11521Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11522
11523@item show host-charset
11524@kindex show host-charset
11525Show the name of the current host character set.
11526
11527@item show target-charset
11528@kindex show target-charset
11529Show the name of the current target character set.
11530
11531@item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11532@kindex set target-wide-charset
11533Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}.  This is
11534the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type.  To
11535display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11536@kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11537
11538@item show target-wide-charset
11539@kindex show target-wide-charset
11540Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11541@end table
11542
11543Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11544Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11545@file{charset-test.c}:
11546
11547@smallexample
11548#include <stdio.h>
11549
11550char ascii_hello[]
11551  = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11552     111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11553char ibm1047_hello[]
11554  = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11555     150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11556
11557main ()
11558@{
11559  printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11560@}
11561@end smallexample
11562
11563In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11564containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11565encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11566
11567We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11568
11569@smallexample
11570$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11571$ gdb -nw charset-test
11572GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11573Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11574@dots{}
11575(@value{GDBP})
11576@end smallexample
11577
11578We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11579@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11580strings:
11581
11582@smallexample
11583(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11584The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11585(@value{GDBP})
11586@end smallexample
11587
11588For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11589initial character set:
11590@smallexample
11591(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11592(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11593The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11594(@value{GDBP})
11595@end smallexample
11596
11597Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11598host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11599characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11600them properly.  Since our current target character set is also
11601@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11602
11603@smallexample
11604(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11605$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11606(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11607$2 = 72 'H'
11608(@value{GDBP})
11609@end smallexample
11610
11611@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11612literals you use in expressions:
11613
11614@smallexample
11615(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11616$3 = 43 '+'
11617(@value{GDBP})
11618@end smallexample
11619
11620The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11621character.
11622
11623@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11624target program uses.  If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11625character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11626
11627@smallexample
11628(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11629$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11630(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11631$5 = 200 '\310'
11632(@value{GDBP})
11633@end smallexample
11634
11635If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11636@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11637
11638@smallexample
11639(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11640ASCII       EBCDIC-US   IBM1047     ISO-8859-1
11641(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11642@end smallexample
11643
11644We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11645program's strings again.  Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11646@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11647target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11648@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11649
11650@smallexample
11651(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11652(@value{GDBP}) show charset
11653The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11654The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11655(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11656$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11657(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11658$7 = 72 '\110'
11659(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11660$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11661(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11662$9 = 200 'H'
11663(@value{GDBP})
11664@end smallexample
11665
11666As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11667string literals you use in expressions:
11668
11669@smallexample
11670(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11671$10 = 78 '+'
11672(@value{GDBP})
11673@end smallexample
11674
11675The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11676character.
11677
11678@node Caching Target Data
11679@section Caching Data of Targets
11680@cindex caching data of targets
11681
11682@value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11683Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11684@xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11685Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11686(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11687remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11688Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11689since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11690values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc.  Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11691(@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11692is executing.
11693Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11694known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11695rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11696in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11697stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11698in the code segment.
11699Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11700cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11701
11702@table @code
11703@kindex set remotecache
11704@item set remotecache on
11705@itemx set remotecache off
11706This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11707with old scripts.
11708
11709@kindex show remotecache
11710@item show remotecache
11711Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11712
11713@kindex set stack-cache
11714@item set stack-cache on
11715@itemx set stack-cache off
11716Enable or disable caching of stack accesses.  When @code{on}, use
11717caching.  By default, this option is @code{on}.
11718
11719@kindex show stack-cache
11720@item show stack-cache
11721Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11722
11723@kindex set code-cache
11724@item set code-cache on
11725@itemx set code-cache off
11726Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses.  When @code{on},
11727use caching.  By default, this option is @code{on}.  This improves
11728performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11729
11730@kindex show code-cache
11731@item show code-cache
11732Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11733accesses.
11734
11735@kindex info dcache
11736@item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11737Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11738current inferior's address space.  The information displayed
11739includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11740number, address, and how many times it was referenced.  This
11741command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11742
11743If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11744printed in hex.
11745
11746@item set dcache size @var{size}
11747@cindex dcache size
11748@kindex set dcache size
11749Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11750
11751@item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11752@cindex dcache line-size
11753@kindex set dcache line-size
11754Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11755Must be a power of 2.
11756
11757@item show dcache size
11758@kindex show dcache size
11759Show maximum number of dcache entries.  @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11760
11761@item show dcache line-size
11762@kindex show dcache line-size
11763Show default size of dcache lines.
11764
11765@end table
11766
11767@node Searching Memory
11768@section Search Memory
11769@cindex searching memory
11770
11771Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11772@code{find} command.
11773
11774@table @code
11775@kindex find
11776@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11777@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11778Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11779etc.  The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11780@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11781@end table
11782
11783@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11784They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11785
11786@table @r
11787@item @var{s}, search query size
11788The size of each search query value.
11789
11790@table @code
11791@item b
11792bytes
11793@item h
11794halfwords (two bytes)
11795@item w
11796words (four bytes)
11797@item g
11798giant words (eight bytes)
11799@end table
11800
11801All values are interpreted in the current language.
11802This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11803then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11804
11805If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11806value's type in the current language.
11807This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11808pattern as a mixture of types.
11809Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11810a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11811which is typically four bytes.
11812
11813@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11814The maximum number of matches to print.  The default is to print all finds.
11815@end table
11816
11817You can use strings as search values.  Quote them with double-quotes
11818 (@code{"}).
11819The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11820regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11821
11822The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11823number of matches found.
11824
11825The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11826@samp{$_}.
11827A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11828
11829For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11830
11831@smallexample
11832void
11833hello ()
11834@{
11835  static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11836  static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11837    __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11838    = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11839  printf ("%s\n", hello);
11840@}
11841@end smallexample
11842
11843@noindent
11844you get during debugging:
11845
11846@smallexample
11847(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
118480x804956d <hello.1620+6>
118491 pattern found
11850(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
118510x8049567 <hello.1620>
118520x804956d <hello.1620+6>
118532 patterns found
11854(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
118550x8049567 <hello.1620>
118561 pattern found
11857(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
118580x8049560 <mixed.1625>
118591 pattern found
11860(gdb) print $numfound
11861$1 = 1
11862(gdb) print $_
11863$2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11864@end smallexample
11865
11866@node Value Sizes
11867@section Value Sizes
11868
11869Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
11870@value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value.  It is possible in
11871some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
11872may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
11873@value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
11874
11875@table @code
11876@kindex set max-value-size
11877@item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
11878@itemx set max-value-size unlimited
11879Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
11880contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
11881requires more memory than that will result in an error.
11882
11883Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
11884allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
11885
11886There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
11887order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
11888currently 16 bytes.
11889
11890The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
11891complete expressions.  For example, an expression denoting a simple
11892integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
11893@var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}.  On the other hand,
11894@value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
11895@var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
11896succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
11897size is less than @var{bytes}.
11898
11899The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
11900
11901@kindex show max-value-size
11902@item show max-value-size
11903Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
11904allocate for the contents of a value.
11905@end table
11906
11907@node Optimized Code
11908@chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11909@cindex optimized code, debugging
11910@cindex debugging optimized code
11911
11912Almost all compilers support optimization.  With optimization
11913disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11914directly to your source code, in a simplistic way.  As the compiler
11915applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11916diverges from your original source code.  With help from debugging
11917information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11918the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11919
11920@value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled.  If you
11921can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11922progress of your program during debugging.  But, there are many cases
11923where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11924
11925When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11926optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11927really there.  Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11928exactly match your source file!  An extreme example: if you define a
11929variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11930variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11931
11932Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11933@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling.  If in
11934doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11935please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11936@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11937
11938@menu
11939* Inline Functions::            How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11940* Tail Call Frames::            @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11941@end menu
11942
11943@node Inline Functions
11944@section Inline Functions
11945@cindex inline functions, debugging
11946
11947@dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11948body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11949routine.  @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11950non-inlined functions.  They appear in backtraces.  You can view their
11951arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11952them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11953You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11954@code{info frame} command.
11955
11956For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11957record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11958@value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11959other compilers do also.  @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11960when using @sc{dwarf 2}.  Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11961do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11962@samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11963function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}.  It instead
11964displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11965local variables in the caller.
11966
11967The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11968unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11969the call.  @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11970start of the inlined function are different instructions.  Stepping to
11971the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11972the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11973instructions are executed.
11974
11975This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11976context of the call and then the effect of the call.  Only stepping by
11977a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11978this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11979
11980There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11981function calls are the same as normal calls:
11982
11983@itemize @bullet
11984@item
11985Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11986work, because the call site does not contain any code.  @value{GDBN}
11987may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11988function, after the call.  This limitation will be removed in a future
11989version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11990or inside the inlined function instead.
11991
11992@item
11993@value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11994using the @code{finish} command.  This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11995debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11996and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11997
11998@end itemize
11999
12000@node Tail Call Frames
12001@section Tail Call Frames
12002@cindex tail call frames, debugging
12003
12004Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement.  In
12005unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12006instruction at the end of @code{B} code.  Optimizing compiler may replace the
12007call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12008instead.  Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12009
12010During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12011function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}.  If function
12012@code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12013then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}.  However, in
12014some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12015@code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12016return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12017
12018This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12019the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags.  With
12020@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12021this information.
12022
12023@kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12024kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12025
12026@smallexample
12027(gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12028   0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12029(gdb) info frame
12030Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12031 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12032 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12033 source language c++.
12034 Arglist at unknown address.
12035 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12036@end smallexample
12037
12038The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12039There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12040used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12041callee by multiple different jump sequences.  In such case @value{GDBN} still
12042tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12043unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12044
12045@table @code
12046@anchor{set debug entry-values}
12047@item set debug entry-values
12048@kindex set debug entry-values
12049When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12050values at function entry and tail calls.  It will show all the possible valid
12051tail calls code paths it has considered.  It will also print the intersection
12052of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12053result.
12054
12055@item show debug entry-values
12056@kindex show debug entry-values
12057Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12058values at function entry and tail calls.
12059@end table
12060
12061The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12062call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12063reference by variable @code{x}):
12064
12065@smallexample
12066static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12067void (*x) (void) = c;
12068static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12069static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12070int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12071
12072Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
12073DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
12074a () at t.c:3
120753	static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12076(gdb) bt
12077#0  a () at t.c:3
12078#1  0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12079@end smallexample
12080
12081Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12082
12083@smallexample
12084int i;
12085static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12086static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12087static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12088static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12089static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12090@{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12091static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12092int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12093
12094tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12095tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12096tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12097(gdb) bt
12098#0  f () at t.c:2
12099#1  0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12100#2  0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12101@end smallexample
12102
12103@set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12104@set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12105
12106@c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12107@ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12108@set ARROW @click{}
12109@set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12110@set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12111@end ifset
12112@ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12113@set ARROW ->
12114@set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12115@set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12116@end ifclear
12117
12118Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12119The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12120@value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12121
12122@code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12123has found.  It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12124prefixed by @code{compare:}.  The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12125printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence.  That one could have many
12126futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12127any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12128
12129For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12130@code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12131also ambigous.  The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12132therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12133omitted.
12134
12135There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12136entry may fail:
12137
12138@smallexample
12139int v;
12140static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12141static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12142static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12143static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12144@{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12145int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12146
12147(gdb) bt
12148#0  c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12149#1  0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
12150function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12151i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12152#2  0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12153@end smallexample
12154
12155@value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12156function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12157tail calls.  Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12158@value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12159prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12160
12161@node Macros
12162@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12163
12164Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12165``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12166@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12167the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12168where it was defined.
12169
12170You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12171with information about preprocessor macros.  Most compilers do not
12172include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12173with the @option{-g} flag.  @xref{Compilation}.
12174
12175A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12176and then provide a different definition after that.  Thus, at different
12177points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12178no definition at all.  If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12179uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line.  Otherwise,
12180@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12181see @ref{List}.
12182
12183Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12184macro invocations present in the expression.  @value{GDBN} also provides
12185the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12186
12187@table @code
12188
12189@kindex macro expand
12190@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12191@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12192@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12193@item macro expand @var{expression}
12194@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12195Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12196@var{expression}.  Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12197not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12198it can be any string of tokens.
12199
12200@kindex macro exp1
12201@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12202@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12203@cindex expand macro once
12204@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)}  Show the results of
12205expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12206@var{expression}.  Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12207left unchanged.  This command allows you to see the effect of a
12208particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12209expansions.  Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12210parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12211can be any string of tokens.
12212
12213@kindex info macro
12214@cindex macro definition, showing
12215@cindex definition of a macro, showing
12216@cindex macros, from debug info
12217@item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12218Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12219and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12220definition was established.  The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12221argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12222the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12223
12224@kindex info macros
12225@item info macros @var{location}
12226Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12227by @var{location},  and describe the source location or compiler
12228command-line where those definitions were established.
12229
12230@kindex macro define
12231@cindex user-defined macros
12232@cindex defining macros interactively
12233@cindex macros, user-defined
12234@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12235@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12236Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12237invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12238@var{replacement-list}.  The first form of this command defines an
12239``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12240defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12241@var{arglist}.
12242
12243A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12244expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12245@code{macro undef} command, described below.  The definition overrides
12246all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12247as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12248
12249@kindex macro undef
12250@item macro undef @var{macro}
12251Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12252This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12253define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12254in the program being debugged.
12255
12256@kindex macro list
12257@item macro list
12258List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12259@end table
12260
12261@cindex macros, example of debugging with
12262Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action.  First, we
12263show our source files:
12264
12265@smallexample
12266$ cat sample.c
12267#include <stdio.h>
12268#include "sample.h"
12269
12270#define M 42
12271#define ADD(x) (M + x)
12272
12273main ()
12274@{
12275#define N 28
12276  printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12277#undef N
12278  printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12279#define N 1729
12280  printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12281@}
12282$ cat sample.h
12283#define Q <
12284$
12285@end smallexample
12286
12287Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12288@value{NGCC}.  We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12289minimum.  Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12290and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12291version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12292includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12293information.
12294
12295@smallexample
12296$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12297$
12298@end smallexample
12299
12300Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12301
12302@smallexample
12303$ gdb -nw sample
12304GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12305Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12306GDB is free software, @dots{}
12307(@value{GDBP})
12308@end smallexample
12309
12310We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12311program is not running.  @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12312to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12313
12314@smallexample
12315(@value{GDBP}) list main
123163
123174       #define M 42
123185       #define ADD(x) (M + x)
123196
123207       main ()
123218       @{
123229       #define N 28
1232310        printf ("Hello, world!\n");
1232411      #undef N
1232512        printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12326(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12327Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12328#define ADD(x) (M + x)
12329(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12330Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12331  included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12332#define Q <
12333(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12334expands to: (42 + 1)
12335(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12336expands to: once (M + 1)
12337(@value{GDBP})
12338@end smallexample
12339
12340In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12341the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12342@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12343which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12344
12345Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12346force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12347
12348@smallexample
12349(@value{GDBP}) break main
12350Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12351(@value{GDBP}) run
12352Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12353
12354Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
1235510        printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12356(@value{GDBP})
12357@end smallexample
12358
12359At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12360
12361@smallexample
12362(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12363Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12364#define N 28
12365(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12366expands to: 28 < 42
12367(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12368$1 = 1
12369(@value{GDBP})
12370@end smallexample
12371
12372As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12373give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12374thereof) in force at each point:
12375
12376@smallexample
12377(@value{GDBP}) next
12378Hello, world!
1237912        printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12380(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12381The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12382at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12383(@value{GDBP}) next
12384We're so creative.
1238514        printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12386(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12387Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12388#define N 1729
12389(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12390expands to: 1729 < 42
12391(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12392$2 = 0
12393(@value{GDBP})
12394@end smallexample
12395
12396In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12397line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax.  For macros defined in
12398such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12399of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12400
12401@smallexample
12402(@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12403Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12404-D__STDC__=1
12405(@value{GDBP})
12406@end smallexample
12407
12408
12409@node Tracepoints
12410@chapter Tracepoints
12411@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12412@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12413
12414@cindex tracepoints
12415In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12416the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12417anything helpful about its behavior.  If the program's correctness
12418depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12419might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12420fail, even when the code itself is correct.  It is useful to be able
12421to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12422
12423Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12424specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12425arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12426Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12427those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints.  The
12428expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12429for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12430a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12431in memory at that moment.  However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12432values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12433unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12434
12435The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12436targets.  @xref{Targets}.  In addition, your remote target must know
12437how to collect trace data.  This functionality is implemented in the
12438remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12439support tracepoints as of this writing.  The format of the remote
12440packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12441Packets}.
12442
12443It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12444of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12445through the file.  @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12446
12447This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12448
12449@menu
12450* Set Tracepoints::
12451* Analyze Collected Data::
12452* Tracepoint Variables::
12453* Trace Files::
12454@end menu
12455
12456@node Set Tracepoints
12457@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12458
12459Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12460tracepoints can be set.  A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12461breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12462standard breakpoint commands.  For instance, as with breakpoints,
12463tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12464of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12465as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12466
12467For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12468of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12469it hits that tracepoint.  The collected data can include registers,
12470local variables, or global data.  Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12471commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12472tracepoint was hit.
12473
12474Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature.  Ignore counts on
12475tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12476commands when they are hit.  Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12477either.
12478
12479@cindex fast tracepoints
12480Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12481a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12482faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12483
12484@cindex static tracepoints
12485@cindex markers, static tracepoints
12486@cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12487Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12488that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12489in the target.  Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12490tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}.  With static tracing, a set of
12491instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12492the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12493address.  These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12494investigating what the target is actually doing.  @value{GDBN}'s
12495support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12496points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12497tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12498@value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support.  Namely, support for collecting
12499registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12500point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12501The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12502instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12503static tracepoint marker.
12504
12505@code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12506@xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12507
12508This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12509conditions and actions.
12510
12511@menu
12512* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12513* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12514* Tracepoint Passcounts::
12515* Tracepoint Conditions::
12516* Trace State Variables::
12517* Tracepoint Actions::
12518* Listing Tracepoints::
12519* Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12520* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12521* Tracepoint Restrictions::
12522@end menu
12523
12524@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12525@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12526
12527@table @code
12528@cindex set tracepoint
12529@kindex trace
12530@item trace @var{location}
12531The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12532Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12533@xref{Specify Location}.  The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12534which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12535collect some data, and then allow the program to continue.  Setting a tracepoint
12536or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12537supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12538in tracing}).
12539If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12540these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12541command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12542not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.  In addition,
12543@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12544address is not yet resolved.  (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12545Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12546until they are resolved.  The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12547@value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12548@value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12549tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12550the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12551
12552Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12553
12554@smallexample
12555(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121}    // a source file and line number
12556
12557(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2}           // 2 lines forward
12558
12559(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function}  // first source line of function
12560
12561(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12562
12563(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4}    // an address
12564@end smallexample
12565
12566@noindent
12567You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12568
12569@item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12570Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12571@var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12572if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12573@xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12574information on tracepoint conditions.
12575
12576@item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12577@cindex set fast tracepoint
12578@cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12579@kindex ftrace
12580The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint.  For targets that
12581support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12582less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12583instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support.  It
12584may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12585location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12586message.
12587
12588@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12589@code{trace}.
12590
12591On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12592be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12593placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12594program is available to install trampolines.  Some Unix-type systems,
12595such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12596address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12597to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12598to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12599
12600@example
12601sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12602@end example
12603
12604@noindent
12605which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12606trampolines.  The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12607
12608@item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12609@cindex set static tracepoint
12610@cindex static tracepoints, setting
12611@cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12612@kindex strace
12613The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint.  For targets that
12614support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12615instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}.  It may not
12616be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12617which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12618
12619@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12620@code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12621@code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}.  This probes the marker
12622identified by the @var{marker} string identifier.  This identifier
12623depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12624using.  You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12625of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12626@xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12627Markers}.  For example, in the following small program using the UST
12628tracing engine:
12629
12630@smallexample
12631main ()
12632@{
12633  trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12634@}
12635@end smallexample
12636
12637@noindent
12638the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12639@code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12640
12641@smallexample
12642(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12643Cnt Enb ID         Address            What
126441   n   ust/bar33  0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12645         Data: "str %s"
12646[etc...]
12647@end smallexample
12648
12649@noindent
12650so you may probe the marker above with:
12651
12652@smallexample
12653(@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12654@end smallexample
12655
12656Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12657$_sdata}.  This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12658call to the tracing library.  In the UST example above, you'll see
12659that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12660string.  The user data is then the result of running that formating
12661string against the following arguments.  Note that @code{info
12662static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12663the @samp{Data:} field.
12664
12665You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12666the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12667@value{GDBN}.  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12668
12669@vindex $tpnum
12670@cindex last tracepoint number
12671@cindex recent tracepoint number
12672@cindex tracepoint number
12673The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12674of the most recently set tracepoint.
12675
12676@kindex delete tracepoint
12677@cindex tracepoint deletion
12678@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12679Permanently delete one or more tracepoints.  With no argument, the
12680default is to delete all tracepoints.  Note that the regular
12681@code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12682
12683Examples:
12684
12685@smallexample
12686(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12687
12688(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace}       // remove all tracepoints
12689@end smallexample
12690
12691@noindent
12692You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12693@end table
12694
12695@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12696@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12697
12698These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12699
12700@table @code
12701@kindex disable tracepoint
12702@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12703Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12704@var{num} is given.  A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12705a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten.  You can re-enable
12706a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12707If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12708has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12709change will be effective immediately.  Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12710next trace experiment.
12711
12712@kindex enable tracepoint
12713@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12714Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints.  If this command is
12715issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12716tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12717become effective immediately.  Otherwise, they will become effective the
12718next time a trace experiment is run.
12719@end table
12720
12721@node Tracepoint Passcounts
12722@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12723
12724@table @code
12725@kindex passcount
12726@cindex tracepoint pass count
12727@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12728Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint.  The passcount is a way to
12729automatically stop a trace experiment.  If a tracepoint's passcount is
12730@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12731the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit.  If the tracepoint number
12732@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12733passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint.  If no passcount is
12734given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12735user.
12736
12737Examples:
12738
12739@smallexample
12740(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12741@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12742
12743(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12}  // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12744@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12745(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12746(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12747(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12748(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12749(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12750(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1}        // Stop tracing when foo has been
12751@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12752@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12753@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12754@end smallexample
12755@end table
12756
12757@node Tracepoint Conditions
12758@subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12759@cindex conditional tracepoints
12760@cindex tracepoint conditions
12761
12762The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12763reaches a specified place.  You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12764a tracepoint.  A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12765programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  A
12766tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12767program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12768is true.
12769
12770Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12771using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12772@xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}.  They can
12773also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12774just as with breakpoints.
12775
12776Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12777the conditional expression itself.  Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12778expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12779suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12780Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12781accesses, and so forth.
12782
12783For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12784frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred.  You
12785could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12786of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12787through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12788collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12789search through.
12790
12791@smallexample
12792(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12793@end smallexample
12794
12795@node Trace State Variables
12796@subsection Trace State Variables
12797@cindex trace state variables
12798
12799A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12800created and managed by target-side code.  The syntax is the same as
12801that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12802but they are stored on the target.  They must be created explicitly,
12803using a @code{tvariable} command.  They are always 64-bit signed
12804integers.
12805
12806Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12807to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12808experiment starts.  There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12809trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12810
12811@cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12812Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12813them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12814variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12815while the trace experiment is running.  Trace state variables share
12816the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12817cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12818@code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12819variable with the same name.
12820
12821@table @code
12822
12823@item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12824@kindex tvariable
12825The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12826@code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12827@var{expression}.  The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12828entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12829otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12830@code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12831variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12832existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12833value. The default initial value is 0.
12834
12835@item info tvariables
12836@kindex info tvariables
12837List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12838Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12839currently running.
12840
12841@item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12842@kindex delete tvariable
12843Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12844are specified.
12845
12846@end table
12847
12848@node Tracepoint Actions
12849@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12850
12851@table @code
12852@kindex actions
12853@cindex tracepoint actions
12854@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12855This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12856tracepoint is hit.  If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12857specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12858recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12859@code{actions} without bothering about its number).  You specify the
12860actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12861terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}.  So
12862far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12863@code{while-stepping}.
12864
12865@code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12866Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12867actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12868
12869@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12870To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12871and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12872
12873@smallexample
12874(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12875
12876(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12877
12878(@value{GDBP}) @b{end}              // signals the end of actions.
12879@end smallexample
12880
12881In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12882commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12883hit.  Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12884following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12885followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12886sequence of single steps.  The @code{while-stepping} command is
12887terminated by its own separate @code{end} command.  Lastly, the action
12888list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12889
12890@smallexample
12891(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12892(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12893Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12894> collect bar,baz
12895> collect $regs
12896> while-stepping 12
12897  > collect $pc, arr[i]
12898  > end
12899end
12900@end smallexample
12901
12902@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12903@item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12904Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12905This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12906In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12907special arguments are supported:
12908
12909@table @code
12910@item $regs
12911Collect all registers.
12912
12913@item $args
12914Collect all function arguments.
12915
12916@item $locals
12917Collect all local variables.
12918
12919@item $_ret
12920Collect the return address.  This is helpful if you want to see more
12921of a backtrace.
12922
12923@emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
12924determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
12925collected instead.  On some architectures the reliability is higher
12926for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
12927When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
12928found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
12929
12930@item $_probe_argc
12931Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12932tracepoint is located.
12933@xref{Static Probe Points}.
12934
12935@item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12936@var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11.  Collects the @var{n}th argument
12937from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12938@xref{Static Probe Points}.
12939
12940@item $_sdata
12941@vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12942Collect static tracepoint marker specific data.  Only available for
12943static tracepoints.  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12944Lists}.  On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12945instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call.  The
12946tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12947character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12948instrumented the program.  Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12949Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12950
12951@smallexample
12952 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12953 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12954@end smallexample
12955
12956In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12957@samp{hello $yourname}.  When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12958inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12959@value{GDBN}.
12960@end table
12961
12962You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12963with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12964arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12965
12966The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12967@code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12968particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12969to the first zero.  The upper bound is by default the value of the
12970@code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12971number, that is the upper bound instead.  So for instance
12972@samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12973@samp{mystr}.
12974
12975The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12976particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12977
12978@kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12979@item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12980Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.  This
12981command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions.  The results
12982are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12983state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12984values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12985action were used.
12986
12987@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12988@item while-stepping @var{n}
12989Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12990collecting new data after each step.  The @code{while-stepping}
12991command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12992(followed by its own @code{end} command):
12993
12994@smallexample
12995> while-stepping 12
12996  > collect $regs, myglobal
12997  > end
12998>
12999@end smallexample
13000
13001@noindent
13002Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13003@code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13004you need it.  You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13005@code{stepping}.
13006
13007@item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13008@kindex set default-collect
13009@cindex default collection action
13010This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13011hit.  It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13012to every tracepoint action list.  The expressions are parsed
13013individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13014@code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13015local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13016
13017@item show default-collect
13018@kindex show default-collect
13019Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13020tracepoint hit.
13021
13022@end table
13023
13024@node Listing Tracepoints
13025@subsection Listing Tracepoints
13026
13027@table @code
13028@kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13029@kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13030@cindex information about tracepoints
13031@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13032Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}.  If you don't
13033specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13034tracepoints defined so far.  The format is similar to that used for
13035@code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13036command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13037
13038A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13039tracing:
13040
13041@itemize @bullet
13042@item
13043its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13044
13045@item
13046the state about installed on target of each location
13047@end itemize
13048
13049@smallexample
13050(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13051Num     Type           Disp Enb Address    What
130521       tracepoint     keep y   0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13053        while-stepping 20
13054          collect globfoo, $regs
13055        end
13056        collect globfoo2
13057        end
13058        pass count 1200
130592       tracepoint     keep y   <MULTIPLE>
13060        collect $eip
130612.1                         y     0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13062        installed on target
130632.2                         y     0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13064        installed on target
130652.3                         y     <PENDING>  set_tracepoint
130663       tracepoint     keep y   0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13067        not installed on target
13068(@value{GDBP})
13069@end smallexample
13070
13071@noindent
13072This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13073@end table
13074
13075@node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13076@subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13077
13078@table @code
13079@kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13080@cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13081@item info static-tracepoint-markers
13082Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13083program.
13084
13085For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13086
13087@table @emph
13088@item Count
13089An incrementing counter, output to help readability.  This is not a
13090stable identifier.
13091@item ID
13092The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13093@item Enabled or Disabled
13094Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}.  @samp{n} identifies marks
13095that are not enabled.
13096@item Address
13097Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13098@item What
13099Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13100number.  If the debug information included in the program does not
13101allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13102will be left blank.
13103@end table
13104
13105@noindent
13106In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13107
13108@table @emph
13109@item Data
13110User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call.  In the
13111UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13112marker call.
13113@item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13114The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13115@end table
13116
13117@smallexample
13118(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13119Cnt ID         Enb Address            What
131201   ust/bar2   y   0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13121     Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13122     Probed by static tracepoints: #2
131232   ust/bar33  n   0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13124     Data: str %s
13125(@value{GDBP})
13126@end smallexample
13127@end table
13128
13129@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13130@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13131
13132@table @code
13133@kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13134@cindex start a new trace experiment
13135@cindex collected data discarded
13136@item tstart
13137This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13138It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13139trace buffer during the previous trace experiment.  If any arguments
13140are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13141experiment's state.  The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13142especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13143the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13144information, and so forth.
13145
13146@kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13147@cindex stop a running trace experiment
13148@item tstop
13149This command stops the trace experiment.  If any arguments are
13150supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note.  This is
13151useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13152instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13153needs to be stopped quickly.
13154
13155@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13156automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13157(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13158
13159@kindex tstatus
13160@cindex status of trace data collection
13161@cindex trace experiment, status of
13162@item tstatus
13163This command displays the status of the current trace data
13164collection.
13165@end table
13166
13167Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13168
13169@smallexample
13170(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13171(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13172Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13173> collect $regs,$locals,$args
13174> while-stepping 11
13175  > collect $regs
13176  > end
13177> end
13178(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13179	[time passes @dots{}]
13180(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13181@end smallexample
13182
13183@anchor{disconnected tracing}
13184@cindex disconnected tracing
13185You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13186@value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13187involuntarily.  For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13188ask what you want to do with the trace.  But for unexpected
13189terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13190unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13191@code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13192continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13193
13194@table @code
13195@item set disconnected-tracing on
13196@itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13197@kindex set disconnected-tracing
13198Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13199has disconnected from the target.  Note that @code{detach} or
13200@code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13201matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13202for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13203
13204@item show disconnected-tracing
13205@kindex show disconnected-tracing
13206Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13207
13208@end table
13209
13210When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13211still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13212meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons.  If it is running,
13213it will continue after reconnection.
13214
13215Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13216tracepoints in effect.  @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13217information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13218to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13219have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime.  If one of
13220the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13221debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13222which to specify that tracepoint.  This matching-up process is
13223necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13224created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13225
13226@cindex circular trace buffer
13227If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13228can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13229buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13230frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13231collecting.  This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13232hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13233buffer is full.  To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13234@samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on.  You can set this at any time,
13235including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13236buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13237the next run.
13238
13239@table @code
13240@item set circular-trace-buffer on
13241@itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13242@kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13243Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13244for trace data.  A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13245fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13246data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13247
13248@item show circular-trace-buffer
13249@kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13250Show the current choice for the trace buffer.  Note that this may not
13251match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13252match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13253for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13254
13255@end table
13256
13257@table @code
13258@item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13259@itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13260@kindex set trace-buffer-size
13261Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes.  Not all
13262targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13263the trace buffer, or some other limitation.  Set to a value of
13264@code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13265likes.  This is also the default.
13266
13267@item show trace-buffer-size
13268@kindex show trace-buffer-size
13269Show the current requested size for the trace buffer.  Note that this
13270will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13271and was able to handle the requested size.  For instance, if the
13272target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13273not reflect the change until the next run starts.  Use @code{tstatus}
13274to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13275@end table
13276
13277@table @code
13278@item set trace-user @var{text}
13279@kindex set trace-user
13280
13281@item show trace-user
13282@kindex show trace-user
13283
13284@item set trace-notes @var{text}
13285@kindex set trace-notes
13286Set the trace run's notes.
13287
13288@item show trace-notes
13289@kindex show trace-notes
13290Show the trace run's notes.
13291
13292@item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13293@kindex set trace-stop-notes
13294Set the trace run's stop notes.  The handling of the note is as for
13295@code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13296stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13297
13298@item show trace-stop-notes
13299@kindex show trace-stop-notes
13300Show the trace run's stop notes.
13301
13302@end table
13303
13304@node Tracepoint Restrictions
13305@subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13306
13307@cindex tracepoint restrictions
13308There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints.  As
13309described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13310without interaction from @value{GDBN}.  Thus the full capabilities of
13311the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13312examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13313collected.  The following items describe some common problems, but it
13314is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13315mentioned here.
13316
13317@itemize @bullet
13318
13319@item
13320Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues).  Thus
13321the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13322You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13323convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13324state variables).  Some language features may implicitly call
13325functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13326cannot be collected either.
13327
13328@item
13329Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13330@code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13331behave erratically.  The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13332instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13333may change (for instance it is loaded into a register).  The
13334tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13335variables that is correct for the tracepoint location.  When the
13336tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13337where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13338program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13339
13340@item
13341Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13342may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13343in a misleading way.
13344
13345@item
13346When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13347dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13348being pointed to.  However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13349not automatically collect the string.  You need to explicitly
13350dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13351collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to.  For example,
13352@code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13353by @code{ptr}.
13354
13355@item
13356It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13357tracepoint.  Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13358bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13359(adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13360target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13361Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13362using a trace frame.  The number of stack frames that can be examined
13363depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack.  Note that
13364if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13365stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13366invalid address.
13367
13368@item
13369If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13370infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13371the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13372for that tracepoint.  However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13373multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13374inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop.  In those cases
13375@value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13376it to zero.
13377
13378@end itemize
13379
13380@node Analyze Collected Data
13381@section Using the Collected Data
13382
13383After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13384for examining the trace data.  The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13385collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13386snapshot every time it single-steps.  All these snapshots are
13387consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13388examine them later.  The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13389specific trace snapshot.  When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13390snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13391registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13392rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13393debugged.  This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13394(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13395behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13396when the tracepoint occurred.  Any requests for data that are not in
13397the buffer will fail.
13398
13399@menu
13400* tfind::                       How to select a trace snapshot
13401* tdump::                       How to display all data for a snapshot
13402* save tracepoints::            How to save tracepoints for a future run
13403@end menu
13404
13405@node tfind
13406@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13407
13408@kindex tfind
13409@cindex select trace snapshot
13410@cindex find trace snapshot
13411The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13412@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13413counting from zero.  If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13414snapshot is selected.
13415
13416Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13417
13418@table @code
13419@item tfind start
13420Find the first snapshot in the buffer.  This is a synonym for
13421@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13422
13423@item tfind none
13424Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13425
13426@item tfind end
13427Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13428
13429@item tfind
13430No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13431one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13432
13433@item tfind -
13434Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one.  This permits
13435retracing earlier steps.
13436
13437@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13438Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}.  Search
13439proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot.  If no
13440argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13441for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13442
13443@item tfind pc @var{addr}
13444Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13445program counter.  Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13446snapshot.  If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13447snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13448
13449@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13450Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13451addresses (exclusive).
13452
13453@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13454Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13455@var{addr2} (inclusive).
13456
13457@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13458Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}.  If
13459the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13460that source file.  Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13461trace snapshot.  If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13462next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13463@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13464stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13465@end table
13466
13467The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13468designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer.  For
13469instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13470snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13471trace snapshot.  So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13472simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13473snapshots in order.  Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13474@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13475The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13476for the next source line executed.  The @code{tfind pc} command with
13477no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13478(PC) as the current frame.  The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13479no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13480tracepoint as the current one.
13481
13482In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13483these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13484scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13485you are interested in.  Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13486registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13487
13488@smallexample
13489(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13490(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13491> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13492          $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13493> tfind
13494> end
13495
13496Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13497Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13498Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13499Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13500Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13501Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13502Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13503Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13504Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13505Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13506Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13507@end smallexample
13508
13509Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13510the buffer:
13511
13512@smallexample
13513(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13514(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13515> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13516> tfind line
13517> end
13518
13519Frame 0, X = 1
13520Frame 7, X = 2
13521Frame 13, X = 255
13522@end smallexample
13523
13524@node tdump
13525@subsection @code{tdump}
13526@kindex tdump
13527@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13528@cindex tracepoint data, display
13529
13530This command takes no arguments.  It prints all the data collected at
13531the current trace snapshot.
13532
13533@smallexample
13534(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13535(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13536Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13537> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13538> end
13539
13540(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13541
13542(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13543#0  gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13544at gdb_test.c:444
13545444        printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13546
13547(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13548Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13549d0             0xc4aa0085       -995491707
13550d1             0x18     24
13551d2             0x80     128
13552d3             0x33     51
13553d4             0x71aea3d        119204413
13554d5             0x22     34
13555d6             0xe0     224
13556d7             0x380035 3670069
13557a0             0x19e24a 1696330
13558a1             0x3000668        50333288
13559a2             0x100    256
13560a3             0x322000 3284992
13561a4             0x3000698        50333336
13562a5             0x1ad3cc 1758156
13563fp             0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13564sp             0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13565ps             0x0      0
13566pc             0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13567fpcontrol      0x0      0
13568fpstatus       0x0      0
13569fpiaddr        0x0      0
13570p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13571p1 = (void *) 0x11
13572p2 = (void *) 0x22
13573p3 = (void *) 0x33
13574p4 = (void *) 0x44
13575p5 = (void *) 0x55
13576p6 = (void *) 0x66
13577gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13578
13579(@value{GDBP})
13580@end smallexample
13581
13582@code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13583actions and printing the value of each expression listed.  So
13584@code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13585actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13586
13587Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13588uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13589frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13590collected while stepping.  This allows it to correctly choose whether
13591to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13592body of the while-stepping loop.  However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13593then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13594list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13595same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13596@c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13597
13598@node save tracepoints
13599@subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13600@kindex save tracepoints
13601@kindex save-tracepoints
13602@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13603
13604This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13605their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13606suitable for use in a later debugging session.  To read the saved
13607tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13608Files}).  The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13609alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13610
13611@node Tracepoint Variables
13612@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13613@cindex tracepoint variables
13614@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13615
13616@table @code
13617@vindex $trace_frame
13618@item (int) $trace_frame
13619The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13620snapshot is selected.
13621
13622@vindex $tracepoint
13623@item (int) $tracepoint
13624The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13625
13626@vindex $trace_line
13627@item (int) $trace_line
13628The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13629
13630@vindex $trace_file
13631@item (char []) $trace_file
13632The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13633
13634@vindex $trace_func
13635@item (char []) $trace_func
13636The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13637@end table
13638
13639Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13640use @code{output} instead.
13641
13642Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13643stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13644data.  Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13645which are managed by the target.
13646
13647@smallexample
13648(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13649
13650(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13651> output $trace_file
13652> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13653> tfind
13654> end
13655@end smallexample
13656
13657@node Trace Files
13658@section Using Trace Files
13659@cindex trace files
13660
13661In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13662longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13663for a different activity.  To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13664dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13665of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13666
13667@table @code
13668
13669@kindex tsave
13670@item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13671@itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13672Save the trace data to @var{filename}.  By default, this command
13673assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13674necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13675then save it.  If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13676optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13677the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13678more efficient if the trace buffer is very large.  (Note, however, that
13679@code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13680By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13681You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13682format.  The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13683that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools.  Please go to
13684@indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13685
13686@kindex target tfile
13687@kindex tfile
13688@kindex target ctf
13689@kindex ctf
13690@item target tfile @var{filename}
13691@itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13692Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13693a source of trace data.  Commands that examine data work as they do with
13694a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13695@code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13696the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13697Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13698the host.
13699
13700@smallexample
13701(@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13702(@value{GDBP}) tfind
13703Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
1370439            ++a;  /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13705(@value{GDBP}) tdump
13706Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13707i = 0
13708a = 0
13709b = 1 '\001'
13710c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13711d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13712(@value{GDBP}) p b
13713$1 = 1
13714@end smallexample
13715
13716@end table
13717
13718@node Overlays
13719@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13720@cindex overlays
13721
13722If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13723memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13724problem.  @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13725use overlays.
13726
13727@menu
13728* How Overlays Work::              A general explanation of overlays.
13729* Overlay Commands::               Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13730* Automatic Overlay Debugging::    @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13731                                   mapped by asking the inferior.
13732* Overlay Sample Program::         A sample program using overlays.
13733@end menu
13734
13735@node How Overlays Work
13736@section How Overlays Work
13737@cindex mapped overlays
13738@cindex unmapped overlays
13739@cindex load address, overlay's
13740@cindex mapped address
13741@cindex overlay area
13742
13743Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13744kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13745other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13746management hardware, for example.  Suppose further that you want to
13747adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13748
13749One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13750independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13751@dfn{overlays}.  Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13752their machine code in the larger memory.  Place your main program in
13753instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13754largest overlay as well.
13755
13756Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13757overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13758for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13759there.
13760
13761@c NB:  In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13762@c size of all overlays.  This is intentional to remind the developer
13763@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13764
13765@smallexample
13766@group
13767    Data             Instruction            Larger
13768Address Space       Address Space        Address Space
13769+-----------+       +-----------+        +-----------+
13770|           |       |           |        |           |
13771+-----------+       +-----------+        +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13772| program   |       |   main    |   .----| overlay 1 | load address
13773| variables |       |  program  |   |    +-----------+
13774| and heap  |       |           |   |    |           |
13775+-----------+       |           |   |    +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13776|           |       +-----------+   |    |           | load address
13777+-----------+       |           |   |  .-| overlay 2 |
13778                    |           |   |  | |           |
13779         mapped --->+-----------+   |  | +-----------+
13780         address    |           |   |  | |           |
13781                    |  overlay  | <-'  | |           |
13782                    |   area    |  <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13783                    |           | <---.  |           | load address
13784                    +-----------+     `--| overlay 3 |
13785                    |           |        |           |
13786                    +-----------+        |           |
13787                                         +-----------+
13788                                         |           |
13789                                         +-----------+
13790
13791                    @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13792@end group
13793@end smallexample
13794
13795The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13796and instruction address spaces.  To map an overlay, the program copies
13797its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13798Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13799may be mapped at a time.  For a system with a single address space for
13800data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13801program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13802program and the overlay area.
13803
13804An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13805@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13806instruction memory.  An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13807in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13808is its address in the larger memory.  The mapped address is also called
13809the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13810called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13811
13812Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13813program to limited instruction memory.  They introduce a new set of
13814global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13815
13816@itemize @bullet
13817
13818@item
13819Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13820must make sure that overlay is actually mapped.  Otherwise, the call or
13821return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13822overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13823
13824@item
13825If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13826will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13827your program's performance.
13828
13829@item
13830The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13831overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13832mapped address.  However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13833and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13834You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13835addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13836ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13837
13838@item
13839The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13840to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13841instruction and data spaces.
13842
13843@end itemize
13844
13845The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13846improved in many ways:
13847
13848@itemize @bullet
13849
13850@item
13851If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13852hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13853contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13854This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13855area in the usual way.
13856
13857@item
13858If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13859overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13860
13861@item
13862You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions.  In
13863general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13864code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13865return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13866the data.  Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13867must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13868different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13869
13870@end itemize
13871
13872
13873@node Overlay Commands
13874@section Overlay Commands
13875
13876To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13877correspond to a separate section of the executable file.  The section's
13878virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13879mapped and load addresses.  Identifying overlays with sections allows
13880@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13881variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13882
13883@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13884you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}.  The commands are:
13885
13886@table @code
13887@item overlay off
13888@kindex overlay
13889Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.  When overlay support is
13890disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13891always present at their mapped addresses.  By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13892overlay support is disabled.
13893
13894@item overlay manual
13895@cindex manual overlay debugging
13896Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging.  In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13897relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13898using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13899commands described below.
13900
13901@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13902@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13903@cindex map an overlay
13904Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13905be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.  When an
13906overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13907functions and variables at their mapped addresses.  @value{GDBN} assumes
13908that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13909@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13910
13911@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13912@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13913@cindex unmap an overlay
13914Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13915must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13916When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13917overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13918
13919@item overlay auto
13920Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging.  In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13921consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13922to see which overlays are mapped.  For details, see @ref{Automatic
13923Overlay Debugging}.
13924
13925@item overlay load-target
13926@itemx overlay load
13927@cindex reloading the overlay table
13928Re-read the overlay table from the inferior.  Normally, @value{GDBN}
13929re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13930stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13931overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}.  This command is only
13932useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13933
13934@item overlay list-overlays
13935@itemx overlay list
13936@cindex listing mapped overlays
13937Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13938addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13939
13940@end table
13941
13942Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13943of the function the address falls in:
13944
13945@smallexample
13946(@value{GDBP}) print main
13947$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13948@end smallexample
13949@noindent
13950When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13951unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13952asterisks around them.  For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13953unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13954
13955@smallexample
13956(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13957No sections are mapped.
13958(@value{GDBP}) print foo
13959$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13960@end smallexample
13961@noindent
13962When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13963name normally:
13964
13965@smallexample
13966(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13967Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13968        mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13969(@value{GDBP}) print foo
13970$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13971@end smallexample
13972
13973When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13974address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13975overlay is mapped.  This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13976@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13977code.  However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13978
13979@itemize @bullet
13980@item
13981@cindex breakpoints in overlays
13982@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13983You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13984@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13985@item
13986@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13987unmapped overlays.  However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13988overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13989you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13990breakpoints properly.
13991@end itemize
13992
13993
13994@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13995@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13996@cindex automatic overlay debugging
13997
13998@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13999are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14000inferior.  If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14001@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14002looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14003current state of the overlays.
14004
14005Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14006@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14007
14008@table @asis
14009
14010@item @code{_ovly_table}:
14011This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14012
14013@smallexample
14014struct
14015@{
14016  /* The overlay's mapped address.  */
14017  unsigned long vma;
14018
14019  /* The size of the overlay, in bytes.  */
14020  unsigned long size;
14021
14022  /* The overlay's load address.  */
14023  unsigned long lma;
14024
14025  /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14026     zero otherwise.  */
14027  unsigned long mapped;
14028@}
14029@end smallexample
14030
14031@item @code{_novlys}:
14032This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14033number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14034
14035@end table
14036
14037To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14038looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14039@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14040executable file.  When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14041the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14042currently mapped.
14043
14044In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14045@code{_ovly_debug_event}.  If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14046will silently set a breakpoint there.  If the overlay manager then
14047calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14048will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14049are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14050in overlays.  This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14051overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14052are not being executed.
14053
14054@node Overlay Sample Program
14055@section Overlay Sample Program
14056@cindex overlay example program
14057
14058When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14059at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14060addresses.  To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14061Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}).  Unfortunately,
14062since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14063architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14064portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14065
14066However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14067program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14068suite.  The program consists of the following files from
14069@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14070
14071@table @file
14072@item overlays.c
14073The main program file.
14074@item ovlymgr.c
14075A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14076@item foo.c
14077@itemx bar.c
14078@itemx baz.c
14079@itemx grbx.c
14080Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14081@item d10v.ld
14082@itemx m32r.ld
14083Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14084and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14085@end table
14086
14087You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14088cross-compiler like this:
14089
14090@smallexample
14091$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14092$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14093$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14094$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14095$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14096$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14097$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14098                  baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14099@end smallexample
14100
14101The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14102you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14103target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14104
14105
14106@node Languages
14107@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14108@cindex languages
14109
14110Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14111rarely expressed in the same manner.  For instance, in ANSI C,
14112dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14113Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}.  Values can also be
14114represented (and displayed) differently.  Hex numbers in C appear as
14115@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14116
14117@cindex working language
14118Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14119allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14120native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14121consistent with the syntax of your program's native language.  The
14122language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14123language}.
14124
14125@menu
14126* Setting::                     Switching between source languages
14127* Show::                        Displaying the language
14128* Checks::                      Type and range checks
14129* Supported Languages::         Supported languages
14130* Unsupported Languages::       Unsupported languages
14131@end menu
14132
14133@node Setting
14134@section Switching Between Source Languages
14135
14136There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14137set it automatically, or select it manually yourself.  You can use the
14138@code{set language} command for either purpose.  On startup, @value{GDBN}
14139defaults to setting the language automatically.  The working language is
14140used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14141are printed, etc.
14142
14143In addition to the working language, every source file that
14144@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language.  For some object
14145file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14146source file is in.  However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14147language from the name of the file.  The language of a source file
14148controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14149show each frame appropriately for its own language.  There is no way to
14150set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14151set the language associated with a filename extension.  @xref{Show, ,
14152Displaying the Language}.
14153
14154This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14155as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14156another language.  In that case, make the
14157program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14158@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14159program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14160
14161@menu
14162* Filenames::                   Filename extensions and languages.
14163* Manually::                    Setting the working language manually
14164* Automatically::               Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14165@end menu
14166
14167@node Filenames
14168@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14169
14170If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14171@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14172
14173@table @file
14174@item .ada
14175@itemx .ads
14176@itemx .adb
14177@itemx .a
14178Ada source file.
14179
14180@item .c
14181C source file
14182
14183@item .C
14184@itemx .cc
14185@itemx .cp
14186@itemx .cpp
14187@itemx .cxx
14188@itemx .c++
14189C@t{++} source file
14190
14191@item .d
14192D source file
14193
14194@item .m
14195Objective-C source file
14196
14197@item .f
14198@itemx .F
14199Fortran source file
14200
14201@item .mod
14202Modula-2 source file
14203
14204@item .s
14205@itemx .S
14206Assembler source file.  This actually behaves almost like C, but
14207@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14208@end table
14209
14210In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14211extension.  @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14212
14213@node Manually
14214@subsection Setting the Working Language
14215
14216If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14217expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14218your program.
14219
14220@kindex set language
14221If you wish, you may set the language manually.  To do this, issue the
14222command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14223a language, such as
14224@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14225For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14226
14227Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14228language automatically.  This can lead to confusion if you try
14229to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14230source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14231languages---but means different things.  For instance, if the current
14232source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14233command such as:
14234
14235@smallexample
14236print a = b + c
14237@end smallexample
14238
14239@noindent
14240might not have the effect you intended.  In C, this means to add
14241@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}.  The result
14242printed would be the value of @code{a}.  In Modula-2, this means to compare
14243@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14244
14245@node Automatically
14246@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14247
14248To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14249@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}.  @value{GDBN}
14250then infers the working language.  That is, when your program stops in a
14251frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14252working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14253frame.  If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14254or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14255does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14256not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14257
14258This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14259entirely in one source language.  However, program modules and libraries
14260written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14261a different source language.  Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14262case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14263
14264@node Show
14265@section Displaying the Language
14266
14267The following commands help you find out which language is the
14268working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14269
14270@table @code
14271@item show language
14272@anchor{show language}
14273@kindex show language
14274Display the current working language.  This is the
14275language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14276build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14277
14278@item info frame
14279@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14280Display the source language for this frame.  This language becomes the
14281working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14282@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14283information listed here.
14284
14285@item info source
14286@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14287Display the source language of this source file.
14288@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14289information listed here.
14290@end table
14291
14292In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14293not in the standard list.  You can then set the extension associated
14294with a language explicitly:
14295
14296@table @code
14297@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14298@kindex set extension-language
14299Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14300assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14301
14302@item info extensions
14303@kindex info extensions
14304List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14305@end table
14306
14307@node Checks
14308@section Type and Range Checking
14309
14310Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14311errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks.  These include
14312checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14313sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time.  Checks such as
14314these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14315by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14316errors when your program is running.
14317
14318By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14319rules of the current source language.  Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14320the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14321into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14322
14323@menu
14324* Type Checking::               An overview of type checking
14325* Range Checking::              An overview of range checking
14326@end menu
14327
14328@cindex type checking
14329@cindex checks, type
14330@node Type Checking
14331@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14332
14333Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14334arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14335otherwise an error occurs.  These checks prevent type mismatch
14336errors from ever causing any run-time problems.  For example,
14337
14338@smallexample
14339int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return  b ? 1 : 2; @}
14340
14341(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14342$1 = 2
14343@exdent but
14344(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14345Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14346@end smallexample
14347
14348The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14349@samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14350
14351For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14352@value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14353to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14354When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14355expressions like the second example above.
14356
14357Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14358related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14359For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14360a @code{struct foo}.  These particular type errors have nothing to do
14361with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14362little sense to evaluate anyway.
14363
14364@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14365
14366@kindex set check type
14367@kindex show check type
14368@table @code
14369@item set check type on
14370@itemx set check type off
14371Set strict type checking on or off.  If any type mismatches occur in
14372evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14373message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14374
14375@item show check type
14376Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14377is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14378@end table
14379
14380@cindex range checking
14381@cindex checks, range
14382@node Range Checking
14383@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14384
14385In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14386bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks.  Such range
14387checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14388computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14389not exceed the bounds of the array.
14390
14391For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14392@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14393always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14394warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14395
14396A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14397array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14398of any type.  Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14399error.  In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14400result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14401the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14402
14403@smallexample
14404@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14405@end smallexample
14406
14407This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14408specific to individual compilers or machines.  @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14409Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14410
14411@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14412
14413@kindex set check range
14414@kindex show check range
14415@table @code
14416@item set check range auto
14417Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14418@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14419each language.
14420
14421@item set check range on
14422@itemx set check range off
14423Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14424current working language.  A warning is issued if the setting does not
14425match the language default.  If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14426then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14427
14428@item set check range warn
14429Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14430but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway.  Evaluating the
14431expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14432memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14433systems).
14434
14435@item show range
14436Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14437being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14438@end table
14439
14440@node Supported Languages
14441@section Supported Languages
14442
14443@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14444OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14445@c This is false ...
14446Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14447language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14448and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14449,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14450language.
14451
14452The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14453supported by @value{GDBN}.  These sections are not meant to be language
14454tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14455@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14456formats should look like for different languages.  There are many good
14457books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14458language reference or tutorial.
14459
14460@menu
14461* C::                           C and C@t{++}
14462* D::                           D
14463* Go::                          Go
14464* Objective-C::                 Objective-C
14465* OpenCL C::                    OpenCL C
14466* Fortran::                     Fortran
14467* Pascal::                      Pascal
14468* Rust::                        Rust
14469* Modula-2::                    Modula-2
14470* Ada::                         Ada
14471@end menu
14472
14473@node C
14474@subsection C and C@t{++}
14475
14476@cindex C and C@t{++}
14477@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14478
14479Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14480to both languages.  Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14481together.
14482
14483@cindex C@t{++}
14484@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14485@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14486The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14487compiler and @value{GDBN}.  Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14488effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14489C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14490compiler (@code{aCC}).
14491
14492@menu
14493* C Operators::                 C and C@t{++} operators
14494* C Constants::                 C and C@t{++} constants
14495* C Plus Plus Expressions::     C@t{++} expressions
14496* C Defaults::                  Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14497* C Checks::                    C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14498* Debugging C::                 @value{GDBN} and C
14499* Debugging C Plus Plus::       @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14500* Decimal Floating Point::      Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14501@end menu
14502
14503@node C Operators
14504@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14505
14506@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14507
14508Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
14509@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
14510often defined on groups of types.
14511
14512For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14513
14514@itemize @bullet
14515
14516@item
14517@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14518specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14519
14520@item
14521@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14522@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14523
14524@item
14525@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14526
14527@item
14528@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14529
14530@end itemize
14531
14532@noindent
14533The following operators are supported.  They are listed here
14534in order of increasing precedence:
14535
14536@table @code
14537@item ,
14538The comma or sequencing operator.  Expressions in a comma-separated list
14539are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14540expression being the last expression evaluated.
14541
14542@item =
14543Assignment.  The value of an assignment expression is the value
14544assigned.  Defined on scalar types.
14545
14546@item @var{op}=
14547Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14548and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14549@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.  The operator
14550@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14551@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14552
14553@item ?:
14554The ternary operator.  @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14555of as:  if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}.  The argument @var{a}
14556should be of an integral type.
14557
14558@item ||
14559Logical @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
14560
14561@item &&
14562Logical @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
14563
14564@item |
14565Bitwise @sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
14566
14567@item ^
14568Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}.  Defined on integral types.
14569
14570@item &
14571Bitwise @sc{and}.  Defined on integral types.
14572
14573@item ==@r{, }!=
14574Equality and inequality.  Defined on scalar types.  The value of these
14575expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14576
14577@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14578Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14579Defined on scalar types.  The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14580and non-zero for true.
14581
14582@item <<@r{, }>>
14583left shift, and right shift.  Defined on integral types.
14584
14585@item @@
14586The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14587
14588@item +@r{, }-
14589Addition and subtraction.  Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14590pointer types.
14591
14592@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14593Multiplication, division, and modulus.  Multiplication and division are
14594defined on integral and floating-point types.  Modulus is defined on
14595integral types.
14596
14597@item ++@r{, }--
14598Increment and decrement.  When appearing before a variable, the
14599operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14600when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14601operation takes place.
14602
14603@item *
14604Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.  Same precedence as
14605@code{++}.
14606
14607@item &
14608Address operator.  Defined on variables.  Same precedence as @code{++}.
14609
14610For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14611allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14612to examine the address
14613where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14614stored.
14615
14616@item -
14617Negative.  Defined on integral and floating-point types.  Same
14618precedence as @code{++}.
14619
14620@item !
14621Logical negation.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
14622@code{++}.
14623
14624@item ~
14625Bitwise complement operator.  Defined on integral types.  Same precedence as
14626@code{++}.
14627
14628
14629@item .@r{, }->
14630Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member.  For convenience,
14631@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14632pointer based on the stored type information.
14633Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14634
14635@item .*@r{, }->*
14636Dereferences of pointers to members.
14637
14638@item []
14639Array indexing.  @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14640@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
14641
14642@item ()
14643Function parameter list.  Same precedence as @code{->}.
14644
14645@item ::
14646C@t{++} scope resolution operator.  Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14647and @code{class} types.
14648
14649@item ::
14650Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14651(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  Same precedence as @code{::},
14652above.
14653@end table
14654
14655If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14656attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14657predefined meaning.
14658
14659@node C Constants
14660@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14661
14662@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14663
14664@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14665following ways:
14666
14667@itemize @bullet
14668@item
14669Integer constants are a sequence of digits.  Octal constants are
14670specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14671by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}.  Constants may also end with a letter
14672@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14673@code{long} value.
14674
14675@item
14676Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14677point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14678exponent.  An exponent is of the form:
14679@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14680sequence of digits.  The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14681A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14682@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14683the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14684a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14685constant.
14686
14687@item
14688Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14689integral equivalents.
14690
14691@item
14692Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14693(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14694(usually its @sc{ascii} value).  Within quotes, the single character may
14695be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14696the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14697of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14698@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14699@samp{\n} for newline.
14700
14701Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14702constant with @samp{L}, as in C.  For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14703form of @samp{x}.  The target wide character set is used when
14704computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14705
14706@item
14707String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14708double quotes (@code{"}).  Any valid character constant (as described
14709above) may appear.  Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14710a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14711characters.
14712
14713Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14714with @samp{L}, as in C.  The target wide character set is used when
14715computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14716
14717@item
14718Pointer constants are an integral value.  You can also write pointers
14719to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14720
14721@item
14722Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14723and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14724integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14725and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14726@end itemize
14727
14728@node C Plus Plus Expressions
14729@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14730
14731@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14732@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14733
14734@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14735@cindex C@t{++} compilers
14736@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14737@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14738@quotation
14739@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14740the proper compiler and the proper debug format.  Currently,
14741@value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14742with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible.  The DWARF
14743debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14744popular platforms.  Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14745work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14746code.  @xref{Compilation}.
14747@end quotation
14748
14749@enumerate
14750
14751@cindex member functions
14752@item
14753Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14754
14755@smallexample
14756count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14757@end smallexample
14758
14759@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14760@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14761@item
14762While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14763expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14764that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14765pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.  @code{using}
14766declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14767
14768@cindex call overloaded functions
14769@cindex overloaded functions, calling
14770@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14771@item
14772You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14773call to the right definition, with some restrictions.  @value{GDBN} does not
14774perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14775calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14776in the program.  It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14777default arguments.
14778
14779It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14780promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14781class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14782functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14783number of function arguments.
14784
14785Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14786@code{set overload-resolution off}.  @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14787,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14788
14789You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14790explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14791@smallexample
14792p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14793@end smallexample
14794
14795The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14796see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14797
14798@cindex reference declarations
14799@item
14800@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14801them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14802dereferenced.
14803
14804In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14805reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14806avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14807The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14808you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14809
14810@item
14811@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14812expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do.  Since
14813one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14814necessary, for example in an expression like
14815@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}.  @value{GDBN} also allows
14816resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14817debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14818
14819@item
14820@value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14821specification.
14822@end enumerate
14823
14824@node C Defaults
14825@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14826
14827@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14828
14829If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14830defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14831C or C@t{++}.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14832selects the working language.
14833
14834If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14835recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14836@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14837these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14838@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14839for further details.
14840
14841@node C Checks
14842@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14843
14844@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14845
14846By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14847checking is used.  However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14848will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14849constants to pointers.
14850
14851Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations.  Array
14852indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14853that is not itself an array.
14854
14855@node Debugging C
14856@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14857
14858The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14859the @code{union} type.  When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14860inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed.  Otherwise, it
14861appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14862
14863The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14864with pointers and a memory allocation function.  @xref{Expressions,
14865,Expressions}.
14866
14867@node Debugging C Plus Plus
14868@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14869
14870@cindex commands for C@t{++}
14871
14872Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14873designed specifically for use with C@t{++}.  Here is a summary:
14874
14875@table @code
14876@cindex break in overloaded functions
14877@item @r{breakpoint menus}
14878When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14879@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14880locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14881@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14882
14883@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14884@item rbreak @var{regex}
14885Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14886breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14887classes.
14888@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14889
14890@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14891@item catch throw
14892@itemx catch rethrow
14893@itemx catch catch
14894Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands.  @xref{Set
14895Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14896
14897@cindex inheritance
14898@item ptype @var{typename}
14899Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14900@var{typename}.
14901@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14902
14903@item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14904The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14905method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}.  This shows
14906one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14907multiple inheritance is in use.
14908
14909@cindex C@t{++} demangling
14910@item demangle @var{name}
14911Demangle @var{name}.
14912@xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14913
14914@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14915@item set print demangle
14916@itemx show print demangle
14917@itemx set print asm-demangle
14918@itemx show print asm-demangle
14919Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14920displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14921@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14922
14923@item set print object
14924@itemx show print object
14925Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14926@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14927
14928@item set print vtbl
14929@itemx show print vtbl
14930Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14931@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14932(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14933ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14934
14935@kindex set overload-resolution
14936@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14937@item set overload-resolution on
14938Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation.  The default
14939is on.  For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14940and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14941using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14942Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14943If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14944
14945@item set overload-resolution off
14946Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation.  For
14947overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14948chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14949symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type.  For
14950overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14951searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14952argument types.
14953
14954@kindex show overload-resolution
14955@item show overload-resolution
14956Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14957
14958@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14959You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14960the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14961@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}.  You can
14962also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14963available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14964@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14965@end table
14966
14967@node Decimal Floating Point
14968@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14969@cindex decimal floating point format
14970
14971@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14972decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14973@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14974specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14975
14976There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14977Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14978PowerPC and S/390.  @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14979configured target.
14980
14981Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14982to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14983(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14984
14985In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14986point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14987underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14988
14989In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14990to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14991See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14992
14993@node D
14994@subsection D
14995
14996@cindex D
14997@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14998GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14999specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15000
15001@node Go
15002@subsection Go
15003
15004@cindex Go (programming language)
15005@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15006@file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15007
15008Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15009
15010@table @code
15011@cindex current Go package
15012@item The current Go package
15013The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15014specifying global variables and functions.
15015
15016For example, given the program:
15017
15018@example
15019package main
15020var myglob = "Shall we?"
15021func main () @{
15022  // ...
15023@}
15024@end example
15025
15026When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15027
15028@example
15029(gdb) p myglob
15030(gdb) p main.myglob
15031@end example
15032
15033@cindex builtin Go types
15034@item Builtin Go types
15035The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15036as a string.
15037
15038@cindex builtin Go functions
15039@item Builtin Go functions
15040The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15041function and handles it internally.
15042
15043@cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15044@item Restrictions on Go expressions
15045All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15046The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15047Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15048@end table
15049
15050@node Objective-C
15051@subsection Objective-C
15052
15053@cindex Objective-C
15054This section provides information about some commands and command
15055options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code.  See also
15056@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15057few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15058
15059@menu
15060* Method Names in Commands::
15061* The Print Command with Objective-C::
15062@end menu
15063
15064@node Method Names in Commands
15065@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15066
15067The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15068names as line specifications:
15069
15070@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15071@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15072@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15073@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15074@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15075@itemize
15076@item @code{clear}
15077@item @code{break}
15078@item @code{info line}
15079@item @code{jump}
15080@item @code{list}
15081@end itemize
15082
15083A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15084
15085@smallexample
15086-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15087@end smallexample
15088
15089where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15090plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method.  The class
15091name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15092brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15093source code.  For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15094instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15095debugged, enter:
15096
15097@smallexample
15098break -[Fruit create]
15099@end smallexample
15100
15101To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15102enter:
15103
15104@smallexample
15105list +[NSText initialize]
15106@end smallexample
15107
15108In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15109required.  In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15110sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search.  It
15111is also possible to specify just a method name:
15112
15113@smallexample
15114break create
15115@end smallexample
15116
15117You must specify the complete method name, including any colons.  If
15118your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15119you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15120method.  Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15121none apply.
15122
15123As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15124@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15125
15126@smallexample
15127clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15128@end smallexample
15129
15130@node The Print Command with Objective-C
15131@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15132@cindex Objective-C, print objects
15133@kindex print-object
15134@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15135
15136The print command has also been extended to accept methods.  For example:
15137
15138@smallexample
15139print -[@var{object} hash]
15140@end smallexample
15141
15142@cindex print an Objective-C object description
15143@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15144@noindent
15145will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15146and print the result.  Also, an additional command has been added,
15147@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15148the description of an object.  However, this command may only work
15149with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15150function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15151
15152@node OpenCL C
15153@subsection OpenCL C
15154
15155@cindex OpenCL C
15156This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15157
15158@menu
15159* OpenCL C Datatypes::
15160* OpenCL C Expressions::
15161* OpenCL C Operators::
15162@end menu
15163
15164@node OpenCL C Datatypes
15165@subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15166
15167@cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15168@value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15169by OpenCL 1.1.  In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15170data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15171extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15172
15173@node OpenCL C Expressions
15174@subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15175
15176@cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15177@value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15178lvalue where possible.  Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15179supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15180
15181@node OpenCL C Operators
15182@subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15183
15184@cindex OpenCL C Operators
15185@value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15186vector data types.
15187
15188@node Fortran
15189@subsection Fortran
15190@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15191
15192@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15193currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15194
15195@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15196Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15197among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15198functions.  When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15199will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15200underscore.
15201
15202@menu
15203* Fortran Operators::           Fortran operators and expressions
15204* Fortran Defaults::            Default settings for Fortran
15205* Special Fortran Commands::    Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15206@end menu
15207
15208@node Fortran Operators
15209@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15210
15211@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15212
15213Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
15214@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15215arithmetic types.  Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15216
15217@table @code
15218@item **
15219The exponentiation operator.  It raises the first operand to the power
15220of the second one.
15221
15222@item :
15223The range operator.  Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15224represent a section of array.
15225
15226@item %
15227The access component operator.  Normally used to access elements in derived
15228types.  Also suitable for unions.  As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15229this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15230union type.
15231@end table
15232
15233@node Fortran Defaults
15234@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15235
15236@cindex Fortran Defaults
15237
15238Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15239default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols.  You can
15240change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15241@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15242
15243@node Special Fortran Commands
15244@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15245
15246@cindex Special Fortran commands
15247
15248@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15249such as displaying common blocks.
15250
15251@table @code
15252@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15253@kindex info common
15254@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15255This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15256block whose name is @var{common-name}.  With no argument, the names of
15257all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15258printed.
15259@end table
15260
15261@node Pascal
15262@subsection Pascal
15263
15264@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15265Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15266nested functions does not currently work.  @value{GDBN} does not support
15267entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15268syntax.
15269
15270The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15271controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15272@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15273
15274@node Rust
15275@subsection Rust
15276
15277@value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15278Programming Language}.  Type- and value-printing, and expression
15279parsing, are reasonably complete.  However, there are a few
15280peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15281
15282@itemize @bullet
15283@item
15284Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15285crate.  Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15286crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15287
15288That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15289crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15290to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15291@samp{B}.
15292
15293As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15294items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15295
15296@item
15297Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15298expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15299For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15300@samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15301@samp{K::x::y}.
15302
15303However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15304debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15305circumvent this.  To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15306a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15307scope.
15308
15309In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15310the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15311
15312@item
15313The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15314expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15315
15316@item
15317Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15318
15319@item
15320The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15321@code{Drop} trait.  Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15322never be destroyed.
15323
15324@item
15325@value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics.  In order
15326to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15327will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15328
15329@item
15330@value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust.  In most
15331cases this does not cause any problems.  However, in an expression
15332context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15333invalid results.  This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15334operator between the function name and its generic arguments.  For
15335example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15336@code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15337@code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15338
15339@item
15340As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15341the debugging information it generates.  These holes prevent certain
15342features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15343@itemize @bullet
15344
15345@item
15346Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15347
15348@item
15349Trait objects cannot be created or inspected.
15350
15351@item
15352Operator overloading is not implemented.
15353
15354@item
15355When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15356type names.
15357
15358@item
15359The type @code{Self} is not available.
15360
15361@item
15362@code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15363available in the crate.
15364@end itemize
15365@end itemize
15366
15367@node Modula-2
15368@subsection Modula-2
15369
15370@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15371
15372The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15373output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15374developed).  Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15375attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15376to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15377table.
15378
15379@cindex expressions in Modula-2
15380@menu
15381* M2 Operators::                Built-in operators
15382* Built-In Func/Proc::          Built-in functions and procedures
15383* M2 Constants::                Modula-2 constants
15384* M2 Types::                    Modula-2 types
15385* M2 Defaults::                 Default settings for Modula-2
15386* Deviations::                  Deviations from standard Modula-2
15387* M2 Checks::                   Modula-2 type and range checks
15388* M2 Scope::                    The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15389* GDB/M2::                      @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15390@end menu
15391
15392@node M2 Operators
15393@subsubsection Operators
15394@cindex Modula-2 operators
15395
15396Operators must be defined on values of specific types.  For instance,
15397@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures.  Operators are
15398often defined on groups of types.  For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15399following definitions hold:
15400
15401@itemize @bullet
15402
15403@item
15404@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15405their subranges.
15406
15407@item
15408@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15409
15410@item
15411@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15412
15413@item
15414@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15415@var{type}}.
15416
15417@item
15418@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15419
15420@item
15421@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15422
15423@item
15424@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15425@end itemize
15426
15427@noindent
15428The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15429increasing precedence:
15430
15431@table @code
15432@item ,
15433Function argument or array index separator.
15434
15435@item :=
15436Assignment.  The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15437@var{value}.
15438
15439@item <@r{, }>
15440Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15441types.
15442
15443@item <=@r{, }>=
15444Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15445on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15446set types.  Same precedence as @code{<}.
15447
15448@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15449Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15450Same precedence as @code{<}.  In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15451available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15452comment character.
15453
15454@item IN
15455Set membership.  Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15456Same precedence as @code{<}.
15457
15458@item OR
15459Boolean disjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
15460
15461@item AND@r{, }&
15462Boolean conjunction.  Defined on boolean types.
15463
15464@item @@
15465The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15466
15467@item +@r{, }-
15468Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15469and difference on set types.
15470
15471@item *
15472Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15473on set types.
15474
15475@item /
15476Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15477types.  Same precedence as @code{*}.
15478
15479@item DIV@r{, }MOD
15480Integer division and remainder.  Defined on integral types.  Same
15481precedence as @code{*}.
15482
15483@item -
15484Negative.  Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15485
15486@item ^
15487Pointer dereferencing.  Defined on pointer types.
15488
15489@item NOT
15490Boolean negation.  Defined on boolean types.  Same precedence as
15491@code{^}.
15492
15493@item .
15494@code{RECORD} field selector.  Defined on @code{RECORD} data.  Same
15495precedence as @code{^}.
15496
15497@item []
15498Array indexing.  Defined on @code{ARRAY} data.  Same precedence as @code{^}.
15499
15500@item ()
15501Procedure argument list.  Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects.  Same precedence
15502as @code{^}.
15503
15504@item ::@r{, }.
15505@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15506@end table
15507
15508@quotation
15509@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15510treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15511@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15512@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15513@end quotation
15514
15515
15516@node Built-In Func/Proc
15517@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15518@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15519
15520Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15521In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15522
15523@table @var
15524
15525@item a
15526represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15527
15528@item c
15529represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15530
15531@item i
15532represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15533
15534@item m
15535represents an identifier that belongs to a set.  Generally used in the
15536same function with the metavariable @var{s}.  The type of @var{s} should
15537be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15538
15539@item n
15540represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15541
15542@item r
15543represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15544
15545@item t
15546represents a type.
15547
15548@item v
15549represents a variable.
15550
15551@item x
15552represents a variable or constant of one of many types.  See the
15553explanation of the function for details.
15554@end table
15555
15556All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15557
15558@table @code
15559@item ABS(@var{n})
15560Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15561
15562@item CAP(@var{c})
15563If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15564equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15565
15566@item CHR(@var{i})
15567Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15568
15569@item DEC(@var{v})
15570Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
15571
15572@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15573Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
15574new value.
15575
15576@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15577Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}.  Returns the new
15578set.
15579
15580@item FLOAT(@var{i})
15581Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15582
15583@item HIGH(@var{a})
15584Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15585
15586@item INC(@var{v})
15587Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one.  Returns the new value.
15588
15589@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15590Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}.  Returns the
15591new value.
15592
15593@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15594Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15595there.  Returns the new set.
15596
15597@item MAX(@var{t})
15598Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15599
15600@item MIN(@var{t})
15601Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15602
15603@item ODD(@var{i})
15604Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15605
15606@item ORD(@var{x})
15607Returns the ordinal value of its argument.  For example, the ordinal
15608value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15609the @sc{ascii} character set).  The argument @var{x} must be of an
15610ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15611
15612@item SIZE(@var{x})
15613Returns the size of its argument.  The argument @var{x} can be a
15614variable or a type.
15615
15616@item TRUNC(@var{r})
15617Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15618
15619@item TSIZE(@var{x})
15620Returns the size of its argument.  The argument @var{x} can be a
15621variable or a type.
15622
15623@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15624Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15625@end table
15626
15627@quotation
15628@emph{Warning:}  Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15629@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15630an error.
15631@end quotation
15632
15633@cindex Modula-2 constants
15634@node M2 Constants
15635@subsubsection Constants
15636
15637@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15638ways:
15639
15640@itemize @bullet
15641
15642@item
15643Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits.  When used in an
15644expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15645rest of the expression.  Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15646trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15647
15648@item
15649Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15650decimal point and another sequence of digits.  An optional exponent can
15651then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15652@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent.  All of the
15653digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15654digits.
15655
15656@item
15657Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15658like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).  They may
15659also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15660followed by a @samp{C}.
15661
15662@item
15663String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15664pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15665Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed.  @xref{C
15666Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15667sequences.
15668
15669@item
15670Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15671
15672@item
15673Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15674@code{FALSE}.
15675
15676@item
15677Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15678
15679@item
15680Set constants are not yet supported.
15681@end itemize
15682
15683@node M2 Types
15684@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15685@cindex Modula-2 types
15686
15687Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15688syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15689types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types.  You can also
15690print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15691This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15692sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15693
15694The first example contains the following section of code:
15695
15696@smallexample
15697VAR
15698   s: SET OF CHAR ;
15699   r: [20..40] ;
15700@end smallexample
15701
15702@noindent
15703and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15704@code{r} and @code{s}.
15705
15706@smallexample
15707(@value{GDBP}) print s
15708@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15709(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15710SET OF CHAR
15711(@value{GDBP}) print r
1571221
15713(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15714[20..40]
15715@end smallexample
15716
15717@noindent
15718Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15719
15720@smallexample
15721VAR
15722   s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15723@end smallexample
15724
15725@noindent
15726then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15727
15728@smallexample
15729(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15730type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15731@end smallexample
15732
15733@noindent
15734Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15735expressions using the debugger.
15736
15737The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15738and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15739
15740@smallexample
15741VAR
15742   s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15743@end smallexample
15744
15745@smallexample
15746(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15747ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15748@end smallexample
15749
15750Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15751is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15752arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15753above.
15754
15755Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15756
15757@smallexample
15758TYPE
15759   colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15760   t = [blue..yellow] ;
15761VAR
15762   s: t ;
15763BEGIN
15764   s := blue ;
15765@end smallexample
15766
15767@noindent
15768The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15769and value of a variable.
15770
15771@smallexample
15772(@value{GDBP}) print s
15773$1 = blue
15774(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15775type = [blue..yellow]
15776@end smallexample
15777
15778@noindent
15779In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15780displayed.  Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15781their @code{C} counterparts.
15782
15783@smallexample
15784VAR
15785   s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15786BEGIN
15787   s[1] := 1 ;
15788@end smallexample
15789
15790@smallexample
15791(@value{GDBP}) print s
15792$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15793(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15794type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15795@end smallexample
15796
15797The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15798pointer types as shown in this example:
15799
15800@smallexample
15801VAR
15802   s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15803BEGIN
15804   NEW(s) ;
15805   s^[1] := 1 ;
15806@end smallexample
15807
15808@noindent
15809and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15810
15811@smallexample
15812(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15813type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15814@end smallexample
15815
15816@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15817Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15818types:
15819
15820@smallexample
15821TYPE
15822   foo = RECORD
15823            f1: CARDINAL ;
15824            f2: CHAR ;
15825            f3: myarray ;
15826         END ;
15827
15828   myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15829   myrange = [-2..2] ;
15830VAR
15831   s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15832@end smallexample
15833
15834@noindent
15835and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15836below.
15837
15838@smallexample
15839(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15840type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15841    f1 : CARDINAL;
15842    f2 : CHAR;
15843    f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15844END
15845@end smallexample
15846
15847@node M2 Defaults
15848@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15849@cindex Modula-2 defaults
15850
15851If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15852both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15853Modula-2.  This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15854selected the working language.
15855
15856If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15857code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15858working language to Modula-2.  @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15859Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15860
15861@node Deviations
15862@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15863@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15864
15865A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15866This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15867
15868@itemize @bullet
15869@item
15870Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15871integers.  This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15872debugging.  (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15873pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15874through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15875returned a pointer.)
15876
15877@item
15878C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15879non-printable characters.  @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15880escape sequences embedded.  Single non-printable characters are
15881printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15882
15883@item
15884The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15885argument.
15886
15887@item
15888All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15889@end itemize
15890
15891@node M2 Checks
15892@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15893@cindex Modula-2 checks
15894
15895@quotation
15896@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15897range checking.
15898@end quotation
15899@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15900
15901@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15902
15903@itemize @bullet
15904@item
15905They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15906@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15907
15908@item
15909They have been declared on the same line.  (Note:  This is true of the
15910@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15911@end itemize
15912
15913As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15914whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15915
15916Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15917index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15918
15919@node M2 Scope
15920@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15921@cindex scope
15922@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15923@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15924@ifinfo
15925@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15926@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15927@end ifinfo
15928@ifnotinfo
15929@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15930@end ifnotinfo
15931
15932There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15933(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}).  The two have
15934similar syntax:
15935
15936@smallexample
15937
15938@var{module} . @var{id}
15939@var{scope} :: @var{id}
15940@end smallexample
15941
15942@noindent
15943where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15944@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15945identifier within your program, except another module.
15946
15947Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15948specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}.  If it is not
15949found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15950enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15951
15952Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15953the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15954definition module specified by @var{module}.  With this operator, it is
15955an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15956module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15957@var{module}.
15958
15959@node GDB/M2
15960@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15961
15962Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15963Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15964specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15965@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}.  The first four
15966apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15967analogue in Modula-2.
15968
15969The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15970with any language, is not useful with Modula-2.  Its
15971intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15972created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}.  However, because an
15973address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15974@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15975
15976@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15977In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15978interpreted as the beginning of a comment.  Use @code{<>} instead.
15979
15980@node Ada
15981@subsection Ada
15982@cindex Ada
15983
15984The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15985output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15986Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15987attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15988to be difficult.
15989
15990
15991@cindex expressions in Ada
15992@menu
15993* Ada Mode Intro::              General remarks on the Ada syntax
15994                                   and semantics supported by Ada mode
15995                                   in @value{GDBN}.
15996* Omissions from Ada::          Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15997* Additions to Ada::            Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15998* Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15999                                   subprograms.
16000* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16001* Ada Exceptions::              Ada Exceptions
16002* Ada Tasks::                   Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16003* Ada Tasks and Core Files::    Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16004* Ravenscar Profile::           Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16005                                   Profile
16006* Ada Glitches::                Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16007@end menu
16008
16009@node Ada Mode Intro
16010@subsubsection Introduction
16011@cindex Ada mode, general
16012
16013The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16014syntax, with some extensions.
16015The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16016
16017@itemize @bullet
16018@item
16019That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16020arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16021leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16022program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16023
16024@item
16025That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16026are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16027
16028@item
16029That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16030@end itemize
16031
16032Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16033user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16034according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16035names with their packages, regardless of context.  Where this causes
16036ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16037
16038The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16039As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16040was translated from an Ada source file.
16041
16042While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments.  This is useful
16043mostly for documenting command files.  The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16044(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16045middle (to allow based literals).
16046
16047@node Omissions from Ada
16048@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16049@cindex Ada, omissions from
16050
16051Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16052
16053@itemize @bullet
16054@item
16055Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16056
16057@itemize @minus
16058@item
16059@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16060 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16061
16062@item
16063@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16064
16065@item
16066@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16067
16068@item
16069@t{'Tag}.
16070
16071@item
16072@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16073operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16074
16075@item
16076@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16077@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16078
16079@item
16080@t{'Address}.
16081@end itemize
16082
16083@item
16084The names in
16085@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16086concatenation is not implemented.  Thus, escape characters in strings are
16087not currently available.
16088
16089@item
16090Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16091equality of representations.  They will generally work correctly
16092for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16093They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16094types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16095(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16096zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16097indeterminate values.
16098
16099@item
16100The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16101@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16102are not implemented.
16103
16104@item
16105@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16106@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16107@cindex aggregates (Ada)
16108There is limited support for array and record aggregates.  They are
16109permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16110
16111@smallexample
16112(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16113(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16114(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16115(@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16116(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16117(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16118@end smallexample
16119
16120Changing a
16121discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16122undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16123However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16124them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16125aggregate assignment.  For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16126declared to have a type such as:
16127
16128@smallexample
16129type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16130    Id : Integer;
16131    Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16132end record;
16133@end smallexample
16134
16135you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16136assignments:
16137
16138@smallexample
16139(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16140(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16141@end smallexample
16142
16143As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16144rules concerning aggregates.  You may leave out some of the
16145components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16146component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16147original values upon assignment.  You may freely use dynamic values as
16148indices in component associations.  You may even use overlapping or
16149redundant component associations, although which component values are
16150assigned in such cases is not defined.
16151
16152@item
16153Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16154
16155@item
16156The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16157than that of real Ada.  It makes only limited use of the context in
16158which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16159looser in its rules for allowing type matches.  As a result, some
16160function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16161the proper resolution.
16162
16163@item
16164The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16165
16166@item
16167Entry calls are not implemented.
16168
16169@item
16170Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16171formats are not supported.
16172
16173@item
16174It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16175
16176@item
16177The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16178are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16179context.
16180Should your program
16181redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16182you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16183@end itemize
16184
16185@node Additions to Ada
16186@subsubsection Additions to Ada
16187@cindex Ada, deviations from
16188
16189As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16190extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16191
16192@itemize @bullet
16193@item
16194If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16195a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16196then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16197@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.  In
16198Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16199in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16200Ada.  However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16201which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16202
16203@item
16204@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16205appears in function or file @var{B}.''  When @var{B} is a file name,
16206you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16207
16208@item
16209The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16210@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16211
16212@item
16213A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16214(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16215@end itemize
16216
16217In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16218additions specific to Ada:
16219
16220@itemize @bullet
16221@item
16222The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16223its right-hand operand as its value.  Thus, you may enter
16224
16225@smallexample
16226(@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16227(@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16228@end smallexample
16229
16230@item
16231The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,''  returning as its value
16232the value of its right-hand operand.
16233This allows, for example,
16234complex conditional breaks:
16235
16236@smallexample
16237(@value{GDBP}) break f
16238(@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16239@end smallexample
16240
16241@item
16242Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16243characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16244which is also used to print strings.  A sequence of characters of the form
16245@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16246(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal.  The
16247sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16248in strings.   For example,
16249@smallexample
16250   "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16251@end smallexample
16252@noindent
16253contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16254after each period.
16255
16256@item
16257The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16258@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case).  For example, it is valid
16259to write
16260
16261@smallexample
16262(@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16263@end smallexample
16264
16265@item
16266When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16267array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16268For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16269of 3 might print as
16270
16271@smallexample
16272(3 => 10, 17, 1)
16273@end smallexample
16274
16275@noindent
16276That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16277clause.
16278
16279@item
16280You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16281multi-character subsequence of
16282their names (an exact match gets preference).
16283For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16284in place of  @t{a'length}.
16285
16286@item
16287@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16288Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16289to lower case.  The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16290some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16291For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16292enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16293For example,
16294@smallexample
16295(@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16296@end smallexample
16297
16298@item
16299Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16300access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16301specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag).  Likewise, component
16302selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16303object.
16304
16305@end itemize
16306
16307@node Overloading support for Ada
16308@subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16309@cindex overloading, Ada
16310
16311The debugger supports limited overloading.  Given a subprogram call in which
16312the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16313actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16314the set of definitions.  It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16315procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16316functions to procedures elsewhere.
16317
16318If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16319one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16320use, for instance:
16321
16322@smallexample
16323(@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16324Multiple matches for f
16325[0] cancel
16326[1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16327[2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16328>
16329@end smallexample
16330
16331In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16332(type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16333instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16334
16335Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16336case:
16337
16338@table @code
16339
16340@kindex set ada print-signatures
16341@item set ada print-signatures
16342Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16343selection menus.  It is @code{on} by default.
16344@xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16345
16346@kindex show ada print-signatures
16347@item show ada print-signatures
16348Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16349overloads selection menu.
16350@xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16351
16352@end table
16353
16354@node Stopping Before Main Program
16355@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16356
16357@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16358It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16359before reaching the main procedure.
16360As defined in the Ada Reference
16361Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16362@code{adainit}.  To run your program up to the beginning of
16363elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16364@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16365
16366@node Ada Exceptions
16367@subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16368
16369A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16370
16371@table @code
16372@kindex info exceptions
16373@item info exceptions
16374@itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16375The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16376defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16377With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16378whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16379@end table
16380
16381Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16382without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16383argument.
16384
16385@smallexample
16386(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16387All defined Ada exceptions:
16388constraint_error: 0x613da0
16389program_error: 0x613d20
16390storage_error: 0x613ce0
16391tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16392const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16393(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16394All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16395constraint_error: 0x613da0
16396const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16397@end smallexample
16398
16399It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16400when an exception is raised.  For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16401
16402@node Ada Tasks
16403@subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16404@cindex Ada, tasking
16405
16406Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16407@value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16408
16409@table @code
16410@kindex info tasks
16411@item info tasks
16412This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16413
16414
16415@smallexample
16416@iftex
16417@leftskip=0.5cm
16418@end iftex
16419(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16420  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                 Name
16421   1   8088000   0   15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16422   2   80a4000   1   15 Accept Statement      b
16423   3   809a800   1   15 Child Activation Wait a
16424*  4   80ae800   3   15 Runnable              c
16425
16426@end smallexample
16427
16428@noindent
16429In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16430task currently being inspected.
16431
16432@table @asis
16433@item ID
16434Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16435
16436@item TID
16437The Ada task ID.
16438
16439@item P-ID
16440The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16441
16442@item Pri
16443The base priority of the task.
16444
16445@item State
16446Current state of the task.
16447
16448@table @code
16449@item Unactivated
16450The task has been created but has not been activated.  It cannot be
16451executing.
16452
16453@item Runnable
16454The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada.  (It may be waiting
16455for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16456
16457@item Terminated
16458The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5).  Any dependents
16459that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16460terminated themselves.
16461
16462@item Child Activation Wait
16463The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16464
16465@item Accept Statement
16466The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16467
16468@item Waiting on entry call
16469The task is waiting on an entry call.
16470
16471@item Async Select Wait
16472The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16473select statement.
16474
16475@item Delay Sleep
16476The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16477alternative open.
16478
16479@item Child Termination Wait
16480The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16481waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16482waiting on a terminate Phase.
16483
16484@item Wait Child in Term Alt
16485The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16486finish terminating.
16487
16488@item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16489The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16490@end table
16491
16492@item Name
16493Name of the task in the program.
16494
16495@end table
16496
16497@kindex info task @var{taskno}
16498@item info task @var{taskno}
16499This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16500the following example:
16501@smallexample
16502@iftex
16503@leftskip=0.5cm
16504@end iftex
16505(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16506  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                  Name
16507   1   8077880    0  15 Child Activation Wait  main_task
16508*  2   807c468    1  15 Runnable               task_1
16509(@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16510Ada Task: 0x807c468
16511Name: task_1
16512Thread: 0x807f378
16513Parent: 1 (main_task)
16514Base Priority: 15
16515State: Runnable
16516@end smallexample
16517
16518@item task
16519@kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16520@cindex current Ada task ID
16521This command prints the ID of the current task.
16522
16523@smallexample
16524@iftex
16525@leftskip=0.5cm
16526@end iftex
16527(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16528  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                  Name
16529   1   8077870    0  15 Child Activation Wait  main_task
16530*  2   807c458    1  15 Runnable               t
16531(@value{GDBP}) task
16532[Current task is 2]
16533@end smallexample
16534
16535@item task @var{taskno}
16536@cindex Ada task switching
16537This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16538command (@pxref{Threads}).  It switches the context of debugging
16539from the current task to the given task.
16540
16541@smallexample
16542@iftex
16543@leftskip=0.5cm
16544@end iftex
16545(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16546  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                  Name
16547   1   8077870    0  15 Child Activation Wait  main_task
16548*  2   807c458    1  15 Runnable               t
16549(@value{GDBP}) task 1
16550[Switching to task 1]
16551#0  0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16552(@value{GDBP}) bt
16553#0  0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16554#1  0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16555#2  0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16556#3  0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16557#4  0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16558@end smallexample
16559
16560@item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16561@itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16562@cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16563@cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16564@kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16565These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16566command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).  The
16567@var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16568in @ref{Specify Location}.
16569
16570Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16571to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16572particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint.  The @var{taskno} is one of the
16573numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16574column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16575
16576If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16577breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16578program.
16579
16580You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16581well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16582breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16583
16584For example,
16585
16586@smallexample
16587@iftex
16588@leftskip=0.5cm
16589@end iftex
16590(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16591  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                 Name
16592   1 140022020   0   15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16593   2 140045060   1   15 Accept/Select Wait    t2
16594   3 140044840   1   15 Runnable              t1
16595*  4 140056040   1   15 Runnable              t3
16596(@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16597Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16598(@value{GDBP}) cont
16599Continuing.
16600task # 1 running
16601task # 2 running
16602
16603Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
1660415               flush;
16605(@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16606  ID       TID P-ID Pri State                 Name
16607   1 140022020   0   15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16608*  2 140045060   1   15 Runnable              t2
16609   3 140044840   1   15 Runnable              t1
16610   4 140056040   1   15 Delay Sleep           t3
16611@end smallexample
16612@end table
16613
16614@node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16615@subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16616@cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16617
16618When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16619tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16620the platform being used.
16621For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16622switching is not supported.
16623
16624On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16625memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support.  When inspecting
16626a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16627privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16628Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16629file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16630
16631@node Ravenscar Profile
16632@subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16633@cindex Ravenscar Profile
16634
16635The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16636specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16637requirements.
16638
16639@table @code
16640@kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16641@cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16642@item set ravenscar task-switching on
16643Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16644Profile.  This is the default.
16645
16646@kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16647@item set ravenscar task-switching off
16648Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16649Profile.  This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16650for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16651the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16652To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16653
16654@kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16655@item show ravenscar task-switching
16656Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16657using the Ravenscar Profile.
16658
16659@end table
16660
16661@node Ada Glitches
16662@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16663@cindex Ada, problems
16664
16665Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16666we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16667@value{GDBN},
16668some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16669and the GNU Ada compiler.
16670
16671@itemize @bullet
16672@item
16673Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16674storage are invisible to the debugger.
16675
16676@item
16677Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16678argument lists are treated as positional).
16679
16680@item
16681Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16682
16683@item
16684Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16685floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16686the host machine.
16687
16688@item
16689The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16690the standard symbols defined by the Ada language.  @value{GDBN} knows about
16691this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16692look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16693symbols in other packages or subprograms.  If you have
16694defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16695local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16696GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion.  When this happens,
16697you can usually resolve the confusion
16698by qualifying the problematic names with package
16699@code{Standard} explicitly.
16700@end itemize
16701
16702Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16703information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16704of affected entities.  In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16705around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16706to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16707enabled.
16708
16709@kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16710@kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16711@table @code
16712
16713@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16714Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16715value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16716types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16717a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16718This is the default.
16719
16720@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16721This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler.  If @value{GDBN}
16722sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16723trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16724the issue.  It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16725@code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16726recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16727
16728@end table
16729
16730@cindex GNAT descriptive types
16731@cindex GNAT encoding
16732Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16733of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16734@file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16735how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16736In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16737which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16738
16739These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16740format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16741types available in Ada.  Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16742Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16743types by their pure DWARF equivalent.  To facilitate that transition,
16744a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16745those descriptive types.  It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16746well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16747
16748@table @code
16749
16750@kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16751@item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16752Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16753The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16754
16755@kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16756@item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16757Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16758
16759@end table
16760
16761@node Unsupported Languages
16762@section Unsupported Languages
16763
16764@cindex unsupported languages
16765@cindex minimal language
16766In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16767@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16768It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16769of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16770This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16771an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16772
16773If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16774select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16775language.
16776
16777@node Symbols
16778@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16779
16780The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16781symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16782program.  This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16783does not change as your program executes.  @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16784program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16785(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16786file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16787
16788@cindex symbol names
16789@cindex names of symbols
16790@cindex quoting names
16791Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16792characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters.  The
16793most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16794source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}).  File names
16795are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16796ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16797@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}.  To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16798@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16799
16800@smallexample
16801p 'foo.c'::x
16802@end smallexample
16803
16804@noindent
16805looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16806
16807@table @code
16808@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16809@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16810@kindex set case-sensitive
16811@item set case-sensitive on
16812@itemx set case-sensitive off
16813@itemx set case-sensitive auto
16814Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16815with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16816Occasionally, you may wish to control that.  The command @code{set
16817case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16818case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones.  If
16819you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16820suitable for the source language.  The default is case-sensitive
16821matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16822case-insensitive matches.
16823
16824@kindex show case-sensitive
16825@item show case-sensitive
16826This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16827lookups.
16828
16829@kindex set print type methods
16830@item set print type methods
16831@itemx set print type methods on
16832@itemx set print type methods off
16833Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16834declared in that class.  You can control this behavior either by
16835passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16836print type methods}.  Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16837display the methods; this is the default.  Specifying @code{off} will
16838cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16839
16840@kindex show print type methods
16841@item show print type methods
16842This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16843classes.
16844
16845@kindex set print type typedefs
16846@item set print type typedefs
16847@itemx set print type typedefs on
16848@itemx set print type typedefs off
16849
16850Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16851defined in that class.  You can control this behavior either by
16852passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16853print type typedefs}.  Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16854display the typedef definitions; this is the default.  Specifying
16855@code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16856Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16857printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16858types.
16859
16860@kindex show print type typedefs
16861@item show print type typedefs
16862This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16863printing classes.
16864
16865@kindex info address
16866@cindex address of a symbol
16867@item info address @var{symbol}
16868Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored.  For a register
16869variable, this says which register it is kept in.  For a non-register
16870local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16871is always stored.
16872
16873Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16874at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16875the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16876
16877@kindex info symbol
16878@cindex symbol from address
16879@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16880@item info symbol @var{addr}
16881Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16882If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16883nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16884
16885@smallexample
16886(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16887_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16888@end smallexample
16889
16890@noindent
16891This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command.  You can use
16892it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16893
16894For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16895library containing the symbol is also printed:
16896
16897@smallexample
16898(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16899_start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16900(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16901__read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16902@end smallexample
16903
16904@kindex demangle
16905@cindex demangle
16906@item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16907Demangle @var{name}.
16908If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16909@var{name} in.  Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16910
16911The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16912and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16913
16914The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16915of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16916
16917@kindex whatis
16918@item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16919Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16920or a name of a data type.  With no argument, print the data type of
16921@code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16922
16923If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16924is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16925assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16926
16927If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16928literal type as it is used in the source code.  If the type was
16929defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16930the data type underlying the @code{typedef}.  If the type of the
16931variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16932@code{struct} or  @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16933fields or methods.  It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16934name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}).  If you want to see the members of
16935such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16936
16937If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16938@code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16939Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16940in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}.  However, if that
16941underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16942unroll it.
16943
16944For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16945@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16946@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16947
16948@var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16949Available flags are:
16950
16951@table @code
16952@item r
16953Display in ``raw'' form.  Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16954parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16955members.  The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16956
16957@item m
16958Do not print methods defined in the class.
16959
16960@item M
16961Print methods defined in the class.  This is the default, but the flag
16962exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16963
16964@item t
16965Do not print typedefs defined in the class.  Note that this controls
16966whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16967names are substituted when printing other types.
16968
16969@item T
16970Print typedefs defined in the class.  This is the default, but the flag
16971exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16972@end table
16973
16974@kindex ptype
16975@item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16976@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16977detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16978@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16979
16980Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16981@code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16982a variable, expression, or a data type.  This means that @code{ptype}
16983of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16984present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that.  @code{typedef}s at
16985the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled.  Only @code{typedef}s of
16986fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16987@code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16988
16989For example, for this variable declaration:
16990
16991@smallexample
16992typedef double real_t;
16993struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16994typedef struct complex complex_t;
16995complex_t var;
16996real_t *real_pointer_var;
16997@end smallexample
16998
16999@noindent
17000the two commands give this output:
17001
17002@smallexample
17003@group
17004(@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17005type = complex_t
17006(@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17007type = struct complex @{
17008    real_t real;
17009    double imag;
17010@}
17011(@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17012type = struct complex
17013(@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17014type = struct complex
17015(@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17016type = struct complex @{
17017    real_t real;
17018    double imag;
17019@}
17020(@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17021type = real_t *
17022(@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17023type = double *
17024@end group
17025@end smallexample
17026
17027@noindent
17028As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17029the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17030
17031@cindex incomplete type
17032Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17033of complex data structure.  If the debug information included in the
17034program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17035the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}.  For example,
17036given these declarations:
17037
17038@smallexample
17039    struct foo;
17040    struct foo *fooptr;
17041@end smallexample
17042
17043@noindent
17044but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17045
17046@smallexample
17047  (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17048  $1 = <incomplete type>
17049@end smallexample
17050
17051@noindent
17052``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17053completely specified.
17054
17055@kindex info types
17056@item info types @var{regexp}
17057@itemx info types
17058Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17059expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17060no argument).  Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17061complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17062types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17063@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17064name is @code{value}.
17065
17066This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17067@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17068lists all source files where a type is defined.
17069
17070@kindex info type-printers
17071@item info type-printers
17072Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17073have ``type printers'' available.  When using @command{ptype} or
17074@command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17075is needed.  @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17076type printers.
17077
17078@code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17079
17080@kindex enable type-printer
17081@kindex disable type-printer
17082@item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17083@item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17084These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17085
17086@kindex info scope
17087@cindex local variables
17088@item info scope @var{location}
17089List all the variables local to a particular scope.  This command
17090accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17091an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17092to the scope defined by that location.  (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17093details about supported forms of @var{location}.)  For example:
17094
17095@smallexample
17096(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17097Scope for command_line_handler:
17098Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17099Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17100Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17101Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17102Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17103Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17104Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17105@end smallexample
17106
17107@noindent
17108This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17109during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17110collect}.
17111
17112@kindex info source
17113@item info source
17114Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17115the function containing the current point of execution:
17116@itemize @bullet
17117@item
17118the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17119@item
17120the directory it was compiled in,
17121@item
17122its length, in lines,
17123@item
17124which programming language it is written in,
17125@item
17126if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17127(which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17128@item
17129whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17130if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17131@item
17132whether the debugging information includes information about
17133preprocessor macros.
17134@end itemize
17135
17136
17137@kindex info sources
17138@item info sources
17139Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17140debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17141have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17142
17143@kindex info functions
17144@item info functions
17145Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17146
17147@item info functions @var{regexp}
17148Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17149whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17150Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17151include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17152start with @code{step}.  If a function name contains characters
17153that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17154@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17155
17156@kindex info variables
17157@item info variables
17158Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17159outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17160
17161@item info variables @var{regexp}
17162Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17163variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17164@var{regexp}.
17165
17166@kindex info classes
17167@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17168@item info classes
17169@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17170Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17171(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17172expression.
17173
17174@kindex info selectors
17175@item info selectors
17176@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17177Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17178(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17179expression.
17180
17181@ignore
17182This was never implemented.
17183@kindex info methods
17184@item info methods
17185@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17186The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17187methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17188specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes.  Many
17189C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods.  Thus, the output
17190from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use.  The
17191@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17192which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17193@end ignore
17194
17195@cindex opaque data types
17196@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17197@item set opaque-type-resolution on
17198Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types.  An opaque type is a type
17199declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17200@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17201source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17202another source file.  The default is on.
17203
17204A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17205the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17206
17207@item set opaque-type-resolution off
17208Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types.  In this case, the type
17209is printed as follows:
17210@smallexample
17211@{<no data fields>@}
17212@end smallexample
17213
17214@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17215@item show opaque-type-resolution
17216Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17217
17218@kindex set print symbol-loading
17219@cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17220@item set print symbol-loading
17221@itemx set print symbol-loading full
17222@itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17223@itemx set print symbol-loading off
17224The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17225printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17226By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17227shared library, and normally this is what you want.  However, when
17228debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17229can be annoying.
17230When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17231and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17232it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17233libraries.  When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17234
17235@kindex show print symbol-loading
17236@item show print symbol-loading
17237Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17238entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17239
17240@kindex maint print symbols
17241@cindex symbol dump
17242@kindex maint print psymbols
17243@cindex partial symbol dump
17244@kindex maint print msymbols
17245@cindex minimal symbol dump
17246@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
17247@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
17248@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
17249Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
17250These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.  Only
17251symbols with debugging data are included.  If you use @samp{maint print
17252symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
17253collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
17254only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read.  You can use the
17255command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.  If you
17256use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
17257symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
17258files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.  Finally,
17259@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
17260required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
17261@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17262@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17263
17264@kindex maint info symtabs
17265@kindex maint info psymtabs
17266@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17267@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17268@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17269@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17270@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17271@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17272
17273List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17274structures whose names match @var{regexp}.  If @var{regexp} is not
17275given, list them all.  The output includes expressions which you can
17276copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17277structure in more detail.  For example:
17278
17279@smallexample
17280(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17281@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17282  ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17283  @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17284    ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17285    readin no
17286    fullname (null)
17287    text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17288    globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17289    statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17290    dependencies (none)
17291  @}
17292@}
17293(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17294(@value{GDBP})
17295@end smallexample
17296@noindent
17297We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17298the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17299and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17300If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17301read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17302
17303@smallexample
17304(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17305Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17306line 1574.
17307(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17308@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17309  ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17310  @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17311    ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17312    dirname (null)
17313    fullname (null)
17314    blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17315    linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17316    debugformat DWARF 2
17317  @}
17318@}
17319(@value{GDBP})
17320@end smallexample
17321
17322@kindex maint info line-table
17323@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17324@cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17325@item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17326
17327List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17328instances whose name matches @var{regexp}.  If @var{regexp} is not
17329given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17330
17331@kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17332@cindex symbol cache size
17333@item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17334Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17335The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17336most applications.  This option exists to allow for experimenting
17337with different sizes.
17338
17339@kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17340@item maint show symbol-cache-size
17341Show the size of the symbol cache.
17342
17343@kindex maint print symbol-cache
17344@cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17345@item maint print symbol-cache
17346Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17347This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17348
17349@kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17350@cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17351@item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17352Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17353This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17354
17355@kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17356@cindex symbol cache, flushing
17357@item maint flush-symbol-cache
17358Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17359This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17360It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17361
17362@end table
17363
17364@node Altering
17365@chapter Altering Execution
17366
17367Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17368find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17369correct results in the rest of the run.  You can find the answer by
17370experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17371program.
17372
17373For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17374locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17375address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17376
17377@menu
17378* Assignment::                  Assignment to variables
17379* Jumping::                     Continuing at a different address
17380* Signaling::                   Giving your program a signal
17381* Returning::                   Returning from a function
17382* Calling::                     Calling your program's functions
17383* Patching::                    Patching your program
17384* Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17385@end menu
17386
17387@node Assignment
17388@section Assignment to Variables
17389
17390@cindex assignment
17391@cindex setting variables
17392To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17393@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.  For example,
17394
17395@smallexample
17396print x=4
17397@end smallexample
17398
17399@noindent
17400stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17401value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17402@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17403information on operators in supported languages.
17404
17405@kindex set variable
17406@cindex variables, setting
17407If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17408@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command.  @code{set} is
17409really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17410not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17411,Value History}).  The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17412
17413If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17414appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17415variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  This command is identical
17416to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands.  For example, if your
17417program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17418a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17419command @code{set width}:
17420
17421@smallexample
17422(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17423type = double
17424(@value{GDBP}) p width
17425$4 = 13
17426(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17427Invalid syntax in expression.
17428@end smallexample
17429
17430@noindent
17431The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}.  In
17432order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17433
17434@smallexample
17435(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17436@end smallexample
17437
17438Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17439with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17440@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}.  For example, if
17441your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17442to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17443the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17444
17445@smallexample
17446@group
17447(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17448type = double
17449(@value{GDBP}) p g
17450$1 = 1
17451(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17452(@value{GDBP}) p g
17453$2 = 1
17454(@value{GDBP}) r
17455The program being debugged has been started already.
17456Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17457Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17458"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17459                                 Invalid bfd target.
17460(@value{GDBP}) show g
17461The current BFD target is "=4".
17462@end group
17463@end smallexample
17464
17465@noindent
17466The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17467@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value.  In order to set the variable
17468@code{g}, use
17469
17470@smallexample
17471(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17472@end smallexample
17473
17474@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17475freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17476and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17477same length or shorter.
17478@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17479@comment        /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17480
17481To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17482construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17483(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).  For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17484to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17485and representation in memory), and
17486
17487@smallexample
17488set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17489@end smallexample
17490
17491@noindent
17492stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17493
17494@node Jumping
17495@section Continuing at a Different Address
17496
17497Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17498it stopped, with the @code{continue} command.  You can instead continue at
17499an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17500
17501@table @code
17502@kindex jump
17503@kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17504@item jump @var{location}
17505@itemx j @var{location}
17506Resume execution at @var{location}.  Execution stops again immediately
17507if there is a breakpoint there.  @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17508of the different forms of @var{location}.  It is common
17509practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17510@code{jump}.  @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17511
17512The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17513the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17514register other than the program counter.  If @var{location} is in
17515a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17516be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17517of local variables.  For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17518confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17519executing.  However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17520well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17521@end table
17522
17523On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17524command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}.  The
17525difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17526changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue.  For
17527example,
17528
17529@smallexample
17530set $pc = 0x485
17531@end smallexample
17532
17533@noindent
17534makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17535address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17536@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17537
17538The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17539up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17540that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17541detail.
17542
17543@c @group
17544@node Signaling
17545@section Giving your Program a Signal
17546@cindex deliver a signal to a program
17547
17548@table @code
17549@kindex signal
17550@item signal @var{signal}
17551Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17552signal @var{signal}.  The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17553signal.  For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17554SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17555
17556Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17557giving a signal.  This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17558a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17559@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17560signal.
17561
17562@emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17563delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17564reported a stop.  This includes the situation where a thread was
17565stopped due to a signal.  So if you want to continue execution
17566suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17567same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command.  If you issue
17568the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17569@value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17570
17571Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17572@code{kill} utility from the shell.  Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17573causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17574the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}).  The @code{signal} command
17575passes the signal directly to your program.
17576
17577@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17578after executing the command.
17579
17580@kindex queue-signal
17581@item queue-signal @var{signal}
17582Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17583when execution of the thread resumes.  The @var{signal} can be the name or
17584the number of a signal.  For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17585@code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17586The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17587otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17588You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17589@code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17590
17591Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17592for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17593will be delivered.  This is useful when your program stopped on account
17594of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17595@code{continue} command.
17596
17597This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17598is just queued, execution is not resumed.  And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17599be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17600(@pxref{Signals}).
17601@end table
17602@c @end group
17603
17604@xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17605commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17606
17607@node Returning
17608@section Returning from a Function
17609
17610@table @code
17611@cindex returning from a function
17612@kindex return
17613@item return
17614@itemx return @var{expression}
17615You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17616command.  If you give an
17617@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17618value.
17619@end table
17620
17621When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17622(and all frames within it).  You can think of this as making the
17623discarded frame return prematurely.  If you wish to specify a value to
17624be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17625
17626This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17627Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17628innermost remaining frame.  That frame becomes selected.  The
17629specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17630of functions.
17631
17632The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17633program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17634returned.  In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17635and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17636selected stack frame returns naturally.
17637
17638@value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17639the inferior.  The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17640type being returned by the selected stack frame.  For example it is common for
17641OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17642CPU registers.  Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17643registers.  Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17644specific placement rules.  @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17645current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17646assignment into the right register(s).
17647
17648Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info.  @value{GDBN} will always
17649use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17650debug info is available.  For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17651function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17652int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17653into a @code{long long int}:
17654
17655@smallexample
17656Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
1765729        return 31;
17658(@value{GDBP}) return -1
17659Make func return now? (y or n) y
17660#0  0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
1766143        printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17662(@value{GDBP})
17663@end smallexample
17664
17665However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17666function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17667to return from user.  Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17668in different inferior registers than the caller code expects.  For example,
17669typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17670of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17671architectures).  Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17672an appropriate cast explicitly:
17673
17674@smallexample
17675Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17676(@value{GDBP}) return -1
17677Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17678Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17679(@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17680Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17681#0  0x00400526 in main ()
17682(@value{GDBP})
17683@end smallexample
17684
17685@node Calling
17686@section Calling Program Functions
17687
17688@table @code
17689@cindex calling functions
17690@cindex inferior functions, calling
17691@item print @var{expr}
17692Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17693The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17694debugged.
17695
17696@kindex call
17697@item call @var{expr}
17698Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17699returned values.
17700
17701You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17702execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17703(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17704with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17705print.  If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17706value history.
17707@end table
17708
17709It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17710@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17711the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments).  What happens
17712in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17713
17714Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17715call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17716exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17717frame.  In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17718an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found.  GDB builds a
17719dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17720seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame.  What happens
17721in that case is controlled by the
17722@code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17723
17724@table @code
17725@item set unwindonsignal
17726@kindex set unwindonsignal
17727@cindex unwind stack in called functions
17728@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17729Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17730that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged.  If set to on,
17731@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17732the context to what it was before the call.  If set to off (the
17733default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17734received.
17735
17736@item show unwindonsignal
17737@kindex show unwindonsignal
17738Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17739@value{GDBN}.
17740
17741@item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17742@kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17743@cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17744@cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17745Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17746unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17747debugged.  If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17748it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17749the call.  If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17750the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17751
17752@item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17753@kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17754Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17755@value{GDBN}.
17756
17757@end table
17758
17759@cindex weak alias functions
17760Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17761for another function.  In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17762the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17763which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17764As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17765even crash.  A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17766function instead.
17767
17768@node Patching
17769@section Patching Programs
17770
17771@cindex patching binaries
17772@cindex writing into executables
17773@cindex writing into corefiles
17774
17775By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17776executable code (or the corefile) read-only.  This prevents accidental
17777alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17778patching your program's binary.
17779
17780If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17781explicitly with the @code{set write} command.  For example, you might
17782want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17783repairs.
17784
17785@table @code
17786@kindex set write
17787@item set write on
17788@itemx set write off
17789If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17790core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17791off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17792
17793If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17794@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17795write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17796
17797@item show write
17798@kindex show write
17799Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17800as well as reading.
17801@end table
17802
17803@node Compiling and Injecting Code
17804@section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17805@cindex injecting code
17806@cindex writing into executables
17807@cindex compiling code
17808
17809@value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17810programs running under @value{GDBN}.  GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17811@file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17812This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17813
17814@table @code
17815@kindex compile code
17816@item compile code @var{source-code}
17817@itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17818Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17819language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}).  If compilation and
17820injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17821@value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17822message will be printed.  If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17823successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17824and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17825It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17826After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17827new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17828
17829The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17830The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17831E.g.:
17832
17833@smallexample
17834compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17835@end smallexample
17836
17837If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17838may conflict.  The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17839from actual source code.  E.g.:
17840
17841@smallexample
17842compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17843@end smallexample
17844
17845Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text.  To
17846enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17847following the command.  This will start the multiple-line editor and
17848allow you to type as many lines of source code as required.  When you
17849have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17850editor.
17851
17852@smallexample
17853compile code
17854>printf ("hello\n");
17855>printf ("world\n");
17856>end
17857@end smallexample
17858
17859Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17860provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope.  In this case, you must
17861specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17862@code{_gdb_expr_}.  The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17863inferior.  Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17864@var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17865inferior symbols otherwise.
17866
17867@kindex compile file
17868@item compile file @var{filename}
17869@itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17870Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17871
17872@smallexample
17873compile file /home/user/example.c
17874@end smallexample
17875@end table
17876
17877@table @code
17878@item compile print @var{expr}
17879@itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17880Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17881current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}).  By default the
17882value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17883you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17884@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17885Formats}.
17886
17887@item compile print
17888@itemx compile print /@var{f}
17889@cindex reprint the last value
17890Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17891multiple lines of text.  To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17892command without any text following the command.  This will start the
17893multiple-line editor.
17894@end table
17895
17896@noindent
17897The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17898
17899@table @code
17900@anchor{set debug compile}
17901@item set debug compile
17902@cindex compile command debugging info
17903Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17904injecting the code.  The default is off.
17905
17906@item show debug compile
17907Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17908compiling and injecting the code.
17909@end table
17910
17911@subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17912
17913@value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17914to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17915and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17916injecting process.
17917
17918@noindent
17919The options used, in increasing precedence:
17920
17921@table @asis
17922@item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17923These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17924system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17925(@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17926
17927@item compilation options recorded in the target
17928@value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17929into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17930to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}.  One has to
17931explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17932@value{NGCC} produces no DWARF.  This feature is only relevant for
17933platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17934try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17935
17936@item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17937@end table
17938
17939@noindent
17940You can override compilation options using the following command:
17941
17942@table @code
17943@item set compile-args
17944@cindex compile command options override
17945Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17946@code{compile} commands.  These options override any conflicting ones
17947from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17948compilation.
17949
17950@item show compile-args
17951Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17952This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17953use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17954@end table
17955
17956@subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17957
17958There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17959command.  As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17960highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17961
17962@table @asis
17963@item C code examples and caveats
17964When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17965attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler.  The source
17966code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17967access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17968the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17969
17970Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17971follow.  This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17972much like any other normal debugging session.
17973
17974@smallexample
17975void function1 (void)
17976@{
17977   int i = 42;
17978   printf ("function 1\n");
17979@}
17980
17981void function2 (void)
17982@{
17983   int j = 12;
17984   function1 ();
17985@}
17986
17987int main(void)
17988@{
17989   int k = 6;
17990   int *p;
17991   function2 ();
17992   return 0;
17993@}
17994@end smallexample
17995
17996For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17997been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17998@code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17999
18000To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18001program must be compiled and packaged with debug information.  The
18002@code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule.  Without debug
18003information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18004be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18005
18006So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18007information enabled.  The @code{compile} command will have access to
18008all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18009out).  Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18010@code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18011the variable @code{k}.  You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18012and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}.  You can also
18013read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18014@code{C}.  Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18015@code{compile} command are persistent.  In the following example:
18016
18017@smallexample
18018compile code k = 3;
18019@end smallexample
18020
18021@noindent
18022the variable @code{k} is now 3.  It will retain that value until
18023something else in the example program changes it, or another
18024@code{compile} command changes it.
18025
18026Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18027injected by the @code{compile} command.  In the example, the variables
18028@code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18029currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18030are not in scope.  Therefore, the following command
18031
18032@smallexample
18033compile code j = 3;
18034@end smallexample
18035
18036@noindent
18037will result in a compilation error message.
18038
18039Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18040scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18041the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18042
18043You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18044part of your source code.  Variables and types that are created as part
18045of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18046the duration of its run.  This example is valid:
18047
18048@smallexample
18049compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18050@end smallexample
18051
18052However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18053command has completed:
18054
18055@smallexample
18056compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18057@end smallexample
18058
18059@noindent
18060a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18061exists.  Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18062command is removed when its execution ends.  Caution is advised
18063when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18064code submitted to the @code{compile} command.  This example is valid:
18065
18066@smallexample
18067compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18068@end smallexample
18069
18070The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}.  The variable
18071@code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18072it has been assigned.  However, pointers require particular care in
18073assignment.  If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18074changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18075variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18076to an invalid location when the command exits.  The following example
18077would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18078
18079@smallexample
18080compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18081@end smallexample
18082
18083In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18084@code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18085However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18086assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18087location when the command exists.  A general rule should be followed
18088in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18089or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18090
18091Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18092defined in @code{compile} command.  Types defined in the @code{compile}
18093command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18094Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18095@code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18096need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18097
18098@smallexample
18099(gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18100(gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18101gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18102Compilation failed.
18103(gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
1810442
18105@end smallexample
18106
18107Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18108accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18109Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18110will print to the console.
18111@end table
18112
18113@subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18114
18115@value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
18116may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
18117@value{GDBN} is running.  Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
18118shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
18119command @code{set environment}).  @xref{Environment}.  @code{PATH} on
18120@value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18121target architecture and operating system.
18122
18123Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18124@code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18125debugged.  @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18126example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18127@code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18128for pattern @code{s390x?}.  @var{os} is currently supported only for
18129pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18130
18131@node GDB Files
18132@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18133
18134@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18135both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18136program.  To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18137@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18138
18139@menu
18140* Files::                       Commands to specify files
18141* File Caching::                Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18142* Separate Debug Files::        Debugging information in separate files
18143* MiniDebugInfo::               Debugging information in a special section
18144* Index Files::                 Index files speed up GDB
18145* Symbol Errors::               Errors reading symbol files
18146* Data Files::                  GDB data files
18147@end menu
18148
18149@node Files
18150@section Commands to Specify Files
18151
18152@cindex symbol table
18153@cindex core dump file
18154
18155You may want to specify executable and core dump file names.  The usual
18156way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18157@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18158Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18159
18160Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18161@value{GDBN} session.  Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18162specify a file you want to use.  Or you are debugging a remote target
18163via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18164Program}).  In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18165new files are useful.
18166
18167@table @code
18168@cindex executable file
18169@kindex file
18170@item file @var{filename}
18171Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged.  It is read for its
18172symbols and for the contents of pure memory.  It is also the program
18173executed when you use the @code{run} command.  If you do not specify a
18174directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18175@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18176directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18177to run.  You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18178and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18179
18180@cindex unlinked object files
18181@cindex patching object files
18182You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18183the @code{file} command.  You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18184file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables.  Also,
18185if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18186@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique.  Note
18187that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18188case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18189the wrong place.  But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18190
18191@item file
18192@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18193has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18194
18195@kindex exec-file
18196@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18197Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18198in @var{filename}.  @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18199if necessary to locate your program.  Omitting @var{filename} means to
18200discard information on the executable file.
18201
18202@kindex symbol-file
18203@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18204Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}.  @code{PATH} is
18205searched when necessary.  Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18206table and program to run from the same file.
18207
18208@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18209program's symbol table.
18210
18211The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18212some breakpoints and auto-display expressions.  This is because they may
18213contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18214which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18215@value{GDBN}.
18216
18217@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18218executing it once.
18219
18220When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18221understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18222generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18223other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18224Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18225using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18226optimized code.
18227
18228For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18229using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18230symbol table in full right away.  Instead, it scans the symbol table
18231quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present.  The
18232details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18233
18234The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18235start up faster.  For the most part, it is invisible except for
18236occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18237file are being read.  (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18238pauses into messages if desired.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18239Warnings and Messages}.)
18240
18241We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet.  When the
18242symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18243symbol table data in full right away.  Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18244still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18245in stabs format.
18246
18247@kindex readnow
18248@cindex reading symbols immediately
18249@cindex symbols, reading immediately
18250@item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18251@itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18252You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18253tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18254load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18255entire symbol table available.
18256
18257@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18258@c flux.  13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18259@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18260@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18261@c only current dir is used.  FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18262@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18263@c files.
18264
18265@kindex core-file
18266@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18267@itemx core
18268Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18269of memory''.  Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18270address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18271executable file itself for other parts.
18272
18273@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18274to be used.
18275
18276Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18277under @value{GDBN}.  So, if you have been running your program and you
18278wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18279the program is running.  To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18280(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18281
18282@kindex add-symbol-file
18283@cindex dynamic linking
18284@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18285@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
18286@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18287The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18288information from the file @var{filename}.  You would use this command
18289when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18290into the program that is running.  The @var{address} should give the memory
18291address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18292this out for itself.  You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18293of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18294section name and base address for that section.  You can specify any
18295@var{address} as an expression.
18296
18297The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18298originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command.  You can use the
18299@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18300thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18301
18302Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18303
18304@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18305@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18306@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18307@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18308@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18309Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18310executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18311relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18312information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18313
18314@itemize @bullet
18315@item
18316the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18317that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18318@item
18319every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18320been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18321@item
18322you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18323provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18324@end itemize
18325
18326@noindent
18327Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18328relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18329typically make the requirements above easy to meet.  However, it's
18330important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18331procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18332assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet.  In
18333general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18334relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18335as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18336way.
18337
18338@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18339
18340@kindex remove-symbol-file
18341@item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18342@item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18343Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command.  The
18344file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18345that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory.  Example:
18346
18347@smallexample
18348(gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18349add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18350    .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18351(y or n) y
18352Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18353(gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18354Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18355(gdb)
18356@end smallexample
18357
18358
18359@code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18360
18361@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18362@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18363@cindex load symbols from memory
18364@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18365Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18366object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18367For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18368process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18369some system calls.  The argument can be any expression whose
18370evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18371For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18372@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18373
18374@kindex section
18375@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18376The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18377@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}.  This can be used if the
18378exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18379@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18380itself are wrong.  Each section must be changed separately.  The
18381@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18382their addresses.
18383
18384@kindex info files
18385@kindex info target
18386@item info files
18387@itemx info target
18388@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18389current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18390including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18391use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded.  The
18392command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18393current ones.
18394
18395@kindex maint info sections
18396@item maint info sections
18397Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18398is @code{maint info sections}.  In addition to the section information
18399displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18400offset of each section in the executable and core dump files.  In addition,
18401@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18402may be arbitrarily combined):
18403
18404@table @code
18405@item ALLOBJ
18406Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18407@item @var{sections}
18408Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18409@item @var{section-flags}
18410Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18411The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18412@table @code
18413@item ALLOC
18414Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18415Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18416@item LOAD
18417Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18418Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18419@item RELOC
18420Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18421@item READONLY
18422Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18423@item CODE
18424Section contains executable code only.
18425@item DATA
18426Section contains data only (no executable code).
18427@item ROM
18428Section will reside in ROM.
18429@item CONSTRUCTOR
18430Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18431@item HAS_CONTENTS
18432Section is not empty.
18433@item NEVER_LOAD
18434An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18435@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18436A notification to the linker that the section contains
18437COFF shared library information.
18438@item IS_COMMON
18439Section contains common symbols.
18440@end table
18441@end table
18442@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18443@cindex read-only sections
18444@item set trust-readonly-sections on
18445Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18446really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18447In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18448out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18449For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18450enhancement to debugging performance.
18451
18452The default is off.
18453
18454@item set trust-readonly-sections off
18455Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections.  This means that
18456the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18457and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18458
18459@item show trust-readonly-sections
18460Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18461@end table
18462
18463All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18464as arguments.  @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18465name and remembers it that way.
18466
18467@cindex shared libraries
18468@anchor{Shared Libraries}
18469@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18470Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18471DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18472
18473On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18474shared libraries.  @xref{Expat}.
18475
18476@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18477when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18478(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18479references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18480debugging a core file).
18481
18482@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18483@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18484@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18485
18486There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18487symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18488particularly large or there are many of them.
18489
18490To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18491commands:
18492
18493@table @code
18494@kindex set auto-solib-add
18495@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18496If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18497will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18498attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18499informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded.  If @var{mode}
18500is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18501@code{sharedlibrary} command.  The default value is @code{on}.
18502
18503@cindex memory used for symbol tables
18504If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18505takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18506memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18507symbols from shared libraries.  To that end, type @kbd{set
18508auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18509library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18510@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18511the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18512
18513@kindex show auto-solib-add
18514@item show auto-solib-add
18515Display the current autoloading mode.
18516@end table
18517
18518@cindex load shared library
18519To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18520command:
18521
18522@table @code
18523@kindex info sharedlibrary
18524@kindex info share
18525@item info share @var{regex}
18526@itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18527Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18528that match @var{regex}.  If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18529all shared libraries that are loaded.
18530
18531@kindex info dll
18532@item info dll @var{regex}
18533This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18534
18535@kindex sharedlibrary
18536@kindex share
18537@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18538@itemx share @var{regex}
18539Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18540Unix regular expression.
18541As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18542required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}.  If
18543@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18544loaded.
18545
18546@item nosharedlibrary
18547@kindex nosharedlibrary
18548@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18549Unload all shared object library symbols.  This discards all symbols
18550that have been loaded from all shared libraries.  Symbols from shared
18551libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18552discarded.
18553@end table
18554
18555Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18556when any of shared library events happen.  The best way to do this is
18557to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18558Catchpoints}).
18559
18560@value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18561command for this.  This command exists for historical reasons.  It is
18562less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18563conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18564
18565@table @code
18566@item set stop-on-solib-events
18567@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18568This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18569when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18570The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18571shared library.
18572
18573@item show stop-on-solib-events
18574@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18575Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18576library events happen.
18577@end table
18578
18579Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18580configurations.  @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18581this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18582on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18583libraries from the target.  If copies of the target libraries are
18584provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18585copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18586not.
18587
18588@cindex where to look for shared libraries
18589For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18590libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18591may try to load the host's libraries.  @value{GDBN} has two variables
18592to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18593
18594@table @code
18595@cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18596@cindex system root, alternate
18597@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18598@kindex set sysroot
18599@item set sysroot @var{path}
18600Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged.  Any
18601absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18602runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18603target program's memory.  When starting processes remotely, and when
18604attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18605executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18606@value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system.  If you use
18607@code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18608to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18609e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18610@var{path}.
18611
18612If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18613system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18614from the remote system.  This is only supported when using a remote
18615target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18616Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).  The part of @var{path}
18617following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18618root prefix on the remote file system.  If @var{path} starts with the
18619sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18620@file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18621functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18622provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}.  If you want
18623to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18624named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18625equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18626
18627For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18628SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18629absolute file name with @var{path}.  But first, on Unix hosts,
18630@value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18631slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18632
18633@smallexample
18634  c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18635@end smallexample
18636
18637Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18638@var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18639system:
18640
18641@smallexample
18642  c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18643@end smallexample
18644
18645If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18646the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18647for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18648colons:
18649
18650@smallexample
18651  c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18652@end smallexample
18653
18654This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18655with more than one drive.  E.g., you may want to setup your local
18656copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18657@samp{z}):
18658
18659@smallexample
18660 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18661 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18662 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18663@end smallexample
18664
18665@noindent
18666and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18667@value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18668@file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18669
18670If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18671removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18672
18673@smallexample
18674  c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18675@end smallexample
18676
18677This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18678if you don't want or need to.
18679
18680The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18681sysroot}.
18682
18683@cindex default system root
18684@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18685You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18686@samp{--with-sysroot} option.  If the system root is inside
18687@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18688@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18689automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18690location.
18691
18692@kindex show sysroot
18693@item show sysroot
18694Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18695
18696@kindex set solib-search-path
18697@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18698If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18699directories to search for shared libraries.  @samp{solib-search-path}
18700is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18701path to the library is relative instead of absolute.  If you want to
18702use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18703@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18704finding your host's libraries.  @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18705it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18706of shared library symbols.
18707
18708@kindex show solib-search-path
18709@item show solib-search-path
18710Display the current shared library search path.
18711
18712@cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18713@kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18714@kindex show target-file-system-kind
18715@item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18716Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18717
18718Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18719make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on.  For
18720example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18721system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18722@value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18723@file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}.  On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18724drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18725indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18726normally considered a directory separator character.  In that case,
18727the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18728as a relative file name with no directory components.  This would make
18729it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18730shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18731with @code{set solib-search-path}.  Setting
18732@code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18733to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18734map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18735semantics.  The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18736to one of the supported file system kinds.  In that case, @value{GDBN}
18737tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18738current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18739Current ABI}).  The supported file system settings are:
18740
18741@table @code
18742@item unix
18743Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18744kind.  Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18745are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18746the forward slash.
18747
18748@item dos-based
18749Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18750File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18751followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18752both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18753considered directory separators.
18754
18755@item auto
18756Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18757target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18758This is the default.
18759@end table
18760@end table
18761
18762@cindex file name canonicalization
18763@cindex base name differences
18764When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18765frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18766program's debug info.  Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18767@dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18768even for very large programs.  (The base name of a file is the last
18769portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18770This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18771cannot have more than one base name.  This is usually true, but
18772references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18773facilities violate that assumption.  If your program records files
18774using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18775using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18776@code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18777pair of file names it needs to compare.  This will make file-name
18778comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18779
18780@table @code
18781@item set basenames-may-differ
18782@kindex set basenames-may-differ
18783Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18784
18785@item show basenames-may-differ
18786@kindex show basenames-may-differ
18787Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18788@end table
18789
18790@node File Caching
18791@section File Caching
18792@cindex caching of opened files
18793@cindex caching of bfd objects
18794
18795To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18796reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files.  @xref{Top, ,
18797BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.  The following commands
18798allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18799
18800@table @code
18801@kindex maint info bfds
18802@item maint info bfds
18803This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18804@value{GDBN}.
18805
18806@kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18807@kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18808@kindex bfd caching
18809@item maint set bfd-sharing
18810@item maint show bfd-sharing
18811Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared.  When sharing is
18812enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18813than reopening the same file.  Turning sharing off does not cause
18814already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18815that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object.  Similarly,
18816re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18817objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18818
18819@kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18820@kindex bfd caching
18821@item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18822Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18823
18824@kindex show debug bfd-cache
18825@kindex bfd caching
18826@item show debug bfd-cache
18827Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18828@end table
18829
18830@node Separate Debug Files
18831@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18832@cindex separate debugging information files
18833@cindex debugging information in separate files
18834@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18835@cindex debugging information directory, global
18836@cindex global debugging information directories
18837@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18838@cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18839
18840@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18841file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18842@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18843Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18844than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18845information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18846install only when they need to debug a problem.
18847
18848@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18849file:
18850
18851@itemize @bullet
18852@item
18853The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18854the separate debug info file.  The separate debug file's name is
18855usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18856name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18857(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}).  In addition, the
18858debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18859checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18860the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18861
18862@item
18863The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18864also present in the corresponding debug info file.  (This is supported
18865only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18866for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.)  For more details about
18867this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18868command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18869The GNU Linker}.  The debug info file's name is not specified
18870explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18871below.
18872@end itemize
18873
18874Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18875uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18876
18877@itemize @bullet
18878@item
18879For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18880the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18881directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18882directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18883directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18884
18885@item
18886For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18887@file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18888a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18889first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18890are the rest of the bit string.  (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18891hex characters, not 10.)
18892@end itemize
18893
18894So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18895@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18896file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18897@code{abcdef1234}.  If the list of the global debug directories includes
18898@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18899debug information files, in the indicated order:
18900
18901@itemize @minus
18902@item
18903@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18904@item
18905@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18906@item
18907@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18908@item
18909@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18910@end itemize
18911
18912@anchor{debug-file-directory}
18913Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18914configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}.  During @value{GDBN} run
18915you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18916@value{GDBN} is currently using.
18917
18918@table @code
18919
18920@kindex set debug-file-directory
18921@item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18922Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18923information files to @var{directory}.  Multiple path components can be set
18924concatenating them by a path separator.
18925
18926@kindex show debug-file-directory
18927@item show debug-file-directory
18928Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18929information files.
18930
18931@end table
18932
18933@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18934@cindex debug link sections
18935A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18936@code{.gnu_debuglink}.  The section must contain:
18937
18938@itemize
18939@item
18940A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18941a zero byte,
18942@item
18943zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18944boundary within the section, and
18945@item
18946a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18947executable file itself.  The checksum is computed on the debugging
18948information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18949zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18950@end itemize
18951
18952Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18953contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18954described above.
18955
18956@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18957@cindex build ID sections
18958The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18959ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider).  This section is
18960often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18961It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18962the same across multiple builds of the same build tree.  The default
18963algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18964content for the build ID string.  The same section with an identical
18965value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18966stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18967
18968The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18969executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18970debugging information.  The sections of the debugging information file
18971should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18972but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18973in an ordinary executable.
18974
18975The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18976@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18977the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18978following commands:
18979
18980@smallexample
18981@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18982@kbd{strip -g foo}
18983@end smallexample
18984
18985@noindent
18986These commands remove the debugging
18987information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18988@file{foo.debug}.  You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18989two files:
18990
18991@itemize @bullet
18992@item
18993The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18994behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18995
18996@smallexample
18997@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18998@end smallexample
18999
19000Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19001a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19002foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19003the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19004
19005@item
19006Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19007the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}.  Build ID support plus
19008compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19009utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19010@end itemize
19011
19012@noindent
19013
19014@cindex CRC algorithm definition
19015The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19016IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19017
19018@c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19019@c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19020@c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19021@c different ways!
19022@ifhtml
19023@display
19024@html
19025 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19026 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19027@end html
19028@end display
19029@end ifhtml
19030@ifnothtml
19031@display
19032 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19033 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19034@end display
19035@end ifnothtml
19036
19037The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19038significant bit of each byte first.  The initial pattern
19039@code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19040the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19041CRC.
19042
19043@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19044@dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19045However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19046@emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19047trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19048
19049To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19050which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}.  Inverting the
19051initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19052this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19053@code{0xffffffff}.
19054
19055@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19056@smallexample
19057unsigned long
19058gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19059                     unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19060@{
19061  static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19062    @{
19063      0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19064      0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19065      0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19066      0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19067      0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19068      0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19069      0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19070      0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19071      0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19072      0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19073      0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19074      0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19075      0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19076      0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19077      0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19078      0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19079      0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19080      0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19081      0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19082      0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19083      0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19084      0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19085      0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19086      0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19087      0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19088      0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19089      0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19090      0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19091      0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19092      0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19093      0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19094      0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19095      0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19096      0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19097      0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19098      0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19099      0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19100      0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19101      0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19102      0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19103      0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19104      0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19105      0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19106      0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19107      0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19108      0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19109      0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19110      0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19111      0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19112      0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19113      0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19114      0x2d02ef8d
19115    @};
19116  unsigned char *end;
19117
19118  crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19119  for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19120    crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19121  return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19122@}
19123@end smallexample
19124
19125@noindent
19126This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19127
19128@node MiniDebugInfo
19129@section Debugging information in a special section
19130@cindex separate debug sections
19131@cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19132
19133Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19134special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section.  This feature is called
19135@dfn{MiniDebugInfo}.  This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19136is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19137
19138The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19139information for use in simple backtraces.  It is not intended to be a
19140replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19141Debug Files}).  The example below shows the intended use; however,
19142@value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19143debugging information might be included in the section.
19144
19145@value{GDBN} has support for this extension.  If the section exists,
19146then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19147can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19148
19149This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19150standard utilities:
19151
19152@smallexample
19153# Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19154# to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19155nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19156  | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19157
19158# Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19159# (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19160# of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19161nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19162  | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19163  | sort > funcsyms
19164
19165# Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19166# table.
19167comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19168
19169# Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19170objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19171
19172# Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19173# removing some unnecessary sections.
19174objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19175  --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19176
19177# Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19178strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19179
19180# Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19181# original binary.
19182xz mini_debuginfo
19183objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19184@end smallexample
19185
19186@node Index Files
19187@section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19188@cindex index files
19189@cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19190
19191When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19192file in order to construct an internal symbol table.  This lets most
19193@value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19194on.  For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19195@value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19196startup.
19197
19198The index is stored as a section in the symbol file.  @value{GDBN} can
19199write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19200using @command{objcopy}.
19201
19202To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19203
19204@table @code
19205@item save gdb-index @var{directory}
19206@kindex save gdb-index
19207Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
19208@value{GDBN}.  Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
19209with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
19210@var{directory}.
19211@end table
19212
19213Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19214file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19215
19216@smallexample
19217$ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19218    --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19219@end smallexample
19220
19221@value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19222sections that have been deprecated.  Usually they are deprecated because
19223they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19224To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19225specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19226The default is @code{off}.
19227This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19228@xref{Index Section Format}.
19229
19230@emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19231must be done before gdb reads the file.  The following will not work:
19232
19233@smallexample
19234$ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19235@end smallexample
19236
19237Instead you must do, for example,
19238
19239@smallexample
19240$ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19241@end smallexample
19242
19243There are currently some limitation on indices.  They only work when
19244for DWARF debugging information, not stabs.  And, they do not
19245currently work for programs using Ada.
19246
19247@node Symbol Errors
19248@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19249
19250While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19251such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19252output.  By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19253they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19254debugging compilers.  If you are interested in seeing information
19255about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19256only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19257times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19258to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19259complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19260Messages}).
19261
19262The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19263
19264@table @code
19265@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19266
19267The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19268(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements).  This
19269error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19270in its outer scope blocks.
19271
19272@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19273the same scope as the outer block.  In the error message, @var{symbol}
19274may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19275function.
19276
19277@item block at @var{address} out of order
19278
19279The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19280order of increasing addresses.  This error indicates that it does not
19281do so.
19282
19283@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19284locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading.  (You
19285can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19286@code{set verbose on}.  @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19287Messages}.)
19288
19289@item bad block start address patched
19290
19291The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19292smaller than the address of the preceding source line.  This is known
19293to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19294
19295@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19296starting on the previous source line.
19297
19298@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19299
19300@cindex foo
19301Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19302larger than the size of the string table.
19303
19304@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19305name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19306with this name.
19307
19308@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19309
19310The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19311not yet know how to read.  @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19312uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19313
19314@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19315This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19316are not accessible.  If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19317debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19318on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19319and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19320
19321@item stub type has NULL name
19322
19323@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19324
19325@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19326The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19327information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19328it.
19329
19330@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19331
19332@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19333
19334@end table
19335
19336@node Data Files
19337@section GDB Data Files
19338
19339@cindex prefix for data files
19340@value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file.  These files
19341are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19342
19343You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19344is currently using.
19345
19346@table @code
19347@kindex set data-directory
19348@item set data-directory @var{directory}
19349Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19350to @var{directory}.
19351
19352@kindex show data-directory
19353@item show data-directory
19354Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19355@end table
19356
19357@cindex default data directory
19358@cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19359You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19360@samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option.  If the data directory is inside
19361@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19362@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19363automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19364location.
19365
19366The data directory may also be specified with the
19367@code{--data-directory} command line option.
19368@xref{Mode Options}.
19369
19370@node Targets
19371@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19372
19373@cindex debugging target
19374A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19375
19376Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19377in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19378you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands.  When you need more
19379flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19380host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19381realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19382command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19383(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19384
19385@cindex target architecture
19386It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19387architectures}.  When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19388one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19389command.
19390
19391@table @code
19392@kindex set architecture
19393@kindex show architecture
19394@item set architecture @var{arch}
19395This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}.  The
19396value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19397supported architectures.
19398
19399@item show architecture
19400Show the current target architecture.
19401
19402@item set processor
19403@itemx processor
19404@kindex set processor
19405@kindex show processor
19406These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19407and @code{show architecture}.
19408@end table
19409
19410@menu
19411* Active Targets::              Active targets
19412* Target Commands::             Commands for managing targets
19413* Byte Order::                  Choosing target byte order
19414@end menu
19415
19416@node Active Targets
19417@section Active Targets
19418
19419@cindex stacking targets
19420@cindex active targets
19421@cindex multiple targets
19422
19423There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19424recording sessions.  Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19425and process mutually exclusive.  Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19426on multiple active targets, one in each class.  This allows you to (for
19427example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19428the executable file after the process finishes.  Or if you start process
19429recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19430presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19431remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19432
19433Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19434file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).  To
19435specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19436command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19437
19438@node Target Commands
19439@section Commands for Managing Targets
19440
19441@table @code
19442@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19443Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19444process.  A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19445facilities.  You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19446protocol of the target machine.
19447
19448Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19449typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19450with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19451
19452The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19453after executing the command.
19454
19455@kindex help target
19456@item help target
19457Displays the names of all targets available.  To display targets
19458currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19459(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19460
19461@item help target @var{name}
19462Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19463select it.
19464
19465@kindex set gnutarget
19466@item set gnutarget @var{args}
19467@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files.  @value{GDBN}
19468knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19469a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19470with the @code{set gnutarget} command.  Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19471with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19472
19473@quotation
19474@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19475you must know the actual BFD name.
19476@end quotation
19477
19478@noindent
19479@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19480
19481@kindex show gnutarget
19482@item show gnutarget
19483Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19484@code{gnutarget} is set to read.  If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19485@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19486and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19487@end table
19488
19489@cindex common targets
19490Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19491configuration):
19492
19493@table @code
19494@kindex target
19495@item target exec @var{program}
19496@cindex executable file target
19497An executable file.  @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19498@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19499
19500@item target core @var{filename}
19501@cindex core dump file target
19502A core dump file.  @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19503@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19504
19505@item target remote @var{medium}
19506@cindex remote target
19507A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19508connection.  This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19509protocol over @var{medium} for debugging.  @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19510
19511For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19512machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19513
19514@smallexample
19515target remote /dev/ttya
19516@end smallexample
19517
19518@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command.  This is only
19519useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19520system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19521clobbered by the download.
19522
19523@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19524@cindex built-in simulator target
19525Builtin CPU simulator.  @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19526In general,
19527@smallexample
19528        target sim
19529        load
19530        run
19531@end smallexample
19532@noindent
19533works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19534drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19535provide these.  For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19536see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19537Processors}.
19538
19539@item target native
19540@cindex native target
19541Setup for local/native process debugging.  Useful to make the
19542@code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19543etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19544(@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19545
19546@end table
19547
19548Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19549your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19550
19551Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19552you've successfully established a connection.  You may wish to control
19553various aspects of this process.
19554
19555@table @code
19556
19557@item set hash
19558@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19559@cindex hash mark while downloading
19560This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19561downloading a file to the remote monitor.  If on, a hash mark is
19562displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19563monitor.
19564
19565@item show hash
19566@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19567Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19568
19569@item set debug monitor
19570@kindex set debug monitor
19571@cindex display remote monitor communications
19572Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19573@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19574
19575@item show debug monitor
19576@kindex show debug monitor
19577Show the current status of displaying communications between
19578@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19579@end table
19580
19581@table @code
19582
19583@kindex load @var{filename}
19584@item load @var{filename}
19585@anchor{load}
19586Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19587@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available.  Where it exists, it
19588is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19589on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19590@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19591the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19592
19593If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19594execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19595target is @dots{}}''
19596
19597The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19598For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19599link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19600specifies a fixed address.
19601@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19602
19603Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19604load programs into flash memory.
19605
19606@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19607@end table
19608
19609@node Byte Order
19610@section Choosing Target Byte Order
19611
19612@cindex choosing target byte order
19613@cindex target byte order
19614
19615Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19616offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19617orders.  Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19618designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19619which to use.  However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19620@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19621
19622@table @code
19623@kindex set endian
19624@item set endian big
19625Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19626
19627@item set endian little
19628Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19629
19630@item set endian auto
19631Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19632executable.
19633
19634@item show endian
19635Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19636
19637@end table
19638
19639Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19640data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19641target system.
19642
19643
19644@node Remote Debugging
19645@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19646@cindex remote debugging
19647
19648If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19649@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19650For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19651or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19652powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19653
19654Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19655to make this work with particular debugging targets.  In addition,
19656@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19657but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19658write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19659communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19660
19661Other remote targets may be available in your
19662configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19663
19664@menu
19665* Connecting::                  Connecting to a remote target
19666* File Transfer::               Sending files to a remote system
19667* Server::	                Using the gdbserver program
19668* Remote Configuration::        Remote configuration
19669* Remote Stub::                 Implementing a remote stub
19670@end menu
19671
19672@node Connecting
19673@section Connecting to a Remote Target
19674@cindex remote debugging, connecting
19675@cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19676@cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19677@cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19678@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19679@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19680
19681This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19682types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19683symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19684connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19685
19686@subsection Types of Remote Connections
19687
19688@value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19689mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.  Note that many remote targets
19690support only @code{target remote} mode.  There are several major
19691differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19692
19693@table @asis
19694
19695@cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19696@item Result of detach or program exit
19697@strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19698detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.  When using
19699@code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19700
19701@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19702you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19703though no program is running.  You can rerun the program, attach to a
19704running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19705
19706When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19707invoked using the @option{--once} option.  If the @option{--once} option
19708was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19709@code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19710
19711@item Specifying the program to debug
19712For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19713program on the host system.  If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19714some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19715target.
19716
19717@strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19718on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19719(@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19720
19721@cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19722@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19723on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19724to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19725
19726@anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19727You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19728or process ID to attach.  To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19729option.  Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19730the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19731@code{run} command in this scenario).  Note that the conditions under which
19732@code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19733(@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}).  The
19734@option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19735
19736@item The @code{run} command
19737@strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19738supported.  Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19739the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data.  The
19740remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19741@kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19742
19743@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19744supported.  The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19745@code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19746the program to run.  Command line arguments are supported, except for
19747wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19748
19749If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19750@code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19751resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19752@code{target remote} mode.
19753
19754@anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19755@item Attaching
19756@strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19757not supported.  To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19758must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19759
19760@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19761you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19762established.  If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19763@code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19764(@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19765
19766@end table
19767
19768@anchor{Host and target files}
19769@subsection Host and Target Files
19770@cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19771@cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19772
19773@value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19774information for your program running on the target.  This requires
19775access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19776symbol files.  Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19777remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19778
19779Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19780@pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19781the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}.  With such a
19782target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19783@code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19784
19785If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19786program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19787unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19788@code{file} command.  Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19789the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19790the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).  Alternatively, you
19791may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19792target libraries.
19793
19794The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19795and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19796system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19797are.  Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19798during debugging.  On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19799files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19800programs.
19801
19802@subsection Remote Connection Commands
19803@cindex remote connection commands
19804@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19805over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}.  In
19806each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19807program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies.  The
19808@code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19809establish a connection to the target.  Both commands accept the same
19810arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19811
19812@table @code
19813
19814@item target remote @var{serial-device}
19815@itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19816@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19817Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target.  For example,
19818to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19819
19820@smallexample
19821target remote /dev/ttyb
19822@end smallexample
19823
19824If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19825@samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19826(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19827@code{target} command.
19828
19829@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19830@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19831@itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19832@itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19833@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19834Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19835The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19836address; @var{port} must be a decimal number.  The @var{host} could be
19837the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19838it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19839target.
19840
19841For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19842@code{manyfarms}:
19843
19844@smallexample
19845target remote manyfarms:2828
19846@end smallexample
19847
19848If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19849debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19850same host), you can omit the hostname.  For example, to connect to
19851port 1234 on your local machine:
19852
19853@smallexample
19854target remote :1234
19855@end smallexample
19856@noindent
19857
19858Note that the colon is still required here.
19859
19860@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19861@itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19862@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19863Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}.  For example, to
19864connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19865
19866@smallexample
19867target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19868@end smallexample
19869
19870When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19871keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''.  @acronym{UDP}
19872can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19873cause havoc with your debugging session.
19874
19875@item target remote | @var{command}
19876@itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19877@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19878Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19879pipe.  The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19880by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19881protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19882standard output.  You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19883that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19884using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19885
19886If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19887@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal.  (If the
19888program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19889
19890@end table
19891
19892@cindex interrupting remote programs
19893@cindex remote programs, interrupting
19894Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19895interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19896program.  This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19897and the serial drivers the remote system uses.  If you type the
19898interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19899
19900@smallexample
19901Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19902Give up (and stop debugging it)?  (y or n)
19903@end smallexample
19904
19905In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19906the remote debugging session.  (If you decide you want to try again later,
19907you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.)  If you type
19908@kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19909
19910In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19911@value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19912
19913@table @code
19914@kindex detach (remote)
19915@item detach
19916When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19917@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19918Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19919will depend on your particular remote stub.  After the @code{detach}
19920command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19921another target.  In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19922still connected to the target.
19923
19924@kindex disconnect
19925@item disconnect
19926The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19927the target is generally not resumed.  It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19928(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging.  After
19929the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19930another target.
19931
19932@cindex send command to remote monitor
19933@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19934@cindex add new commands for external monitor
19935@kindex monitor
19936@item monitor @var{cmd}
19937This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19938remote monitor.  Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19939sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19940can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19941and implement.
19942@end table
19943
19944@node File Transfer
19945@section Sending files to a remote system
19946@cindex remote target, file transfer
19947@cindex file transfer
19948@cindex sending files to remote systems
19949
19950Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19951connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}.  This is convenient
19952for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19953running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface.  For other targets,
19954e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19955the only way to upload or download files.
19956
19957Not all remote targets support these commands.
19958
19959@table @code
19960@kindex remote put
19961@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19962Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19963@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19964
19965@kindex remote get
19966@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19967Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19968on the host system.
19969
19970@kindex remote delete
19971@item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19972Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19973
19974@end table
19975
19976@node Server
19977@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19978
19979@kindex gdbserver
19980@cindex remote connection without stubs
19981@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19982allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19983@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19984linking in the usual debugging stub.
19985
19986@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19987because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19988that @value{GDBN} itself does.  In fact, a system that can run
19989@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19990@value{GDBN} locally!  @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19991because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself.  It is
19992also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19993started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19994Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19995the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19996do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19997by cross-compiling.  You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19998choice for debugging.
19999
20000@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20001or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20002protocol.
20003
20004@quotation
20005@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20006Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20007@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20008target system with the same privileges as the user running
20009@code{gdbserver}.
20010@end quotation
20011
20012@anchor{Running gdbserver}
20013@subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20014@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20015@cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20016
20017Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system.  You need a copy of the
20018program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20019@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20020strip the program if necessary to save space.  @value{GDBN} on the host
20021system does all the symbol handling.
20022
20023To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20024the name of your program; and the arguments for your program.  The usual
20025syntax is:
20026
20027@smallexample
20028target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20029@end smallexample
20030
20031@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20032hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20033stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20034For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20035@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20036@file{/dev/com1}:
20037
20038@smallexample
20039target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20040@end smallexample
20041
20042@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20043with it.
20044
20045To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20046
20047@smallexample
20048target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20049@end smallexample
20050
20051The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20052specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20053TCP.  The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20054expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20055(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.)  You can choose any number
20056you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20057TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20058reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20059conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20060and exits.}  You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20061@code{target remote} command.
20062
20063The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20064with ssh:
20065
20066@smallexample
20067(gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20068@end smallexample
20069
20070The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20071and we don't want escape-character handling.  Ssh does this by default when
20072a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20073You could elide it if you want to.
20074
20075Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20076@code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20077display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20078Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20079
20080@anchor{Attaching to a program}
20081@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20082@cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20083@cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20084
20085On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20086This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument.  The syntax is:
20087
20088@smallexample
20089target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20090@end smallexample
20091
20092@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.  It isn't
20093necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20094
20095In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20096@value{GDBN} attach command
20097(@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20098
20099@pindex pidof
20100You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20101@code{pidof} utility:
20102
20103@smallexample
20104target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20105@end smallexample
20106
20107In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20108has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20109@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20110
20111@subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20112
20113This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20114port.
20115
20116@code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20117terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode.  On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20118extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20119@value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20120which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20121mode.  Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20122cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20123stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20124
20125When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20126Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}.  For
20127completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20128
20129@cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20130By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20131subsequent connections are possible.  However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20132with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20133connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.  This
20134means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20135first one.  It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20136connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20137connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode.  The
20138@option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20139multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20140instance closes its port after the first connection.
20141
20142@anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20143@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20144
20145You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20146specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to.  Then you can
20147attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20148program.  For more information,
20149@pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20150
20151@cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20152The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20153status information about the debugging process.
20154@cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20155The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20156remote protocol debug output.  These options are intended for
20157@code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20158
20159@cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20160The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20161@code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20162Possible options are:
20163
20164@table @code
20165@item none
20166Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20167@item all
20168Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20169@item timestamps
20170Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20171@end table
20172
20173Options are processed in order.  Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20174appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20175
20176@cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20177The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20178for debugging.  The option should be followed by the name of the
20179wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20180@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20181
20182@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20183command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20184program to debug, then any arguments to the program.  The wrapper
20185runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20186
20187You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20188its arguments as a wrapper.  Several standard Unix utilities do
20189this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}.  Any Unix shell script ending
20190with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20191
20192For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20193the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20194environment:
20195
20196@smallexample
20197$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20198@end smallexample
20199
20200@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20201
20202The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20203@itemize
20204
20205@item
20206Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20207
20208@item
20209Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20210(@pxref{Host and target files}).
20211Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20212connect.  Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20213@value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20214@code{--with-sysroot}).
20215
20216@item
20217Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20218For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20219the @code{target} command.  Otherwise you may get an error whose
20220text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20221@samp{Connection refused}.  Don't use the @code{load}
20222command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20223program is already on the target.
20224
20225@end itemize
20226
20227@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20228@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20229@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20230
20231During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20232@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20233Here are the available commands.
20234
20235@table @code
20236@item monitor help
20237List the available monitor commands.
20238
20239@item monitor set debug 0
20240@itemx monitor set debug 1
20241Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20242
20243@item monitor set remote-debug 0
20244@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20245Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20246protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20247
20248@item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20249Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20250Possible options are:
20251
20252@table @code
20253@item none
20254Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20255@item all
20256Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20257@item timestamps
20258Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20259@end table
20260
20261Options are processed in order.  Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20262appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20263
20264@item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20265@cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20266When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20267directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20268libthread-db-search-path}).  If you omit @var{path},
20269@samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20270
20271The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20272not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20273
20274@item monitor exit
20275Tell gdbserver to exit immediately.  This command should be followed by
20276@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session.  @code{gdbserver} will
20277detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20278Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20279of a multi-process mode debug session.
20280
20281@end table
20282
20283@subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20284@cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20285
20286On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20287tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20288
20289For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20290@dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20291This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20292@code{gdbserver}.  In addition, support for static tracepoints
20293requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20294support.  At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20295@url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported.  This support
20296is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20297standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20298@code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20299to point at such headers.  You can explicitly disable the support
20300using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20301
20302There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20303
20304@table @code
20305@item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20306
20307You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20308library.  On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20309@code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20310
20311@item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20312
20313You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20314your system's support for preloading shared libraries.  Many Unixes
20315support the concept of preloading user defined libraries.  In most
20316cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20317in the environment.  See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20318@option{--wrapper} command line option.
20319
20320@item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20321
20322On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20323by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20324of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library.  On most Unix
20325systems, the function is @code{dlopen}.  You'll use the @code{call}
20326command for that.  For example:
20327
20328@smallexample
20329(@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20330@end smallexample
20331
20332Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20333available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20334@end table
20335
20336On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20337systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20338remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20339loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20340program's address space yet, including the in-process agent.  In that
20341case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20342features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20343libraries.  The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20344main procedure.  E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20345@code{gdbserver} like so:
20346
20347@smallexample
20348$ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20349@end smallexample
20350
20351Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20352
20353@smallexample
20354$ gdb myprogram
20355(@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
203560x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20357(@value{GDBP}) b main
20358(@value{GDBP}) continue
20359@end smallexample
20360
20361The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20362process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20363command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20364process.  You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20365tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20366tracing.
20367
20368@node Remote Configuration
20369@section Remote Configuration
20370
20371@kindex set remote
20372@kindex show remote
20373This section documents the configuration options available when
20374debugging remote programs.  For the options related to the File I/O
20375extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20376system-call-allowed}.
20377
20378@table @code
20379@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20380@cindex address size for remote targets
20381@cindex bits in remote address
20382Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20383number of bits.  @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20384that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target.  The
20385default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20386
20387@item show remoteaddresssize
20388Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20389
20390@item set serial baud @var{n}
20391@cindex baud rate for remote targets
20392Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud.  The
20393value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20394remote targets.
20395
20396@item show serial baud
20397Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20398
20399@item set serial parity @var{parity}
20400Set the parity for the remote serial I/O.  Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20401@code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}.  The default is @code{none}.
20402
20403@item show serial parity
20404Show the current parity of the serial port.
20405
20406@item set remotebreak
20407@cindex interrupt remote programs
20408@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20409@anchor{set remotebreak}
20410If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20411when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20412on the remote.  If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20413character instead.  The default is off, since most remote systems
20414expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20415
20416@item show remotebreak
20417Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20418interrupt the remote program.
20419
20420@item set remoteflow on
20421@itemx set remoteflow off
20422@kindex set remoteflow
20423Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20424on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20425
20426@item show remoteflow
20427@kindex show remoteflow
20428Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20429
20430@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20431Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20432communications to @var{base}.  Supported values of @var{base} are:
20433@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}.  The default is
20434@code{ascii}.
20435
20436@item show remotelogbase
20437Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20438protocol.
20439
20440@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20441@cindex record serial communications on file
20442Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}.  The
20443default is not to record at all.
20444
20445@item show remotelogfile.
20446Show the current setting  of the file name on which to record the
20447serial communications.
20448
20449@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20450@cindex timeout for serial communications
20451@cindex remote timeout
20452Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20453@var{num} seconds.  The default is 2 seconds.
20454
20455@item show remotetimeout
20456Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20457responses.
20458
20459@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20460@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20461@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20462@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20463@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20464@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20465Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20466watchpoints.  A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20467
20468@cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20469@cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20470@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20471@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20472Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20473a remote hardware watchpoint.  A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20474as unlimited.
20475
20476@item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20477Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20478a remote hardware watchpoint.
20479
20480@item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20481@itemx show remote exec-file
20482@anchor{set remote exec-file}
20483@cindex executable file, for remote target
20484Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20485extended-remote}.  This should be set to a filename valid on the
20486target system.  If it is not set, the target will use a default
20487filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20488
20489@item set remote interrupt-sequence
20490@cindex interrupt remote programs
20491@cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20492Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20493@samp{BREAK-g} as the
20494sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20495@samp{Ctrl-C} is a default.  Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20496is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20497Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20498It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20499
20500@item show interrupt-sequence
20501Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20502is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20503@code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20504also known as Magic SysRq g.
20505
20506@item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20507@cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20508Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20509@value{GDBN} connects to it.  This is mostly needed when you debug
20510Linux kernel.  Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20511which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20512
20513@item show interrupt-on-connect
20514Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20515to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20516
20517@kindex set tcp
20518@kindex show tcp
20519@item set tcp auto-retry on
20520@cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20521Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections.  This is useful if the remote
20522debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20523condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20524before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect.  When auto-retry is
20525enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20526to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20527@code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20528
20529@item set tcp auto-retry off
20530Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20531
20532@item show tcp auto-retry
20533Show the current auto-retry setting.
20534
20535@item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20536@itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20537@cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20538@cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20539Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20540@var{seconds}.  The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20541(enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20542that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20543value.  If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20544@value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20545unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}.  The default is 15 seconds.
20546
20547@item show tcp connect-timeout
20548Show the current connection timeout setting.
20549@end table
20550
20551@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20552The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20553your debugging stub.  If you need to override the autodetection, you
20554can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets.  Each
20555packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20556packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20557or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet).  They
20558all default to @samp{auto}.  For more information about each packet,
20559see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20560
20561During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20562If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20563in @value{GDBN}.  You may want to report the problem to the
20564@value{GDBN} developers.
20565
20566For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20567packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}.  The available settings
20568are:
20569
20570@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20571@item Command Name
20572@tab Remote Packet
20573@tab Related Features
20574
20575@item @code{fetch-register}
20576@tab @code{p}
20577@tab @code{info registers}
20578
20579@item @code{set-register}
20580@tab @code{P}
20581@tab @code{set}
20582
20583@item @code{binary-download}
20584@tab @code{X}
20585@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20586
20587@item @code{read-aux-vector}
20588@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20589@tab @code{info auxv}
20590
20591@item @code{symbol-lookup}
20592@tab @code{qSymbol}
20593@tab Detecting multiple threads
20594
20595@item @code{attach}
20596@tab @code{vAttach}
20597@tab @code{attach}
20598
20599@item @code{verbose-resume}
20600@tab @code{vCont}
20601@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20602
20603@item @code{run}
20604@tab @code{vRun}
20605@tab @code{run}
20606
20607@item @code{software-breakpoint}
20608@tab @code{Z0}
20609@tab @code{break}
20610
20611@item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20612@tab @code{Z1}
20613@tab @code{hbreak}
20614
20615@item @code{write-watchpoint}
20616@tab @code{Z2}
20617@tab @code{watch}
20618
20619@item @code{read-watchpoint}
20620@tab @code{Z3}
20621@tab @code{rwatch}
20622
20623@item @code{access-watchpoint}
20624@tab @code{Z4}
20625@tab @code{awatch}
20626
20627@item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20628@tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20629@tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20630
20631@item @code{target-features}
20632@tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20633@tab @code{set architecture}
20634
20635@item @code{library-info}
20636@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20637@tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20638
20639@item @code{memory-map}
20640@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20641@tab @code{info mem}
20642
20643@item @code{read-sdata-object}
20644@tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20645@tab @code{print $_sdata}
20646
20647@item @code{read-spu-object}
20648@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20649@tab @code{info spu}
20650
20651@item @code{write-spu-object}
20652@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20653@tab @code{info spu}
20654
20655@item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20656@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20657@tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20658
20659@item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20660@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20661@tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20662
20663@item @code{threads}
20664@tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20665@tab @code{info threads}
20666
20667@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20668@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20669@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20670
20671@item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20672@tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20673@tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20674
20675@item @code{search-memory}
20676@tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20677@tab @code{find}
20678
20679@item @code{supported-packets}
20680@tab @code{qSupported}
20681@tab Remote communications parameters
20682
20683@item @code{catch-syscalls}
20684@tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20685@tab @code{catch syscall}
20686
20687@item @code{pass-signals}
20688@tab @code{QPassSignals}
20689@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20690
20691@item @code{program-signals}
20692@tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20693@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20694
20695@item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20696@tab @code{vFile:close}
20697@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20698
20699@item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20700@tab @code{vFile:open}
20701@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20702
20703@item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20704@tab @code{vFile:pread}
20705@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20706
20707@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20708@tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20709@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20710
20711@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20712@tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20713@tab @code{remote delete}
20714
20715@item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20716@tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20717@tab Host I/O
20718
20719@item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20720@tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20721@tab Host I/O
20722
20723@item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20724@tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20725@tab Host I/O
20726
20727@item @code{noack-packet}
20728@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20729@tab Packet acknowledgment
20730
20731@item @code{osdata}
20732@tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20733@tab @code{info os}
20734
20735@item @code{query-attached}
20736@tab @code{qAttached}
20737@tab Querying remote process attach state.
20738
20739@item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20740@tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20741@tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20742
20743@item @code{trace-status}
20744@tab @code{qTStatus}
20745@tab @code{tstatus}
20746
20747@item @code{traceframe-info}
20748@tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20749@tab Traceframe info
20750
20751@item @code{install-in-trace}
20752@tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20753@tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20754
20755@item @code{disable-randomization}
20756@tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20757@tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20758
20759@item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20760@tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20761@tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20762
20763@item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20764@tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20765@tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20766
20767@item @code{swbreak-feature}
20768@tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20769@tab @code{break}
20770
20771@item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20772@tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20773@tab @code{hbreak}
20774
20775@item @code{fork-event-feature}
20776@tab @code{fork stop reason}
20777@tab @code{fork}
20778
20779@item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20780@tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20781@tab @code{vfork}
20782
20783@item @code{exec-event-feature}
20784@tab @code{exec stop reason}
20785@tab @code{exec}
20786
20787@item @code{thread-events}
20788@tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20789@tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20790
20791@item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20792@tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20793@tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20794
20795@end multitable
20796
20797@node Remote Stub
20798@section Implementing a Remote Stub
20799
20800@cindex debugging stub, example
20801@cindex remote stub, example
20802@cindex stub example, remote debugging
20803The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20804communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20805@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}.  Normally, you can simply allow
20806these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details.  (If you're
20807implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20808with one of the existing stub files.  @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20809organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20810
20811@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20812To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20813@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20814prerequisites for the program to run by itself.  For example, for a C
20815program, you need:
20816
20817@enumerate
20818@item
20819A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20820have a name like @file{crt0}.  The startup routine may be supplied by
20821your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20822
20823@item
20824A C subroutine library to support your program's
20825subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20826
20827@item
20828A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20829download program.  These are often supplied by the hardware
20830manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20831documentation.
20832@end enumerate
20833
20834The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20835communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20836machine).  In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20837
20838@table @emph
20839@item On the host,
20840@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20841else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20842(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20843
20844@item On the target,
20845you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20846implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.  The file containing these
20847subroutines is called  a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20848
20849On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20850@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20851@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20852@end table
20853
20854The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20855machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20856@sc{sparc} boards.
20857
20858@cindex remote serial stub list
20859These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20860
20861@table @code
20862
20863@item i386-stub.c
20864@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20865@cindex Intel
20866@cindex i386
20867For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20868
20869@item m68k-stub.c
20870@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20871@cindex Motorola 680x0
20872@cindex m680x0
20873For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20874
20875@item sh-stub.c
20876@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20877@cindex Renesas
20878@cindex SH
20879For Renesas SH architectures.
20880
20881@item sparc-stub.c
20882@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20883@cindex Sparc
20884For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20885
20886@item sparcl-stub.c
20887@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20888@cindex Fujitsu
20889@cindex SparcLite
20890For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20891
20892@end table
20893
20894The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20895recently added stubs.
20896
20897@menu
20898* Stub Contents::       What the stub can do for you
20899* Bootstrapping::       What you must do for the stub
20900* Debug Session::       Putting it all together
20901@end menu
20902
20903@node Stub Contents
20904@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20905
20906@cindex remote serial stub
20907The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20908subroutines:
20909
20910@table @code
20911@item set_debug_traps
20912@findex set_debug_traps
20913@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20914This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20915program stops.  You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20916program's startup code.
20917
20918@item handle_exception
20919@findex handle_exception
20920@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20921This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20922explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20923run when a trap is triggered.
20924
20925@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20926execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20927with @value{GDBN} on the host machine.  This is where the communications
20928protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20929representative on the target machine.  It begins by sending summary
20930information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20931retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20932execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20933@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20934machine.
20935
20936@item breakpoint
20937@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20938Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20939breakpoint.  Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20940way for @value{GDBN} to get control.  For instance, if your target
20941machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20942pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20943@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}.  On some machines,
20944simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20945again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20946your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20947@value{GDBN} session gets control.
20948
20949Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20950to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20951start of your debugging session.
20952@end table
20953
20954@node Bootstrapping
20955@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20956
20957@cindex remote stub, support routines
20958The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20959chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20960debugging target machine.
20961
20962First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20963serial port.
20964
20965@table @code
20966@item int getDebugChar()
20967@findex getDebugChar
20968Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20969It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20970different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20971
20972@item void putDebugChar(int)
20973@findex putDebugChar
20974Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20975It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20976different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20977@end table
20978
20979@cindex control C, and remote debugging
20980@cindex interrupting remote targets
20981If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20982running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20983for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20984character).  That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20985remote system to stop.
20986
20987Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20988probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20989is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20990@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20991
20992Other routines you need to supply are:
20993
20994@table @code
20995@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20996@findex exceptionHandler
20997Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20998handling tables.  You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20999way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21000are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21001containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21002The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21003its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21004might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc).  When this
21005exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21006@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21007and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs.  So if
21008you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21009should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21010
21011For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21012gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs.  The gate
21013should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level).  The
21014@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21015help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21016
21017@item void flush_i_cache()
21018@findex flush_i_cache
21019On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21020instruction cache, if any, on your target machine.  If there is no
21021instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21022
21023On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21024function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21025@end table
21026
21027@noindent
21028You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21029
21030@table @code
21031@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21032@findex memset
21033This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21034memory to a known value.  If you have one of the free versions of
21035@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21036either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21037@end table
21038
21039If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21040library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21041but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21042subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21043
21044
21045@node Debug Session
21046@subsection Putting it All Together
21047
21048@cindex remote serial debugging summary
21049In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21050steps.
21051
21052@enumerate
21053@item
21054Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21055(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21056@display
21057@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21058@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21059@end display
21060
21061@item
21062Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21063procedure is called:
21064
21065@smallexample
21066set_debug_traps();
21067breakpoint();
21068@end smallexample
21069
21070On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21071automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21072breakpoint.  If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21073@code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21074after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21075doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21076progress.
21077
21078@item
21079For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21080@code{exceptionHook}.  Normally you just use:
21081
21082@smallexample
21083void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21084@end smallexample
21085
21086@noindent
21087but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21088function in your program, that function is called when
21089@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21090error).  The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21091one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21092
21093@item
21094Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21095your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21096
21097@item
21098Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21099the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21100
21101@item
21102@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21103@c document that.  FIXME.
21104Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21105whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21106
21107@item
21108Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21109(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21110
21111@end enumerate
21112
21113@node Configurations
21114@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21115
21116While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21117cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions.  This chapter
21118describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21119
21120There are three major categories of configurations: native
21121configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21122operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21123different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21124are quite different from each other.
21125
21126@menu
21127* Native::
21128* Embedded OS::
21129* Embedded Processors::
21130* Architectures::
21131@end menu
21132
21133@node Native
21134@section Native
21135
21136This section describes details specific to particular native
21137configurations.
21138
21139@menu
21140* BSD libkvm Interface::	Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21141* SVR4 Process Information::    SVR4 process information
21142* DJGPP Native::                Features specific to the DJGPP port
21143* Cygwin Native::		Features specific to the Cygwin port
21144* Hurd Native::                 Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21145* Darwin::			Features specific to Darwin
21146@end menu
21147
21148@node BSD libkvm Interface
21149@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21150
21151@cindex libkvm
21152@cindex kernel memory image
21153@cindex kernel crash dump
21154
21155BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21156interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21157memory images, including live systems and crash dumps.  @value{GDBN}
21158uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21159dumps on many native BSD configurations.  This is implemented as a
21160special @code{kvm} debugging target.  For debugging a live system, load
21161the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21162@code{kvm} target:
21163
21164@smallexample
21165(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21166@end smallexample
21167
21168For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21169argument:
21170
21171@smallexample
21172(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21173@end smallexample
21174
21175Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21176available:
21177
21178@table @code
21179@kindex kvm
21180@item kvm pcb
21181Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21182
21183@item kvm proc
21184Set current context from proc address.  This command isn't available on
21185modern FreeBSD systems.
21186@end table
21187
21188@node SVR4 Process Information
21189@subsection SVR4 Process Information
21190@cindex /proc
21191@cindex examine process image
21192@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21193
21194Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
21195@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
21196process using file-system subroutines.
21197
21198If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
21199facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
21200information about the process running your program, or about any
21201process running on your system.  This includes, as of this writing,
21202@sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
21203
21204This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
21205that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
21206
21207@table @code
21208@kindex info proc
21209@cindex process ID
21210@item info proc
21211@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21212Summarize available information about any running process.  If a
21213process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21214that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21215debugged.  The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21216line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21217executable file's absolute file name.
21218
21219On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21220@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21221within a process.  If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21222a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21223needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21224a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21225
21226@item info proc cmdline
21227@cindex info proc cmdline
21228Show the original command line of the process.  This command is
21229specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21230
21231@item info proc cwd
21232@cindex info proc cwd
21233Show the current working directory of the process.  This command is
21234specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21235
21236@item info proc exe
21237@cindex info proc exe
21238Show the name of executable of the process.  This command is specific
21239to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
21240
21241@item info proc mappings
21242@cindex memory address space mappings
21243Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
21244information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
21245rights to each range.  On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
21246includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
21247memory access rights to that range.
21248
21249@item info proc stat
21250@itemx info proc status
21251@cindex process detailed status information
21252These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems.  They show
21253the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
21254how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
21255the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
21256consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
21257value; etc.  For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
21258(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21259
21260@item info proc all
21261Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21262above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21263
21264@ignore
21265@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21266@comment procfs.c was re-written.  Keep their descriptions around
21267@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21268@kindex info proc times
21269@item info proc times
21270Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21271its children.
21272
21273@kindex info proc id
21274@item info proc id
21275Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21276the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21277@end ignore
21278
21279@item set procfs-trace
21280@kindex set procfs-trace
21281@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21282This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21283
21284@item show procfs-trace
21285@kindex show procfs-trace
21286Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21287
21288@item set procfs-file @var{file}
21289@kindex set procfs-file
21290Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21291@var{file}.  @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21292contents of the file.  The default is to display the trace on the
21293standard output.
21294
21295@item show procfs-file
21296@kindex show procfs-file
21297Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21298
21299@item proc-trace-entry
21300@itemx proc-trace-exit
21301@itemx proc-untrace-entry
21302@itemx proc-untrace-exit
21303@kindex proc-trace-entry
21304@kindex proc-trace-exit
21305@kindex proc-untrace-entry
21306@kindex proc-untrace-exit
21307These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21308from the @code{syscall} interface.
21309
21310@item info pidlist
21311@kindex info pidlist
21312@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21313For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21314processes and all the threads within each process.
21315
21316@item info meminfo
21317@kindex info meminfo
21318@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21319For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21320@end table
21321
21322@node DJGPP Native
21323@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21324@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21325@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21326@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21327
21328@cindex DPMI
21329@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21330MS-Windows.  @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21331that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21332top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21333
21334@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21335defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port.  This
21336subsection describes those commands.
21337
21338@table @code
21339@kindex info dos
21340@item info dos
21341This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21342information about the target system and important OS structures.
21343
21344@kindex sysinfo
21345@cindex MS-DOS system info
21346@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21347@item info dos sysinfo
21348This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21349platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21350DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21351
21352@cindex GDT
21353@cindex LDT
21354@cindex IDT
21355@cindex segment descriptor tables
21356@cindex descriptor tables display
21357@item info dos gdt
21358@itemx info dos ldt
21359@itemx info dos idt
21360These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21361and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT).  The descriptor
21362tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21363that is currently in use.  The segment's selector is an index into a
21364descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21365descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21366rights.
21367
21368A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21369segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21370allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21371conventional memory).  However, the DPMI host will usually define
21372additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21373
21374@cindex garbled pointers
21375These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21376Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21377displayed.  An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21378display a single entry whose index is given by the argument.  For
21379example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21380debugged program's data segment:
21381
21382@smallexample
21383@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21384@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21385@end smallexample
21386
21387@noindent
21388This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21389the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21390
21391@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21392@item info dos pde
21393@itemx info dos pte
21394These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21395Directory and the Page Tables.  Page Directories and Page Tables are
21396data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
21397into physical addresses.  A Page Table includes an entry for every
21398page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
21399may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries.  A
21400Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
21401that is currently in use.
21402
21403Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
21404Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
21405the Page Tables.  An argument, an integer expression, given to the
21406@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
21407Directory table.  An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
21408means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
21409the specified entry in the Page Directory.
21410
21411@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
21412These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
21413Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
21414controller.
21415
21416These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
21417
21418@cindex physical address from linear address
21419@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21420This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21421address.  The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21422already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21423because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21424segment.  For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21425the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21426
21427@smallexample
21428@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21429@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21430@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21431@end smallexample
21432
21433@noindent
21434This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21435whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21436attributes of that page.
21437
21438Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21439since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21440address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21441be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21442declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21443@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21444
21445Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21446transfer buffer:
21447
21448@smallexample
21449@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21450@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21451@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21452@end smallexample
21453
21454@noindent
21455(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
214563rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.)  The output
21457clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21458memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21459linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21460
21461This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21462@end table
21463
21464@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21465In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21466debugging via a serial data link.  The following commands are specific
21467to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21468
21469@table @code
21470@kindex set com1base
21471@kindex set com1irq
21472@kindex set com2base
21473@kindex set com2irq
21474@kindex set com3base
21475@kindex set com3irq
21476@kindex set com4base
21477@kindex set com4irq
21478@item set com1base @var{addr}
21479This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21480port.
21481
21482@item set com1irq @var{irq}
21483This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21484for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21485
21486There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21487etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21488other 3 COM ports.
21489
21490@kindex show com1base
21491@kindex show com1irq
21492@kindex show com2base
21493@kindex show com2irq
21494@kindex show com3base
21495@kindex show com3irq
21496@kindex show com4base
21497@kindex show com4irq
21498The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21499display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21500lines used by the COM ports.
21501
21502@item info serial
21503@kindex info serial
21504@cindex DOS serial port status
21505This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports.  For each
21506port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21507IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21508counts of various errors encountered so far.
21509@end table
21510
21511
21512@node Cygwin Native
21513@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21514@cindex MS Windows debugging
21515@cindex native Cygwin debugging
21516@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21517
21518@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21519DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21520
21521@cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21522@cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21523MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21524special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21525by typing @kbd{C-c}.  For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21526supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21527sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21528ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21529
21530There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21531this section.  Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21532described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21533
21534@table @code
21535@kindex info w32
21536@item info w32
21537This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21538information about the target system and important OS structures.
21539
21540@item info w32 selector
21541This command displays information returned by
21542the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21543It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21544a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21545Without argument, this command displays information
21546about the six segment registers.
21547
21548@item info w32 thread-information-block
21549This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21550Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21551selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21552
21553@kindex signal-event
21554@item signal-event @var{id}
21555This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}.  Used to resume
21556crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
21557
21558To use it, create or edit the following keys in
21559@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
21560@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
21561(for x86_64 versions):
21562
21563@itemize @minus
21564@item
21565@code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
21566Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
21567"attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
21568
21569The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
21570crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
21571the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
21572to attach.
21573
21574@item
21575@code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}.  @code{1} will
21576make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
21577automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
21578``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
21579terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
21580@end itemize
21581
21582@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21583@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21584@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21585@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21586If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21587happen inside the Cygwin DLL.  If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21588@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21589exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21590``bookkeeping''.  This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21591Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21592@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21593
21594@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21595@item show cygwin-exceptions
21596Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21597inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21598
21599@kindex set new-console
21600@item set new-console @var{mode}
21601If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21602be started in a new console on next start.
21603If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21604be started in the same console as the debugger.
21605
21606@kindex show new-console
21607@item show new-console
21608Displays whether a new console is used
21609when the debuggee is started.
21610
21611@kindex set new-group
21612@item set new-group @var{mode}
21613This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21614start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21615This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21616@samp{Ctrl-C}.
21617
21618@kindex show new-group
21619@item show new-group
21620Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21621
21622@kindex set debugevents
21623@item set debugevents
21624This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21625to the debuggee seen by the debugger.  This includes events that
21626signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21627unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21628Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21629
21630@kindex set debugexec
21631@item set debugexec
21632This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21633(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21634
21635@kindex set debugexceptions
21636@item set debugexceptions
21637This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21638debuggee seen by the debugger.
21639
21640@kindex set debugmemory
21641@item set debugmemory
21642This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21643and writes by the debugger.
21644
21645@kindex set shell
21646@item set shell
21647This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21648via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21649
21650@kindex show shell
21651@item show shell
21652Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21653
21654@end table
21655
21656@menu
21657* Non-debug DLL Symbols::  Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21658@end menu
21659
21660@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21661@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21662@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21663@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21664
21665Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21666not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21667@file{kernel32.dll}).  When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21668symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21669information contained in the DLL's export table.  This section
21670describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21671``minimal symbols''.
21672
21673Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21674will have been loaded.  The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21675start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21676program run once to completion.
21677
21678@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21679
21680In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21681tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21682DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}.  The plain name is
21683also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21684sufficient.  In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21685(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21686necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21687contents of the DLL.  Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21688exclamation mark (``!'')  being interpreted as a language operator.
21689
21690Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21691though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa.  Since
21692symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21693some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21694@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21695(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21696
21697@smallexample
21698(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21699All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21700
21701Non-debugging symbols:
217020x77e885f4  CreateFileA
217030x77e885f4  KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21704@end smallexample
21705
21706@smallexample
21707(@value{GDBP}) info function !
21708All functions matching regular expression "!":
21709
21710Non-debugging symbols:
217110x6100114c  cygwin1!__assert
217120x61004034  cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
217130x61004240  cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21714[etc...]
21715@end smallexample
21716
21717@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21718
21719Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21720type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21721refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21722contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21723contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21724means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21725a function within a DLL without a running program.
21726
21727Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21728automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21729variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21730type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21731problem:
21732
21733@smallexample
21734(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21735$1 = 268572168
21736@end smallexample
21737
21738@smallexample
21739(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
217400x10021610:      "\230y\""
21741@end smallexample
21742
21743And two possible solutions:
21744
21745@smallexample
21746(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21747$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21748@end smallexample
21749
21750@smallexample
21751(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
217520x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>:    0x10021608      0x00000000
21753(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
217540x10021608:     0x0022fd98
21755(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
217560x22fd98:        "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21757@end smallexample
21758
21759Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21760starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21761examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21762function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21763to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21764
21765@smallexample
21766(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21767Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21768@end smallexample
21769
21770The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21771break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21772safe.
21773
21774@node Hurd Native
21775@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21776@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21777
21778This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21779@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21780
21781@table @code
21782@item set signals
21783@itemx set sigs
21784@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21785@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21786This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21787@value{GDBN}.  Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21788affected by this command.  @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21789@code{signals}.
21790
21791@item show signals
21792@itemx show sigs
21793@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21794@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21795Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21796
21797@item set signal-thread
21798@itemx set sigthread
21799@kindex set signal-thread
21800@kindex set sigthread
21801This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21802thread.  That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21803process.  @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21804signal-thread}.
21805
21806@item show signal-thread
21807@itemx show sigthread
21808@kindex show signal-thread
21809@kindex show sigthread
21810These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21811delivered a signal.
21812
21813@item set stopped
21814@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21815This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21816as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal.  The stopped process can be
21817continued by delivering a signal to it.
21818
21819@item show stopped
21820@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21821This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21822stopped.
21823
21824@item set exceptions
21825@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21826Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21827When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21828single-stepping will work.  To restore the default, set exception
21829trapping on.
21830
21831@item show exceptions
21832@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21833Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21834
21835@item set task pause
21836@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21837@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21838@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21839This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21840Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21841whenever @value{GDBN} gets control.  Setting it to off will take
21842effect the next time the inferior is continued.  If this option is set
21843to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21844thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21845
21846@item show task pause
21847@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21848Show the current state of task suspension.
21849
21850@item set task detach-suspend-count
21851@cindex task suspend count
21852@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21853This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21854@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21855
21856@item show task detach-suspend-count
21857Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21858
21859@item set task exception-port
21860@itemx set task excp
21861@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21862This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21863forward exceptions.  The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21864rights} of the task.  @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21865
21866@item set noninvasive
21867@cindex noninvasive task options
21868This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21869invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned.  This
21870is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21871@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21872
21873@item info send-rights
21874@itemx info receive-rights
21875@itemx info port-rights
21876@itemx info port-sets
21877@itemx info dead-names
21878@itemx info ports
21879@itemx info psets
21880@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21881@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21882@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21883@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21884@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21885These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21886receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21887There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21888port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21889
21890@item set thread pause
21891@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21892@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21893@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21894This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21895control.  Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21896thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control.  Setting it to
21897off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21898Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21899control, the whole task is suspended.  However, if you used @code{set
21900task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21901only the current thread.
21902
21903@item show thread pause
21904@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21905This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21906
21907@item set thread run
21908This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21909
21910@item show thread run
21911Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21912
21913@item set thread detach-suspend-count
21914@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21915@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21916This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21917thread when detaching.  This number is relative to the suspend count
21918found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21919takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21920
21921@item show thread detach-suspend-count
21922Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21923detaching.
21924
21925@item set thread exception-port
21926@itemx set thread excp
21927Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions.  This
21928overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21929@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21930
21931@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21932Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21933value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread.  This command
21934changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21935
21936@item set thread default
21937@itemx show thread default
21938@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21939Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21940default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21941thread default exception-port}, etc.).  The @code{thread default}
21942variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21943threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21944the non-default commands.
21945@end table
21946
21947@node Darwin
21948@subsection Darwin
21949@cindex Darwin
21950
21951@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21952
21953@table @code
21954@item set debug darwin @var{num}
21955@kindex set debug darwin
21956When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21957the Darwin support.  Higher values produce more verbose output.
21958
21959@item show debug darwin
21960@kindex show debug darwin
21961Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21962
21963@item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21964@kindex set debug mach-o
21965When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21966@value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files.  (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21967file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.)  Higher
21968values produce more verbose output.  This is a command to diagnose
21969problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21970usage.
21971
21972@item show debug mach-o
21973@kindex show debug mach-o
21974Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21975
21976@item set mach-exceptions on
21977@itemx set mach-exceptions off
21978@kindex set mach-exceptions
21979On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21980mapped to a Posix signal.  Use this command to turn on trapping of
21981Mach exceptions in the inferior.  This might be sometimes useful to
21982better understand the cause of a fault.  The default is off.
21983
21984@item show mach-exceptions
21985@kindex show mach-exceptions
21986Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21987@end table
21988
21989
21990@node Embedded OS
21991@section Embedded Operating Systems
21992
21993This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21994embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21995architectures.
21996
21997@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21998various real-time operating systems.
21999
22000@node Embedded Processors
22001@section Embedded Processors
22002
22003This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22004configurations.
22005
22006@cindex send command to simulator
22007Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22008allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22009
22010@table @code
22011@item sim @var{command}
22012@kindex sim@r{, a command}
22013Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator.  Consult the
22014documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22015acceptable commands.
22016@end table
22017
22018
22019@menu
22020* ARM::                         ARM
22021* M68K::                        Motorola M68K
22022* MicroBlaze::			Xilinx MicroBlaze
22023* MIPS Embedded::               MIPS Embedded
22024* PowerPC Embedded::            PowerPC Embedded
22025* AVR::                         Atmel AVR
22026* CRIS::                        CRIS
22027* Super-H::                     Renesas Super-H
22028@end menu
22029
22030@node ARM
22031@subsection ARM
22032
22033@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22034
22035@table @code
22036@item set arm disassembler
22037@kindex set arm
22038This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles.  The
22039@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22040
22041@item show arm disassembler
22042@kindex show arm
22043Show the current disassembly style.
22044
22045@item set arm apcs32
22046@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22047This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22048
22049@item show arm apcs32
22050Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22051
22052@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22053This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type.  The
22054argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22055
22056@table @code
22057@item auto
22058Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22059@item softfpa
22060Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22061processors.
22062@item fpa
22063GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22064@item softvfp
22065Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22066@item vfp
22067VFP co-processor.
22068@end table
22069
22070@item show arm fpu
22071Show the current type of the FPU.
22072
22073@item set arm abi
22074This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22075
22076@item show arm abi
22077Show the currently used ABI.
22078
22079@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22080@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22081whether instructions are ARM or Thumb.  This command controls
22082@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22083available.  The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22084use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22085register).
22086
22087@item show arm fallback-mode
22088Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22089
22090@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22091This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22092instructions are ARM or Thumb.  The default is @samp{auto}, which
22093causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22094of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22095
22096@item show arm force-mode
22097Show the current forced instruction mode.
22098
22099@item set debug arm
22100Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22101target support subsystem.
22102
22103@item show debug arm
22104Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22105@end table
22106
22107@table @code
22108@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22109The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22110
22111@table @code
22112@item --swi-support=@var{type}
22113Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.  The argument
22114@var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22115The default value is @code{all}.
22116
22117@table @code
22118@item none
22119@item demon
22120@item angel
22121@item redboot
22122@item all
22123@end table
22124@end table
22125@end table
22126
22127@node M68K
22128@subsection M68k
22129
22130The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22131
22132@node MicroBlaze
22133@subsection MicroBlaze
22134@cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22135@cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22136
22137The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22138FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series.  Boards with these processors
22139usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22140Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22141This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22142the target FPGA.  The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22143communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22144presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board.  By default
22145@code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}.  (While it is possible to change
22146this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22147commands.  Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22148
22149Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22150
22151@table @code
22152@item target remote :1234
22153Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22154on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22155
22156@item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22157Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22158running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22159
22160@item load
22161Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22162
22163@item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22164Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22165
22166@item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22167Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22168@end table
22169
22170@node MIPS Embedded
22171@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22172
22173@noindent
22174@value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22175
22176@table @code
22177@item set mipsfpu double
22178@itemx set mipsfpu single
22179@itemx set mipsfpu none
22180@itemx set mipsfpu auto
22181@itemx show mipsfpu
22182@kindex set mipsfpu
22183@kindex show mipsfpu
22184@cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22185@cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22186If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22187coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22188need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22189file).  This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22190functions which return floating point values.  It also allows
22191@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22192functions on the board.  If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22193with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22194processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}.  The default
22195double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22196@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22197
22198In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22199floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22200and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22201
22202As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22203@samp{show mipsfpu}.
22204@end table
22205
22206@node PowerPC Embedded
22207@subsection PowerPC Embedded
22208
22209@cindex DVC register
22210@value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22211implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22212
22213@smallexample
22214(@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22215  if  @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22216@end smallexample
22217
22218The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22219such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22220debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22221variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte).  This feature
22222is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22223or newer.
22224
22225When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22226ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22227in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22228watching variables of scalar types.
22229
22230You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22231region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22232
22233@smallexample
22234(@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22235(@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22236@end smallexample
22237
22238PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints.  See the discussion
22239about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22240
22241@cindex ranged breakpoint
22242PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22243@dfn{ranged breakpoints}.  A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22244the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22245the range it specifies.  To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22246use the @code{break-range} command.
22247
22248@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22249
22250@table @code
22251@kindex break-range
22252@item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22253Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22254@var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22255a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22256location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22257for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22258The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22259executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22260(including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22261
22262@kindex set powerpc
22263@item set powerpc soft-float
22264@itemx show powerpc soft-float
22265Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22266convention.  By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22267on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22268
22269@item set powerpc vector-abi
22270@itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22271Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22272arguments and return values.  The valid options are @samp{auto};
22273@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22274@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22275registers.  By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22276based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22277
22278@item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22279@itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22280Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22281of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22282address of its first byte.
22283
22284@end table
22285
22286@node AVR
22287@subsection Atmel AVR
22288@cindex AVR
22289
22290When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22291following AVR-specific commands:
22292
22293@table @code
22294@item info io_registers
22295@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22296@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22297This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers.  For
22298each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22299@end table
22300
22301@node CRIS
22302@subsection CRIS
22303@cindex CRIS
22304
22305When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22306following CRIS-specific commands:
22307
22308@table @code
22309@item set cris-version @var{ver}
22310@cindex CRIS version
22311Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22312The CRIS version affects register names and sizes.  This command is useful in
22313case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22314
22315@item show cris-version
22316Show the current CRIS version.
22317
22318@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22319@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22320Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging.  The default is @samp{on}.
22321Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22322@code{R59}.
22323
22324@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22325Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22326
22327@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22328@cindex CRIS mode
22329Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}.  It should only be changed when
22330debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22331@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22332
22333@item show cris-mode
22334Show the current CRIS mode.
22335@end table
22336
22337@node Super-H
22338@subsection Renesas Super-H
22339@cindex Super-H
22340
22341For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22342commands:
22343
22344@table @code
22345@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22346@kindex set sh calling-convention
22347Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22348Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22349With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22350convention.  If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22351that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22352is called using the Renesas calling convention.  If the calling convention
22353is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22354regardless of the DWARF-2 information.  This can be used to override the
22355default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22356does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22357
22358@item show sh calling-convention
22359@kindex show sh calling-convention
22360Show the current calling convention setting.
22361
22362@end table
22363
22364
22365@node Architectures
22366@section Architectures
22367
22368This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22369all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22370
22371@menu
22372* AArch64::
22373* i386::
22374* Alpha::
22375* MIPS::
22376* HPPA::               HP PA architecture
22377* SPU::                Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22378* PowerPC::
22379* Nios II::
22380@end menu
22381
22382@node AArch64
22383@subsection AArch64
22384@cindex AArch64 support
22385
22386When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22387following special commands:
22388
22389@table @code
22390@item set debug aarch64
22391@kindex set debug aarch64
22392This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22393messages are to be displayed.
22394
22395@item show debug aarch64
22396Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22397
22398@end table
22399
22400@node i386
22401@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22402
22403@table @code
22404@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22405@kindex set struct-convention
22406@cindex struct return convention
22407@cindex struct/union returned in registers
22408Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22409@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}.  Possible values of
22410@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22411default).  @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22412are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22413@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22414be returned in a register.
22415
22416@item show struct-convention
22417@kindex show struct-convention
22418Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22419from functions.
22420@end table
22421
22422
22423@subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22424@cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22425
22426Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22427@footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22428registers.} through @samp{BND3}.  Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22429which are the lower bound and upper bound.  Bounds are effective addresses or
22430memory locations.  The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22431complement form.  A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22432(1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22433
22434@samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22435through @samp{bnd3raw}.  Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22436display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22437upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22438@value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}.  In this sense it
22439can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22440
22441As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22442access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71.  The values present on
22443bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22444
22445@smallexample
22446	bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22447	bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22448@end smallexample
22449
22450This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw.  Any
22451change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22452counterpart.  When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22453Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22454the pointer.
22455
22456Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22457application memory.  These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22458the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds.  Evaluating and changing
22459bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22460bugs on MPX context.  @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22461
22462@table @code
22463@item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22464@kindex show mpx bound
22465Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22466
22467@item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22468@kindex  set mpx bound
22469Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22470This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22471whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22472for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22473@end table
22474
22475@node Alpha
22476@subsection Alpha
22477
22478See the following section.
22479
22480@node MIPS
22481@subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22482
22483@cindex stack on Alpha
22484@cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22485@cindex Alpha stack
22486@cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22487Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22488sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22489find the beginning of a function.
22490
22491@cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22492To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22493@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22494you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22495commands:
22496
22497@table @code
22498@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22499@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22500Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22501search for the beginning of a function.  A value of @var{0} (the
22502default) means there is no limit.  However, except for @var{0}, the
22503larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22504and therefore the longer it takes to run.  You should only need to use
22505this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22506
22507@item show heuristic-fence-post
22508Display the current limit.
22509@end table
22510
22511@noindent
22512These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22513for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22514
22515Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22516programs:
22517
22518@table @code
22519@item set mips abi @var{arg}
22520@kindex set mips abi
22521@cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22522Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior.  Possible
22523values of @var{arg} are:
22524
22525@table @samp
22526@item auto
22527The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22528default).
22529@item o32
22530@item o64
22531@item n32
22532@item n64
22533@item eabi32
22534@item eabi64
22535@end table
22536
22537@item show mips abi
22538@kindex show mips abi
22539Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22540
22541@item set mips compression @var{arg}
22542@kindex set mips compression
22543@cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22544Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22545@acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22546inferior.  @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22547internal interpretation purposes.  This setting is only referred to
22548when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22549the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22550Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22551provided by the executable.
22552
22553Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22554The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22555executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22556identified as such.
22557
22558This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22559debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22560implicitly from an executable.
22561
22562The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22563identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22564@acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s.  If these function-scope annotations
22565are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22566compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22567
22568@item show mips compression
22569@kindex show mips compression
22570Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22571@value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22572
22573@item set mipsfpu
22574@itemx show mipsfpu
22575@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22576
22577@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22578@kindex set mips mask-address
22579@cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22580This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22581@acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off.  The argument @var{arg} can be
22582@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}.  The latter is the default
22583setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22584
22585@item show mips mask-address
22586@kindex show mips mask-address
22587Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22588not.
22589
22590@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22591@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22592This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22593transfer data in 32-bit quantities.  If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22594that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22595and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22596
22597@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22598@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22599Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22600
22601@item set debug mips
22602@kindex set debug mips
22603This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22604target code in @value{GDBN}.
22605
22606@item show debug mips
22607@kindex show debug mips
22608Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22609@end table
22610
22611
22612@node HPPA
22613@subsection HPPA
22614@cindex HPPA support
22615
22616When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22617following special commands:
22618
22619@table @code
22620@item set debug hppa
22621@kindex set debug hppa
22622This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22623messages are to be displayed.
22624
22625@item show debug hppa
22626Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22627
22628@item maint print unwind @var{address}
22629@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22630This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22631given @var{address}.
22632
22633@end table
22634
22635
22636@node SPU
22637@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22638@cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22639@cindex SPU
22640
22641When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22642it provides the following special commands:
22643
22644@table @code
22645@item info spu event
22646@kindex info spu
22647Display SPU event facility status.  Shows current event mask
22648and pending event status.
22649
22650@item info spu signal
22651Display SPU signal notification facility status.  Shows pending
22652signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22653notification channels.
22654
22655@item info spu mailbox
22656Display SPU mailbox facility status.  Shows all pending entries,
22657in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22658SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22659
22660@item info spu dma
22661Display MFC DMA status.  Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22662DMA queue.  For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22663and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22664
22665@item info spu proxydma
22666Display MFC Proxy-DMA status.  Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22667Proxy-DMA queue.  For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22668and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22669
22670@end table
22671
22672When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22673on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22674special commands:
22675
22676@table @code
22677@item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22678@kindex set spu
22679Set whether to stop for new SPE threads.  When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22680will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22681function.  The default is @code{off}.
22682
22683@item show spu stop-on-load
22684@kindex show spu
22685Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22686
22687@item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22688Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.  When set to
22689@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22690cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops.  This provides a consistent
22691view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache.  If an application
22692does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22693
22694@item show spu auto-flush-cache
22695Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22696
22697@end table
22698
22699@node PowerPC
22700@subsection PowerPC
22701@cindex PowerPC architecture
22702
22703When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22704pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22705numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22706in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22707@code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22708
22709The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22710by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22711@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22712
22713For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22714wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22715
22716@node Nios II
22717@subsection Nios II
22718@cindex Nios II architecture
22719
22720When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22721it provides the following special commands:
22722
22723@table @code
22724
22725@item set debug nios2
22726@kindex set debug nios2
22727This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22728target code in @value{GDBN}.
22729
22730@item show debug nios2
22731@kindex show debug nios2
22732Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22733@end table
22734
22735@node Controlling GDB
22736@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22737
22738You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22739@code{set} command.  For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22740data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.  Other settings are
22741described here.
22742
22743@menu
22744* Prompt::                      Prompt
22745* Editing::                     Command editing
22746* Command History::             Command history
22747* Screen Size::                 Screen size
22748* Numbers::                     Numbers
22749* ABI::                         Configuring the current ABI
22750* Auto-loading::                Automatically loading associated files
22751* Messages/Warnings::           Optional warnings and messages
22752* Debugging Output::            Optional messages about internal happenings
22753* Other Misc Settings::         Other Miscellaneous Settings
22754@end menu
22755
22756@node Prompt
22757@section Prompt
22758
22759@cindex prompt
22760
22761@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22762called the @dfn{prompt}.  This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.  You
22763can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command.  For
22764instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22765the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22766which one you are talking to.
22767
22768@emph{Note:}  @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22769prompt you set.  This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22770or a prompt that does not.
22771
22772@table @code
22773@kindex set prompt
22774@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22775Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22776
22777@kindex show prompt
22778@item show prompt
22779Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22780@end table
22781
22782Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22783prompt extensions.  The commands for interacting with these extensions
22784are:
22785
22786@table @code
22787@kindex set extended-prompt
22788@item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22789Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22790@xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22791substitution.  Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22792string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22793is displayed.
22794
22795For example:
22796
22797@smallexample
22798set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22799@end smallexample
22800
22801Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22802@var{prompt_hook} hook.  @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22803
22804@kindex show extended-prompt
22805@item show extended-prompt
22806Prints the extended prompt.  Any escape sequences specified as part of
22807the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22808corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22809@end table
22810
22811@node Editing
22812@section Command Editing
22813@cindex readline
22814@cindex command line editing
22815
22816@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface.  This
22817@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22818command line interface to the user.  Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22819or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22820substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22821debugging sessions.
22822
22823You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22824command @code{set}.
22825
22826@table @code
22827@kindex set editing
22828@cindex editing
22829@item set editing
22830@itemx set editing on
22831Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22832
22833@item set editing off
22834Disable command line editing.
22835
22836@kindex show editing
22837@item show editing
22838Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22839@end table
22840
22841@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22842@xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22843@end ifset
22844@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22845@xref{Command Line Editing},
22846@end ifclear
22847for more details about the Readline
22848interface.  Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22849encouraged to read that chapter.
22850
22851@node Command History
22852@section Command History
22853@cindex command history
22854
22855@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22856debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22857happened.  Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22858history facility.
22859
22860@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22861package, to provide the history facility.
22862@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22863@xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22864@end ifset
22865@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22866@xref{Using History Interactively},
22867@end ifclear
22868for the detailed description of the History library.
22869
22870To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22871the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22872(@pxref{Server Prefix}).  This
22873means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22874affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22875pressed on a line by itself.
22876
22877@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22878The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22879history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22880use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22881
22882Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22883history.
22884
22885@table @code
22886@cindex history substitution
22887@cindex history file
22888@kindex set history filename
22889@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22890@item set history filename @var{fname}
22891Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22892This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22893list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22894exits.  You can access this list through history expansion or through
22895the history command editing characters listed below.  This file defaults
22896to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22897@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22898is not set.
22899
22900@cindex save command history
22901@kindex set history save
22902@item set history save
22903@itemx set history save on
22904Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22905@code{set history filename} command.  By default, this option is disabled.
22906
22907@item set history save off
22908Stop recording command history in a file.
22909
22910@cindex history size
22911@kindex set history size
22912@cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22913@item set history size @var{size}
22914@itemx set history size unlimited
22915Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22916This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22917to 256 if this variable is not set.  Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22918are ignored.  If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22919either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22920@value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22921
22922@cindex remove duplicate history
22923@kindex set history remove-duplicates
22924@item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22925@itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22926Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22927If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22928history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22929entry being added to the command history list.  If @var{count} is
22930@code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded.  If @var{count} is 0, then
22931removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22932
22933Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22934removal.  This option is set to 0 by default.
22935
22936@end table
22937
22938History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22939@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22940@xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22941@end ifset
22942@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22943@xref{Event Designators},
22944@end ifclear
22945for more details.
22946
22947@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22948Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22949is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22950@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22951follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22952a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded.  The readline
22953history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22954@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22955
22956The commands to control history expansion are:
22957
22958@table @code
22959@item set history expansion on
22960@itemx set history expansion
22961@kindex set history expansion
22962Enable history expansion.  History expansion is off by default.
22963
22964@item set history expansion off
22965Disable history expansion.
22966
22967@c @group
22968@kindex show history
22969@item show history
22970@itemx show history filename
22971@itemx show history save
22972@itemx show history size
22973@itemx show history expansion
22974These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22975@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22976@c @end group
22977@end table
22978
22979@table @code
22980@kindex show commands
22981@cindex show last commands
22982@cindex display command history
22983@item show commands
22984Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22985
22986@item show commands @var{n}
22987Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22988
22989@item show commands +
22990Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22991@end table
22992
22993@node Screen Size
22994@section Screen Size
22995@cindex size of screen
22996@cindex screen size
22997@cindex pagination
22998@cindex page size
22999@cindex pauses in output
23000
23001Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23002information output to the screen.  To help you read all of it,
23003@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23004output.  Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23005to discard the remaining output.  Also, the screen width setting
23006determines when to wrap lines of output.  Depending on what is being
23007printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23008rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23009
23010Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23011driver software.  For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23012together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23013@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings.  If this is not correct,
23014you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23015width} commands:
23016
23017@table @code
23018@kindex set height
23019@kindex set width
23020@kindex show width
23021@kindex show height
23022@item set height @var{lpp}
23023@itemx set height unlimited
23024@itemx show height
23025@itemx set width @var{cpl}
23026@itemx set width unlimited
23027@itemx show width
23028These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23029a screen width of @var{cpl} characters.  The associated @code{show}
23030commands display the current settings.
23031
23032If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23033@value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23034output is.  This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23035buffer.
23036
23037Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23038width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23039
23040@item set pagination on
23041@itemx set pagination off
23042@kindex set pagination
23043Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on.  Turning
23044pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}.  Note that
23045running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23046Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23047
23048@item show pagination
23049@kindex show pagination
23050Show the current pagination mode.
23051@end table
23052
23053@node Numbers
23054@section Numbers
23055@cindex number representation
23056@cindex entering numbers
23057
23058You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23059@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23060@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23061begin with @samp{0x}.  Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23062@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
2306310; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23064format is specified---is base 10.  You can change the default base for
23065both input and output with the commands described below.
23066
23067@table @code
23068@kindex set input-radix
23069@item set input-radix @var{base}
23070Set the default base for numeric input.  Supported choices
23071for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  The base must itself be
23072specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23073example, any of
23074
23075@smallexample
23076set input-radix 012
23077set input-radix 10.
23078set input-radix 0xa
23079@end smallexample
23080
23081@noindent
23082sets the input base to decimal.  On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23083leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23084@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23085interpreted in the current radix.  Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23086@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23087change the radix.
23088
23089@kindex set output-radix
23090@item set output-radix @var{base}
23091Set the default base for numeric display.  Supported choices
23092for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16.  The base must itself be
23093specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23094
23095@kindex show input-radix
23096@item show input-radix
23097Display the current default base for numeric input.
23098
23099@kindex show output-radix
23100@item show output-radix
23101Display the current default base for numeric display.
23102
23103@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23104@itemx show radix
23105@kindex set radix
23106@kindex show radix
23107These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23108of numbers.  @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23109the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23110default value of 10.
23111
23112@end table
23113
23114@node ABI
23115@section Configuring the Current ABI
23116
23117@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23118application automatically.  However, sometimes you need to override its
23119conclusions.  Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23120current ABI.
23121
23122@cindex OS ABI
23123@kindex set osabi
23124@kindex show osabi
23125@cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23126
23127One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23128system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23129@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23130but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23131One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23132an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23133not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23134platform provides.
23135
23136When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23137``Newlib'' OS ABI.  This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23138@code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23139The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23140
23141@table @code
23142@item show osabi
23143Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23144
23145@item set osabi
23146With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23147
23148@item set osabi @var{abi}
23149Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23150@end table
23151
23152@cindex float promotion
23153
23154Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23155function depends on whether the function is prototyped.  For a prototyped
23156(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23157according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}.  For unprototyped
23158(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23159@code{double} and then passed.
23160
23161Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23162a function is prototyped.  If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23163as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23164
23165@table @code
23166@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23167@item set coerce-float-to-double
23168@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23169Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23170to an unprototyped function.  This is the default setting.
23171
23172@item set coerce-float-to-double off
23173Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23174functions.
23175
23176@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23177@item show coerce-float-to-double
23178Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23179@end table
23180
23181@kindex set cp-abi
23182@kindex show cp-abi
23183@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23184objects.  The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23185used to build your application.  @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23186programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23187multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23188program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23189Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23190before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23191``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler.  Other C@t{++} compilers may
23192use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well.  The default setting is
23193``auto''.
23194
23195@table @code
23196@item show cp-abi
23197Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23198
23199@item set cp-abi
23200With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23201
23202@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23203@itemx set cp-abi auto
23204Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23205@end table
23206
23207@node Auto-loading
23208@section Automatically loading associated files
23209@cindex auto-loading
23210
23211@value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23212without being explicitly told so by the user.  We call this feature
23213@dfn{auto-loading}.  While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23214@value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23215results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23216sources).
23217
23218@menu
23219* Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23220* libthread_db.so.1 file::             @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23221
23222* Auto-loading safe path::             @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23223* Auto-loading verbose mode::          @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23224@end menu
23225
23226There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23227In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23228in various extension languages.  @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23229
23230Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23231file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23232(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23233
23234For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
23235control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
23236
23237@table @code
23238@anchor{set auto-load off}
23239@kindex set auto-load off
23240@item set auto-load off
23241Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
23242You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
23243(@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
23244@smallexample
23245$ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
23246@end smallexample
23247
23248Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
23249and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
23250still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
23251To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
23252@option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
23253@code{set auto-load no}.
23254
23255@anchor{show auto-load}
23256@kindex show auto-load
23257@item show auto-load
23258Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
23259or disabled.
23260
23261@smallexample
23262(gdb) show auto-load
23263gdb-scripts:  Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
23264libthread-db:  Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
23265local-gdbinit:  Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
23266                is on.
23267python-scripts:  Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
23268safe-path:  List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23269            is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23270scripts-directory:  List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
23271                    is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
23272@end smallexample
23273
23274@anchor{info auto-load}
23275@kindex info auto-load
23276@item info auto-load
23277Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
23278not.
23279
23280@smallexample
23281(gdb) info auto-load
23282gdb-scripts:
23283Loaded  Script
23284Yes     /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
23285libthread-db:  No auto-loaded libthread-db.
23286local-gdbinit:  Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23287                loaded.
23288python-scripts:
23289Loaded  Script
23290Yes     /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23291@end smallexample
23292@end table
23293
23294These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23295
23296@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23297@item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23298@tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23299@item @xref{show auto-load}.
23300@tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23301@item @xref{info auto-load}.
23302@tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23303@item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23304@tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23305@item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23306@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23307@item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23308@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23309@item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23310@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23311@item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23312@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23313@item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23314@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23315@item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23316@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23317@item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23318@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23319@item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23320@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23321@item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23322@tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23323@item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23324@tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23325@item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23326@tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23327@item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23328@tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23329@item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23330@tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23331@item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23332@tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23333@item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23334@tab Control for thread debugging library.
23335@item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23336@tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23337@item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23338@tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23339@item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23340@tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23341@item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23342@tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23343@item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23344@tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23345@end multitable
23346
23347@node Init File in the Current Directory
23348@subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23349@cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23350
23351By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23352from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23353see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23354
23355Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23356configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23357
23358@table @code
23359@anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23360@kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23361@item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23362Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23363(@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23364
23365@anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23366@kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23367@item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23368Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23369current directory is enabled or disabled.
23370
23371@anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23372@kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23373@item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23374Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23375current directory have been auto-loaded.
23376@end table
23377
23378@node libthread_db.so.1 file
23379@subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23380@cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23381
23382This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23383
23384@value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23385to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23386
23387The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23388without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23389libraries have to be trusted in general.  In all other cases of
23390@samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23391auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23392library.
23393
23394Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23395@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23396
23397@table @code
23398@anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23399@kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23400@item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23401Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23402
23403@anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23404@kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23405@item show auto-load libthread-db
23406Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23407enabled or disabled.
23408
23409@anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23410@kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23411@item info auto-load libthread-db
23412Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23413for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23414@end table
23415
23416@node Auto-loading safe path
23417@subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23418@cindex auto-loading safe-path
23419
23420As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23421an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23422@value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23423directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23424Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23425
23426If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23427get loaded:
23428
23429@smallexample
23430$ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23431Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23432warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23433         declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23434         to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23435warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23436         declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23437         to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23438@end smallexample
23439
23440@noindent
23441To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23442invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23443
23444@smallexample
23445$ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23446@end smallexample
23447
23448The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23449
23450@table @code
23451@anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23452@kindex set auto-load safe-path
23453@item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23454Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23455loading and execution of scripts.  You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23456Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23457directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23458(@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23459If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23460its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23461
23462The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23463systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23464to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23465
23466@anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23467@kindex show auto-load safe-path
23468@item show auto-load safe-path
23469Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23470scripts.
23471
23472@anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23473@kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23474@item add-auto-load-safe-path
23475Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23476automatic loading and execution of scripts.  Multiple entries may be delimited
23477by the host platform path separator in use.
23478@end table
23479
23480This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23481to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}).  @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23482substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23483The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23484@value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23485
23486Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23487corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23488@option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23489This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23490system superuser only.  Users can add their source directories in init files in
23491their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}).  See also deprecated
23492init file in the current directory
23493(@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23494
23495To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23496example, you could use one of the following ways:
23497
23498@table @asis
23499@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23500Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23501You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23502by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23503
23504@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23505Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23506@value{GDBN} session.
23507
23508@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23509Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23510This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23511from trusted sources.
23512
23513@item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23514During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23515This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23516trusted sources.
23517@end table
23518
23519On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23520also suppresses any such warning messages:
23521
23522@table @asis
23523@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23524You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23525
23526@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23527Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23528(@pxref{Home Directory Init File}).  While it is improbable, you could also
23529use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23530@end table
23531
23532This setting applies to the file names as entered by user.  If no entry matches
23533@value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23534their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23535entries again.  @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23536own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23537recommended to be entered.
23538
23539@node Auto-loading verbose mode
23540@subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23541@cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23542
23543For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23544be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23545execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23546all the files attempted to be loaded.  Both existing and non-existing files may
23547be printed.
23548
23549For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23550(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23551may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23552
23553@smallexample
23554(gdb) set debug auto-load on
23555(gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23556auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23557           for objfile "/tmp/true".
23558auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23559auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23560auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23561warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23562         by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23563@end smallexample
23564
23565@table @code
23566@anchor{set debug auto-load}
23567@kindex set debug auto-load
23568@item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23569Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23570
23571@anchor{show debug auto-load}
23572@kindex show debug auto-load
23573@item show debug auto-load
23574Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23575on or off.
23576@end table
23577
23578@node Messages/Warnings
23579@section Optional Warnings and Messages
23580
23581@cindex verbose operation
23582@cindex optional warnings
23583By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings.  If you are
23584running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23585command.  This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23586internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23587
23588Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23589which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23590see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23591
23592@table @code
23593@kindex set verbose
23594@item set verbose on
23595Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23596
23597@item set verbose off
23598Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23599
23600@kindex show verbose
23601@item show verbose
23602Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23603@end table
23604
23605By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23606object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23607find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23608Symbol Files}).
23609
23610@table @code
23611
23612@kindex set complaints
23613@item set complaints @var{limit}
23614Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23615unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem.  Set
23616@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23617to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23618
23619@kindex show complaints
23620@item show complaints
23621Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23622
23623@end table
23624
23625@anchor{confirmation requests}
23626By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23627lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands.  For example, if
23628you try to run a program which is already running:
23629
23630@smallexample
23631(@value{GDBP}) run
23632The program being debugged has been started already.
23633Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23634@end smallexample
23635
23636If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23637commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23638
23639@table @code
23640
23641@kindex set confirm
23642@cindex flinching
23643@cindex confirmation
23644@cindex stupid questions
23645@item set confirm off
23646Disables confirmation requests.  Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23647the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23648automatically disables confirmation requests.
23649
23650@item set confirm on
23651Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23652
23653@kindex show confirm
23654@item show confirm
23655Displays state of confirmation requests.
23656
23657@end table
23658
23659@cindex command tracing
23660If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23661useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}.  In this mode each command will be
23662printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23663quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23664
23665@table @code
23666@kindex set trace-commands
23667@cindex command scripts, debugging
23668@item set trace-commands on
23669Enable command tracing.
23670@item set trace-commands off
23671Disable command tracing.
23672@item show trace-commands
23673Display the current state of command tracing.
23674@end table
23675
23676@node Debugging Output
23677@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23678@cindex optional debugging messages
23679
23680@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23681various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23682interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug.  This
23683section documents those commands.
23684
23685@table @code
23686@kindex set exec-done-display
23687@item set exec-done-display
23688Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23689completion.  When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23690asynchronous command finishes its execution.  The default is off.
23691@kindex show exec-done-display
23692@item show exec-done-display
23693Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23694notification.
23695@kindex set debug
23696@cindex ARM AArch64
23697@item set debug aarch64
23698Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23699The default is off.
23700@kindex show debug
23701@item show debug aarch64
23702Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23703ARM AArch64.
23704@cindex gdbarch debugging info
23705@cindex architecture debugging info
23706@item set debug arch
23707Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info.  The default is off
23708@item show debug arch
23709Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23710@item set debug aix-solib
23711@cindex AIX shared library debugging
23712Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23713support module.  The default is off.
23714@item show debug aix-thread
23715Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23716@item set debug aix-thread
23717@cindex AIX threads
23718Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23719module.
23720@item show debug aix-thread
23721Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23722@item set debug check-physname
23723@cindex physname
23724Check the results of the ``physname'' computation.  When reading DWARF
23725debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23726each entity's name.  @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23727different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23728When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23729both ways and display any discrepancies.
23730@item show debug check-physname
23731Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23732@item set debug coff-pe-read
23733@cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23734Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23735exported symbols.  The default is off.
23736@item show debug coff-pe-read
23737Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23738reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23739@item set debug dwarf-die
23740@cindex DWARF DIEs
23741Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23742The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23743A value of zero turns off the display.
23744@item show debug dwarf-die
23745Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23746@item set debug dwarf-line
23747@cindex DWARF Line Tables
23748Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23749DWARF line tables.  The default is 0 (off).
23750A value of 1 provides basic information.
23751A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23752@item show debug dwarf-line
23753Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23754@item set debug dwarf-read
23755@cindex DWARF Reading
23756Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23757DWARF debug info.  The default is 0 (off).
23758A value of 1 provides basic information.
23759A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23760@item show debug dwarf-read
23761Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23762@item set debug displaced
23763@cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23764Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23765displaced stepping support.  The default is off.
23766@item show debug displaced
23767Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23768related to displaced stepping.
23769@item set debug event
23770@cindex event debugging info
23771Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info.  The
23772default is off.
23773@item show debug event
23774Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23775info.
23776@item set debug expression
23777@cindex expression debugging info
23778Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23779expression parsing.  The default is off.
23780@item show debug expression
23781Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23782@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23783@item set debug fbsd-lwp
23784@cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
23785Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
23786@item show debug fbsd-lwp
23787Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
23788@item set debug frame
23789@cindex frame debugging info
23790Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info.  The
23791default is off.
23792@item show debug frame
23793Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23794info.
23795@item set debug gnu-nat
23796@cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23797Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23798@item show debug gnu-nat
23799Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23800@item set debug infrun
23801@cindex inferior debugging info
23802Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23803The default is off.  @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23804for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23805@item show debug infrun
23806Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23807@item set debug jit
23808@cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23809Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23810@item show debug jit
23811Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23812@item set debug lin-lwp
23813@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23814@cindex Linux lightweight processes
23815Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23816@item show debug lin-lwp
23817Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23818@item set debug linux-namespaces
23819@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23820Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23821@item show debug linux-namespaces
23822Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23823@item set debug mach-o
23824@cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23825Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23826processing.  The default is off.
23827@item show debug mach-o
23828Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23829reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23830@item set debug notification
23831@cindex remote async notification debugging info
23832Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23833The default is off.
23834@item show debug notification
23835Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23836@item set debug observer
23837@cindex observer debugging info
23838Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging.  This
23839includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23840@item show debug observer
23841Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23842@item set debug overload
23843@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23844Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23845info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc.  The default
23846is off.
23847@item show debug overload
23848Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23849debugging info.
23850@cindex expression parser, debugging info
23851@cindex debug expression parser
23852@item set debug parser
23853Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23854Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23855parser.  @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23856details.  The default is off.
23857@item show debug parser
23858Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23859@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23860@cindex serial connections, debugging
23861@cindex debug remote protocol
23862@cindex remote protocol debugging
23863@cindex display remote packets
23864@item set debug remote
23865Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23866the serial line to the remote machine.  The info is printed on the
23867@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23868@item show debug remote
23869Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23870@item set debug serial
23871Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23872default is off.
23873@item show debug serial
23874Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23875info.
23876@item set debug solib-frv
23877@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23878Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23879@item show debug solib-frv
23880Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23881messages.
23882@item set debug symbol-lookup
23883@cindex symbol lookup
23884Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23885The default is 0 (off).
23886A value of 1 provides basic information.
23887A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23888@item show debug symbol-lookup
23889Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23890@item set debug symfile
23891@cindex symbol file functions
23892Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23893The default is off.  @xref{Files}.
23894@item show debug symfile
23895Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23896@item set debug symtab-create
23897@cindex symbol table creation
23898Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23899The default is 0 (off).
23900A value of 1 provides basic information.
23901A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23902@item show debug symtab-create
23903Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23904@item set debug target
23905@cindex target debugging info
23906Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23907includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23908default is 0.  Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23909value of large memory transfers.
23910@item show debug target
23911Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23912info.
23913@item set debug timestamp
23914@cindex timestampping debugging info
23915Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23916When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23917message.
23918@item show debug timestamp
23919Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23920debugging info.
23921@item set debug varobj
23922@cindex variable object debugging info
23923Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23924info. The default is off.
23925@item show debug varobj
23926Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23927debugging info.
23928@item set debug xml
23929@cindex XML parser debugging
23930Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23931@item show debug xml
23932Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23933@end table
23934
23935@node Other Misc Settings
23936@section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23937@cindex miscellaneous settings
23938
23939@table @code
23940@kindex set interactive-mode
23941@item set interactive-mode
23942If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23943in a terminal.  In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23944for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23945the command prompt.  If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23946in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23947If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23948its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23949is, non-interactively otherwise.
23950
23951In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23952correctly which mode should be used.  But this setting can be useful
23953in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23954inside a cygwin window.
23955
23956@kindex show interactive-mode
23957@item show interactive-mode
23958Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23959@end table
23960
23961@node Extending GDB
23962@chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23963@cindex extending GDB
23964
23965@value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23966@value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23967extensions when it reads a file for debugging.  This allows the
23968user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23969being debugged.
23970
23971@menu
23972* Sequences::                Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23973* Python::                   Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23974* Guile::                    Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23975* Auto-loading extensions::  Automatically loading extensions
23976* Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23977* Aliases::                  Creating new spellings of existing commands
23978@end menu
23979
23980To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23981of evaluating the contents of a file.  When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23982can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23983the filename extension.  Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23984are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23985@xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23986
23987You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23988setting:
23989
23990@table @code
23991@kindex set script-extension
23992@kindex show script-extension
23993@item set script-extension off
23994All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23995
23996@item set script-extension soft
23997The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23998extension.  If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23999evaluates the script using that language.  Otherwise, it evaluates
24000the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24001
24002@item set script-extension strict
24003The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24004extension, and evaluates the script using that language.  If the
24005language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24006
24007@item show script-extension
24008Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24009
24010@end table
24011
24012@node Sequences
24013@section Canned Sequences of Commands
24014
24015Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24016Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24017commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24018files.
24019
24020@menu
24021* Define::             How to define your own commands
24022* Hooks::              Hooks for user-defined commands
24023* Command Files::      How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24024* Output::             Commands for controlled output
24025* Auto-loading sequences::  Controlling auto-loaded command files
24026@end menu
24027
24028@node Define
24029@subsection User-defined Commands
24030
24031@cindex user-defined command
24032@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24033A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24034which you assign a new name as a command.  This is done with the
24035@code{define} command.  User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
24036separated by whitespace.  Arguments are accessed within the user command
24037via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}.  A trivial example:
24038
24039@smallexample
24040define adder
24041  print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24042end
24043@end smallexample
24044
24045@noindent
24046To execute the command use:
24047
24048@smallexample
24049adder 1 2 3
24050@end smallexample
24051
24052@noindent
24053This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24054its three arguments.  Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24055reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24056functions calls.
24057
24058@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24059@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24060In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24061been passed.  This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
24062
24063@smallexample
24064define adder
24065  if $argc == 2
24066    print $arg0 + $arg1
24067  end
24068  if $argc == 3
24069    print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24070  end
24071end
24072@end smallexample
24073
24074@table @code
24075
24076@kindex define
24077@item define @var{commandname}
24078Define a command named @var{commandname}.  If there is already a command
24079by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24080The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24081numbers, dashes, and underscores.  It may also start with any predefined
24082prefix command.  For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24083a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24084
24085The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24086which are given following the @code{define} command.  The end of these
24087commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24088
24089@kindex document
24090@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24091@item document @var{commandname}
24092Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24093accessed by @code{help}.  The command @var{commandname} must already be
24094defined.  This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24095reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24096After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24097@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24098
24099You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24100documentation of a command.  Redefining the command with @code{define}
24101does not change the documentation.
24102
24103@kindex dont-repeat
24104@cindex don't repeat command
24105@item dont-repeat
24106Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24107command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24108(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24109
24110@kindex help user-defined
24111@item help user-defined
24112List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24113COMAND_USER.  The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24114included (if any).
24115
24116@kindex show user
24117@item show user
24118@itemx show user @var{commandname}
24119Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24120not its documentation).  If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24121definitions for all user-defined commands.
24122This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24123
24124@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24125@kindex show max-user-call-depth
24126@kindex set max-user-call-depth
24127@item show max-user-call-depth
24128@itemx set max-user-call-depth
24129The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24130levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24131infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24132This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24133@end table
24134
24135In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24136use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24137
24138When user-defined commands are executed, the
24139commands of the definition are not printed.  An error in any command
24140stops execution of the user-defined command.
24141
24142If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24143without asking when used inside a user-defined command.  Many @value{GDBN}
24144commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24145messages when used in a user-defined command.
24146
24147@node Hooks
24148@subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24149@cindex command hooks
24150@cindex hooks, for commands
24151@cindex hooks, pre-command
24152
24153@kindex hook
24154You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24155command.  Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24156command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24157before that command.
24158
24159@cindex hooks, post-command
24160@kindex hookpost
24161A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24162Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24163@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24164that command.  Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24165pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24166
24167It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks.  If this
24168occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24169
24170@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24171@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not.  FIXME!
24172
24173@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24174In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists.  Defining
24175(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24176execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24177displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24178
24179For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24180single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24181you could define:
24182
24183@smallexample
24184define hook-stop
24185handle SIGALRM nopass
24186end
24187
24188define hook-run
24189handle SIGALRM pass
24190end
24191
24192define hook-continue
24193handle SIGALRM pass
24194end
24195@end smallexample
24196
24197As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24198command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24199you could define:
24200
24201@smallexample
24202define hook-echo
24203echo <<<---
24204end
24205
24206define hookpost-echo
24207echo --->>>\n
24208end
24209
24210(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
24211<<<---Hello World--->>>
24212(@value{GDBP})
24213
24214@end smallexample
24215
24216You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
24217not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
24218name, e.g.@:  @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
24219@c FIXME!  So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
24220@c or not?
24221You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
24222@code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
24223@samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
24224
24225If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
24226@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
24227(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
24228
24229If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
24230get a warning from the @code{define} command.
24231
24232@node Command Files
24233@subsection Command Files
24234
24235@cindex command files
24236@cindex scripting commands
24237A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
24238@value{GDBN} commands.  Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
24239also be included.  An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
24240does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
24241terminal.
24242
24243You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
24244command.  Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
24245scripts that are not Command Files.  The exact behavior can be configured
24246using the @code{script-extension} setting.
24247@xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
24248
24249@table @code
24250@kindex source
24251@cindex execute commands from a file
24252@item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
24253Execute the command file @var{filename}.
24254@end table
24255
24256The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
24257unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
24258@emph{flow-control commands} described below.  The commands are not
24259printed as they are executed.  An error in any command terminates
24260execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
24261
24262@value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
24263If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
24264directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
24265(specified with the @samp{directory} command);
24266except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
24267is not relevant to scripts.
24268
24269If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
24270on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
24271The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
24272search path.  So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
24273and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24274look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
24275The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
24276For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
24277the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
24278look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
24279For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
24280it is stripped before concatenation.  For example, if @var{filename} is
24281@file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
24282will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
24283
24284If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
24285each command as it is executed.  The option must be given before
24286@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
24287
24288Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
24289without asking when used in a command file.  Many @value{GDBN} commands that
24290normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
24291when called from command files.
24292
24293@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input.  In this
24294mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24295standard error.  Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24296not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24297the next command.
24298
24299@smallexample
24300gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24301@end smallexample
24302
24303(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24304will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24305would be directed to @file{log}.
24306
24307Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24308commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24309complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24310variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24311built, etc.  @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24312deal with these complexities.  Using these commands, you can write
24313complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24314conditionally, etc.
24315
24316@table @code
24317@kindex if
24318@kindex else
24319@item if
24320@itemx else
24321This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24322commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24323expression to evaluate.  It is followed by a series of commands that
24324are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24325There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24326of commands that are only executed if the expression was false.  The
24327end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24328
24329@kindex while
24330@item while
24331This command allows to write loops.  Its syntax is similar to
24332@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24333to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24334line, terminated by an @code{end}.  These commands are called the
24335@dfn{body} of the loop.  The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24336executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24337
24338@kindex loop_break
24339@item loop_break
24340This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24341Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24342line.
24343
24344@kindex loop_continue
24345@item loop_continue
24346This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24347in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.  Execution
24348branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24349the controlling expression.
24350
24351@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24352@item end
24353Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24354@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24355@end table
24356
24357
24358@node Output
24359@subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24360
24361During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24362@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24363explicitly printed by the commands in the definition.  This section
24364describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24365want.
24366
24367@table @code
24368@kindex echo
24369@item echo @var{text}
24370@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24371@c because it is not in ANSI.
24372Print @var{text}.  Nonprinting characters can be included in
24373@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24374newline.  @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24375In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24376by a space stands for a space.  This is useful for displaying a
24377string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24378trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24379To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24380@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24381
24382A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24383the command onto subsequent lines.  For example,
24384
24385@smallexample
24386echo This is some text\n\
24387which is continued\n\
24388onto several lines.\n
24389@end smallexample
24390
24391produces the same output as
24392
24393@smallexample
24394echo This is some text\n
24395echo which is continued\n
24396echo onto several lines.\n
24397@end smallexample
24398
24399@kindex output
24400@item output @var{expression}
24401Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24402newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }.  The value is not entered in the
24403value history either.  @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24404on expressions.
24405
24406@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24407Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}.  You can use
24408the same formats as for @code{print}.  @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24409Formats}, for more information.
24410
24411@kindex printf
24412@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24413Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24414the string @var{template}.  To print several values, make
24415@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24416which may be either numbers or pointers.  Their values are printed as
24417specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24418executing the code below:
24419
24420@smallexample
24421printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24422@end smallexample
24423
24424As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24425are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24426by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24427evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24428style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24429printed.
24430
24431For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24432
24433@smallexample
24434printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24435@end smallexample
24436
24437@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24438specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24439character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24440
24441@itemize @bullet
24442@item
24443The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24444
24445@item
24446The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24447width.
24448
24449@item
24450The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24451@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24452
24453@item
24454The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24455supported.
24456
24457@item
24458The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24459
24460@item
24461The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24462@end itemize
24463
24464@noindent
24465Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24466underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24467the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24468supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24469
24470As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24471sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24472@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24473single character.  Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24474supported.
24475
24476Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24477(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24478together with a floating point specifier.
24479letters:
24480
24481@itemize @bullet
24482@item
24483@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24484
24485@item
24486@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24487
24488@item
24489@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24490@end itemize
24491
24492If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24493support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24494such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24495
24496In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24497available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24498
24499Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24500@smallexample
24501printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24502@end smallexample
24503
24504@kindex eval
24505@item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24506Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24507the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24508
24509@end table
24510
24511@node Auto-loading sequences
24512@subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24513@cindex native script auto-loading
24514
24515When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24516command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24517@value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24518@xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24519
24520Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24521and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24522
24523@table @code
24524@anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24525@kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24526@item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24527Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24528
24529@anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24530@kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24531@item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24532Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24533disabled.
24534
24535@anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24536@kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24537@cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24538@item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24539Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24540auto-loaded.
24541@end table
24542
24543If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24544matching names are printed.
24545
24546@c Python docs live in a separate file.
24547@include python.texi
24548
24549@c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24550@include guile.texi
24551
24552@node Auto-loading extensions
24553@section Auto-loading extensions
24554@cindex auto-loading extensions
24555
24556@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24557when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24558command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24559@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24560section of modern file formats like ELF.
24561
24562@menu
24563* objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file.  The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24564* .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section.  The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24565* Which flavor to choose?::
24566@end menu
24567
24568The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24569debugging commands and features.
24570
24571Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24572and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24573See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24574for more information.
24575For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24576For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24577
24578Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24579@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24580
24581@node objfile-gdbdotext file
24582@subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24583@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24584@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24585@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24586
24587When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24588@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24589where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24590where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24591
24592@table @code
24593@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24594GDB's own command language
24595@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24596Python
24597@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24598Guile
24599@end table
24600
24601@var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24602is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24603components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24604If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24605script in the specified extension language.
24606
24607If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24608@var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24609
24610Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24611@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24612
24613For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24614scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename.  But if no scripts are
24615found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24616its @file{.exe} suffix.  This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24617is attempted on any platform.  This makes the script filenames compatible
24618between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24619
24620@table @code
24621@anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24622@kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24623@item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24624Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.  Multiple directory entries
24625may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24626(@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24627
24628Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24629@code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24630
24631@anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24632This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}.  The default
24633@code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24634configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24635
24636Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24637@var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24638reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24639determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).  @file{$debugdir} and
24640@file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24641delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24642platform.
24643
24644The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24645systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24646to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24647
24648@anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24649@kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24650@item show auto-load scripts-directory
24651Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24652
24653@anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24654@kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24655@item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24656Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24657Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24658@end table
24659
24660@value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24661@value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24662@var{objfile} is opened.
24663So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24664is evaluated more than once.
24665
24666@node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24667@subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24668@cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24669
24670For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24671when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24672it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24673If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24674specifying scripts to load.  Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24675specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24676script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24677
24678The following entries are supported:
24679
24680@table @code
24681@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24682@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24683@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24684@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24685@end table
24686
24687@subsubsection Script File Entries
24688
24689If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24690in the current directory and then along the source search path
24691(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24692except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24693directory is not relevant to scripts.
24694
24695File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24696for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24697
24698@example
24699/* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates.  */
24700#define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24701  asm("\
24702.pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24703.byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24704.asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24705.popsection \n\
24706");
24707@end example
24708
24709@noindent
24710For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24711Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24712
24713@example
24714DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24715@end example
24716
24717The script name may include directories if desired.
24718
24719Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24720@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24721
24722If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24723using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24724and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24725will remove duplicates.
24726
24727@subsubsection Script Text Entries
24728
24729Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24730itself instead of loading it from a file.
24731The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24732the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24733contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24734The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24735execute in the specified language.  The name needs to be unique among
24736all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24737on its name.
24738
24739Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24740testsuite.
24741
24742@example
24743#include "symcat.h"
24744#include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24745asm(
24746".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24747".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24748".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24749".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24750".ascii \"  def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24751".ascii \"    super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24752    "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24753".ascii \"  def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24754".ascii \"    print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24755".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24756".byte 0\n"
24757".popsection\n"
24758);
24759@end example
24760
24761Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24762@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24763The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24764containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24765
24766@node Which flavor to choose?
24767@subsection Which flavor to choose?
24768
24769Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24770be clear which one to choose.  This section provides some guidance.
24771
24772@noindent
24773Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24774
24775@itemize @bullet
24776@item
24777Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24778
24779@item
24780Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24781
24782Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24783in the source search path.
24784For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24785isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24786
24787@item
24788Doesn't require source code additions.
24789@end itemize
24790
24791@noindent
24792Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24793
24794@itemize @bullet
24795@item
24796Works with static linking.
24797
24798Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24799trigger their loading.  When an application is statically linked the only
24800objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24801scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24802@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24803
24804@item
24805Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24806
24807Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24808shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24809
24810@item
24811Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24812
24813In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24814libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24815@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24816cumbersome.  It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24817@code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24818top of the source tree to the source search path.
24819@end itemize
24820
24821@node Multiple Extension Languages
24822@section Multiple Extension Languages
24823
24824The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24825and generally do not interfere with each other.
24826There are some things to be aware of, however.
24827
24828@subsection Python comes first
24829
24830Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24831existing behaviour Python comes first.  This is generally solved by the
24832``first one wins'' principle.  @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24833extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24834(say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24835language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24836pretty-printed form of a value).
24837This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24838while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24839reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24840
24841@node Aliases
24842@section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24843@cindex aliases for commands
24844
24845It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24846For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24847a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24848that involves less typing.
24849
24850@value{GDBN} itself uses aliases.  For example @samp{s} is an alias
24851of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24852abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24853
24854Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24855of multi-word commands.  For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24856@samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24857
24858You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24859
24860@table @code
24861
24862@kindex alias
24863@item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24864
24865@end table
24866
24867@var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24868Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24869underscores.
24870
24871@var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24872that is being aliased.
24873
24874The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24875of the command.  Abbreviations are not shown in command
24876lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24877
24878The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24879and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24880
24881Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24882of a command so that there is less to type.
24883Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24884shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24885and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24886The following will accomplish this.
24887
24888@smallexample
24889(gdb) alias -a di = disas
24890@end smallexample
24891
24892Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24893With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24894for it with the @samp{document} command.
24895An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24896
24897Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24898@samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24899This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24900of a command.
24901
24902@smallexample
24903(gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24904(gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24905(gdb) set p elms 20
24906(gdb) show p elms
24907Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24908@end smallexample
24909
24910Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24911and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24912command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24913
24914Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24915@var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24916
24917@smallexample
24918(gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24919@end smallexample
24920
24921Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24922alias for a more complex command.
24923This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24924
24925@smallexample
24926(gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24927(gdb) spe 20
24928@end smallexample
24929
24930@node Interpreters
24931@chapter Command Interpreters
24932@cindex command interpreters
24933
24934@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24935infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24936between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24937
24938@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24939interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24940and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}).  This manual
24941describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24942
24943By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24944However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24945interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24946startup options.  Defined interpreters include:
24947
24948@table @code
24949@item console
24950@cindex console interpreter
24951The traditional console or command-line interpreter.  This is the most often
24952used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24953@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24954
24955@item mi
24956@cindex mi interpreter
24957The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}).  Used primarily
24958by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24959or an IDE.  For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24960Interface}.
24961
24962@item mi2
24963@cindex mi2 interpreter
24964The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24965
24966@item mi1
24967@cindex mi1 interpreter
24968The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24969
24970@end table
24971
24972@cindex invoke another interpreter
24973
24974@kindex interpreter-exec
24975You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
24976interpreter using the appropriate command.  If you are running the
24977console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24978
24979@smallexample
24980interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24981@end smallexample
24982
24983@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24984@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24985
24986Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
24987duration of the specified command.  It does not change the interpreter
24988permanently.
24989
24990@cindex start a new independent interpreter
24991
24992Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
24993possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
24994device (usually a tty).
24995
24996For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
24997@value{GDBN} console view.  It may do so by embedding a terminal
24998emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
24999command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25000terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25001input/output device.  The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25002at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25003while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25004the separate MI interpreter.
25005
25006To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25007@code{new-ui} command:
25008
25009@kindex new-ui
25010@cindex new user interface
25011@smallexample
25012new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25013@end smallexample
25014
25015The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25016This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25017For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc.  The
25018@var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25019interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25020pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems.  For example:
25021
25022@smallexample
25023(@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25024@end smallexample
25025
25026@noindent
25027runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25028
25029@node TUI
25030@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25031@cindex TUI
25032@cindex Text User Interface
25033
25034@menu
25035* TUI Overview::                TUI overview
25036* TUI Keys::                    TUI key bindings
25037* TUI Single Key Mode::         TUI single key mode
25038* TUI Commands::                TUI-specific commands
25039* TUI Configuration::           TUI configuration variables
25040@end menu
25041
25042The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25043interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25044file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25045commands in separate text windows.  The TUI mode is supported only
25046on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25047is available.
25048
25049The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25050@samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25051You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25052using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25053enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}.  @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25054@ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25055
25056@node TUI Overview
25057@section TUI Overview
25058
25059In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25060
25061@table @emph
25062@item command
25063This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25064prompt and the @value{GDBN} output.  The @value{GDBN} input is still
25065managed using readline.
25066
25067@item source
25068The source window shows the source file of the program.  The current
25069line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25070
25071@item assembly
25072The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25073
25074@item register
25075This window shows the processor registers.  Registers are highlighted
25076when their values change.
25077@end table
25078
25079The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25080by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25081Breakpoints are indicated with two markers.  The first marker
25082indicates the breakpoint type:
25083
25084@table @code
25085@item B
25086Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25087
25088@item b
25089Breakpoint which was never hit.
25090
25091@item H
25092Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25093
25094@item h
25095Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25096@end table
25097
25098The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25099
25100@table @code
25101@item +
25102Breakpoint is enabled.
25103
25104@item -
25105Breakpoint is disabled.
25106@end table
25107
25108The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25109thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25110changes.
25111
25112These windows are not all visible at the same time.  The command
25113window is always visible.  The others can be arranged in several
25114layouts:
25115
25116@itemize @bullet
25117@item
25118source only,
25119
25120@item
25121assembly only,
25122
25123@item
25124source and assembly,
25125
25126@item
25127source and registers, or
25128
25129@item
25130assembly and registers.
25131@end itemize
25132
25133A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25134
25135@table @emph
25136@item target
25137Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25138(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25139
25140@item process
25141Gives the current process or thread number.
25142When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25143
25144@item function
25145Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25146The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25147When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25148the string @code{??} is displayed.
25149
25150@item line
25151Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25152When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25153
25154@item pc
25155Indicates the current program counter address.
25156@end table
25157
25158@node TUI Keys
25159@section TUI Key Bindings
25160@cindex TUI key bindings
25161
25162The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25163@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25164(@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25165@end ifset
25166@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25167(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25168@end ifclear
25169The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25170@value{GDBN} standard mode.
25171
25172@table @kbd
25173@kindex C-x C-a
25174@item C-x C-a
25175@kindex C-x a
25176@itemx C-x a
25177@kindex C-x A
25178@itemx C-x A
25179Enter or leave the TUI mode.  When leaving the TUI mode,
25180the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25181its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly.  When reentering
25182the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25183The screen is then refreshed.
25184
25185@kindex C-x 1
25186@item C-x 1
25187Use a TUI layout with only one window.  The layout will
25188either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}.  When the TUI mode
25189is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25190
25191Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25192
25193@kindex C-x 2
25194@item C-x 2
25195Use a TUI layout with at least two windows.  When the current
25196layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25197When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25198previous layout and the new one.
25199
25200Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25201
25202@kindex C-x o
25203@item C-x o
25204Change the active window.  The TUI associates several key bindings
25205(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window.  This command
25206gives the focus to the next TUI window.
25207
25208Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
25209
25210@kindex C-x s
25211@item C-x s
25212Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
25213keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
25214@end table
25215
25216The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
25217
25218@table @asis
25219@kindex PgUp
25220@item @key{PgUp}
25221Scroll the active window one page up.
25222
25223@kindex PgDn
25224@item @key{PgDn}
25225Scroll the active window one page down.
25226
25227@kindex Up
25228@item @key{Up}
25229Scroll the active window one line up.
25230
25231@kindex Down
25232@item @key{Down}
25233Scroll the active window one line down.
25234
25235@kindex Left
25236@item @key{Left}
25237Scroll the active window one column left.
25238
25239@kindex Right
25240@item @key{Right}
25241Scroll the active window one column right.
25242
25243@kindex C-L
25244@item @kbd{C-L}
25245Refresh the screen.
25246@end table
25247
25248Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25249are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25250window has the focus.  When another window is active, you must use
25251other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25252and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25253
25254@node TUI Single Key Mode
25255@section TUI Single Key Mode
25256@cindex TUI single key mode
25257
25258The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25259frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys.  Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25260switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25261
25262@table @kbd
25263@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25264@item c
25265continue
25266
25267@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25268@item d
25269down
25270
25271@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25272@item f
25273finish
25274
25275@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25276@item n
25277next
25278
25279@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25280@item q
25281exit the SingleKey mode.
25282
25283@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25284@item r
25285run
25286
25287@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25288@item s
25289step
25290
25291@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25292@item u
25293up
25294
25295@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25296@item v
25297info locals
25298
25299@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25300@item w
25301where
25302@end table
25303
25304Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25305The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25306it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25307with the TUI SingleKey mode.  Once the command is entered the TUI
25308SingleKey mode is restored.  The only way to permanently leave
25309this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25310
25311
25312@node TUI Commands
25313@section TUI-specific Commands
25314@cindex TUI commands
25315
25316The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25317These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25318the TUI mode.  When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25319of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25320
25321Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25322terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25323interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25324these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25325possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25326
25327@table @code
25328@item tui enable
25329@kindex tui enable
25330Activate TUI mode.  The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25331TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25332otherwise a default layout is used.
25333
25334@item tui disable
25335@kindex tui disable
25336Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25337
25338@item info win
25339@kindex info win
25340List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25341
25342@item layout @var{name}
25343@kindex layout
25344Changes which TUI windows are displayed.  In each layout the command
25345window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25346additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25347
25348@table @code
25349@item next
25350Display the next layout.
25351
25352@item prev
25353Display the previous layout.
25354
25355@item src
25356Display the source and command windows.
25357
25358@item asm
25359Display the assembly and command windows.
25360
25361@item split
25362Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25363
25364@item regs
25365When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25366windows.  When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25367register, assembler, and command windows.
25368@end table
25369
25370@item focus @var{name}
25371@kindex focus
25372Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling.  The
25373@var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25374
25375@table @code
25376@item next
25377Make the next window active for scrolling.
25378
25379@item prev
25380Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25381
25382@item src
25383Make the source window active for scrolling.
25384
25385@item asm
25386Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25387
25388@item regs
25389Make the register window active for scrolling.
25390
25391@item cmd
25392Make the command window active for scrolling.
25393@end table
25394
25395@item refresh
25396@kindex refresh
25397Refresh the screen.  This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25398
25399@item tui reg @var{group}
25400@kindex tui reg
25401Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25402@var{group}.  If the register window is not currently displayed this
25403command will cause the register window to be displayed.  The list of
25404register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25405following groups are available on most targets:
25406@table @code
25407@item next
25408Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25409through all of the available register groups.
25410
25411@item prev
25412Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25413through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25414@var{next}.
25415
25416@item general
25417Display the general registers.
25418@item float
25419Display the floating point registers.
25420@item system
25421Display the system registers.
25422@item vector
25423Display the vector registers.
25424@item all
25425Display all registers.
25426@end table
25427
25428@item update
25429@kindex update
25430Update the source window and the current execution point.
25431
25432@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25433@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25434@kindex winheight
25435Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25436lines.  Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25437decrease it.  The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25438source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25439disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25440
25441@item tabset @var{nchars}
25442@kindex tabset
25443Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.  This
25444setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25445assembly windows.
25446@end table
25447
25448@node TUI Configuration
25449@section TUI Configuration Variables
25450@cindex TUI configuration variables
25451
25452Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25453
25454@table @code
25455@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25456@kindex set tui border-kind
25457Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25458The possible values are the following:
25459@table @code
25460@item space
25461Use a space character to draw the border.
25462
25463@item ascii
25464Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25465
25466@item acs
25467Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border.  The border is
25468drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25469@end table
25470
25471@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25472@kindex set tui border-mode
25473@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25474@kindex set tui active-border-mode
25475Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25476or the active window.  The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25477@table @code
25478@item normal
25479Use normal attributes to display the border.
25480
25481@item standout
25482Use standout mode.
25483
25484@item reverse
25485Use reverse video mode.
25486
25487@item half
25488Use half bright mode.
25489
25490@item half-standout
25491Use half bright and standout mode.
25492
25493@item bold
25494Use extra bright or bold mode.
25495
25496@item bold-standout
25497Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25498@end table
25499@end table
25500
25501@node Emacs
25502@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25503
25504@cindex Emacs
25505@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25506A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25507edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25508@value{GDBN}.
25509
25510To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs.  Give the
25511executable file you want to debug as an argument.  This command starts
25512@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25513created Emacs buffer.
25514@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25515
25516Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25517things:
25518
25519@itemize @bullet
25520@item
25521All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25522the GUD buffer.
25523
25524This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25525and output done by the program you are debugging.
25526
25527This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25528commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25529in this way.
25530
25531All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25532with your program.  In particular, you can send signals the usual
25533way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25534stop.
25535
25536@item
25537@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25538
25539Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25540source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25541left margin of the current line.  Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25542source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25543and the source.
25544
25545Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25546usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25547@end itemize
25548
25549We call this @dfn{text command mode}.  Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25550a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25551that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25552@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25553
25554If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25555gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25556your program resides.  If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25557sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25558with the previous buffer.  In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25559program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25560some operating systems it might not find the source.  So, although the
25561@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25562buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25563
25564The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25565line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25566that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.  @xref{Files,
25567,Commands to Specify Files}.
25568
25569By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}.  If you
25570need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25571keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25572customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25573one you want.
25574
25575In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25576addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25577
25578@table @kbd
25579@item C-h m
25580Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25581
25582@item C-c C-s
25583Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25584update the display window to show the current file and location.
25585
25586@item C-c C-n
25587Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25588calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command.  Then update the display window
25589to show the current file and location.
25590
25591@item C-c C-i
25592Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25593display window accordingly.
25594
25595@item C-c C-f
25596Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25597@code{finish} command.
25598
25599@item C-c C-r
25600Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25601command.
25602
25603@item C-c <
25604Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25605(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25606like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25607
25608@item C-c >
25609Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25610@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25611@end table
25612
25613In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25614tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25615
25616In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25617separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25618Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25619become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25620source buffer.  Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25621selected frame become the current one.  In graphical mode, the
25622speedbar displays watch expressions.
25623
25624If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25625it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25626request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25627the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25628frame.
25629
25630The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25631which are visiting the source files in the usual way.  You can edit
25632the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25633communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers.  If you add or
25634delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25635to correspond properly with the code.
25636
25637A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25638given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25639Emacs Manual}).
25640
25641@node GDB/MI
25642@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25643
25644@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25645
25646@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25647@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25648@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25649@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}).  It
25650is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25651use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25652
25653This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface.  It is written
25654in the form of a reference manual.
25655
25656Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25657features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25658(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25659
25660@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25661
25662@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25663This chapter uses the following notation:
25664
25665@itemize @bullet
25666@item
25667@code{|} separates two alternatives.
25668
25669@item
25670@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25671it may or may not be given.
25672
25673@item
25674@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25675may repeat zero or more times.
25676
25677@item
25678@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25679may repeat one or more times.
25680
25681@item
25682@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25683@end itemize
25684
25685@ignore
25686@heading Dependencies
25687@end ignore
25688
25689@menu
25690* GDB/MI General Design::
25691* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25692* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25693* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25694* GDB/MI Output Records::
25695* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25696* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25697* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25698* GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25699* GDB/MI Program Context::
25700* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25701* GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25702* GDB/MI Program Execution::
25703* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25704* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25705* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25706* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25707* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25708* GDB/MI File Commands::
25709@ignore
25710* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25711* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25712* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25713@end ignore
25714* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25715* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25716* GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25717* GDB/MI Support Commands::
25718* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25719@end menu
25720
25721@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25722@node GDB/MI General Design
25723@section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25724@cindex GDB/MI General Design
25725
25726Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25727parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25728and notifications.  Each command results in exactly one response,
25729indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25730For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25731requested information.  For the commands that resume the target, the
25732response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25733Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25734target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25735a command and reported as part of that command response.
25736
25737The important examples of notifications are:
25738@itemize @bullet
25739
25740@item
25741Exec notifications.  These are used to report changes in
25742target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped.  It would not
25743be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25744commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25745different threads.  Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25746happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25747command itself was successfully executed.
25748
25749@item
25750Console output, and status notifications.  Console output
25751notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25752diagnostics for other commands.  Status notifications are used to
25753report the progress of a long-running operation.  Naturally, including
25754this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25755until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25756
25757@item
25758General notifications.  Commands may have various side effects on
25759the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose.  For example,
25760a command may change the selected thread.  Although such changes can
25761be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25762orthogonal frontend design.
25763
25764@end itemize
25765
25766There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25767@value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25768the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25769processed.  Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25770we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25771the user interface.
25772
25773
25774@menu
25775* Context management::
25776* Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25777* Thread groups::
25778@end menu
25779
25780@node Context management
25781@subsection Context management
25782
25783@subsubsection Threads and Frames
25784
25785In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25786done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25787Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25788be specified.  The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25789and supplies them to target on each command.  This is convenient,
25790because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25791explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25792@value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25793to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25794
25795In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25796useful.  First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25797itself.  Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25798each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25799want to access additional threads for internal purposes.  This
25800increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25801frontend may be operating on a wrong one.  Therefore, each MI command
25802should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on.  To
25803make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25804@samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
25805identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
25806
25807Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25808a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25809operations.  However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25810current thread or frame be changed.  For example, when stopping on a
25811breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
25812hit.  For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
25813@samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
25814frontend's selection to the one specified by user.  @value{GDBN}
25815communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
25816@samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25817
25818Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25819frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25820right context.  However, getting this to work right is cumbersome.  The
25821simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25822before every command.  This doubles the number of commands that need
25823to be sent.  The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25824if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25825thread the frontend wants to operate on.  However, getting this
25826optimization right can be tricky.  In particular, if the frontend
25827sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25828selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25829change.  So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25830problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25831all subsequent commands.  No frontend is known to do this exactly
25832right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25833@samp{--frame} options.
25834
25835@subsubsection Language
25836
25837The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25838By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25839But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25840to use the @samp{--language} option.  This option takes one argument,
25841which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25842For instance:
25843
25844@smallexample
25845-data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25846^done,value="4"
25847(gdb)
25848@end smallexample
25849
25850The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25851@samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25852@samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25853
25854@node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25855@subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25856
25857On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25858even while the target is running.  This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25859command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}).  The frontend may
25860specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25861@code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25862either running the executable or attaching to the target.  After the
25863frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25864find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25865@code{-list-target-features} command.
25866
25867@table @code
25868@item -gdb-set mi-async on
25869@item -gdb-set mi-async off
25870Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25871
25872When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25873@code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25874for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25875
25876When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25877commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25878@code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25879MI commands even while the target is running.
25880
25881@item -gdb-show mi-async
25882Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25883@end table
25884
25885Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25886@code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25887of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25888commands possible.  CLI background commands are now always possible
25889``out of the box'' if the target supports them.  The old spelling is
25890kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25891
25892Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25893many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25894running.  Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25895when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}).  Then,
25896it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25897are running.
25898
25899When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25900target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25901some targets.  In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25902stack will not work, on any target.  Commands that read memory, or
25903modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target.  Note
25904that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25905@code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25906context of a specific thread,  so frontend should try to find a
25907stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25908@samp{--thread} option).
25909
25910Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25911highly target dependent.  However, the two commands
25912@code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25913to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25914
25915@node Thread groups
25916@subsection Thread groups
25917@value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25918On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25919hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25920processes running on each core.  This section describes the MI
25921mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25922
25923The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25924target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25925accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25926thread belongs to.  Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25927neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25928current process in the MI interface.  The only strictly new feature
25929that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25930into processes.
25931
25932To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25933hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25934@dfn{thread group}.  Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25935thread groups.  A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25936and may have additional attributes specific to the type.  A new
25937command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25938thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25939debugging at the moment.  By passing an identifier of a thread group
25940to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25941the members of specific thread group.
25942
25943To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25944wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25945introduced.  Available thread group is an thread group that
25946@value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25947@code{-target-attach} command.  The list of available top-level thread
25948groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25949In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25950after attaching to that thread group.
25951
25952Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25953Programs}).  Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25954type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25955such thread groups.
25956
25957@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25958@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25959@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25960
25961@menu
25962* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25963* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25964@end menu
25965
25966@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25967@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25968
25969@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25970@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25971@table @code
25972@item @var{command} @expansion{}
25973@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25974
25975@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25976@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25977@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25978
25979@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25980@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25981@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25982
25983@item @var{token} @expansion{}
25984"any sequence of digits"
25985
25986@item @var{option} @expansion{}
25987@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25988
25989@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25990@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25991
25992@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25993@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25994
25995@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25996@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25997"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25998
25999@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26000@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26001
26002@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26003@code{CR | CR-LF}
26004@end table
26005
26006@noindent
26007Notes:
26008
26009@itemize @bullet
26010@item
26011The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26012output is described below.
26013
26014@item
26015The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26016finishes.
26017
26018@item
26019Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26020list.  Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26021followed by an optional argument parameter.  Options occur first in the
26022parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26023@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26024@end itemize
26025
26026Pragmatics:
26027
26028@itemize @bullet
26029@item
26030We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26031
26032@item
26033We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26034@end itemize
26035
26036@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26037@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26038
26039@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26040@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26041The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26042followed, optionally, by a single result record.  This result record
26043is for the most recent command.  The sequence of output records is
26044terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26045
26046If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26047corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26048@var{token}.
26049
26050@table @code
26051@item @var{output} @expansion{}
26052@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26053
26054@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26055@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26056
26057@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26058@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26059
26060@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26061@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26062
26063@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26064@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26065
26066@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26067@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26068
26069@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26070@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26071
26072@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26073@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26074
26075@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26076@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26077
26078@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26079@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26080depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26081
26082@item @var{result} @expansion{}
26083@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26084
26085@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26086@code{ @var{string} }
26087
26088@item @var{value} @expansion{}
26089@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26090
26091@item @var{const} @expansion{}
26092@code{@var{c-string}}
26093
26094@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26095@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26096
26097@item @var{list} @expansion{}
26098@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26099@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26100
26101@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26102@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26103
26104@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26105@code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26106
26107@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26108@code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26109
26110@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26111@code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26112
26113@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26114@code{CR | CR-LF}
26115
26116@item @var{token} @expansion{}
26117@emph{any sequence of digits}.
26118@end table
26119
26120@noindent
26121Notes:
26122
26123@itemize @bullet
26124@item
26125All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26126
26127@item
26128The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request.  Note that
26129for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26130may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26131output messages, it is generally omitted.  Frontends should treat
26132all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26133target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26134prior command.
26135
26136@item
26137@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26138@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26139progress of a slow operation.  It can be discarded.  All status output is
26140prefixed by @samp{+}.
26141
26142@item
26143@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26144@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26145(stopped, started, disappeared).  All async output is prefixed by
26146@samp{*}.
26147
26148@item
26149@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26150@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26151client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information).  All notify
26152output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26153
26154@item
26155@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26156@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26157console.  It is the textual response to a CLI command.  All the console
26158output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26159
26160@item
26161@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26162@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26163All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26164
26165@item
26166@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26167@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26168instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log.  All
26169the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26170
26171@item
26172@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26173New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26174@var{values}.
26175
26176
26177@end itemize
26178
26179@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26180details about the various output records.
26181
26182@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26183@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26184@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26185
26186@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26187@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26188
26189For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26190but there may be some unexpected behaviour.  For example, commands
26191that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26192command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26193@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26194@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26195
26196This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26197recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
26198(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
26199
26200@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26201@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
26202@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
26203@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
26204
26205The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
26206program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
26207
26208Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
26209by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}.  This makes it difficult
26210to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage.  This
26211section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
26212might change.
26213
26214Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
26215for these the MI version will remain unchanged.  The following is a
26216list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
26217parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
26218
26219@itemize @bullet
26220@item
26221New MI commands may be added.
26222
26223@item
26224New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
26225
26226@item
26227The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
26228@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
26229
26230@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
26231@c   at your own risk.  Yes, in general?
26232
26233@c The order of fields may change?  Shouldn't really matter but it might
26234@c resolve inconsistencies.
26235@end itemize
26236
26237If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
26238will be increased by one.  This will allow the front end to parse the
26239output according to the MI version.  Apart from mi0, new versions of
26240@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
26241responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
26242
26243@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
26244@c version?
26245
26246The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
26247end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
26248follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
26249@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
26250@cindex mailing lists
26251
26252@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26253@node GDB/MI Output Records
26254@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
26255
26256@menu
26257* GDB/MI Result Records::
26258* GDB/MI Stream Records::
26259* GDB/MI Async Records::
26260* GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
26261* GDB/MI Frame Information::
26262* GDB/MI Thread Information::
26263* GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
26264@end menu
26265
26266@node GDB/MI Result Records
26267@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
26268
26269@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26270@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
26271In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
26272@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
26273
26274@table @code
26275@findex ^done
26276@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
26277The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
26278values.
26279
26280@item "^running"
26281@findex ^running
26282This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}.  Historically, it
26283was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
26284target.  This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
26285all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
26286identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
26287which threads are resumed.
26288
26289@item "^connected"
26290@findex ^connected
26291@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
26292
26293@item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
26294@findex ^error
26295The operation failed.  The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
26296the corresponding error message.
26297
26298If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
26299code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
26300error condition.  At present, only one error code is defined:
26301
26302@table @samp
26303@item "undefined-command"
26304Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
26305@end table
26306
26307@item "^exit"
26308@findex ^exit
26309@value{GDBN} has terminated.
26310
26311@end table
26312
26313@node GDB/MI Stream Records
26314@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
26315
26316@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
26317@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26318@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
26319target, and the log.  The output intended for each of these streams is
26320funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
26321
26322Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26323identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26324Syntax}).  In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26325@code{@var{string-output}}.  This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26326line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26327
26328@table @code
26329@item "~" @var{string-output}
26330The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26331CLI console window.  It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26332
26333@item "@@" @var{string-output}
26334The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26335target.  This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26336asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26337
26338@item "&" @var{string-output}
26339The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26340internals.
26341@end table
26342
26343@node GDB/MI Async Records
26344@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26345
26346@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26347@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26348@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26349additional changes that have occurred.  Those changes can either be a
26350consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26351target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26352
26353The following is the list of possible async records:
26354
26355@table @code
26356
26357@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26358The target is now running.  The @var{thread} field can be the global
26359thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
26360@samp{all} if all threads are running.  The frontend should assume
26361that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
26362notification is produced.  The frontend should not assume that this
26363notification is output only once for any command.  @value{GDBN} may
26364emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
26365because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
26366thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
26367it run freely.
26368
26369@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26370The target has stopped.  The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26371following values:
26372
26373@table @code
26374@item breakpoint-hit
26375A breakpoint was reached.
26376@item watchpoint-trigger
26377A watchpoint was triggered.
26378@item read-watchpoint-trigger
26379A read watchpoint was triggered.
26380@item access-watchpoint-trigger
26381An access watchpoint was triggered.
26382@item function-finished
26383An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26384@item location-reached
26385An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26386@item watchpoint-scope
26387A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26388@item end-stepping-range
26389An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26390similar CLI command was accomplished.
26391@item exited-signalled
26392The inferior exited because of a signal.
26393@item exited
26394The inferior exited.
26395@item exited-normally
26396The inferior exited normally.
26397@item signal-received
26398A signal was received by the inferior.
26399@item solib-event
26400The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26401This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26402set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26403in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26404@item fork
26405The inferior has forked.  This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26406(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26407@item vfork
26408The inferior has vforked.  This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26409(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26410@item syscall-entry
26411The inferior entered a system call.  This is reported when @code{catch
26412syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26413@item syscall-return
26414The inferior returned from a system call.  This is reported when
26415@code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26416@item exec
26417The inferior called @code{exec}.  This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26418(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26419@end table
26420
26421The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
26422that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
26423Depending on whether all-stop
26424mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26425stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26426If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26427value of @code{"all"}.  Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26428field will be a list of thread identifiers.  Presently, this list will
26429always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26430several threads in the list.  The @var{core} field reports the
26431processor core on which the stop event has happened.  This field may be absent
26432if such information is not available.
26433
26434@item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26435@itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26436A thread group was either added or removed.  The @var{id} field
26437contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group.  When a thread
26438group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26439process.  When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26440cannot be used in any way.
26441
26442@item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26443A thread group became associated with a running program,
26444either because the program was just started or the thread group
26445was attached to a program.  The @var{id} field contains the
26446@value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group.  The @var{pid} field
26447contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26448
26449@item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26450A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26451either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26452from.  The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26453thread group.  The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26454only when the inferior exited with some code.
26455
26456@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26457@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26458A thread either was created, or has exited.  The @var{id} field
26459contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread.  The @var{gid}
26460field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26461
26462@item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
26463Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed.  This notification
26464is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
26465@code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
26466that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
26467changes them.  In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
26468(via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
26469will generate this notification.  Changing the thread or frame from another
26470user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
26471
26472The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
26473stopped.  See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
26474
26475We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26476highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26477that thread.
26478
26479@item =library-loaded,...
26480Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program.  This
26481notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26482@var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}.  The @var{id} field is an
26483opaque identifier of the library.  For remote debugging case,
26484@var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26485library file on the target, and on the host respectively.  For native
26486debugging, both those fields have the same value.  The
26487@var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26488and should not be relied on to convey any useful information.  The
26489@var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26490group in whose context the library was loaded.  If the field is
26491absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26492thread groups.
26493
26494@item =library-unloaded,...
26495Reports that a library was unloaded by the program.  This notification
26496has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26497the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26498The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26499thread group in whose context the library was unloaded.  If the field is
26500absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26501thread groups.
26502
26503@item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26504@itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26505Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26506@var{tfnum}.  The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26507frame is @var{tpnum}.
26508
26509@item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26510Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26511initial value @var{initial}.
26512
26513@item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26514@itemx =tsv-deleted
26515Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26516trace state variables are deleted.
26517
26518@item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26519Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26520the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26521trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26522value of trace state variable is known.
26523
26524@item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26525@itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26526@itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26527Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26528respectively.  Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26529user.
26530
26531The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26532breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}.  The
26533@var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26534
26535Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26536command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26537
26538@item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
26539@itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26540Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26541inferior.  The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26542group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26543
26544The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution.  If the
26545method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
26546and contain the currently used format.  @xref{Process Record and Replay}
26547for existing method and format values.
26548
26549@item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26550Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26551changed to @var{value}.  In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26552the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26553For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26554is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26555
26556@item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26557Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26558written in an inferior.  The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26559thread group corresponding to the affected inferior.  The optional
26560@code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26561executable code.
26562@end table
26563
26564@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26565@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26566
26567When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26568tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26569following fields:
26570
26571@table @code
26572@item number
26573The breakpoint number.  For a breakpoint that represents one location
26574of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26575@samp{1.2}.
26576
26577@item type
26578The type of the breakpoint.  For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26579@samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26580
26581@item catch-type
26582If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26583indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26584
26585@item disp
26586This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26587the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26588meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26589
26590@item enabled
26591This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26592value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26593Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26594
26595@item addr
26596The address of the breakpoint.  This may be a hexidecimal number,
26597giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26598breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26599multiple locations.  This field will not be present if no address can
26600be determined.  For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26601
26602@item func
26603If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26604If not known, this field is not present.
26605
26606@item filename
26607The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26608If not known, this field is not present.
26609
26610@item fullname
26611The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26612known.  If not known, this field is not present.
26613
26614@item line
26615The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26616If not known, this field is not present.
26617
26618@item at
26619If the source file is not known, this field may be provided.  If
26620provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26621by a symbol name.
26622
26623@item pending
26624If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26625text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26626
26627@item evaluated-by
26628Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26629@samp{target}.
26630
26631@item thread
26632If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26633thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26634
26635@item task
26636If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26637field will hold the task identifier.
26638
26639@item cond
26640If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26641
26642@item ignore
26643The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26644
26645@item enable
26646The enable count of the breakpoint.
26647
26648@item traceframe-usage
26649FIXME.
26650
26651@item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26652For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26653
26654@item mask
26655For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26656
26657@item pass
26658A tracepoint's pass count.
26659
26660@item original-location
26661The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26662This field is optional.
26663
26664@item times
26665The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26666
26667@item installed
26668This field is only given for tracepoints.  This is either @samp{y},
26669meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26670is not.
26671
26672@item what
26673Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26674
26675@end table
26676
26677For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26678(@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26679
26680@smallexample
26681-> -break-insert main
26682<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26683    enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26684    fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26685    times="0"@}
26686<- (gdb)
26687@end smallexample
26688
26689@node GDB/MI Frame Information
26690@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26691
26692Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26693frame.  This information is a tuple that may have the following
26694fields:
26695
26696@table @code
26697@item level
26698The level of the stack frame.  The innermost frame has the level of
26699zero.  This field is always present.
26700
26701@item func
26702The name of the function corresponding to the frame.  This field may
26703be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26704
26705@item addr
26706The code address for the frame.  This field is always present.
26707
26708@item file
26709The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26710address.  This field may be absent.
26711
26712@item line
26713The source line corresponding to the frames' code address.  This field
26714may be absent.
26715
26716@item from
26717The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26718corresponds to the frame's code address.  This field may be absent.
26719
26720@end table
26721
26722@node GDB/MI Thread Information
26723@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26724
26725Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26726uses a tuple with the following fields:
26727
26728@table @code
26729@item id
26730The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.  This field is
26731always present.
26732
26733@item target-id
26734Target-specific string identifying the thread.  This field is always present.
26735
26736@item details
26737Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26738It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26739frontend.  This field is optional.
26740
26741@item state
26742Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26743thread is presently running.  This field is always present.
26744
26745@item core
26746The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26747thread was last seen on.  This field is optional.
26748@end table
26749
26750@node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26751@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26752
26753Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26754stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26755@value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26756the @code{exception-name} field.
26757
26758@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26759@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26760@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26761@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26762
26763This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26764the @sc{gdb/mi} interface.  In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26765following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26766the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26767
26768Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26769readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26770
26771@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26772
26773Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26774information of the breakpoint.
26775
26776@smallexample
26777-> -break-insert main
26778<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26779    enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26780    fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26781    times="0"@}
26782<- (gdb)
26783@end smallexample
26784
26785@subheading Program Execution
26786
26787Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26788reason that execution stopped.
26789
26790@smallexample
26791-> -exec-run
26792<- ^running
26793<- (gdb)
26794<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26795   frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26796   args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26797   file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26798<- (gdb)
26799-> -exec-continue
26800<- ^running
26801<- (gdb)
26802<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26803<- (gdb)
26804@end smallexample
26805
26806@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26807
26808Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26809
26810@smallexample
26811-> (gdb)
26812<- -gdb-exit
26813<- ^exit
26814@end smallexample
26815
26816Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26817take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit.  During that time, @value{GDBN}
26818performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26819or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26820@value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26821fails to exit in reasonable time.
26822
26823@subheading A Bad Command
26824
26825Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26826
26827@smallexample
26828-> -rubbish
26829<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26830<- (gdb)
26831@end smallexample
26832
26833
26834@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26835@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26836@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26837
26838The remaining sections describe blocks of commands.  Each block of
26839commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26840
26841@subheading Motivation
26842
26843The motivation for this collection of commands.
26844
26845@subheading Introduction
26846
26847A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26848
26849@subheading Commands
26850
26851For each command in the block, the following is described:
26852
26853@subsubheading Synopsis
26854
26855@smallexample
26856 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26857@end smallexample
26858
26859@subsubheading Result
26860
26861@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26862
26863The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26864
26865@subsubheading Example
26866
26867Example(s) formatted for readability.  Some of the described commands  have
26868not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26869
26870
26871@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26872@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26873@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26874
26875@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26876@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26877This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26878breakpoints.
26879
26880@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26881@findex -break-after
26882
26883@subsubheading Synopsis
26884
26885@smallexample
26886 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26887@end smallexample
26888
26889The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26890hit @var{count} times.  To see how this is reflected in the output of
26891the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26892@samp{-break-list} command below.
26893
26894@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26895
26896The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26897
26898@subsubheading Example
26899
26900@smallexample
26901(gdb)
26902-break-insert main
26903^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26904enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26905fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26906times="0"@}
26907(gdb)
26908-break-after 1 3
26909~
26910^done
26911(gdb)
26912-break-list
26913^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26914hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26915@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26916@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26917@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26918@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26919@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26920body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26921addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26922line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26923(gdb)
26924@end smallexample
26925
26926@ignore
26927@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26928@findex -break-catch
26929@end ignore
26930
26931@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26932@findex -break-commands
26933
26934@subsubheading Synopsis
26935
26936@smallexample
26937 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26938@end smallexample
26939
26940Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26941@var{number} is hit.  The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26942are the commands.  If no command is specified, any previously-set
26943commands are cleared.  @xref{Break Commands}.  Typical use of this
26944functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26945some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26946
26947@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26948
26949The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26950
26951@subsubheading Example
26952
26953@smallexample
26954(gdb)
26955-break-insert main
26956^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26957enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26958fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26959times="0"@}
26960(gdb)
26961-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26962^done
26963(gdb)
26964@end smallexample
26965
26966@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26967@findex -break-condition
26968
26969@subsubheading Synopsis
26970
26971@smallexample
26972 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26973@end smallexample
26974
26975Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26976@var{expr} is true.  The condition becomes part of the
26977@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26978command below).
26979
26980@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26981
26982The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26983
26984@subsubheading Example
26985
26986@smallexample
26987(gdb)
26988-break-condition 1 1
26989^done
26990(gdb)
26991-break-list
26992^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26993hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26994@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26995@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26996@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26997@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26998@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26999body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27000addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27001line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27002(gdb)
27003@end smallexample
27004
27005@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27006@findex -break-delete
27007
27008@subsubheading Synopsis
27009
27010@smallexample
27011 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27012@end smallexample
27013
27014Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27015list.  This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27016
27017@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27018
27019The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27020
27021@subsubheading Example
27022
27023@smallexample
27024(gdb)
27025-break-delete 1
27026^done
27027(gdb)
27028-break-list
27029^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27030hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27031@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27032@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27033@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27034@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27035@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27036body=[]@}
27037(gdb)
27038@end smallexample
27039
27040@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27041@findex -break-disable
27042
27043@subsubheading Synopsis
27044
27045@smallexample
27046 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27047@end smallexample
27048
27049Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s).  The field @samp{enabled} in the
27050break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27051
27052@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27053
27054The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27055
27056@subsubheading Example
27057
27058@smallexample
27059(gdb)
27060-break-disable 2
27061^done
27062(gdb)
27063-break-list
27064^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27065hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27066@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27067@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27068@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27069@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27070@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27071body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27072addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27073line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27074(gdb)
27075@end smallexample
27076
27077@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27078@findex -break-enable
27079
27080@subsubheading Synopsis
27081
27082@smallexample
27083 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27084@end smallexample
27085
27086Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27087
27088@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27089
27090The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27091
27092@subsubheading Example
27093
27094@smallexample
27095(gdb)
27096-break-enable 2
27097^done
27098(gdb)
27099-break-list
27100^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27101hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27102@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27103@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27104@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27105@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27106@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27107body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27108addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27109line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27110(gdb)
27111@end smallexample
27112
27113@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27114@findex -break-info
27115
27116@subsubheading Synopsis
27117
27118@smallexample
27119 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27120@end smallexample
27121
27122@c REDUNDANT???
27123Get information about a single breakpoint.
27124
27125The result is a table of breakpoints.  @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27126Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27127table.
27128
27129@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27130
27131The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27132
27133@subsubheading Example
27134N.A.
27135
27136@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27137@findex -break-insert
27138@anchor{-break-insert}
27139
27140@subsubheading Synopsis
27141
27142@smallexample
27143 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27144    [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27145    [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27146@end smallexample
27147
27148@noindent
27149If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27150
27151@table @var
27152@item linespec location
27153A linespec location.  @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27154
27155@item explicit location
27156An explicit location.  @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27157analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27158listed below.  @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27159
27160@table @samp
27161@item --source @var{filename}
27162The source file name of the location.  This option requires the use
27163of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27164
27165@item --function @var{function}
27166The name of a function or method.
27167
27168@item --label @var{label}
27169The name of a label.
27170
27171@item --line @var{lineoffset}
27172An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27173@end table
27174
27175@item address location
27176An address location, *@var{address}.  @xref{Address Locations}.
27177@end table
27178
27179@noindent
27180The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27181
27182@table @samp
27183@item -t
27184Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27185@item -h
27186Insert a hardware breakpoint.
27187@item -f
27188If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
27189refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27190breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27191an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27192cannot be parsed.
27193@item -d
27194Create a disabled breakpoint.
27195@item -a
27196Create a tracepoint.  @xref{Tracepoints}.  When this parameter
27197is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
27198@item -c @var{condition}
27199Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27200@item -i @var{ignore-count}
27201Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
27202@item -p @var{thread-id}
27203Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27204@var{thread-id}.
27205@end table
27206
27207@subsubheading Result
27208
27209@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27210resulting breakpoint.
27211
27212Note: this format is open to change.
27213@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27214
27215@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27216
27217The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
27218@samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
27219
27220@subsubheading Example
27221
27222@smallexample
27223(gdb)
27224-break-insert main
27225^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
27226fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27227times="0"@}
27228(gdb)
27229-break-insert -t foo
27230^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
27231fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27232times="0"@}
27233(gdb)
27234-break-list
27235^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27236hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27237@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27238@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27239@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27240@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27241@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27242body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27243addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
27244fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
27245times="0"@},
27246bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27247addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
27248fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27249times="0"@}]@}
27250(gdb)
27251@c -break-insert -r foo.*
27252@c ~int foo(int, int);
27253@c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
27254@c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
27255@c times="0"@}
27256@c (gdb)
27257@end smallexample
27258
27259@subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
27260@findex -dprintf-insert
27261
27262@subsubheading Synopsis
27263
27264@smallexample
27265 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
27266    [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27267    [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
27268    [ @var{argument} ]
27269@end smallexample
27270
27271@noindent
27272If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
27273the @code{-break-insert} command.  @xref{-break-insert}.
27274
27275The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27276
27277@table @samp
27278@item -t
27279Insert a temporary breakpoint.
27280@item -f
27281If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
27282refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
27283breakpoint.  Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
27284an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
27285cannot be parsed.
27286@item -d
27287Create a disabled breakpoint.
27288@item -c @var{condition}
27289Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27290@item -i @var{ignore-count}
27291Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
27292to @var{ignore-count}.
27293@item -p @var{thread-id}
27294Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
27295@var{thread-id}.
27296@end table
27297
27298@subsubheading Result
27299
27300@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
27301resulting breakpoint.
27302
27303@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
27304
27305@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27306
27307The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
27308
27309@subsubheading Example
27310
27311@smallexample
27312(gdb)
273134-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
273144^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27315addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27316fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
27317times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
27318original-location="foo"@}
27319(gdb)
273205-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
273215^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27322addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
27323fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
27324times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
27325original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
27326(gdb)
27327@end smallexample
27328
27329@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
27330@findex -break-list
27331
27332@subsubheading Synopsis
27333
27334@smallexample
27335 -break-list
27336@end smallexample
27337
27338Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
27339
27340@table @samp
27341@item Number
27342number of the breakpoint
27343@item Type
27344type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27345@item Disposition
27346should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27347or @samp{nokeep}
27348@item Enabled
27349is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27350@item Address
27351memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27352@item What
27353logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27354name, line number
27355@item Thread-groups
27356list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27357@item Times
27358number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27359@end table
27360
27361If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27362@code{body} field is an empty list.
27363
27364@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27365
27366The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27367
27368@subsubheading Example
27369
27370@smallexample
27371(gdb)
27372-break-list
27373^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27374hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27375@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27376@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27377@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27378@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27379@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27380body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27381addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27382times="0"@},
27383bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27384addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27385line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27386(gdb)
27387@end smallexample
27388
27389Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27390
27391@smallexample
27392(gdb)
27393-break-list
27394^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27395hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27396@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27397@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27398@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27399@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27400@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27401body=[]@}
27402(gdb)
27403@end smallexample
27404
27405@subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27406@findex -break-passcount
27407
27408@subsubheading Synopsis
27409
27410@smallexample
27411 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27412@end smallexample
27413
27414Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27415@var{passcount}.  If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27416is not a tracepoint, error is emitted.  This corresponds to CLI
27417command @samp{passcount}.
27418
27419@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27420@findex -break-watch
27421
27422@subsubheading Synopsis
27423
27424@smallexample
27425 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27426@end smallexample
27427
27428Create a watchpoint.  With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27429@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27430read from or on a write to the memory location.  With the @samp{-r}
27431option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27432trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading.  Without
27433either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27434i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27435@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27436
27437Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27438breakpoints inserted.
27439
27440@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27441
27442The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27443@samp{rwatch}.
27444
27445@subsubheading Example
27446
27447Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27448
27449@smallexample
27450(gdb)
27451-break-watch x
27452^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27453(gdb)
27454-exec-continue
27455^running
27456(gdb)
27457*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27458value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27459frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27460fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27461(gdb)
27462@end smallexample
27463
27464Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function.  @value{GDBN} will stop
27465the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27466for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27467
27468@smallexample
27469(gdb)
27470-break-watch C
27471^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27472(gdb)
27473-exec-continue
27474^running
27475(gdb)
27476*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27477wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27478frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27479file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27480fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27481(gdb)
27482-exec-continue
27483^running
27484(gdb)
27485*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27486frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27487value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27488file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27489fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27490(gdb)
27491@end smallexample
27492
27493Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27494execution.  Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27495deleted.
27496
27497@smallexample
27498(gdb)
27499-break-watch C
27500^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27501(gdb)
27502-break-list
27503^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27504hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27505@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27506@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27507@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27508@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27509@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27510body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27511addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27512file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27513fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27514times="1"@},
27515bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27516enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27517(gdb)
27518-exec-continue
27519^running
27520(gdb)
27521*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27522value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27523frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27524file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27525fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27526(gdb)
27527-break-list
27528^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27529hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27530@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27531@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27532@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27533@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27534@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27535body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27536addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27537file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27538fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27539times="1"@},
27540bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27541enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27542(gdb)
27543-exec-continue
27544^running
27545^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27546frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27547value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27548file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27549fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27550(gdb)
27551-break-list
27552^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27553hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27554@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27555@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27556@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27557@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27558@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27559body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27560addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27561file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27562fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27563thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27564(gdb)
27565@end smallexample
27566
27567
27568@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27569@node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27570@section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27571
27572This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27573catchpoints.
27574
27575@menu
27576* Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27577* Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27578@end menu
27579
27580@node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27581@subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27582
27583@subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27584@findex -catch-load
27585
27586@subsubheading Synopsis
27587
27588@smallexample
27589 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27590@end smallexample
27591
27592Add a catchpoint for library load events.  If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27593the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27594Breakpoints}).  If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27595in a disabled state.  The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27596expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27597
27598
27599@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27600
27601The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27602
27603@subsubheading Example
27604
27605@smallexample
27606-catch-load -t foo.so
27607^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27608what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27609(gdb)
27610@end smallexample
27611
27612
27613@subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27614@findex -catch-unload
27615
27616@subsubheading Synopsis
27617
27618@smallexample
27619 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27620@end smallexample
27621
27622Add a catchpoint for library unload events.  If the @samp{-t} option is
27623used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27624Breakpoints}).  If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27625created in a disabled state.  The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27626expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27627
27628@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27629
27630The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27631
27632@subsubheading Example
27633
27634@smallexample
27635-catch-unload -d bar.so
27636^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27637what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27638(gdb)
27639@end smallexample
27640
27641@node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27642@subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27643
27644The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27645that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27646
27647@subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27648@findex -catch-assert
27649
27650@subsubheading Synopsis
27651
27652@smallexample
27653 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27654@end smallexample
27655
27656Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27657
27658The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27659
27660@table @samp
27661@item -c @var{condition}
27662Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27663@item -d
27664Create a disabled catchpoint.
27665@item -t
27666Create a temporary catchpoint.
27667@end table
27668
27669@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27670
27671The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27672
27673@subsubheading Example
27674
27675@smallexample
27676-catch-assert
27677^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27678enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27679thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27680original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27681(gdb)
27682@end smallexample
27683
27684@subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27685@findex -catch-exception
27686
27687@subsubheading Synopsis
27688
27689@smallexample
27690 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27691    [ -t ] [ -u ]
27692@end smallexample
27693
27694Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27695By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27696gets raised.  But it is also possible, by using some of the
27697optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27698catchpoints.
27699
27700The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27701
27702@table @samp
27703@item -c @var{condition}
27704Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27705@item -d
27706Create a disabled catchpoint.
27707@item -e @var{exception-name}
27708Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised.  This option cannot
27709be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27710@item -t
27711Create a temporary catchpoint.
27712@item -u
27713Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised.  This option
27714cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27715@end table
27716
27717@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27718
27719The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27720and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27721
27722@subsubheading Example
27723
27724@smallexample
27725-catch-exception -e Program_Error
27726^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27727enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27728what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27729times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27730(gdb)
27731@end smallexample
27732
27733@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27734@node GDB/MI Program Context
27735@section @sc{gdb/mi}  Program Context
27736
27737@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27738@findex -exec-arguments
27739
27740
27741@subsubheading Synopsis
27742
27743@smallexample
27744 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27745@end smallexample
27746
27747Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27748@samp{-exec-run}.
27749
27750@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27751
27752The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27753
27754@subsubheading Example
27755
27756@smallexample
27757(gdb)
27758-exec-arguments -v word
27759^done
27760(gdb)
27761@end smallexample
27762
27763
27764@ignore
27765@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27766@findex -exec-show-arguments
27767
27768@subsubheading Synopsis
27769
27770@smallexample
27771 -exec-show-arguments
27772@end smallexample
27773
27774Print the arguments of the program.
27775
27776@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27777
27778The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27779
27780@subsubheading Example
27781N.A.
27782@end ignore
27783
27784
27785@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27786@findex -environment-cd
27787
27788@subsubheading Synopsis
27789
27790@smallexample
27791 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27792@end smallexample
27793
27794Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27795
27796@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27797
27798The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27799
27800@subsubheading Example
27801
27802@smallexample
27803(gdb)
27804-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27805^done
27806(gdb)
27807@end smallexample
27808
27809
27810@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27811@findex -environment-directory
27812
27813@subsubheading Synopsis
27814
27815@smallexample
27816 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27817@end smallexample
27818
27819Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27820If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27821search path.  If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27822@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27823occurs as normal.
27824Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks.  Specifying
27825multiple directories in a single command
27826results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27827search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27828If blanks are needed as
27829part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27830the name.  In the command output, the path will show up separated
27831by the system directory-separator character.  The directory-separator
27832character must not be used
27833in any directory name.
27834If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27835
27836@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27837
27838The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27839
27840@subsubheading Example
27841
27842@smallexample
27843(gdb)
27844-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27845^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27846(gdb)
27847-environment-directory ""
27848^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27849(gdb)
27850-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27851^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27852(gdb)
27853-environment-directory -r
27854^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27855(gdb)
27856@end smallexample
27857
27858
27859@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27860@findex -environment-path
27861
27862@subsubheading Synopsis
27863
27864@smallexample
27865 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27866@end smallexample
27867
27868Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27869If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27870search path that existed at gdb start-up.  If directories @var{pathdir} are
27871supplied in addition to the
27872@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27873occurs as normal.
27874Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks.  Specifying
27875multiple directories in a single command
27876results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27877search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27878If blanks are needed as
27879part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27880the name.  In the command output, the path will show up separated
27881by the system directory-separator character.  The directory-separator
27882character must not be used
27883in any directory name.
27884If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27885
27886
27887@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27888
27889The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27890
27891@subsubheading Example
27892
27893@smallexample
27894(gdb)
27895-environment-path
27896^done,path="/usr/bin"
27897(gdb)
27898-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27899^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27900(gdb)
27901-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27902^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27903(gdb)
27904@end smallexample
27905
27906
27907@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27908@findex -environment-pwd
27909
27910@subsubheading Synopsis
27911
27912@smallexample
27913 -environment-pwd
27914@end smallexample
27915
27916Show the current working directory.
27917
27918@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27919
27920The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27921
27922@subsubheading Example
27923
27924@smallexample
27925(gdb)
27926-environment-pwd
27927^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27928(gdb)
27929@end smallexample
27930
27931@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27932@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27933@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27934
27935
27936@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27937@findex -thread-info
27938
27939@subsubheading Synopsis
27940
27941@smallexample
27942 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27943@end smallexample
27944
27945Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
27946@var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
27947@var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID.  When printing
27948information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
27949current thread.
27950
27951@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27952
27953The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27954about all threads.
27955
27956@subsubheading Result
27957
27958The result is a list of threads.  The following attributes are
27959defined for a given thread:
27960
27961@table @samp
27962@item current
27963This field exists only for the current thread.  It has the value @samp{*}.
27964
27965@item id
27966The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27967
27968@item target-id
27969The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27970
27971@item details
27972Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format.  This
27973field is optional.
27974
27975@item name
27976The name of the thread.  If the user specified a name using the
27977@code{thread name} command, then this name is given.  Otherwise, if
27978@value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27979name is given.  If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27980field is omitted.
27981
27982@item frame
27983The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27984
27985@item state
27986The thread's state.  The @samp{state} field may have the following
27987values:
27988
27989@table @code
27990@item stopped
27991The thread is stopped.  Frame information is available for stopped
27992threads.
27993
27994@item running
27995The thread is running.  There's no frame information for running
27996threads.
27997
27998@end table
27999
28000@item core
28001If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
28002then this field is the core identifier.  This field is optional.
28003
28004@end table
28005
28006@subsubheading Example
28007
28008@smallexample
28009-thread-info
28010^done,threads=[
28011@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28012   frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28013           args=[]@},state="running"@},
28014@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28015   frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28016           args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28017           file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28018           state="running"@}],
28019current-thread-id="1"
28020(gdb)
28021@end smallexample
28022
28023@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28024@findex -thread-list-ids
28025
28026@subsubheading Synopsis
28027
28028@smallexample
28029 -thread-list-ids
28030@end smallexample
28031
28032Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28033At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28034threads.
28035
28036This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28037@code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28038
28039@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28040
28041Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28042
28043@subsubheading Example
28044
28045@smallexample
28046(gdb)
28047-thread-list-ids
28048^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28049current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28050(gdb)
28051@end smallexample
28052
28053
28054@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28055@findex -thread-select
28056
28057@subsubheading Synopsis
28058
28059@smallexample
28060 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28061@end smallexample
28062
28063Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28064thread.  It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28065topmost frame for that thread.
28066
28067This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28068@samp{--thread} option to each command.
28069
28070@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28071
28072The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28073
28074@subsubheading Example
28075
28076@smallexample
28077(gdb)
28078-exec-next
28079^running
28080(gdb)
28081*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28082file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28083(gdb)
28084-thread-list-ids
28085^done,
28086thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28087number-of-threads="3"
28088(gdb)
28089-thread-select 3
28090^done,new-thread-id="3",
28091frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28092args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28093@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28094(gdb)
28095@end smallexample
28096
28097@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28098@node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28099@section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28100
28101@subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28102@findex -ada-task-info
28103
28104@subsubheading Synopsis
28105
28106@smallexample
28107 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28108@end smallexample
28109
28110Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28111@var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28112
28113@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28114
28115The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28116about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28117
28118@subsubheading Result
28119
28120The result is a table of Ada tasks.  The following columns are
28121defined for each Ada task:
28122
28123@table @samp
28124@item current
28125This field exists only for the current thread.  It has the value @samp{*}.
28126
28127@item id
28128The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28129
28130@item task-id
28131The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28132
28133@item thread-id
28134The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28135task.
28136
28137This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28138on top of a thread.  But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28139thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28140
28141@item parent-id
28142This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28143In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28144
28145@item priority
28146The base priority of the task.
28147
28148@item state
28149The current state of the task.  For a detailed description of the
28150possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28151
28152@item name
28153The name of the task.
28154
28155@end table
28156
28157@subsubheading Example
28158
28159@smallexample
28160-ada-task-info
28161^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28162hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28163@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28164@{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28165@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28166@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28167@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28168@{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28169@{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28170body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id="   644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28171state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
28172(gdb)
28173@end smallexample
28174
28175@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28176@node GDB/MI Program Execution
28177@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
28178
28179These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
28180record @samp{*stopped}.  Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
28181asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
28182other cases.
28183
28184@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
28185@findex -exec-continue
28186
28187@subsubheading Synopsis
28188
28189@smallexample
28190 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
28191@end smallexample
28192
28193Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
28194to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event.  If the
28195@samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
28196it reaches a stop event.  Stop events may include
28197@itemize @bullet
28198@item
28199breakpoints or watchpoints
28200@item
28201signals or exceptions
28202@item
28203the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
28204@item
28205the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
28206@end itemize
28207In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
28208Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
28209value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable.  If @samp{--all} is
28210specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed.  The @samp{--all} option is
28211ignored in all-stop mode.  If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
28212specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
28213
28214@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28215
28216The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
28217
28218@subsubheading Example
28219
28220@smallexample
28221-exec-continue
28222^running
28223(gdb)
28224@@Hello world
28225*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
28226func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
28227line="13"@}
28228(gdb)
28229@end smallexample
28230
28231
28232@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
28233@findex -exec-finish
28234
28235@subsubheading Synopsis
28236
28237@smallexample
28238 -exec-finish [--reverse]
28239@end smallexample
28240
28241Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
28242function is exited.  Displays the results returned by the function.
28243If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
28244execution of the inferior program until the point where current
28245function was called.
28246
28247@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28248
28249The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
28250
28251@subsubheading Example
28252
28253Function returning @code{void}.
28254
28255@smallexample
28256-exec-finish
28257^running
28258(gdb)
28259@@hello from foo
28260*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28261file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
28262(gdb)
28263@end smallexample
28264
28265Function returning other than @code{void}.  The name of the internal
28266@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
28267value itself.
28268
28269@smallexample
28270-exec-finish
28271^running
28272(gdb)
28273*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
28274args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
28275file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28276gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
28277(gdb)
28278@end smallexample
28279
28280
28281@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
28282@findex -exec-interrupt
28283
28284@subsubheading Synopsis
28285
28286@smallexample
28287 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
28288@end smallexample
28289
28290Interrupts the background execution of the target.  Note how the token
28291associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
28292that has been interrupted.  The token for the interrupt itself only
28293appears in the @samp{^done} output.  If the user is trying to
28294interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
28295
28296Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
28297asynchronous just like other execution commands.  That is, first the
28298@samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
28299reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
28300
28301In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
28302All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
28303@samp{--all}  option is specified.  If the @samp{--thread-group}
28304option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
28305
28306@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28307
28308The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
28309
28310@subsubheading Example
28311
28312@smallexample
28313(gdb)
28314111-exec-continue
28315111^running
28316
28317(gdb)
28318222-exec-interrupt
28319222^done
28320(gdb)
28321111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
28322frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28323fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
28324(gdb)
28325
28326(gdb)
28327-exec-interrupt
28328^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
28329(gdb)
28330@end smallexample
28331
28332@subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
28333@findex -exec-jump
28334
28335@subsubheading Synopsis
28336
28337@smallexample
28338 -exec-jump @var{location}
28339@end smallexample
28340
28341Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
28342parameter.  @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
28343different forms of @var{location}.
28344
28345@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28346
28347The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28348
28349@subsubheading Example
28350
28351@smallexample
28352-exec-jump foo.c:10
28353*running,thread-id="all"
28354^running
28355@end smallexample
28356
28357
28358@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28359@findex -exec-next
28360
28361@subsubheading Synopsis
28362
28363@smallexample
28364 -exec-next [--reverse]
28365@end smallexample
28366
28367Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28368of the next source line is reached.
28369
28370If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28371of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28372source line.  If you issue this command on the first line of a
28373function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28374source line where the function was called.
28375
28376
28377@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28378
28379The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28380
28381@subsubheading Example
28382
28383@smallexample
28384-exec-next
28385^running
28386(gdb)
28387*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28388(gdb)
28389@end smallexample
28390
28391
28392@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28393@findex -exec-next-instruction
28394
28395@subsubheading Synopsis
28396
28397@smallexample
28398 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28399@end smallexample
28400
28401Executes one machine instruction.  If the instruction is a function
28402call, continues until the function returns.  If the program stops at an
28403instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28404printed as well.
28405
28406If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28407of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction.  If the
28408previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28409it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28410(from the current stack frame) is reached.
28411
28412@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28413
28414The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28415
28416@subsubheading Example
28417
28418@smallexample
28419(gdb)
28420-exec-next-instruction
28421^running
28422
28423(gdb)
28424*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28425addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28426(gdb)
28427@end smallexample
28428
28429
28430@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28431@findex -exec-return
28432
28433@subsubheading Synopsis
28434
28435@smallexample
28436 -exec-return
28437@end smallexample
28438
28439Makes current function return immediately.  Doesn't execute the inferior.
28440Displays the new current frame.
28441
28442@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28443
28444The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28445
28446@subsubheading Example
28447
28448@smallexample
28449(gdb)
28450200-break-insert callee4
28451200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28452file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28453(gdb)
28454000-exec-run
28455000^running
28456(gdb)
28457000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28458frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28459file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28460fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28461(gdb)
28462205-break-delete
28463205^done
28464(gdb)
28465111-exec-return
28466111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28467args=[@{name="strarg",
28468value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28469file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28470fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28471(gdb)
28472@end smallexample
28473
28474
28475@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28476@findex -exec-run
28477
28478@subsubheading Synopsis
28479
28480@smallexample
28481 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28482@end smallexample
28483
28484Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning.  The inferior
28485executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28486exits.  In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28487the program has exited exceptionally.
28488
28489When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28490is specified, the current inferior is started.  If the
28491@samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28492group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28493If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28494
28495Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28496the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28497following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28498(@pxref{Starting}).
28499
28500@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28501
28502The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28503
28504@subsubheading Examples
28505
28506@smallexample
28507(gdb)
28508-break-insert main
28509^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28510(gdb)
28511-exec-run
28512^running
28513(gdb)
28514*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28515frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28516fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28517(gdb)
28518@end smallexample
28519
28520@noindent
28521Program exited normally:
28522
28523@smallexample
28524(gdb)
28525-exec-run
28526^running
28527(gdb)
28528x = 55
28529*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28530(gdb)
28531@end smallexample
28532
28533@noindent
28534Program exited exceptionally:
28535
28536@smallexample
28537(gdb)
28538-exec-run
28539^running
28540(gdb)
28541x = 55
28542*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28543(gdb)
28544@end smallexample
28545
28546Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28547@code{SIGINT}.  In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28548
28549@smallexample
28550(gdb)
28551*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28552signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28553@end smallexample
28554
28555
28556@c @subheading -exec-signal
28557
28558
28559@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28560@findex -exec-step
28561
28562@subsubheading Synopsis
28563
28564@smallexample
28565 -exec-step [--reverse]
28566@end smallexample
28567
28568Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28569of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28570function call.  If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28571function.  If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28572execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28573previously executed source line.
28574
28575@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28576
28577The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28578
28579@subsubheading Example
28580
28581Stepping into a function:
28582
28583@smallexample
28584-exec-step
28585^running
28586(gdb)
28587*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28588frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28589@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28590fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28591(gdb)
28592@end smallexample
28593
28594Regular stepping:
28595
28596@smallexample
28597-exec-step
28598^running
28599(gdb)
28600*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28601(gdb)
28602@end smallexample
28603
28604
28605@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28606@findex -exec-step-instruction
28607
28608@subsubheading Synopsis
28609
28610@smallexample
28611 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28612@end smallexample
28613
28614Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction.  If the
28615@samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28616inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28617The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28618whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not.  In the
28619former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28620as well.
28621
28622@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28623
28624The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28625
28626@subsubheading Example
28627
28628@smallexample
28629(gdb)
28630-exec-step-instruction
28631^running
28632
28633(gdb)
28634*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28635frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28636fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28637(gdb)
28638-exec-step-instruction
28639^running
28640
28641(gdb)
28642*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28643frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28644fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28645(gdb)
28646@end smallexample
28647
28648
28649@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28650@findex -exec-until
28651
28652@subsubheading Synopsis
28653
28654@smallexample
28655 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28656@end smallexample
28657
28658Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28659argument is reached.  If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28660until a source line greater than the current one is reached.  The
28661reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28662
28663@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28664
28665The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28666
28667@subsubheading Example
28668
28669@smallexample
28670(gdb)
28671-exec-until recursive2.c:6
28672^running
28673(gdb)
28674x = 55
28675*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28676file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28677(gdb)
28678@end smallexample
28679
28680@ignore
28681@subheading -file-clear
28682Is this going away????
28683@end ignore
28684
28685@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28686@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28687@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28688
28689@subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28690@findex -enable-frame-filters
28691
28692@smallexample
28693-enable-frame-filters
28694@end smallexample
28695
28696@value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28697the MI commands relating to stack traces.  As there is no way to
28698implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28699request that this functionality be enabled.
28700
28701Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28702
28703Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28704this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28705
28706@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28707@findex -stack-info-frame
28708
28709@subsubheading Synopsis
28710
28711@smallexample
28712 -stack-info-frame
28713@end smallexample
28714
28715Get info on the selected frame.
28716
28717@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28718
28719The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28720(without arguments).
28721
28722@subsubheading Example
28723
28724@smallexample
28725(gdb)
28726-stack-info-frame
28727^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28728file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28729fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28730(gdb)
28731@end smallexample
28732
28733@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28734@findex -stack-info-depth
28735
28736@subsubheading Synopsis
28737
28738@smallexample
28739 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28740@end smallexample
28741
28742Return the depth of the stack.  If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28743is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28744
28745@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28746
28747There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28748
28749@subsubheading Example
28750
28751For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28752
28753@smallexample
28754(gdb)
28755-stack-info-depth
28756^done,depth="12"
28757(gdb)
28758-stack-info-depth 4
28759^done,depth="4"
28760(gdb)
28761-stack-info-depth 12
28762^done,depth="12"
28763(gdb)
28764-stack-info-depth 11
28765^done,depth="11"
28766(gdb)
28767-stack-info-depth 13
28768^done,depth="12"
28769(gdb)
28770@end smallexample
28771
28772@anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28773@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28774@findex -stack-list-arguments
28775
28776@subsubheading Synopsis
28777
28778@smallexample
28779 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28780    [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28781@end smallexample
28782
28783Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28784and @var{high-frame} (inclusive).  If @var{low-frame} and
28785@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28786call stack.  If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28787at the corresponding level.  It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28788larger than the actual number of frames.  On the other hand,
28789@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28790which case only existing frames will be returned.
28791
28792If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28793the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28794values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28795type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28796structures and unions.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28797supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28798
28799If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28800are not available are not listed.  Partially available arguments
28801are still displayed, however.
28802
28803Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28804deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28805
28806@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28807
28808@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command.  @code{gdbtk} has a
28809@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28810functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28811
28812@subsubheading Example
28813
28814@smallexample
28815(gdb)
28816-stack-list-frames
28817^done,
28818stack=[
28819frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28820file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28821fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28822frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28823file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28824fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28825frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28826file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28827fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28828frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28829file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28830fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28831frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28832file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28833fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28834(gdb)
28835-stack-list-arguments 0
28836^done,
28837stack-args=[
28838frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28839frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28840frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28841frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28842frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28843(gdb)
28844-stack-list-arguments 1
28845^done,
28846stack-args=[
28847frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28848frame=@{level="1",
28849 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28850frame=@{level="2",args=[
28851@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28852@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28853@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28854@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28855@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28856@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28857frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28858(gdb)
28859-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28860^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28861(gdb)
28862-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28863^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28864args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28865@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28866(gdb)
28867@end smallexample
28868
28869@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28870
28871
28872@anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28873@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28874@findex -stack-list-frames
28875
28876@subsubheading Synopsis
28877
28878@smallexample
28879 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28880@end smallexample
28881
28882List the frames currently on the stack.  For each frame it displays the
28883following info:
28884
28885@table @samp
28886@item @var{level}
28887The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28888@item @var{addr}
28889The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28890@item @var{func}
28891Function name.
28892@item @var{file}
28893File name of the source file where the function lives.
28894@item @var{fullname}
28895The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28896@item @var{line}
28897Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28898@item @var{from}
28899The shared library where this function is defined.  This is only given
28900if the frame's function is not known.
28901@end table
28902
28903If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28904whole stack.  If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28905levels are between the two arguments (inclusive).  If the two arguments
28906are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.  It is
28907an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28908frames.  On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28909actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28910returned.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28911Python frame filters will not be executed.
28912
28913@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28914
28915The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28916
28917@subsubheading Example
28918
28919Full stack backtrace:
28920
28921@smallexample
28922(gdb)
28923-stack-list-frames
28924^done,stack=
28925[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28926  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28927frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28928  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28929frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28930  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28931frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28932  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28933frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28934  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28935frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28936  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28937frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28938  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28939frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28940  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28941frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28942  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28943frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28944  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28945frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28946  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28947frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28948  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28949(gdb)
28950@end smallexample
28951
28952Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28953
28954@smallexample
28955(gdb)
28956-stack-list-frames 3 5
28957^done,stack=
28958[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28959  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28960frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28961  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28962frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28963  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28964(gdb)
28965@end smallexample
28966
28967Show a single frame:
28968
28969@smallexample
28970(gdb)
28971-stack-list-frames 3 3
28972^done,stack=
28973[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28974  file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28975(gdb)
28976@end smallexample
28977
28978
28979@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28980@findex -stack-list-locals
28981@anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28982
28983@subsubheading Synopsis
28984
28985@smallexample
28986 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28987@end smallexample
28988
28989Display the local variable names for the selected frame.  If
28990@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28991the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28992values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28993type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28994structures and unions.  In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28995display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28996other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28997more detail.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28998Python frame filters will not be executed.
28999
29000If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29001that are not available are not listed.  Partially available local
29002variables are still displayed, however.
29003
29004This command is deprecated in favor of the
29005@samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29006
29007@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29008
29009@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29010
29011@subsubheading Example
29012
29013@smallexample
29014(gdb)
29015-stack-list-locals 0
29016^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29017(gdb)
29018-stack-list-locals --all-values
29019^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29020  @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29021-stack-list-locals --simple-values
29022^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29023  @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29024(gdb)
29025@end smallexample
29026
29027@anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29028@subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29029@findex -stack-list-variables
29030
29031@subsubheading Synopsis
29032
29033@smallexample
29034 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29035@end smallexample
29036
29037Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame.  If
29038@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29039the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29040values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29041type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29042structures and unions.  If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29043supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29044
29045If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29046and arguments that are not available are not listed.  Partially
29047available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29048
29049@subsubheading Example
29050
29051@smallexample
29052(gdb)
29053-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29054^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29055(gdb)
29056@end smallexample
29057
29058
29059@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29060@findex -stack-select-frame
29061
29062@subsubheading Synopsis
29063
29064@smallexample
29065 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29066@end smallexample
29067
29068Change the selected frame.  Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29069the stack.
29070
29071This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29072option to every command.
29073
29074@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29075
29076The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29077@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29078
29079@subsubheading Example
29080
29081@smallexample
29082(gdb)
29083-stack-select-frame 2
29084^done
29085(gdb)
29086@end smallexample
29087
29088@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29089@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29090@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29091
29092@ignore
29093
29094@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29095
29096For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29097expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29098used by @code{Insight}.
29099
29100The two main reasons for that are:
29101
29102@enumerate 1
29103@item
29104It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29105
29106@item
29107It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29108now).
29109@end enumerate
29110
29111The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29112slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}.  This section
29113describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29114hints about their use.
29115
29116@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29117expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29118least, the following operations:
29119
29120@itemize @bullet
29121@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29122@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29123@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29124@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29125@end itemize
29126
29127@end ignore
29128
29129@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29130
29131@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29132
29133Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29134changing values of expressions.  Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29135work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29136simple and efficient presentation in the frontend.  A variable object
29137is identified by string name.  When a variable object is created, the
29138frontend specifies the expression for that variable object.  The
29139expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29140expression, and can even involve CPU registers.  After creating a
29141variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29142operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29143object, or to change display format.
29144
29145Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure.  Any variable object
29146that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29147a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29148element of a structure.  A child variable object can itself have
29149children, recursively.  Recursion ends when we reach
29150leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types.  Child variable
29151objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29152is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29153child will be created.
29154
29155For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29156string, or set the value from a string.  String value can be also
29157obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29158that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29159contents.  Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29160
29161A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29162the program stops.  Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29163variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29164operation.  This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29165be transferred to the frontend.  As noted above, children variable
29166objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29167real value.  As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29168variables that frontend has created.
29169
29170The automatic update is not always desirable.  For example, a frontend
29171might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
29172and never update it.  For another example,  fetching memory is
29173relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
29174to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
29175visible on the screen, or ``closed''.  This is possible using so
29176called ``frozen variable objects''.  Such variable objects are never
29177implicitly updated.
29178
29179Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}.  For the
29180fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
29181object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
29182variables.  The meaning of expression never changes.  For a floating
29183variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
29184expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
29185frame.  Consider this example:
29186
29187@smallexample
29188void do_work(...)
29189@{
29190        struct work_state state;
29191
29192        if (...)
29193           do_work(...);
29194@}
29195@end smallexample
29196
29197If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
29198this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
29199object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
29200@code{do_work} invocation.  On the other hand, a floating variable
29201object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
29202
29203If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
29204refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
29205thread and frame in which the variable object is created.  When such
29206variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
29207thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
29208and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
29209
29210The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
29211access this functionality:
29212
29213@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
29214@item @strong{Operation}
29215@tab @strong{Description}
29216
29217@item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
29218@tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
29219@item @code{-var-create}
29220@tab create a variable object
29221@item @code{-var-delete}
29222@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
29223@item @code{-var-set-format}
29224@tab set the display format of this variable
29225@item @code{-var-show-format}
29226@tab show the display format of this variable
29227@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
29228@tab tells how many children this object has
29229@item @code{-var-list-children}
29230@tab return a list of the object's children
29231@item @code{-var-info-type}
29232@tab show the type of this variable object
29233@item @code{-var-info-expression}
29234@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
29235@item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
29236@tab print full expression that this variable object represents
29237@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
29238@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
29239@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
29240@tab get the value of this variable
29241@item @code{-var-assign}
29242@tab set the value of this variable
29243@item @code{-var-update}
29244@tab update the variable and its children
29245@item @code{-var-set-frozen}
29246@tab set frozeness attribute
29247@item @code{-var-set-update-range}
29248@tab set range of children to display on update
29249@end multitable
29250
29251In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
29252how it can be used.
29253
29254@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
29255
29256@subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
29257@findex -enable-pretty-printing
29258
29259@smallexample
29260-enable-pretty-printing
29261@end smallexample
29262
29263@value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
29264MI variable object commands.  However, because there was no way to
29265implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29266request that this functionality be enabled.
29267
29268Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29269
29270Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29271this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29272
29273This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
29274may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
29275
29276@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
29277@findex -var-create
29278
29279@subsubheading Synopsis
29280
29281@smallexample
29282 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
29283    @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
29284@end smallexample
29285
29286This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
29287a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
29288register.
29289
29290The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
29291referenced.  It must be unique.  If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
29292system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically.  It will be
29293unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
29294The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
29295
29296The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
29297specified by @var{frame-addr}.  A @samp{*} indicates that the current
29298frame should be used.  A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
29299object must be created.
29300
29301@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
29302begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
29303
29304@itemize @bullet
29305@item
29306@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
29307
29308@item
29309@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
29310
29311@item
29312@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
29313@end itemize
29314
29315@cindex dynamic varobj
29316A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer.  In this
29317case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}.  Dynamic varobjs
29318have slightly different semantics in some cases.  If the
29319@code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
29320will never create a dynamic varobj.  This ensures backward
29321compatibility for existing clients.
29322
29323@subsubheading Result
29324
29325This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj.  These
29326are:
29327
29328@table @samp
29329@item name
29330The name of the varobj.
29331
29332@item numchild
29333The number of children of the varobj.  This number is not necessarily
29334reliable for a dynamic varobj.  Instead, you must examine the
29335@samp{has_more} attribute.
29336
29337@item value
29338The varobj's scalar value.  For a varobj whose type is some sort of
29339aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
29340will not be interesting.
29341
29342@item type
29343The varobj's type.  This is a string representation of the type, as
29344would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.  If @samp{print object}
29345(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29346@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29347@emph{declared} one.
29348
29349@item thread-id
29350If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29351thread's global identifier.
29352
29353@item has_more
29354For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29355children available.  For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29356
29357@item dynamic
29358This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29359varobj is a dynamic varobj.  If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29360then this attribute will not be present.
29361
29362@item displayhint
29363A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end.  The
29364value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29365@code{display_hint} method.  @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29366@end table
29367
29368Typical output will look like this:
29369
29370@smallexample
29371 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29372  has_more="@var{has_more}"
29373@end smallexample
29374
29375
29376@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29377@findex -var-delete
29378
29379@subsubheading Synopsis
29380
29381@smallexample
29382 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29383@end smallexample
29384
29385Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29386With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29387
29388Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29389
29390
29391@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29392@findex -var-set-format
29393
29394@subsubheading Synopsis
29395
29396@smallexample
29397 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29398@end smallexample
29399
29400Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29401@var{format-spec}.
29402
29403@anchor{-var-set-format}
29404The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29405
29406@smallexample
29407 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29408 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29409@end smallexample
29410
29411The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29412based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29413for pointers, etc.).
29414
29415The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29416but with padding zeroes to the left of the value.  For example, a 32-bit
29417hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29418zero-hexadecimal format.
29419
29420For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29421variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29422
29423@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29424@findex -var-show-format
29425
29426@subsubheading Synopsis
29427
29428@smallexample
29429 -var-show-format @var{name}
29430@end smallexample
29431
29432Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29433
29434@smallexample
29435 @var{format} @expansion{}
29436 @var{format-spec}
29437@end smallexample
29438
29439
29440@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29441@findex -var-info-num-children
29442
29443@subsubheading Synopsis
29444
29445@smallexample
29446 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29447@end smallexample
29448
29449Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29450
29451@smallexample
29452 numchild=@var{n}
29453@end smallexample
29454
29455Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29456It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29457be available.
29458
29459
29460@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29461@findex -var-list-children
29462
29463@subsubheading Synopsis
29464
29465@smallexample
29466 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29467@end smallexample
29468@anchor{-var-list-children}
29469
29470Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29471create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist.  With
29472a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29473@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29474@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29475values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29476value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29477and unions.
29478
29479@var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29480to report.  If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29481reset and all children will be reported.  Otherwise, children starting
29482at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29483reported.
29484
29485If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29486@code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29487For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}.  The
29488intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29489update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29490front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29491then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29492different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29493the visible items.
29494
29495For each child the following results are returned:
29496
29497@table @var
29498
29499@item name
29500Name of the variable object created for this child.
29501
29502@item exp
29503The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29504For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29505
29506For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29507expression.  There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29508
29509For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29510designate access qualifiers.  For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29511@samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}.  In this case the
29512type and value are not present.
29513
29514A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29515pseudo-children, regardless of the language.  This information is not
29516available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29517
29518@item numchild
29519Number of children this child has.  For a dynamic varobj, this will be
295200.
29521
29522@item type
29523The type of the child.  If @samp{print object}
29524(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29525@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29526@emph{declared} one.
29527
29528@item value
29529If values were requested, this is the value.
29530
29531@item thread-id
29532If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
29533thread's global thread id.  Otherwise this result is not present.
29534
29535@item frozen
29536If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29537
29538@item displayhint
29539A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end.  The
29540value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29541@code{display_hint} method.  @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29542
29543@item dynamic
29544This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29545varobj is a dynamic varobj.  If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29546then this attribute will not be present.
29547
29548@end table
29549
29550The result may have its own attributes:
29551
29552@table @samp
29553@item displayhint
29554A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end.  The
29555value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29556@code{display_hint} method.  @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29557
29558@item has_more
29559This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29560remaining after the end of the selected range.
29561@end table
29562
29563@subsubheading Example
29564
29565@smallexample
29566(gdb)
29567 -var-list-children n
29568 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29569 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29570(gdb)
29571 -var-list-children --all-values n
29572 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29573 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29574@end smallexample
29575
29576
29577@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29578@findex -var-info-type
29579
29580@subsubheading Synopsis
29581
29582@smallexample
29583 -var-info-type @var{name}
29584@end smallexample
29585
29586Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}.  The type is
29587returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29588@value{GDBN} CLI:
29589
29590@smallexample
29591 type=@var{typename}
29592@end smallexample
29593
29594
29595@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29596@findex -var-info-expression
29597
29598@subsubheading Synopsis
29599
29600@smallexample
29601 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29602@end smallexample
29603
29604Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29605variable object in user interface.  The string is generally
29606not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29607
29608For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29609@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29610
29611@smallexample
29612(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29613^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29614@end smallexample
29615
29616@noindent
29617Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29618found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29619
29620Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29621includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29622is of limited use.
29623
29624@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29625@findex -var-info-path-expression
29626
29627@subsubheading Synopsis
29628
29629@smallexample
29630 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29631@end smallexample
29632
29633Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29634context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29635Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29636result can be used only for UI presentation.  Typical use of
29637the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29638watchpoint from a variable object.
29639
29640This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29641and will give an error when invoked on one.
29642
29643For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29644@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29645@code{m_size}.  Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29646@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29647@code{c}.  Then, we'll get this output:
29648@smallexample
29649(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29650^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29651@end smallexample
29652
29653@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29654@findex -var-show-attributes
29655
29656@subsubheading Synopsis
29657
29658@smallexample
29659 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29660@end smallexample
29661
29662List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29663
29664@smallexample
29665 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29666@end smallexample
29667
29668@noindent
29669where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29670
29671@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29672@findex -var-evaluate-expression
29673
29674@subsubheading Synopsis
29675
29676@smallexample
29677 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29678@end smallexample
29679
29680Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29681object and returns its value as a string.  The format of the string
29682can be specified with the @samp{-f} option.  The possible values of
29683this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29684(@pxref{-var-set-format}).  If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29685the current display format will be used.  The current display format
29686can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29687
29688@smallexample
29689 value=@var{value}
29690@end smallexample
29691
29692Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29693before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29694
29695@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29696@findex -var-assign
29697
29698@subsubheading Synopsis
29699
29700@smallexample
29701 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29702@end smallexample
29703
29704Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29705by @var{name}.  The object must be @samp{editable}.  If the variable's
29706value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29707subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29708
29709@subsubheading Example
29710
29711@smallexample
29712(gdb)
29713-var-assign var1 3
29714^done,value="3"
29715(gdb)
29716-var-update *
29717^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29718(gdb)
29719@end smallexample
29720
29721@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29722@findex -var-update
29723
29724@subsubheading Synopsis
29725
29726@smallexample
29727 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29728@end smallexample
29729
29730Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29731@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29732list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29733be a root variable object.  Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29734@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29735@code{-var-update} is different.  If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29736object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29737for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}).  The option
29738@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29739names are printed.  The possible values of this option are the same
29740as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).  It is
29741recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29742number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29743
29744With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29745currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29746diagnostic.
29747
29748If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29749only the selected range of children will be reported.
29750
29751@code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29752@samp{changelist}.
29753
29754Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29755
29756@table @samp
29757@item name
29758The name of the varobj.
29759
29760@item value
29761If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29762present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29763
29764@item in_scope
29765@anchor{-var-update}
29766This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29767
29768@table @code
29769@item "true"
29770The variable object's current value is valid.
29771
29772@item "false"
29773The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29774hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29775scope.
29776
29777@item "invalid"
29778The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29779This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29780either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29781command.  The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29782objects.
29783@end table
29784
29785In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29786be prepared for this possibility.  @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29787
29788@item type_changed
29789This is only present if the varobj is still valid.  If the type
29790changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29791be @samp{false}.
29792
29793When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29794become incorrect.  Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29795deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}.  Also, the varobj's update
29796range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29797unset.
29798
29799@item new_type
29800If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29801hold the new type.
29802
29803@item new_num_children
29804For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29805type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29806
29807The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29808valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29809@value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29810instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29811children which may be available.
29812
29813The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29814number of children known by @value{GDBN}.  This is the only way to
29815detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29816only happen at the end of the update range).
29817
29818@item displayhint
29819The display hint, if any.
29820
29821@item has_more
29822This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29823available outside the varobj's update range.
29824
29825@item dynamic
29826This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29827varobj is a dynamic varobj.  If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29828then this attribute will not be present.
29829
29830@item new_children
29831If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29832update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29833be listed in this attribute.
29834@end table
29835
29836@subsubheading Example
29837
29838@smallexample
29839(gdb)
29840-var-assign var1 3
29841^done,value="3"
29842(gdb)
29843-var-update --all-values var1
29844^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29845type_changed="false"@}]
29846(gdb)
29847@end smallexample
29848
29849@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29850@findex -var-set-frozen
29851@anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29852
29853@subsubheading Synopsis
29854
29855@smallexample
29856 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29857@end smallexample
29858
29859Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}.  The
29860@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29861frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen.  If a variable object is
29862frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29863implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29864a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}.  Only
29865@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29866values of its children.  After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29867implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29868Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29869@code{-var-update} does.
29870
29871@subsubheading Example
29872
29873@smallexample
29874(gdb)
29875-var-set-frozen V 1
29876^done
29877(gdb)
29878@end smallexample
29879
29880@subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29881@findex -var-set-update-range
29882@anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29883
29884@subsubheading Synopsis
29885
29886@smallexample
29887 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29888@end smallexample
29889
29890Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29891@code{-var-update}.
29892
29893@var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report.  If
29894@var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29895children will be reported.  Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29896(zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29897
29898@subsubheading Example
29899
29900@smallexample
29901(gdb)
29902-var-set-update-range V 1 2
29903^done
29904@end smallexample
29905
29906@subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29907@findex -var-set-visualizer
29908@anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29909
29910@subsubheading Synopsis
29911
29912@smallexample
29913 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29914@end smallexample
29915
29916Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29917
29918@var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use.  The special value
29919@samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29920
29921If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29922This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29923single argument.  @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29924the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29925Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29926When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29927pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29928
29929The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29930select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29931(@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}).  This is done automatically when
29932a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29933
29934This feature is only available if Python support is enabled.  The MI
29935command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29936can be used to check this.
29937
29938@subsubheading Example
29939
29940Resetting the visualizer:
29941
29942@smallexample
29943(gdb)
29944-var-set-visualizer V None
29945^done
29946@end smallexample
29947
29948Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29949
29950@smallexample
29951(gdb)
29952-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29953^done
29954@end smallexample
29955
29956Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class.  A lambda expression
29957can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29958
29959@smallexample
29960(gdb)
29961-var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29962^done
29963@end smallexample
29964
29965@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29966@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29967@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29968
29969@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29970@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29971This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29972examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29973
29974For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29975@pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29976
29977@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29978@c @subheading -data-assign
29979@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29980@c @subsubheading GDB Command
29981@c set variable
29982@c @subsubheading Example
29983@c N.A.
29984
29985@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29986@findex -data-disassemble
29987
29988@subsubheading Synopsis
29989
29990@smallexample
29991 -data-disassemble
29992    [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29993  | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29994  -- @var{mode}
29995@end smallexample
29996
29997@noindent
29998Where:
29999
30000@table @samp
30001@item @var{start-addr}
30002is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30003@item @var{end-addr}
30004is the end address
30005@item @var{filename}
30006is the name of the file to disassemble
30007@item @var{linenum}
30008is the line number to disassemble around
30009@item @var{lines}
30010is the number of disassembly lines to be produced.  If it is -1,
30011the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30012specified.  If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30013@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30014@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30015displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30016@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30017are displayed.
30018@item @var{mode}
30019is one of:
30020@itemize @bullet
30021@item 0 disassembly only
30022@item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30023@item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30024@item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30025@item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30026@item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30027@end itemize
30028
30029Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated.  The output is ``source centric''
30030which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30031@xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30032@code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30033@end table
30034
30035@subsubheading Result
30036
30037The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30038@samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30039used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30040
30041For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30042following fields:
30043
30044@table @code
30045@item address
30046The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30047
30048@item func-name
30049The name of the function this instruction is within.
30050
30051@item offset
30052The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30053
30054@item inst
30055The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30056
30057@item opcodes
30058This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5.  This contains the raw opcode
30059bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30060
30061@end table
30062
30063For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30064@samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30065
30066@table @code
30067@item line
30068The line number within @samp{file}.
30069
30070@item file
30071The file name from the compilation unit.  This might be an absolute
30072file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30073used.
30074
30075@item fullname
30076Absolute file name of @samp{file}.  It is converted to a canonical form
30077using the source file search path
30078(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30079and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30080
30081If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30082present in the debug information.
30083
30084@item line_asm_insn
30085This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30086@samp{file}.  The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30087@code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30088@samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30089@samp{opcodes}.
30090
30091@end table
30092
30093Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30094manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30095adjust its format.
30096
30097@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30098
30099The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30100
30101@subsubheading Example
30102
30103Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30104
30105@smallexample
30106(gdb)
30107-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30108^done,
30109asm_insns=[
30110@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30111inst="mov  2, %o0"@},
30112@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30113inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30114@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30115inst="or  %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30116@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30117inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30118@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30119inst="or  %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30120(gdb)
30121@end smallexample
30122
30123Disassemble the whole @code{main} function.  Line 32 is part of
30124@code{main}.
30125
30126@smallexample
30127-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30128^done,asm_insns=[
30129@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30130inst="save  %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30131@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30132inst="mov   2, %o0"@},
30133@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30134inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30135[@dots{}]
30136@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30137@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30138(gdb)
30139@end smallexample
30140
30141Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30142
30143@smallexample
30144(gdb)
30145-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30146^done,asm_insns=[
30147@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30148inst="save  %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30149@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30150inst="mov  2, %o0"@},
30151@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30152inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30153(gdb)
30154@end smallexample
30155
30156Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30157
30158@smallexample
30159(gdb)
30160-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30161^done,asm_insns=[
30162src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30163file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30164fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30165line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30166func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save  %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30167src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30168file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30169fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30170line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30171func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov  2, %o0"@},
30172@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30173inst="sethi  %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
30174(gdb)
30175@end smallexample
30176
30177
30178@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
30179@findex -data-evaluate-expression
30180
30181@subsubheading Synopsis
30182
30183@smallexample
30184 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
30185@end smallexample
30186
30187Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression.  The expression could contain an
30188inferior function call.  The function call will execute synchronously.
30189If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
30190
30191@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30192
30193The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
30194@samp{call}.  In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
30195@samp{gdb_eval} command.
30196
30197@subsubheading Example
30198
30199In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
30200@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
30201Command Syntax}.  Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
30202output.
30203
30204@smallexample
30205211-data-evaluate-expression A
30206211^done,value="1"
30207(gdb)
30208311-data-evaluate-expression &A
30209311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
30210(gdb)
30211411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
30212411^done,value="4"
30213(gdb)
30214511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
30215511^done,value="4"
30216(gdb)
30217@end smallexample
30218
30219
30220@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
30221@findex -data-list-changed-registers
30222
30223@subsubheading Synopsis
30224
30225@smallexample
30226 -data-list-changed-registers
30227@end smallexample
30228
30229Display a list of the registers that have changed.
30230
30231@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30232
30233@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
30234has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
30235
30236@subsubheading Example
30237
30238On a PPC MBX board:
30239
30240@smallexample
30241(gdb)
30242-exec-continue
30243^running
30244
30245(gdb)
30246*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
30247func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
30248line="5"@}
30249(gdb)
30250-data-list-changed-registers
30251^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
30252"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
30253"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
30254(gdb)
30255@end smallexample
30256
30257
30258@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
30259@findex -data-list-register-names
30260
30261@subsubheading Synopsis
30262
30263@smallexample
30264 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
30265@end smallexample
30266
30267Show a list of register names for the current target.  If no arguments
30268are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers.  If
30269integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
30270names of the registers corresponding to the arguments.  To ensure
30271consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
30272include empty register names.
30273
30274@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30275
30276@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
30277@samp{-data-list-register-names}.  In @code{gdbtk} there is a
30278corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
30279
30280@subsubheading Example
30281
30282For the PPC MBX board:
30283@smallexample
30284(gdb)
30285-data-list-register-names
30286^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
30287"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
30288"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
30289"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
30290"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
30291"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
30292"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
30293(gdb)
30294-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
30295^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
30296(gdb)
30297@end smallexample
30298
30299@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
30300@findex -data-list-register-values
30301
30302@subsubheading Synopsis
30303
30304@smallexample
30305 -data-list-register-values
30306    [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
30307@end smallexample
30308
30309Display the registers' contents.  The format according to which the
30310registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
30311by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display.  A
30312missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
30313registers must be returned.  The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
30314indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
30315
30316Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
30317
30318@table @code
30319@item x
30320Hexadecimal
30321@item o
30322Octal
30323@item t
30324Binary
30325@item d
30326Decimal
30327@item r
30328Raw
30329@item N
30330Natural
30331@end table
30332
30333@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30334
30335The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
30336all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
30337
30338@subsubheading Example
30339
30340For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
30341don't appear in the actual output):
30342
30343@smallexample
30344(gdb)
30345-data-list-register-values r 64 65
30346^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30347@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30348(gdb)
30349-data-list-register-values x
30350^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30351@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30352@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30353@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30354@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30355@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30356@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30357@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30358@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30359@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30360@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30361@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30362@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30363@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30364@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30365@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30366@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30367@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30368@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30369@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30370@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30371@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30372@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30373@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30374@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30375@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30376@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30377@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30378@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30379@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30380@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30381@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30382@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30383@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30384@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30385@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30386(gdb)
30387@end smallexample
30388
30389
30390@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30391@findex -data-read-memory
30392
30393This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30394
30395@subsubheading Synopsis
30396
30397@smallexample
30398 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30399   @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30400   @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30401@end smallexample
30402
30403@noindent
30404where:
30405
30406@table @samp
30407@item @var{address}
30408An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30409read.  Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30410quoted using the C convention.
30411
30412@item @var{word-format}
30413The format to be used to print the memory words.  The notation is the
30414same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30415,Output Formats}).
30416
30417@item @var{word-size}
30418The size of each memory word in bytes.
30419
30420@item @var{nr-rows}
30421The number of rows in the output table.
30422
30423@item @var{nr-cols}
30424The number of columns in the output table.
30425
30426@item @var{aschar}
30427If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump.  The
30428value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30429member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30430characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30431
30432@item @var{byte-offset}
30433An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30434@end table
30435
30436This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30437@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes.  In total,
30438@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30439(returned as @samp{total-bytes}).  Should less than the requested number
30440of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30441using @samp{N/A}.  The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30442in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30443@samp{addr}.
30444
30445The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30446@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30447@samp{prev-page}.
30448
30449@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30450
30451The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.  @code{gdbtk} has
30452@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30453
30454@subsubheading Example
30455
30456Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30457@code{-6} bytes.  Format as three rows of two columns.  One byte per
30458word.  Display each word in hex.
30459
30460@smallexample
30461(gdb)
304629-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
304639^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30464next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30465prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30466@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30467@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30468@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30469(gdb)
30470@end smallexample
30471
30472Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30473display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30474
30475@smallexample
30476(gdb)
304775-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
304785^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30479next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30480next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30481@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30482(gdb)
30483@end smallexample
30484
30485Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30486as eight rows of four columns.  Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30487used as the non-printable character.
30488
30489@smallexample
30490(gdb)
304914-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
304924^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30493next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30494next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30495@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30496@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30497@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30498@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30499@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30500@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30501@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30502@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30503(gdb)
30504@end smallexample
30505
30506@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30507@findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30508
30509@subsubheading Synopsis
30510
30511@smallexample
30512 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30513   @var{address} @var{count}
30514@end smallexample
30515
30516@noindent
30517where:
30518
30519@table @samp
30520@item @var{address}
30521An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30522to be read.  Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30523quoted using the C convention.
30524
30525@item @var{count}
30526The number of addressable memory units to read.  This should be an integer
30527literal.
30528
30529@item @var{offset}
30530The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading.  This
30531should be an integer literal.  This option is provided so that a frontend
30532is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30533arithmetics itself.
30534
30535@end table
30536
30537This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30538specified range.  First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30539map (if one is defined) will be skipped.  @xref{Memory Region
30540Attributes}.  Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30541regions.  For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30542@value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30543
30544In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30545and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30546every address, which is not practical.   Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30547attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30548of the region, using a binary division scheme.  This heuristic works
30549well for reading accross a memory map boundary.  Note that if a region
30550has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30551@value{GDBN} will not read it.
30552
30553The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30554the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30555list of tuples.  Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30556and has the following fields:
30557
30558@table @code
30559@item begin
30560The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30561
30562@item end
30563The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30564
30565@item offset
30566The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30567the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30568
30569@item contents
30570The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30571
30572@end table
30573
30574
30575
30576@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30577
30578The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30579
30580@subsubheading Example
30581
30582@smallexample
30583(gdb)
30584-data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30585^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30586              end="0xbffff15e",
30587              contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30588(gdb)
30589@end smallexample
30590
30591
30592@subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30593@findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30594
30595@subsubheading Synopsis
30596
30597@smallexample
30598 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30599 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30600@end smallexample
30601
30602@noindent
30603where:
30604
30605@table @samp
30606@item @var{address}
30607An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30608to be written.  Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30609be quoted using the C convention.
30610
30611@item @var{contents}
30612The hex-encoded data to write.  It is an error if @var{contents} does
30613not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30614
30615@item @var{count}
30616Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30617written.  If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30618@value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30619@var{count} memory units.
30620
30621@end table
30622
30623@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30624
30625There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30626
30627@subsubheading Example
30628
30629@smallexample
30630(gdb)
30631-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30632^done
30633(gdb)
30634@end smallexample
30635
30636@smallexample
30637(gdb)
30638-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30639^done
30640(gdb)
30641@end smallexample
30642
30643@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30644@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30645@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30646
30647The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30648tracepoints.  For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30649
30650@subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30651@findex -trace-find
30652
30653@subsubheading Synopsis
30654
30655@smallexample
30656 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30657@end smallexample
30658
30659Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30660@var{parameters}.  The following table lists permissible
30661modes and their parameters.  For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30662
30663@table @samp
30664
30665@item none
30666No parameters are required.  Stops examining trace frames.
30667
30668@item frame-number
30669An integer is required as parameter.  Selects tracepoint frame with
30670that index.
30671
30672@item tracepoint-number
30673An integer is required as parameter.  Finds next
30674trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30675
30676@item pc
30677An address is required as parameter.  Finds
30678next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30679address.
30680
30681@item pc-inside-range
30682Two addresses are required as parameters.  Finds next trace
30683frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30684specified range.  Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30685
30686@item pc-outside-range
30687Two addresses are required as parameters.  Finds
30688next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30689the specified range.  Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30690
30691@item line
30692Line specification is required as parameter.  @xref{Specify Location}.
30693Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30694the specified location.
30695
30696@end table
30697
30698If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30699have fields.  Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30700
30701@table @samp
30702@item found
30703This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30704on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30705
30706@item traceframe
30707The index of the found traceframe.  This field is present iff
30708the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30709
30710@item tracepoint
30711The index of the found tracepoint.  This field is present iff
30712the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30713
30714@item frame
30715The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30716frame.  This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30717@xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30718
30719@end table
30720
30721@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30722
30723The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30724
30725@subheading -trace-define-variable
30726@findex -trace-define-variable
30727
30728@subsubheading Synopsis
30729
30730@smallexample
30731 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30732@end smallexample
30733
30734Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist.  If
30735@var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30736trace variable to that value.  Note that the @var{name} should start
30737with the @samp{$} character.
30738
30739@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30740
30741The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30742
30743@subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30744@findex -trace-frame-collected
30745
30746@subsubheading Synopsis
30747
30748@smallexample
30749 -trace-frame-collected
30750    [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30751    [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30752    [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30753    [--memory-contents]
30754@end smallexample
30755
30756This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30757trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30758that have been collected at a particular trace frame.  The optional
30759parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30760See the output description table below for more details.
30761
30762The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30763varobjs and inspect the objects themselves.  The items returned by
30764this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30765which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30766memory range and which is a computed expression.
30767
30768For instance, if the actions were
30769@smallexample
30770collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30771collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30772@end smallexample
30773
30774@noindent
30775the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}.  The
30776object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30777element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected.  The remaining
30778objects would be computed expressions.
30779
30780An example output would be:
30781
30782@smallexample
30783(gdb)
30784-trace-frame-collected
30785^done,
30786  explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30787  computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30788                        @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30789                        @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30790                        @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30791                        @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30792  registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30793             @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30794             @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30795             ...
30796             @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30797  tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30798  memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30799          @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30800(gdb)
30801@end smallexample
30802
30803Where:
30804
30805@table @code
30806@item explicit-variables
30807The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30808opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30809members).  For each object, its name and value are printed.
30810The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30811field is output.  If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30812if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30813type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30814arrays, structures and unions.
30815
30816@item computed-expressions
30817The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30818current trace frame.  The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30819this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30820@code{explicit-variables} set.  See above.
30821
30822@item registers
30823The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30824For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30825The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30826option.  See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30827list of the allowed formats.  The default is @samp{x}.
30828
30829@item tvars
30830The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30831trace frame.  For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30832current value are returned.
30833
30834@item memory
30835The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30836frame.  Its content is a list of tuples.  Each tuple represents a
30837collected memory range and has the following fields:
30838
30839@table @code
30840@item address
30841The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30842
30843@item length
30844The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30845
30846@item contents
30847The contents of the memory block, in hex.  This field is only present
30848if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30849
30850@end table
30851
30852@end table
30853
30854@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30855
30856There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30857
30858@subsubheading Example
30859
30860@subheading -trace-list-variables
30861@findex -trace-list-variables
30862
30863@subsubheading Synopsis
30864
30865@smallexample
30866 -trace-list-variables
30867@end smallexample
30868
30869Return a table of all defined trace variables.  Each element of the
30870table has the following fields:
30871
30872@table @samp
30873@item name
30874The name of the trace variable.  This field is always present.
30875
30876@item initial
30877The initial value.  This is a 64-bit signed integer.  This
30878field is always present.
30879
30880@item current
30881The value the trace variable has at the moment.  This is a 64-bit
30882signed integer.  This field is absent iff current value is
30883not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30884presently running.
30885
30886@end table
30887
30888@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30889
30890The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30891
30892@subsubheading Example
30893
30894@smallexample
30895(gdb)
30896-trace-list-variables
30897^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30898hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30899     @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30900     @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30901body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30902      variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30903(gdb)
30904@end smallexample
30905
30906@subheading -trace-save
30907@findex -trace-save
30908
30909@subsubheading Synopsis
30910
30911@smallexample
30912 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30913@end smallexample
30914
30915Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}.  Without the
30916@samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30917in a local file.  With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30918to perform the save.
30919
30920@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30921
30922The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30923
30924
30925@subheading -trace-start
30926@findex -trace-start
30927
30928@subsubheading Synopsis
30929
30930@smallexample
30931 -trace-start
30932@end smallexample
30933
30934Starts a tracing experiments.  The result of this command does not
30935have any fields.
30936
30937@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30938
30939The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30940
30941@subheading -trace-status
30942@findex -trace-status
30943
30944@subsubheading Synopsis
30945
30946@smallexample
30947 -trace-status
30948@end smallexample
30949
30950Obtains the status of a tracing experiment.  The result may include
30951the following fields:
30952
30953@table @samp
30954
30955@item supported
30956May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30957supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30958@samp{file} when examining trace file.  In the latter case, examining
30959of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30960started.  This field is always present.
30961
30962@item running
30963May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30964tracing experiement is in progress on target.  This field is present
30965if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30966
30967@item stop-reason
30968Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time.  This field
30969may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet.  The
30970value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30971the @code{-trace-stop} command.  The value of @samp{overflow} means
30972the tracing buffer is full.  The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30973tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30974The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30975tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30976This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30977
30978@item stopping-tracepoint
30979The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded.  This field is
30980present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30981@samp{passcount}.
30982
30983@item frames
30984@itemx frames-created
30985The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30986in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30987during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30988circular trace buffer filled up.  Both fields are optional.
30989
30990@item buffer-size
30991@itemx buffer-free
30992These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30993remaining space.  These fields are optional.
30994
30995@item circular
30996The value of the circular trace buffer flag.  @code{1} means that the
30997trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30998necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30999and may fill up.
31000
31001@item disconnected
31002The value of the disconnected tracing flag.  @code{1} means that
31003tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31004that the trace run will stop.
31005
31006@item trace-file
31007The filename of the trace file being examined.  This field is
31008optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31009
31010@end table
31011
31012@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31013
31014The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31015
31016@subheading -trace-stop
31017@findex -trace-stop
31018
31019@subsubheading Synopsis
31020
31021@smallexample
31022 -trace-stop
31023@end smallexample
31024
31025Stops a tracing experiment.  The result of this command has the same
31026fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31027@samp{running} fields are not output.
31028
31029@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31030
31031The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31032
31033
31034@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31035@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31036@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31037
31038
31039@ignore
31040@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31041@findex -symbol-info-address
31042
31043@subsubheading Synopsis
31044
31045@smallexample
31046 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31047@end smallexample
31048
31049Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31050
31051@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31052
31053The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31054
31055@subsubheading Example
31056N.A.
31057
31058
31059@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31060@findex -symbol-info-file
31061
31062@subsubheading Synopsis
31063
31064@smallexample
31065 -symbol-info-file
31066@end smallexample
31067
31068Show the file for the symbol.
31069
31070@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31071
31072There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.  @code{gdbtk} has
31073@samp{gdb_find_file}.
31074
31075@subsubheading Example
31076N.A.
31077
31078
31079@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31080@findex -symbol-info-function
31081
31082@subsubheading Synopsis
31083
31084@smallexample
31085 -symbol-info-function
31086@end smallexample
31087
31088Show which function the symbol lives in.
31089
31090@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31091
31092@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31093
31094@subsubheading Example
31095N.A.
31096
31097
31098@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31099@findex -symbol-info-line
31100
31101@subsubheading Synopsis
31102
31103@smallexample
31104 -symbol-info-line
31105@end smallexample
31106
31107Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31108
31109@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31110
31111The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31112@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31113
31114@subsubheading Example
31115N.A.
31116
31117
31118@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31119@findex -symbol-info-symbol
31120
31121@subsubheading Synopsis
31122
31123@smallexample
31124 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31125@end smallexample
31126
31127Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31128
31129@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31130
31131The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31132
31133@subsubheading Example
31134N.A.
31135
31136
31137@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31138@findex -symbol-list-functions
31139
31140@subsubheading Synopsis
31141
31142@smallexample
31143 -symbol-list-functions
31144@end smallexample
31145
31146List the functions in the executable.
31147
31148@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31149
31150@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31151@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31152
31153@subsubheading Example
31154N.A.
31155@end ignore
31156
31157
31158@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31159@findex -symbol-list-lines
31160
31161@subsubheading Synopsis
31162
31163@smallexample
31164 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31165@end smallexample
31166
31167Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
31168addresses for the given source filename.  The entries are sorted in
31169ascending PC order.
31170
31171@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31172
31173There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31174
31175@subsubheading Example
31176@smallexample
31177(gdb)
31178-symbol-list-lines basics.c
31179^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
31180(gdb)
31181@end smallexample
31182
31183
31184@ignore
31185@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
31186@findex -symbol-list-types
31187
31188@subsubheading Synopsis
31189
31190@smallexample
31191 -symbol-list-types
31192@end smallexample
31193
31194List all the type names.
31195
31196@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31197
31198The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
31199@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31200
31201@subsubheading Example
31202N.A.
31203
31204
31205@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
31206@findex -symbol-list-variables
31207
31208@subsubheading Synopsis
31209
31210@smallexample
31211 -symbol-list-variables
31212@end smallexample
31213
31214List all the global and static variable names.
31215
31216@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31217
31218@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31219
31220@subsubheading Example
31221N.A.
31222
31223
31224@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
31225@findex -symbol-locate
31226
31227@subsubheading Synopsis
31228
31229@smallexample
31230 -symbol-locate
31231@end smallexample
31232
31233@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31234
31235@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
31236
31237@subsubheading Example
31238N.A.
31239
31240
31241@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
31242@findex -symbol-type
31243
31244@subsubheading Synopsis
31245
31246@smallexample
31247 -symbol-type @var{variable}
31248@end smallexample
31249
31250Show type of @var{variable}.
31251
31252@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31253
31254The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
31255@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
31256
31257@subsubheading Example
31258N.A.
31259@end ignore
31260
31261
31262@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31263@node GDB/MI File Commands
31264@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
31265
31266This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
31267and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
31268
31269@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
31270@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
31271
31272@subsubheading Synopsis
31273
31274@smallexample
31275 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
31276@end smallexample
31277
31278Specify the executable file to be debugged.  This file is the one from
31279which the symbol table is also read.  If no file is specified, the
31280command clears the executable and symbol information.  If breakpoints
31281are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
31282error messages.  Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
31283notification.
31284
31285@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31286
31287The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
31288
31289@subsubheading Example
31290
31291@smallexample
31292(gdb)
31293-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31294^done
31295(gdb)
31296@end smallexample
31297
31298
31299@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
31300@findex -file-exec-file
31301
31302@subsubheading Synopsis
31303
31304@smallexample
31305 -file-exec-file @var{file}
31306@end smallexample
31307
31308Specify the executable file to be debugged.  Unlike
31309@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
31310from this file.  If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
31311about the executable file.  No output is produced, except a completion
31312notification.
31313
31314@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31315
31316The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
31317
31318@subsubheading Example
31319
31320@smallexample
31321(gdb)
31322-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31323^done
31324(gdb)
31325@end smallexample
31326
31327
31328@ignore
31329@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
31330@findex -file-list-exec-sections
31331
31332@subsubheading Synopsis
31333
31334@smallexample
31335 -file-list-exec-sections
31336@end smallexample
31337
31338List the sections of the current executable file.
31339
31340@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31341
31342The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
31343information as this command.  @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
31344@samp{gdb_load_info}.
31345
31346@subsubheading Example
31347N.A.
31348@end ignore
31349
31350
31351@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31352@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31353
31354@subsubheading Synopsis
31355
31356@smallexample
31357 -file-list-exec-source-file
31358@end smallexample
31359
31360List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31361to the current source file for the current executable.  The macro
31362information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31363whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31364
31365@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31366
31367The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31368
31369@subsubheading Example
31370
31371@smallexample
31372(gdb)
31373123-file-list-exec-source-file
31374123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31375(gdb)
31376@end smallexample
31377
31378
31379@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31380@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31381
31382@subsubheading Synopsis
31383
31384@smallexample
31385 -file-list-exec-source-files
31386@end smallexample
31387
31388List the source files for the current executable.
31389
31390It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31391name) of a source file.
31392
31393@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31394
31395The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31396@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31397
31398@subsubheading Example
31399@smallexample
31400(gdb)
31401-file-list-exec-source-files
31402^done,files=[
31403@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31404@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31405@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31406(gdb)
31407@end smallexample
31408
31409@ignore
31410@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31411@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31412
31413@subsubheading Synopsis
31414
31415@smallexample
31416 -file-list-shared-libraries
31417@end smallexample
31418
31419List the shared libraries in the program.
31420
31421@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31422
31423The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31424
31425@subsubheading Example
31426N.A.
31427
31428
31429@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31430@findex -file-list-symbol-files
31431
31432@subsubheading Synopsis
31433
31434@smallexample
31435 -file-list-symbol-files
31436@end smallexample
31437
31438List symbol files.
31439
31440@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31441
31442The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31443
31444@subsubheading Example
31445N.A.
31446@end ignore
31447
31448
31449@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31450@findex -file-symbol-file
31451
31452@subsubheading Synopsis
31453
31454@smallexample
31455 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31456@end smallexample
31457
31458Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument.  When
31459used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info.  No output is
31460produced, except for a completion notification.
31461
31462@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31463
31464The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31465
31466@subsubheading Example
31467
31468@smallexample
31469(gdb)
31470-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31471^done
31472(gdb)
31473@end smallexample
31474
31475@ignore
31476@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31477@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31478@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31479
31480The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31481
31482@c @subheading -overlay-auto
31483
31484@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31485
31486@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31487
31488@c @subheading -overlay-map
31489
31490@c @subheading -overlay-off
31491
31492@c @subheading -overlay-on
31493
31494@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31495
31496@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31497@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31498@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31499
31500Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31501
31502@c @subheading -signal-handle
31503
31504@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31505
31506@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31507@end ignore
31508
31509
31510@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31511@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31512@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31513
31514
31515@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31516@findex -target-attach
31517
31518@subsubheading Synopsis
31519
31520@smallexample
31521 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31522@end smallexample
31523
31524Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31525@value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}.  If attaching to a thread
31526group, the id previously returned by
31527@samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31528
31529@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31530
31531The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31532
31533@subsubheading Example
31534@smallexample
31535(gdb)
31536-target-attach 34
31537=thread-created,id="1"
31538*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31539^done
31540(gdb)
31541@end smallexample
31542
31543@ignore
31544@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31545@findex -target-compare-sections
31546
31547@subsubheading Synopsis
31548
31549@smallexample
31550 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31551@end smallexample
31552
31553Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31554Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31555
31556@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31557
31558The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31559
31560@subsubheading Example
31561N.A.
31562@end ignore
31563
31564
31565@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31566@findex -target-detach
31567
31568@subsubheading Synopsis
31569
31570@smallexample
31571 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31572@end smallexample
31573
31574Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31575If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31576the specified process, or specified thread group.  There's no output.
31577
31578@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31579
31580The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31581
31582@subsubheading Example
31583
31584@smallexample
31585(gdb)
31586-target-detach
31587^done
31588(gdb)
31589@end smallexample
31590
31591
31592@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31593@findex -target-disconnect
31594
31595@subsubheading Synopsis
31596
31597@smallexample
31598 -target-disconnect
31599@end smallexample
31600
31601Disconnect from the remote target.  There's no output and the target is
31602generally not resumed.
31603
31604@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31605
31606The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31607
31608@subsubheading Example
31609
31610@smallexample
31611(gdb)
31612-target-disconnect
31613^done
31614(gdb)
31615@end smallexample
31616
31617
31618@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31619@findex -target-download
31620
31621@subsubheading Synopsis
31622
31623@smallexample
31624 -target-download
31625@end smallexample
31626
31627Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31628It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31629
31630@table @samp
31631@item section
31632The name of the section.
31633@item section-sent
31634The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31635@item section-size
31636The size of the section.
31637@item total-sent
31638The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31639@item total-size
31640The size of the overall executable to download.
31641@end table
31642
31643@noindent
31644Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31645@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31646
31647In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31648downloaded.  These messages include the following fields:
31649
31650@table @samp
31651@item section
31652The name of the section.
31653@item section-size
31654The size of the section.
31655@item total-size
31656The size of the overall executable to download.
31657@end table
31658
31659@noindent
31660At the end, a summary is printed.
31661
31662@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31663
31664The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31665
31666@subsubheading Example
31667
31668Note: each status message appears on a single line.  Here the messages
31669have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31670
31671@smallexample
31672(gdb)
31673-target-download
31674+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31675+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31676total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31677+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31678total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31679+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31680total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31681+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31682total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31683+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31684total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31685+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31686total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31687+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31688total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31689+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31690total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31691+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31692total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31693+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31694total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31695+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31696total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31697+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31698total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31699+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31700total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31701+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31702+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31703+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31704+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31705total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31706+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31707total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31708+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31709total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31710+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31711total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31712+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31713total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31714+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31715total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31716^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31717write-rate="429"
31718(gdb)
31719@end smallexample
31720
31721
31722@ignore
31723@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31724@findex -target-exec-status
31725
31726@subsubheading Synopsis
31727
31728@smallexample
31729 -target-exec-status
31730@end smallexample
31731
31732Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31733not, for instance).
31734
31735@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31736
31737There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31738
31739@subsubheading Example
31740N.A.
31741
31742
31743@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31744@findex -target-list-available-targets
31745
31746@subsubheading Synopsis
31747
31748@smallexample
31749 -target-list-available-targets
31750@end smallexample
31751
31752List the possible targets to connect to.
31753
31754@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31755
31756The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31757
31758@subsubheading Example
31759N.A.
31760
31761
31762@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31763@findex -target-list-current-targets
31764
31765@subsubheading Synopsis
31766
31767@smallexample
31768 -target-list-current-targets
31769@end smallexample
31770
31771Describe the current target.
31772
31773@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31774
31775The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31776other things).
31777
31778@subsubheading Example
31779N.A.
31780
31781
31782@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31783@findex -target-list-parameters
31784
31785@subsubheading Synopsis
31786
31787@smallexample
31788 -target-list-parameters
31789@end smallexample
31790
31791@c ????
31792@end ignore
31793
31794@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31795
31796No equivalent.
31797
31798@subsubheading Example
31799N.A.
31800
31801
31802@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31803@findex -target-select
31804
31805@subsubheading Synopsis
31806
31807@smallexample
31808 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31809@end smallexample
31810
31811Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target.  This command takes two args:
31812
31813@table @samp
31814@item @var{type}
31815The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31816@item @var{parameters}
31817Device names, host names and the like.  @xref{Target Commands, ,
31818Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31819@end table
31820
31821The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31822which the target program is, in the following form:
31823
31824@smallexample
31825^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31826  args=[@var{arg list}]
31827@end smallexample
31828
31829@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31830
31831The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31832
31833@subsubheading Example
31834
31835@smallexample
31836(gdb)
31837-target-select remote /dev/ttya
31838^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31839(gdb)
31840@end smallexample
31841
31842@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31843@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31844@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31845
31846
31847@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31848@findex -target-file-put
31849
31850@subsubheading Synopsis
31851
31852@smallexample
31853 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31854@end smallexample
31855
31856Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31857@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31858
31859@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31860
31861The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31862
31863@subsubheading Example
31864
31865@smallexample
31866(gdb)
31867-target-file-put localfile remotefile
31868^done
31869(gdb)
31870@end smallexample
31871
31872
31873@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31874@findex -target-file-get
31875
31876@subsubheading Synopsis
31877
31878@smallexample
31879 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31880@end smallexample
31881
31882Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31883on the host system.
31884
31885@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31886
31887The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31888
31889@subsubheading Example
31890
31891@smallexample
31892(gdb)
31893-target-file-get remotefile localfile
31894^done
31895(gdb)
31896@end smallexample
31897
31898
31899@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31900@findex -target-file-delete
31901
31902@subsubheading Synopsis
31903
31904@smallexample
31905 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31906@end smallexample
31907
31908Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31909
31910@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31911
31912The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31913
31914@subsubheading Example
31915
31916@smallexample
31917(gdb)
31918-target-file-delete remotefile
31919^done
31920(gdb)
31921@end smallexample
31922
31923
31924@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31925@node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31926@section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31927
31928@subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31929@findex -info-ada-exceptions
31930
31931@subsubheading Synopsis
31932
31933@smallexample
31934 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31935@end smallexample
31936
31937List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31938With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31939names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31940
31941@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31942
31943The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31944
31945@subsubheading Result
31946
31947The result is a table of Ada exceptions.  The following columns are
31948defined for each exception:
31949
31950@table @samp
31951@item name
31952The name of the exception.
31953
31954@item address
31955The address of the exception.
31956
31957@end table
31958
31959@subsubheading Example
31960
31961@smallexample
31962-info-ada-exceptions aint
31963^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31964hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31965@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31966body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31967@{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31968@end smallexample
31969
31970@subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31971
31972The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31973raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31974Catchpoint Commands}.
31975
31976
31977@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31978@node GDB/MI Support Commands
31979@section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31980
31981Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31982some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31983about support for these capabilities.  Similarly, it is also possible
31984to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31985
31986@subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31987@cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31988@findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31989
31990@subsubheading Synopsis
31991
31992@smallexample
31993 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31994@end smallexample
31995
31996Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31997
31998Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31999is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32000Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}.  However,
32001for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32002dash.
32003
32004@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32005
32006There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32007
32008@subsubheading Result
32009
32010The result is a tuple.  There is currently only one field:
32011
32012@table @samp
32013@item exists
32014This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32015@code{"false"} otherwise.
32016
32017@end table
32018
32019@subsubheading Example
32020
32021Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32022
32023@smallexample
32024-info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32025^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32026@end smallexample
32027
32028@noindent
32029And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32030to the debugger:
32031
32032@smallexample
32033-info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32034^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32035@end smallexample
32036
32037@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32038@findex -list-features
32039@cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32040
32041Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32042this version of gdb implements.  A feature can be a command,
32043or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32044important bugfix.  While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32045of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32046startup.
32047
32048The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32049available feature.  Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32050have any internal structure.  The list of possible feature names
32051is given below.
32052
32053Example output:
32054
32055@smallexample
32056(gdb) -list-features
32057^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32058@end smallexample
32059
32060The current list of features is:
32061
32062@ftable @samp
32063@item frozen-varobjs
32064Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32065as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32066of @code{-varobj-create}.
32067@item pending-breakpoints
32068Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32069command.
32070@item python
32071Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32072pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32073@samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32074@item thread-info
32075Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32076@item data-read-memory-bytes
32077Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32078@code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32079@item breakpoint-notifications
32080Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32081CLI will be announced via async records.
32082@item ada-task-info
32083Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32084@item language-option
32085Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32086option (@pxref{Context management}).
32087@item info-gdb-mi-command
32088Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32089@item undefined-command-error-code
32090Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32091records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32092(@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32093@item exec-run-start-option
32094Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32095option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32096@end ftable
32097
32098@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32099@findex -list-target-features
32100
32101Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32102target.  Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32103unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32104features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment.  Whenever
32105a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32106@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32107may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32108Example output:
32109
32110@smallexample
32111(gdb) -list-target-features
32112^done,result=["async"]
32113@end smallexample
32114
32115The current list of features is:
32116
32117@table @samp
32118@item async
32119Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32120execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32121while the target is running.
32122
32123@item reverse
32124Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32125@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32126
32127@end table
32128
32129@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32130@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
32131@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32132
32133@c @subheading -gdb-complete
32134
32135@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
32136@findex -gdb-exit
32137
32138@subsubheading Synopsis
32139
32140@smallexample
32141 -gdb-exit
32142@end smallexample
32143
32144Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
32145
32146@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32147
32148Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
32149
32150@subsubheading Example
32151
32152@smallexample
32153(gdb)
32154-gdb-exit
32155^exit
32156@end smallexample
32157
32158
32159@ignore
32160@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
32161@findex -exec-abort
32162
32163@subsubheading Synopsis
32164
32165@smallexample
32166 -exec-abort
32167@end smallexample
32168
32169Kill the inferior running program.
32170
32171@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32172
32173The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
32174
32175@subsubheading Example
32176N.A.
32177@end ignore
32178
32179
32180@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
32181@findex -gdb-set
32182
32183@subsubheading Synopsis
32184
32185@smallexample
32186 -gdb-set
32187@end smallexample
32188
32189Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
32190@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
32191
32192@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32193
32194The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
32195
32196@subsubheading Example
32197
32198@smallexample
32199(gdb)
32200-gdb-set $foo=3
32201^done
32202(gdb)
32203@end smallexample
32204
32205
32206@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
32207@findex -gdb-show
32208
32209@subsubheading Synopsis
32210
32211@smallexample
32212 -gdb-show
32213@end smallexample
32214
32215Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
32216
32217@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32218
32219The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
32220
32221@subsubheading Example
32222
32223@smallexample
32224(gdb)
32225-gdb-show annotate
32226^done,value="0"
32227(gdb)
32228@end smallexample
32229
32230@c @subheading -gdb-source
32231
32232
32233@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
32234@findex -gdb-version
32235
32236@subsubheading Synopsis
32237
32238@smallexample
32239 -gdb-version
32240@end smallexample
32241
32242Show version information for @value{GDBN}.  Used mostly in testing.
32243
32244@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32245
32246The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}.  @value{GDBN} by
32247default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
32248
32249@subsubheading Example
32250
32251@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
32252@c box in TeX.
32253@smallexample
32254(gdb)
32255-gdb-version
32256~GNU gdb 5.2.1
32257~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32258~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
32259~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
32260~ certain conditions.
32261~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32262~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB.  Type "show warranty" for
32263~ details.
32264~This GDB was configured as
32265 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
32266^done
32267(gdb)
32268@end smallexample
32269
32270@subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
32271@findex -list-thread-groups
32272
32273@subheading Synopsis
32274
32275@smallexample
32276-list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
32277@end smallexample
32278
32279Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}).  When a single thread
32280group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
32281When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
32282thread groups.  Without any parameters, lists information about all
32283top-level thread groups.
32284
32285Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
32286With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
32287available on the target.
32288
32289The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
32290a @samp{groups} result.  The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
32291as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
32292Information}).  The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
32293each tuple describing a thread group.  If top-level groups are
32294requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
32295are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result.  The format
32296of the @samp{group} result is described below.
32297
32298To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
32299together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
32300and the recursion depth.  Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
32301permitted.  If this option is present, then every reported thread group
32302will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
32303@samp{threads} field.
32304
32305In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
32306the following caveats:
32307
32308@itemize @bullet
32309@item
32310When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
32311be the @samp{threads} result.  Because threads may not contain
32312anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
32313
32314@item
32315When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
32316be available.  In particular, the list of threads of a process might
32317be inaccessible.  Further, specifying specific thread groups might
32318not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
32319The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
32320is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
32321
32322@end itemize
32323
32324The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
32325have the following fields:
32326
32327@table @code
32328@item id
32329Identifier of the thread group.  This field is always present.
32330The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
32331convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
32332
32333@item type
32334The type of the thread group.  At present, only @samp{process} is a
32335valid type.
32336
32337@item pid
32338The target-specific process identifier.  This field is only present
32339for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
32340
32341@item exit-code
32342The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
32343This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
32344only if the process is not running.
32345
32346@item num_children
32347The number of children this thread group has.  This field may be
32348absent for an available thread group.
32349
32350@item threads
32351This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32352thread.  It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32353specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32354
32355@item cores
32356This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32357thread of the group is running on.  This field may be absent if
32358such information is not available.
32359
32360@item executable
32361The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32362The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32363and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32364
32365@end table
32366
32367@subheading Example
32368
32369@smallexample
32370@value{GDBP}
32371-list-thread-groups
32372^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32373-list-thread-groups 17
32374^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32375   frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32376@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32377   frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32378           file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32379-list-thread-groups --available
32380^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32381-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32382 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32383                threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32384                         @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32385-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32386^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32387               threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32388                        @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32389@end smallexample
32390
32391@subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32392@findex -info-os
32393
32394@subsubheading Synopsis
32395
32396@smallexample
32397-info-os [ @var{type} ]
32398@end smallexample
32399
32400If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32401operating-system-specific information types.  If one of these types is
32402supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32403of data of that type.
32404
32405The types of information available depend on the target operating
32406system.
32407
32408@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32409
32410The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32411
32412@subsubheading Example
32413
32414When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32415like this:
32416
32417@smallexample
32418@value{GDBP}
32419-info-os
32420^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32421hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32422     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32423     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32424body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32425            col2="CPUs"@},
32426      item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32427            col2="File descriptors"@},
32428      item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32429            col2="Kernel modules"@},
32430      item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32431            col2="Message queues"@},
32432      item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32433            col2="Processes"@},
32434      item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32435            col2="Process groups"@},
32436      item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32437            col2="Semaphores"@},
32438      item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32439            col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32440      item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32441            col2="Sockets"@},
32442      item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32443            col2="Threads"@}]
32444@value{GDBP}
32445-info-os processes
32446^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32447hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32448     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32449     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32450     @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32451body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32452      item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32453      item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32454      ...
32455      item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32456      item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32457(gdb)
32458@end smallexample
32459
32460(Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32461does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32462for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32463popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32464@code{info os} omits it.)
32465
32466@subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32467@findex -add-inferior
32468
32469@subheading Synopsis
32470
32471@smallexample
32472-add-inferior
32473@end smallexample
32474
32475Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}).  The created
32476inferior is not associated with any executable.  Such association may
32477be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32478(@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}).  The command response has a single
32479field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32480thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32481
32482@subheading Example
32483
32484@smallexample
32485@value{GDBP}
32486-add-inferior
32487^done,inferior="i3"
32488@end smallexample
32489
32490@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32491@findex -interpreter-exec
32492
32493@subheading Synopsis
32494
32495@smallexample
32496-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32497@end smallexample
32498@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32499
32500Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32501
32502@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32503
32504The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32505
32506@subheading Example
32507
32508@smallexample
32509(gdb)
32510-interpreter-exec console "break main"
32511&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32512&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32513~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32514^done
32515(gdb)
32516@end smallexample
32517
32518@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32519@findex -inferior-tty-set
32520
32521@subheading Synopsis
32522
32523@smallexample
32524-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32525@end smallexample
32526
32527Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32528
32529@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32530
32531The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32532
32533@subheading Example
32534
32535@smallexample
32536(gdb)
32537-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32538^done
32539(gdb)
32540@end smallexample
32541
32542@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32543@findex -inferior-tty-show
32544
32545@subheading Synopsis
32546
32547@smallexample
32548-inferior-tty-show
32549@end smallexample
32550
32551Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32552
32553@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32554
32555The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32556
32557@subheading Example
32558
32559@smallexample
32560(gdb)
32561-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32562^done
32563(gdb)
32564-inferior-tty-show
32565^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32566(gdb)
32567@end smallexample
32568
32569@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32570@findex -enable-timings
32571
32572@subheading Synopsis
32573
32574@smallexample
32575-enable-timings [yes | no]
32576@end smallexample
32577
32578Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32579command as a field in its output.  This command is to help frontend
32580developers optimize the performance of their code.  No argument is
32581equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32582
32583@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32584
32585No equivalent.
32586
32587@subheading Example
32588
32589@smallexample
32590(gdb)
32591-enable-timings
32592^done
32593(gdb)
32594-break-insert main
32595^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32596addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32597fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32598times="0"@},
32599time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32600(gdb)
32601-enable-timings no
32602^done
32603(gdb)
32604-exec-run
32605^running
32606(gdb)
32607*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32608frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32609@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32610fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32611(gdb)
32612@end smallexample
32613
32614@node Annotations
32615@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32616
32617This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}.  Annotations were
32618designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32619similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32620relatively high level.
32621
32622The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32623(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32624
32625@ignore
32626This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32627@end ignore
32628
32629@menu
32630* Annotations Overview::  What annotations are; the general syntax.
32631* Server Prefix::       Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32632* Prompting::           Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32633* Errors::              Annotations for error messages.
32634* Invalidation::        Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32635* Annotations for Running::
32636                        Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32637* Source Annotations::  Annotations describing source code.
32638@end menu
32639
32640@node Annotations Overview
32641@section What is an Annotation?
32642@cindex annotations
32643
32644Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32645characters, and the name of the annotation.  If there is no additional
32646information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32647is followed immediately by a newline.  If there is additional
32648information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32649additional information, and a newline.  The additional information
32650cannot contain newline characters.
32651
32652Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32653characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}.  Currently there is
32654no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32655@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32656annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32657means those three characters as output.
32658
32659The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32660@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32661how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32662values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output.  Level 0
32663is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32664subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32665for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32666been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32667Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32668
32669@table @code
32670@kindex set annotate
32671@item set annotate @var{level}
32672The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32673annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32674
32675@item show annotate
32676@kindex show annotate
32677Show the current annotation level.
32678@end table
32679
32680This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32681
32682A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32683
32684@smallexample
32685$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32686GNU gdb 6.0
32687Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32688GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32689and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32690under certain conditions.
32691Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32692There is absolutely no warranty for GDB.  Type "show warranty"
32693for details.
32694This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32695
32696^Z^Zpre-prompt
32697(@value{GDBP})
32698^Z^Zprompt
32699@kbd{quit}
32700
32701^Z^Zpost-prompt
32702$
32703@end smallexample
32704
32705Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32706@value{GDBN}.  The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32707denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32708output from @value{GDBN}.
32709
32710@node Server Prefix
32711@section The Server Prefix
32712@cindex server prefix
32713
32714If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32715the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32716command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself.  This
32717means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32718a transparent manner.
32719
32720The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32721the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32722value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32723@code{print} command.
32724
32725Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32726(@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32727
32728@node Prompting
32729@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32730
32731@cindex annotations for prompts
32732When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32733to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32734over, etc.
32735
32736Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}.  Each
32737input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32738denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32739annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32740annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32741associated with the input.  For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32742features the following annotations:
32743
32744@smallexample
32745^Z^Zpre-prompt
32746^Z^Zprompt
32747^Z^Zpost-prompt
32748@end smallexample
32749
32750The input types are
32751
32752@table @code
32753@findex pre-prompt annotation
32754@findex prompt annotation
32755@findex post-prompt annotation
32756@item prompt
32757When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32758
32759@findex pre-commands annotation
32760@findex commands annotation
32761@findex post-commands annotation
32762@item commands
32763When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32764command.  The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32765
32766@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32767@findex overload-choice annotation
32768@findex post-overload-choice annotation
32769@item overload-choice
32770When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32771
32772@findex pre-query annotation
32773@findex query annotation
32774@findex post-query annotation
32775@item query
32776When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32777
32778@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32779@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32780@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32781@item prompt-for-continue
32782When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue.  Note: Don't
32783expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32784prompting.  This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32785presence of annotations.
32786@end table
32787
32788@node Errors
32789@section Errors
32790@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32791
32792@findex quit annotation
32793@smallexample
32794^Z^Zquit
32795@end smallexample
32796
32797This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32798
32799@findex error annotation
32800@smallexample
32801^Z^Zerror
32802@end smallexample
32803
32804This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32805
32806Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32807in the middle of may end abruptly.  For example, if a
32808@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32809cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}.  One
32810cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32811does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32812to the top level.
32813
32814@findex error-begin annotation
32815A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32816
32817@smallexample
32818^Z^Zerror-begin
32819@end smallexample
32820
32821Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32822message.
32823
32824Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32825@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32826@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32827
32828@node Invalidation
32829@section Invalidation Notices
32830
32831@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32832The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32833changed.
32834
32835@table @code
32836@findex frames-invalid annotation
32837@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32838
32839The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32840have changed.
32841
32842@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32843@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32844
32845The breakpoints may have changed.  For example, the user just added or
32846deleted a breakpoint.
32847@end table
32848
32849@node Annotations for Running
32850@section Running the Program
32851@cindex annotations for running programs
32852
32853@findex starting annotation
32854@findex stopping annotation
32855When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32856@code{step} or @code{continue},
32857
32858@smallexample
32859^Z^Zstarting
32860@end smallexample
32861
32862is output.  When the program stops,
32863
32864@smallexample
32865^Z^Zstopped
32866@end smallexample
32867
32868is output.  Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32869annotations describe how the program stopped.
32870
32871@table @code
32872@findex exited annotation
32873@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32874The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32875successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32876
32877@findex signalled annotation
32878@findex signal-name annotation
32879@findex signal-name-end annotation
32880@findex signal-string annotation
32881@findex signal-string-end annotation
32882@item ^Z^Zsignalled
32883The program exited with a signal.  After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32884annotation continues:
32885
32886@smallexample
32887@var{intro-text}
32888^Z^Zsignal-name
32889@var{name}
32890^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32891@var{middle-text}
32892^Z^Zsignal-string
32893@var{string}
32894^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32895@var{end-text}
32896@end smallexample
32897
32898@noindent
32899where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32900@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32901as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.  The arguments
32902@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32903user's benefit and have no particular format.
32904
32905@findex signal annotation
32906@item ^Z^Zsignal
32907The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32908just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32909terminated with it.
32910
32911@findex breakpoint annotation
32912@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32913The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32914
32915@findex watchpoint annotation
32916@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32917The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32918@end table
32919
32920@node Source Annotations
32921@section Displaying Source
32922@cindex annotations for source display
32923
32924@findex source annotation
32925The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32926
32927@smallexample
32928^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32929@end smallexample
32930
32931where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32932file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32933first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32934within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32935debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32936@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32937line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32938@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32939source which is being displayed.  The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32940followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32941depend on the language).
32942
32943@node JIT Interface
32944@chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32945@cindex just-in-time compilation
32946@cindex JIT compilation interface
32947
32948This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32949interface.  A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32950executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32951performance while maintaining platform independence.
32952
32953Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32954portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32955object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32956and debug information.  In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32957@value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32958symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32959
32960If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32961it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary.  If
32962you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32963of this chapter.  At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32964LLVM JIT.
32965
32966Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface.  The
32967JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32968variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol.  When @value{GDBN}
32969attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32970find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32971out about additional code.
32972
32973@menu
32974* Declarations::                Relevant C struct declarations
32975* Registering Code::            Steps to register code
32976* Unregistering Code::          Steps to unregister code
32977* Custom Debug Info::           Emit debug information in a custom format
32978@end menu
32979
32980@node Declarations
32981@section JIT Declarations
32982
32983These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32984implement the interface:
32985
32986@smallexample
32987typedef enum
32988@{
32989  JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32990  JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32991  JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32992@} jit_actions_t;
32993
32994struct jit_code_entry
32995@{
32996  struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32997  struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32998  const char *symfile_addr;
32999  uint64_t symfile_size;
33000@};
33001
33002struct jit_descriptor
33003@{
33004  uint32_t version;
33005  /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33006     to be explicit about the bitwidth.  */
33007  uint32_t action_flag;
33008  struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33009  struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33010@};
33011
33012/* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function.  */
33013void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33014
33015/* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33016   debugger may check the version before we can set it.  */
33017struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33018@end smallexample
33019
33020If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33021modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33022a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33023
33024@node Registering Code
33025@section Registering Code
33026
33027To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33028
33029@itemize @bullet
33030@item
33031Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33032information.  The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33033
33034@item
33035Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33036file.
33037
33038@item
33039Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33040
33041@item
33042Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33043
33044@item
33045Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33046@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33047@end itemize
33048
33049When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33050@code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33051new code.  However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33052@value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33053
33054@node Unregistering Code
33055@section Unregistering Code
33056
33057If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33058
33059@itemize @bullet
33060@item
33061Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33062
33063@item
33064Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33065
33066@item
33067Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33068@code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33069@end itemize
33070
33071If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33072and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33073
33074@node Custom Debug Info
33075@section Custom Debug Info
33076@cindex custom JIT debug info
33077@cindex JIT debug info reader
33078
33079Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33080or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33081debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace.  The
33082issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33083format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33084by the JIT compiler.  This section gives a brief overview on writing
33085such a parser.  More specific details can be found in the source file
33086@file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33087@file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33088
33089The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33090not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33091runtime).  Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33092@code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33093the readers from a preconfigured directory.  Once loaded, the shared
33094object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33095compiler.
33096
33097@menu
33098* Using JIT Debug Info Readers::       How to use supplied readers correctly
33099* Writing JIT Debug Info Readers::     Creating a debug-info reader
33100@end menu
33101
33102@node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33103@subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33104@kindex jit-reader-load
33105@kindex jit-reader-unload
33106
33107Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33108and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33109
33110@table @code
33111@item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33112Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33113object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name.  In
33114the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33115pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33116system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33117@file{/usr/local/lib}).
33118
33119Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33120reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33121reporting an error.  A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33122the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33123@code{jit-reader-load}.
33124
33125@item jit-reader-unload
33126Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
33127
33128@end table
33129
33130@node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33131@subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
33132@cindex writing JIT debug info readers
33133
33134As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
33135certain ABI.  This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
33136
33137@file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
33138required to write a reader.  It is installed (along with
33139@value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
33140the system include directory.
33141
33142Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license.  A reader
33143can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
33144@code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
33145
33146The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
33147which is expected to be a function with the prototype
33148
33149@findex gdb_init_reader
33150@smallexample
33151extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
33152@end smallexample
33153
33154@cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
33155
33156@code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
33157functions.  These functions are executed to read the debug info
33158generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
33159(@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
33160(@code{get_Frame_id}).  It also has a callback that is called when the
33161reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}).  The struct looks like this
33162
33163@smallexample
33164struct gdb_reader_funcs
33165@{
33166  /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION.  */
33167  int reader_version;
33168
33169  /* For use by the reader.  */
33170  void *priv_data;
33171
33172  gdb_read_debug_info *read;
33173  gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
33174  gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
33175  gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
33176@};
33177@end smallexample
33178
33179@cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
33180@cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
33181
33182The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
33183@value{GDBN} to do their job.  For @code{read}, these callbacks are
33184passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
33185and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
33186@code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
33187files and new symbol tables inside those object files.  @code{struct
33188gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
33189frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
33190frame.  Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
33191target's address space.
33192
33193@node In-Process Agent
33194@chapter In-Process Agent
33195@cindex debugging agent
33196The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
33197because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution.  However,
33198as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
33199multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
33200and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
33201example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
33202timing may conceal the bugs.  On the other hand, in some applications,
33203it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
33204long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
33205If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
33206introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
33207code itself is correct.  It is useful to be able to observe the program's
33208behavior without interrupting it.
33209
33210Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
33211some bugs.  In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
33212reduce the number of operations performed by debugger.  The
33213@dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
33214process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
33215itself.  As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
33216performance of debugging can be improved accordingly.  Note that
33217interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
33218because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
33219
33220The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
33221(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations.  The
33222agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
33223data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
33224
33225@anchor{Control Agent}
33226You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
33227debugging with the following commands:
33228
33229@table @code
33230@kindex set agent on
33231@item set agent on
33232Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
33233debugger.  Just which operations requested by the user will be done
33234by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities.  For example,
33235if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
33236and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
33237conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
33238
33239@kindex set agent off
33240@item set agent off
33241Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent.  All
33242of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
33243
33244@kindex show agent
33245@item show agent
33246Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
33247the in-process agent.
33248@end table
33249
33250@menu
33251* In-Process Agent Protocol::
33252@end menu
33253
33254@node In-Process Agent Protocol
33255@section In-Process Agent Protocol
33256@cindex in-process agent protocol
33257
33258The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
33259GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}).  This section documents the protocol
33260used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
33261In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
33262(@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
33263in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
33264some other information.  The data sent to in-process agent is composed
33265of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
33266types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
33267
33268@menu
33269* IPA Protocol Objects::
33270* IPA Protocol Commands::
33271@end menu
33272
33273@node IPA Protocol Objects
33274@subsection IPA Protocol Objects
33275@cindex ipa protocol objects
33276
33277The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
33278complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
33279
33280The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
33281or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
33282two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
33283However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
33284
33285@enumerate
33286@item
33287word size.  On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
33288compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
33289@item
33290ABI.  Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
33291GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
33292the other one.
33293@end enumerate
33294
33295Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
33296
33297@enumerate
33298@item
33299agent expression object.  It represents an agent expression
33300(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
33301@anchor{agent expression object}
33302@item
33303tracepoint action object.  It represents a tracepoint action
33304(@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
33305memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
33306@anchor{tracepoint action object}
33307@item
33308tracepoint object.  It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
33309@anchor{tracepoint object}
33310
33311@end enumerate
33312
33313The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
33314object:
33315
33316@multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
33317@headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
33318@item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
33319@item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
33320@item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
33321@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
33322@item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33323@item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
33324address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
33325of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
33326@item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
33327@item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
33328memory address for collecting.
33329@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
33330@item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33331@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
33332@item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33333@item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
33334@item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
33335@item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
33336@item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
33337@item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
33338@item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
33339@item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
33340@item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
33341@item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
33342@item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
33343@item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
33344@item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
33345@item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33346@item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33347@item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33348@item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33349@ref{agent expression object}
33350@tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33351@ref{agent expression object}
33352@item actions @tab variable
33353@tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33354@end multitable
33355
33356@node IPA Protocol Commands
33357@subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33358@cindex ipa protocol commands
33359
33360The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33361specification.  They don't exist in real commands.
33362
33363@table @samp
33364
33365@item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33366Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33367(@pxref{tracepoint object}).  The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33368head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33369in IPA finally.
33370
33371Replies:
33372@table @samp
33373@item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33374@var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33375The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad.  Both of
33376@var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33377The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33378The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33379@item E @var{NN}
33380for an error
33381
33382@end table
33383
33384@item close
33385Closes the in-process agent.  This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33386is about to kill inferiors.
33387
33388@item qTfSTM
33389@xref{qTfSTM}.
33390@item qTsSTM
33391@xref{qTsSTM}.
33392@item qTSTMat
33393@xref{qTSTMat}.
33394@item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33395Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33396
33397Replies:
33398@table @samp
33399@item E @var{NN}
33400for an error
33401@end table
33402@item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33403Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33404@end table
33405
33406@node GDB Bugs
33407@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33408@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33409@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33410
33411Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33412
33413Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33414may not.  But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33415the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better.  Bug
33416reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33417
33418In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33419information that enables us to fix the bug.
33420
33421@menu
33422* Bug Criteria::                Have you found a bug?
33423* Bug Reporting::               How to report bugs
33424@end menu
33425
33426@node Bug Criteria
33427@section Have You Found a Bug?
33428@cindex bug criteria
33429
33430If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33431
33432@itemize @bullet
33433@cindex fatal signal
33434@cindex debugger crash
33435@cindex crash of debugger
33436@item
33437If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33438@value{GDBN} bug.  Reliable debuggers never crash.
33439
33440@cindex error on valid input
33441@item
33442If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33443bug.  (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33444somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33445
33446@cindex invalid input
33447@item
33448If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33449that is a bug.  However, you should note that your idea of
33450``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33451for traditional practice''.
33452
33453@item
33454If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33455for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33456@end itemize
33457
33458@node Bug Reporting
33459@section How to Report Bugs
33460@cindex bug reports
33461@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33462
33463A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33464If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33465contact that organization first.
33466
33467You can find contact information for many support companies and
33468individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33469distribution.
33470@c should add a web page ref...
33471
33472@ifset BUGURL
33473@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33474In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33475@value{GDBN}.  The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33476@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33477page}.  Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33478be used.
33479
33480@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33481@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.}  Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33482not want to receive bug reports.  Those that do have arranged to receive
33483@samp{bug-gdb}.
33484
33485The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33486serves as a repeater.  The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33487the same messages.  Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33488newsgroup instead of mailing them.  This appears to work, but it has one
33489problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33490path back to the sender.  Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33491we may be unable to reach you.  For this reason, it is better to send
33492bug reports to the mailing list.
33493@end ifset
33494@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33495In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33496@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33497@end ifclear
33498@end ifset
33499
33500The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33501@strong{report all the facts}.  If you are not sure whether to state a
33502fact or leave it out, state it!
33503
33504Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33505problem and assume that some details do not matter.  Thus, you might
33506assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33507Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure.  Perhaps the bug is a
33508stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33509name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33510of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33511the bug.  Play it safe and give a specific, complete example.  That is the
33512easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33513
33514Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33515bug.  It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33516you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33517self-contained.
33518
33519Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33520bell?''  Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33521@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33522bugs properly.
33523
33524To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33525
33526@itemize @bullet
33527@item
33528The version of @value{GDBN}.  @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33529with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33530version}.
33531
33532Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33533the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33534
33535@item
33536The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33537version number.
33538
33539@item
33540The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33541@value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33542@option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33543@code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33544
33545@item
33546What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33547``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33548
33549@item
33550What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33551debugging---e.g.@:  ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33552C Compiler''.  For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33553to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33554those compilers.
33555
33556@item
33557The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33558observe the bug.  For example, did you use @samp{-O}?  To guarantee
33559you will not omit something important, list them all.  A copy of the
33560Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33561
33562If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33563and then we might not encounter the bug.
33564
33565@item
33566A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33567reproduce the bug.
33568
33569@item
33570A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33571incorrect.  For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33572
33573Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33574will certainly notice it.  But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33575not notice unless it is glaringly wrong.  You might as well not give us
33576a chance to make a mistake.
33577
33578Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33579say so explicitly.  Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33580copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33581the C library on your system.  (This has happened!)  Your copy might
33582crash and ours would not.  If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33583ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33584us.  If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33585to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33586
33587@pindex script
33588@cindex recording a session script
33589To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33590such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33591Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33592include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33593
33594Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33595inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33596
33597@item
33598If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33599diffs.  If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33600it by context, not by line number.
33601
33602The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33603sources.  Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33604
33605@end itemize
33606
33607Here are some things that are not necessary:
33608
33609@itemize @bullet
33610@item
33611A description of the envelope of the bug.
33612
33613Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33614which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33615changes will not affect it.
33616
33617This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33618will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33619with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33620We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33621
33622Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33623of the original one, that is a convenience for us.  Errors in the
33624output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33625less time, and so on.
33626
33627However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33628report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33629
33630@item
33631A patch for the bug.
33632
33633A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one.  But do not omit
33634the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33635a patch is all we need.  We might see problems with your patch and decide
33636to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33637
33638Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33639construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33640through the code.  If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33641to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33642
33643And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33644patch should be an improvement, we will not install it.  A test case will
33645help us to understand.
33646
33647@item
33648A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33649
33650Such guesses are usually wrong.  Even we cannot guess right about such
33651things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33652@end itemize
33653
33654@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33655@c and consists of the two following files:
33656@c     rluser.texi
33657@c     hsuser.texi
33658@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33659@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33660@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33661@include rluser.texi
33662@include hsuser.texi
33663@end ifclear
33664
33665@node In Memoriam
33666@appendix In Memoriam
33667
33668The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33669contributors:
33670
33671@table @code
33672@item Fred Fish
33673Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33674to Free Software in general.  Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33675the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33676
33677@item Michael Snyder
33678Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33679with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011.  In addition
33680to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33681adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33682@end table
33683
33684Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33685enjoyable members of the Free Software Community.  We will miss them.
33686
33687@node Formatting Documentation
33688@appendix Formatting Documentation
33689
33690@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33691@cindex reference card
33692The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33693for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33694subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33695@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33696release.}.  If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33697you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33698
33699The release also includes the source for the reference card.  You
33700can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33701
33702@smallexample
33703make refcard.dvi
33704@end smallexample
33705
33706The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33707mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33708that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33709high.  You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33710your @sc{dvi} output program.
33711
33712@cindex documentation
33713
33714All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33715distribution.  The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33716a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33717on-line information and a printed manual.  You can use one of the Info
33718formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33719and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33720
33721@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33722version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory.  The main Info
33723file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33724subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory.  If
33725necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33726but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33727Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33728@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33729
33730If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33731Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33732@code{makeinfo}.
33733
33734If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33735@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33736version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33737
33738@smallexample
33739cd gdb
33740make gdb.info
33741@end smallexample
33742
33743If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33744a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33745Texinfo definitions file.
33746
33747@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33748produces output files called @sc{dvi} files.  To print a typeset
33749document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files.  If your system
33750has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program.  The precise
33751command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33752(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}.  The @sc{dvi} print command may
33753require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33754
33755@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33756@file{texinfo.tex}.  This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33757written in Texinfo format.  On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33758typeset a Texinfo file.  @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33759and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33760directory.
33761
33762If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33763typeset and print this manual.  First switch to the @file{gdb}
33764subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33765@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33766
33767@smallexample
33768make gdb.dvi
33769@end smallexample
33770
33771Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33772
33773@node Installing GDB
33774@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33775@cindex installation
33776
33777@menu
33778* Requirements::                Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33779* Running Configure::           Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33780* Separate Objdir::             Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33781* Config Names::                Specifying names for hosts and targets
33782* Configure Options::           Summary of options for configure
33783* System-wide configuration::   Having a system-wide init file
33784@end menu
33785
33786@node Requirements
33787@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33788@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33789
33790Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33791Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33792
33793@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33794@table @asis
33795@item ISO C90 compiler
33796@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90.  It should be buildable with any
33797working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33798
33799@end table
33800
33801@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33802@table @asis
33803@item Expat
33804@anchor{Expat}
33805@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library.  This library may be
33806included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33807can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33808The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33809standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33810use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33811
33812Expat is used for:
33813
33814@itemize @bullet
33815@item
33816Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33817@item
33818Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33819@item
33820Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33821or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33822@item
33823MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33824@item
33825Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33826@item
33827Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33828@pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33829@end itemize
33830
33831@item zlib
33832@cindex compressed debug sections
33833@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33834compressed debug sections.  Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33835of producing binaries with compressed debug sections.  If @value{GDBN}
33836is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33837information in such binaries.
33838
33839The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33840distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33841@url{http://zlib.net}.
33842
33843@item iconv
33844@value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33845Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation.  If you are
33846on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library.  Some
33847other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33848
33849If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33850in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33851This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33852directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33853
33854On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv.  If you
33855have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33856@option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33857
33858@value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33859arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33860in the top-most source directory.  If Libiconv is built this way, and
33861if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33862implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33863by @value{GDBN}.  One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33864Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33865Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33866@end table
33867
33868@node Running Configure
33869@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33870@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33871@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33872of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33873build the @code{gdb} program.
33874@iftex
33875@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33876@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33877look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33878installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33879@end iftex
33880
33881The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33882@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33883appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33884
33885For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33886@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.  That directory contains:
33887
33888@table @code
33889@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33890script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33891
33892@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33893the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33894
33895@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33896source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33897
33898@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33899@sc{gnu} include files
33900
33901@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33902source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33903
33904@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33905source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33906
33907@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33908source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33909
33910@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33911source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33912
33913@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33914source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33915@end table
33916
33917The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33918from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33919this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33920
33921First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33922if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}.  Pass the
33923identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33924argument.
33925
33926For example:
33927
33928@smallexample
33929cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33930./configure @var{host}
33931make
33932@end smallexample
33933
33934@noindent
33935where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33936@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33937(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33938correct value by examining your system.)
33939
33940Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33941@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33942libraries, then @code{gdb} itself.  The configured source files, and the
33943binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33944
33945@need 750
33946@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33947system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33948shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33949
33950@smallexample
33951sh configure @var{host}
33952@end smallexample
33953
33954If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33955directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33956@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33957@file{configure}
33958creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33959you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33960
33961You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33962source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory.  If you run
33963@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33964that subdirectory.  That is usually not what you want.  In particular,
33965if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33966of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33967configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33968directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory.  This leads to build errors
33969about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33970
33971You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33972However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33973the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable.  Remember
33974that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33975let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33976
33977@node Separate Objdir
33978@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33979
33980If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33981you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33982host and target.  @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33983allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33984rather than in the source directory.  If your @code{make} program
33985handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33986@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33987program specified there.
33988
33989To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33990with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33991(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33992itself from your working directory.  If the path to @file{configure}
33993would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33994the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33995
33996For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33997separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33998
33999@smallexample
34000@group
34001cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34002mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34003cd ../gdb-sun4
34004../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34005make
34006@end group
34007@end smallexample
34008
34009When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34010directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34011(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory.  In
34012the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34013directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34014@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34015
34016Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34017instance of @file{gdb} in it.  If your path to @file{configure} looks
34018like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34019one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package.  This leads to
34020build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34021
34022One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34023directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34024@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34025programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34026You specify a cross-debugging target by
34027giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34028
34029When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34030it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34031called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34032
34033The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34034directory also runs recursively.  If you type @code{make} in a source
34035directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34036directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34037will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34038
34039When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34040directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34041if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34042with each other.
34043
34044@node Config Names
34045@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34046
34047The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34048script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34049aliases are also supported.  The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34050of information in the following pattern:
34051
34052@smallexample
34053@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34054@end smallexample
34055
34056For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34057or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34058option.  The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34059
34060The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34061any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34062aliases.  @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34063@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34064script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34065abbreviations---for example:
34066
34067@smallexample
34068% sh config.sub i386-linux
34069i386-pc-linux-gnu
34070% sh config.sub alpha-linux
34071alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34072% sh config.sub hp9k700
34073hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34074% sh config.sub sun4
34075sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34076% sh config.sub sun3
34077m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34078% sh config.sub i986v
34079Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34080@end smallexample
34081
34082@noindent
34083@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34084directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34085
34086@node Configure Options
34087@section @file{configure} Options
34088
34089Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34090are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}.  @file{configure} also has
34091several other options not listed here.  @inforef{What Configure
34092Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34093
34094@smallexample
34095configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34096          @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34097          @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34098          @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34099          @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34100          @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34101          @var{host}
34102@end smallexample
34103
34104@noindent
34105You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34106@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34107@samp{--}.
34108
34109@table @code
34110@item --help
34111Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
34112
34113@item --prefix=@var{dir}
34114Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
34115@file{@var{dir}}.
34116
34117@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
34118Configure the source to install programs under directory
34119@file{@var{dir}}.
34120
34121@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
34122@need 2000
34123@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
34124@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
34125@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
34126Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
34127@value{GDBN} source directories.  Among other things, you can use this to
34128build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
34129directories.  @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
34130the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
34131directory @var{dirname}.  @file{configure} creates directories under
34132the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
34133@var{dirname}.
34134
34135@item --norecursion
34136Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
34137propagate configuration to subdirectories.
34138
34139@item --target=@var{target}
34140Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
34141@var{target}.  Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
34142programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
34143
34144There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
34145
34146@item @var{host} @dots{}
34147Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
34148
34149There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
34150@end table
34151
34152There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
34153needed for special purposes only.
34154
34155@node System-wide configuration
34156@section System-wide configuration and settings
34157@cindex system-wide init file
34158
34159@value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
34160this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
34161@value{GDBN} does during startup}).
34162
34163Here is the corresponding configure option:
34164
34165@table @code
34166@item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
34167Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
34168@var{file}.
34169@end table
34170
34171If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
34172it may be subject to relocation.  Two possible cases:
34173
34174@itemize @bullet
34175@item
34176If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
34177it will be subject to relocation.  Suppose that the configure options
34178are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
34179if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
34180init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
34181@file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
34182
34183@item
34184By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
34185it will not be relocated.  E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
34186@option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34187then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
34188wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
34189@end itemize
34190
34191If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
34192@option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
34193data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
34194time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
34195system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
34196@option{--data-directory} command-line option.
34197Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
34198initialization.  If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
34199started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
34200reread.
34201
34202@menu
34203* System-wide Configuration Scripts::  Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34204@end menu
34205
34206@node System-wide Configuration Scripts
34207@subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
34208@cindex system-wide configuration scripts
34209
34210The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
34211(as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
34212a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files.  To
34213automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
34214configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}.  Otherwise, any user
34215should be able to source them by hand as needed.
34216
34217The following scripts are currently available:
34218@itemize @bullet
34219
34220@item @file{elinos.py}
34221@pindex elinos.py
34222@cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
34223This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
34224It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
34225ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
34226shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
34227and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
34228
34229@item @file{wrs-linux.py}
34230@pindex wrs-linux.py
34231@cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
34232This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
34233Wind River Linux.  It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
34234the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
34235
34236@end itemize
34237
34238@node Maintenance Commands
34239@appendix Maintenance Commands
34240@cindex maintenance commands
34241@cindex internal commands
34242
34243In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
34244includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
34245that are not documented elsewhere in this manual.  These commands are
34246provided here for reference.  (For commands that turn on debugging
34247messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
34248
34249@table @code
34250@kindex maint agent
34251@kindex maint agent-eval
34252@item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34253@itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
34254Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
34255This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
34256(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).  The @samp{agent} version produces an
34257expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
34258@samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
34259to a result.  For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
34260globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
34261of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
34262the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
34263addition and return the sum.
34264If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
34265If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
34266
34267@kindex maint agent-printf
34268@item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
34269Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
34270into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
34271This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
34272printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
34273
34274@kindex maint info breakpoints
34275@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
34276Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
34277breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
34278internal purposes.  Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
34279breakpoint numbers.  The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
34280is shown:
34281
34282@table @code
34283@item breakpoint
34284Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
34285
34286@item watchpoint
34287Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
34288
34289@item longjmp
34290Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
34291@code{longjmp} calls.
34292
34293@item longjmp resume
34294Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
34295
34296@item until
34297Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
34298
34299@item finish
34300Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
34301
34302@item shlib events
34303Shared library events.
34304
34305@end table
34306
34307@kindex maint info btrace
34308@item maint info btrace
34309Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
34310
34311@kindex maint btrace packet-history
34312@item maint btrace packet-history
34313Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
34314execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command.  Both the
34315information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
34316recording format.
34317
34318@table @code
34319@item bts
34320For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
34321code.  For each block, the following information is printed:
34322
34323@table @asis
34324@item Block number
34325Newer blocks have higher numbers.  The oldest block has number zero.
34326@item Lowest @samp{PC}
34327@item Highest @samp{PC}
34328@end table
34329
34330@item pt
34331For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
34332Intel Processor Trace packets.  For each packet, the following
34333information is printed:
34334
34335@table @asis
34336@item Packet number
34337Newer packets have higher numbers.  The oldest packet has number zero.
34338@item Trace offset
34339The packet's offset in the trace stream.
34340@item Packet opcode and payload
34341@end table
34342@end table
34343
34344@kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
34345@item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34346Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34347packet-history} command.  The history will be computed again when
34348needed.
34349
34350@kindex maint btrace clear
34351@item maint btrace clear
34352Discard the branch trace data.  The data will be fetched anew and the
34353branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34354
34355This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34356buffer.  When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34357available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34358buffer.
34359
34360@kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34361@item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34362@kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34363@item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34364Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34365packet history.
34366
34367@kindex set displaced-stepping
34368@kindex show displaced-stepping
34369@cindex displaced stepping support
34370@cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34371@item set displaced-stepping
34372@itemx show displaced-stepping
34373Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34374if the target supports it.  Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34375over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34376an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34377breakpoint location.  It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34378
34379@table @code
34380@item set displaced-stepping on
34381If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34382displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34383
34384@item set displaced-stepping off
34385@value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34386even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34387
34388@cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34389@item set displaced-stepping auto
34390This is the default mode.  @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34391only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34392architecture supports displaced stepping.
34393@end table
34394
34395@kindex maint check-psymtabs
34396@item maint check-psymtabs
34397Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34398Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34399
34400@kindex maint check-symtabs
34401@item maint check-symtabs
34402Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34403
34404@kindex maint expand-symtabs
34405@item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34406Expand symbol tables.
34407If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34408names matching @var{regexp}.
34409
34410@kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34411@kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34412@cindex demangler crashes
34413@item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34414@itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34415Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34416symbol name demangler.  The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34417If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34418the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34419option to terminate the current session.
34420
34421@kindex maint cplus first_component
34422@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34423Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34424
34425@kindex maint cplus namespace
34426@item maint cplus namespace
34427Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34428
34429@kindex maint deprecate
34430@kindex maint undeprecate
34431@cindex deprecated commands
34432@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34433@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34434Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}.  Deprecated commands
34435cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them.  The optional
34436argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34437favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34438the replacement as part of the warning.
34439
34440@kindex maint dump-me
34441@item maint dump-me
34442@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34443Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34444This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34445with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34446
34447@kindex maint internal-error
34448@kindex maint internal-warning
34449@kindex maint demangler-warning
34450@cindex demangler crashes
34451@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34452@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34453@itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34454
34455Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34456@code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34457as though an internal problem has been detected.  In addition to
34458reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34459opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34460and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34461@value{GDBN} session.
34462
34463These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34464used as the text of the error or warning message.
34465
34466Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34467
34468@smallexample
34469(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34470@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34471A problem internal to GDB has been detected.  Further
34472debugging may prove unreliable.
34473Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34474Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34475(@value{GDBP})
34476@end smallexample
34477
34478@cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34479@cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34480@cindex demangler crashes
34481
34482@kindex maint set internal-error
34483@kindex maint show internal-error
34484@kindex maint set internal-warning
34485@kindex maint show internal-warning
34486@kindex maint set demangler-warning
34487@kindex maint show demangler-warning
34488@item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34489@itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34490@itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34491@itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34492@itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34493@itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34494When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34495gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34496core file of the current @value{GDBN} session.  These commands let you
34497override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34498described in the table below.
34499
34500@table @samp
34501@item quit
34502You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34503quit.  The default is to ask the user what to do.
34504
34505@item corefile
34506You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34507create a core file.  The default is to ask the user what to do.  Note
34508that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34509demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34510disabled.
34511@end table
34512
34513@kindex maint packet
34514@item maint packet @var{text}
34515If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34516then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34517displays the response packet.  @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34518@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34519checksum.
34520
34521@kindex maint print architecture
34522@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34523Print the entire architecture configuration.  The optional argument
34524@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34525
34526@kindex maint print c-tdesc
34527@item maint print c-tdesc
34528Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34529a C source file.  The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34530when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34531
34532@kindex maint print dummy-frames
34533@item maint print dummy-frames
34534Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34535
34536@smallexample
34537(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34538@dots{}
34539(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34540Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
3454158	  return (a + b);
34542The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34543@dots{}
34544(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
345450xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34546(@value{GDBP})
34547@end smallexample
34548
34549Takes an optional file parameter.
34550
34551@kindex maint print registers
34552@kindex maint print raw-registers
34553@kindex maint print cooked-registers
34554@kindex maint print register-groups
34555@kindex maint print remote-registers
34556@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34557@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34558@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34559@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34560@itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34561Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34562
34563The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34564the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34565cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34566including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34567to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34568groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34569print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34570and offsets in the `G' packets.
34571
34572These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34573write the information.
34574
34575@kindex maint print reggroups
34576@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34577Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.  The
34578optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34579information.
34580
34581The register groups info looks like this:
34582
34583@smallexample
34584(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34585 Group      Type
34586 general    user
34587 float      user
34588 all        user
34589 vector     user
34590 system     user
34591 save       internal
34592 restore    internal
34593@end smallexample
34594
34595@kindex flushregs
34596@item flushregs
34597This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34598
34599@kindex maint print objfiles
34600@cindex info for known object files
34601@item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34602Print a dump of all known object files.
34603If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34604match @var{regexp}.  For each object file, this command prints its name,
34605address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34606
34607@kindex maint print user-registers
34608@cindex user registers
34609@item maint print user-registers
34610List all currently available @dfn{user registers}.  User registers
34611typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers.  They
34612include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34613@code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}.  @xref{standard registers}.  User
34614registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34615register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34616registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34617
34618@kindex maint print section-scripts
34619@cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34620@item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34621Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34622If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34623matching @var{regexp}.
34624For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34625and the full path if known.
34626@xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34627
34628@kindex maint print statistics
34629@cindex bcache statistics
34630@item maint print statistics
34631This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34632about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34633statistics for the object file.  The objfile data includes the number
34634of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34635defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34636the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34637used by the various tables.  The bcache statistics include the counts,
34638sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34639average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34640savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34641lengths.
34642
34643@kindex maint print target-stack
34644@cindex target stack description
34645@item maint print target-stack
34646A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34647kind of file or process.  Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34648so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34649In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34650until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34651address.
34652
34653This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34654the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34655
34656@kindex maint print type
34657@cindex type chain of a data type
34658@item maint print type @var{expr}
34659Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}.  The argument
34660can be either a type name or a symbol.  If it is a symbol, the type of
34661that symbol is described.  The type chain produced by this command is
34662a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34663data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34664
34665@kindex maint selftest
34666@cindex self tests
34667Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}.  This will
34668print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
34669
34670@kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34671@kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34672@item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34673@item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34674Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34675information.
34676
34677The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34678describe a variable's location in an easily readable format.  When
34679@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34680expression in an assembly-like format.  Note that some locations are
34681too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34682always see the disassembly form.
34683
34684Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34685
34686@smallexample
34687(gdb) info addr argc
34688Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34689     1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34690@end smallexample
34691
34692For more information on these expressions, see
34693@uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34694
34695@kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34696@kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34697@item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34698@itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34699Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34700
34701@cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34702In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34703produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34704reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34705This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34706cache if it is not referenced.  A higher limit means that cached
34707compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34708memory will be used.  Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34709slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34710
34711@kindex maint set profile
34712@kindex maint show profile
34713@cindex profiling GDB
34714@item maint set profile
34715@itemx maint show profile
34716Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34717
34718Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34719command to enable it.  When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34720collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34721exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file.  Remember that
34722if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34723(often called @file{gmon.out}).  If you have a record of important profiling
34724data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34725
34726Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34727compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34728
34729@kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34730@kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34731@cindex hardware debug registers
34732@item maint set show-debug-regs
34733@itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34734Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34735registers.  Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable.  If
34736enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34737removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34738triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34739
34740@kindex maint set show-all-tib
34741@kindex maint show show-all-tib
34742@item maint set show-all-tib
34743@itemx maint show show-all-tib
34744Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34745at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34746command.
34747
34748@kindex maint set target-async
34749@kindex maint show target-async
34750@item maint set target-async
34751@itemx maint show target-async
34752This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34753asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}).  Normally the
34754default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34755to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34756
34757@kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34758@kindex maint show target-non-stop
34759@item maint set target-non-stop
34760@itemx maint show target-non-stop
34761
34762This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34763mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34764Mode}).  The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34765if supported by the target.
34766
34767@table @code
34768@item maint set target-non-stop auto
34769This is the default mode.  @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34770non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34771
34772@item maint set target-non-stop on
34773@value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34774does not indicate support.
34775
34776@item maint set target-non-stop off
34777@value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34778target supports it.
34779@end table
34780
34781@kindex maint set per-command
34782@kindex maint show per-command
34783@item maint set per-command
34784@itemx maint show per-command
34785@cindex resources used by commands
34786
34787@value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34788This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34789
34790@table @code
34791@item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34792@itemx maint show per-command space
34793Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34794If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34795took, following the command's own output.
34796This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34797@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34798
34799@item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34800@itemx maint show per-command time
34801Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34802for each command.
34803If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34804took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34805Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34806Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34807CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34808Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34809the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34810to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34811spent by the program been debugged.
34812This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34813@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34814
34815@item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34816@itemx maint show per-command symtab
34817Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34818for each command.
34819If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34820
34821@enumerate a
34822@item
34823number of symbol tables
34824@item
34825number of primary symbol tables
34826@item
34827number of blocks in the blockvector
34828@end enumerate
34829@end table
34830
34831@kindex maint space
34832@cindex memory used by commands
34833@item maint space @var{value}
34834An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34835A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34836
34837@kindex maint time
34838@cindex time of command execution
34839@item maint time @var{value}
34840An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34841A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34842
34843@kindex maint translate-address
34844@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34845Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34846@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}.  If found,
34847@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34848the symbol's location to the specified address.  This is similar to
34849the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34850command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34851
34852If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34853is also printed.  For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34854executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34855
34856@end table
34857
34858The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34859@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34860
34861@table @code
34862@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34863@kindex set watchdog
34864@cindex watchdog timer
34865@cindex timeout for commands
34866Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34867target operation to finish.  If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34868reports and error and the command is aborted.
34869
34870@item show watchdog
34871Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34872@end table
34873
34874@node Remote Protocol
34875@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34876
34877@menu
34878* Overview::
34879* Packets::
34880* Stop Reply Packets::
34881* General Query Packets::
34882* Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34883* Tracepoint Packets::
34884* Host I/O Packets::
34885* Interrupts::
34886* Notification Packets::
34887* Remote Non-Stop::
34888* Packet Acknowledgment::
34889* Examples::
34890* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34891* Library List Format::
34892* Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34893* Memory Map Format::
34894* Thread List Format::
34895* Traceframe Info Format::
34896* Branch Trace Format::
34897* Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34898@end menu
34899
34900@node Overview
34901@section Overview
34902
34903There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34904protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34905machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34906recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34907
34908In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34909transmitted and received data, respectively.
34910
34911@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34912@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34913@cindex remote serial protocol
34914All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34915and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34916@var{packet}.  A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34917@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34918@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34919
34920@smallexample
34921@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34922@end smallexample
34923@noindent
34924
34925@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34926@noindent
34927The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34928characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34929eight bit unsigned checksum).
34930
34931Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34932specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34933
34934@smallexample
34935@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34936@end smallexample
34937
34938@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34939@noindent
34940That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment.  @value{GDBN}
34941has never output @var{sequence-id}s.  Stubs that handle packets added
34942since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34943
34944When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34945response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34946the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34947retransmission):
34948
34949@smallexample
34950-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34951<- @code{+}
34952@end smallexample
34953@noindent
34954
34955The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34956once a connection is established.
34957@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34958
34959The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34960debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}.  In
34961the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34962when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34963threads in all attached processes.  This is the default all-stop mode
34964behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34965execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34966
34967@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34968exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34969exceptions).
34970
34971@cindex remote protocol, field separator
34972Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34973@samp{:}.  Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34974@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34975
34976Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34977@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34978would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34979
34980@cindex remote protocol, binary data
34981@anchor{Binary Data}
34982Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34983digits per byte of binary data.  This allowed the traditional remote
34984protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34985Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34986connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34987binary data.
34988
34989The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34990as an escape character.  Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34991character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34992For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34993bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}.  The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34994@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34995@samp{@}}) must always be escaped.  Responses sent by the stub
34996must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34997is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34998(described next).
34999
35000Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35001Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35002instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35003repeat count.  The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35004binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35005@code{@var{n}+29}.  For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35006produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35007code 32) for a repeat count of 3.  (This is because run-length
35008encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.)  Thus, for example,
35009@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35010after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
350113}} more times.
35012
35013The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35014greater than 126 must not be used.  Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35015seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35016five (@samp{"}).  For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35017@samp{0*"00}.
35018
35019The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35020error number.  That number is not well defined.
35021
35022@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35023For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35024(@samp{$#00}) should be returned.  That way it is possible to extend the
35025protocol.  A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35026on that response.
35027
35028At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35029commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35030for memory access.  Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35031can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35032(step) commands.  Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35033support the @samp{vCont} command.  All other commands are optional.
35034
35035@node Packets
35036@section Packets
35037
35038The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35039@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35040@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35041I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35042
35043Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35044syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning.  We
35045include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35046part of the packet's syntax.  No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35047separate its components.  For example, a template like @samp{foo
35048@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35049bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35050@var{baz}.  @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35051@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35052@var{baz}.
35053
35054@cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35055@anchor{thread-id syntax}
35056Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35057a thread.  Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35058interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings.  A @var{thread-id}
35059can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35060pick any thread.
35061
35062In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35063which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35064process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35065The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35066format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35067interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35068to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35069indicate an arbitrary process or thread.  Specifying just a process, as
35070@samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}.  It is an
35071error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35072@samp{p-1.@var{tid}}.  Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35073for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35074ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35075
35076The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35077@value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35078feature using @samp{qSupported}.  @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35079more information.
35080
35081Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35082letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35083
35084Here are the packet descriptions.
35085
35086@table @samp
35087
35088@item !
35089@cindex @samp{!} packet
35090@anchor{extended mode}
35091Enable extended mode.  In extended mode, the remote server is made
35092persistent.  The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35093debugged.
35094
35095Reply:
35096@table @samp
35097@item OK
35098The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
35099@end table
35100
35101@item ?
35102@cindex @samp{?} packet
35103@anchor{? packet}
35104Indicate the reason the target halted.  The reply is the same as for
35105step and continue.  This packet has a special interpretation when the
35106target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
35107
35108Reply:
35109@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35110
35111@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
35112@cindex @samp{A} packet
35113Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
35114specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
35115@var{arg}.  See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
35116
35117Reply:
35118@table @samp
35119@item OK
35120The arguments were set.
35121@item E @var{NN}
35122An error occurred.
35123@end table
35124
35125@item b @var{baud}
35126@cindex @samp{b} packet
35127(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
35128Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
35129
35130JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change?  When it's
35131received, or after the ACK is transmitted.  In either case, there are
35132problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
35133
35134Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
35135it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
35136some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
35137switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
35138of view, nothing actually happened.}
35139
35140@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
35141@cindex @samp{B} packet
35142Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
35143breakpoint at @var{addr}.
35144
35145Don't use this packet.  Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
35146(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
35147
35148@cindex @samp{bc} packet
35149@anchor{bc}
35150@item bc
35151Backward continue.  Execute the target system in reverse.  No parameter.
35152@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35153
35154Reply:
35155@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35156
35157@cindex @samp{bs} packet
35158@anchor{bs}
35159@item bs
35160Backward single step.  Execute one instruction in reverse.  No parameter.
35161@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
35162
35163Reply:
35164@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35165
35166@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35167@cindex @samp{c} packet
35168Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume.  If @var{addr}
35169is omitted, resume at current address.
35170
35171This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35172packet}.
35173
35174Reply:
35175@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35176
35177@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35178@cindex @samp{C} packet
35179Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number).  If
35180@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
35181
35182This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35183packet}.
35184
35185Reply:
35186@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35187
35188@item d
35189@cindex @samp{d} packet
35190Toggle debug flag.
35191
35192Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
35193(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
35194
35195@item D
35196@itemx D;@var{pid}
35197@cindex @samp{D} packet
35198The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
35199remote system.  It is sent to the remote target
35200before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
35201
35202The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
35203protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
35204detach only a specific process.  The @var{pid} is specified as a
35205big-endian hex string.
35206
35207Reply:
35208@table @samp
35209@item OK
35210for success
35211@item E @var{NN}
35212for an error
35213@end table
35214
35215@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
35216@cindex @samp{F} packet
35217A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
35218This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.  @xref{File-I/O
35219Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
35220
35221@item g
35222@anchor{read registers packet}
35223@cindex @samp{g} packet
35224Read general registers.
35225
35226Reply:
35227@table @samp
35228@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35229Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits.  The bytes
35230with the register are transmitted in target byte order.  The size of
35231each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
35232determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
35233@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.  The
35234specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
35235
35236When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
35237Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
35238literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
35239that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
35240is unavailable.  For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
352414 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
35242registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
35243have been collected, and both have zero value:
35244
35245@smallexample
35246-> @code{g}
35247<- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
35248@end smallexample
35249
35250@item E @var{NN}
35251for an error.
35252@end table
35253
35254@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
35255@cindex @samp{G} packet
35256Write general registers.  @xref{read registers packet}, for a
35257description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
35258
35259Reply:
35260@table @samp
35261@item OK
35262for success
35263@item E @var{NN}
35264for an error
35265@end table
35266
35267@item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
35268@cindex @samp{H} packet
35269Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
35270@samp{G}, et.al.).  Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
35271should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
35272is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
35273option), and @samp{g} for other operations.  The thread designator
35274@var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
35275@ref{thread-id syntax}.
35276
35277Reply:
35278@table @samp
35279@item OK
35280for success
35281@item E @var{NN}
35282for an error
35283@end table
35284
35285@c FIXME: JTC:
35286@c   'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model.  If a
35287@c        thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
35288@c        to continue to execute?  As I mentioned above, I think the
35289@c        semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
35290@c        described.  For example:
35291@c
35292@c        'g':    If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35293@c                selected, returns the register block from that thread;
35294@c                otherwise returns current registers.
35295@c
35296@c        'G'     If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
35297@c                selected, sets the registers of the register block of
35298@c                that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
35299
35300@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
35301@anchor{cycle step packet}
35302@cindex @samp{i} packet
35303Step the remote target by a single clock cycle.  If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
35304present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles.  If @var{addr} is present, cycle
35305step starting at that address.
35306
35307@item I
35308@cindex @samp{I} packet
35309Signal, then cycle step.  @xref{step with signal packet}.  @xref{cycle
35310step packet}.
35311
35312@item k
35313@cindex @samp{k} packet
35314Kill request.
35315
35316The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
35317
35318For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
35319system.  For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
35320
35321For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
35322
35323A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
35324that are under @value{GDBN}'s control.  For more precise control, use
35325the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
35326
35327If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
35328@samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
35329acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
35330
35331If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
35332not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
35333probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
35334(@pxref{? packet}).
35335
35336@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
35337@cindex @samp{m} packet
35338Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35339(@pxref{addressable memory unit}).  Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
35340any particular boundary.
35341
35342The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
35343data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
35344and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
35345use byte accesses, or not.  For this reason, this packet may not be
35346suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
35347@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
35348@cindex size of remote memory accesses
35349@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
35350
35351Reply:
35352@table @samp
35353@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35354Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35355The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35356server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35357@item E @var{NN}
35358@var{NN} is errno
35359@end table
35360
35361@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35362@cindex @samp{M} packet
35363Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35364(@pxref{addressable memory unit}).  The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35365byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35366
35367Reply:
35368@table @samp
35369@item OK
35370for success
35371@item E @var{NN}
35372for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35373written).
35374@end table
35375
35376@item p @var{n}
35377@cindex @samp{p} packet
35378Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35379@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35380register value is encoded.
35381
35382Reply:
35383@table @samp
35384@item @var{XX@dots{}}
35385the register's value
35386@item E @var{NN}
35387for an error
35388@item @w{}
35389Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35390@end table
35391
35392@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35393@anchor{write register packet}
35394@cindex @samp{P} packet
35395Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}.  The register
35396number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35397digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35398
35399Reply:
35400@table @samp
35401@item OK
35402for success
35403@item E @var{NN}
35404for an error
35405@end table
35406
35407@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35408@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35409@cindex @samp{q} packet
35410@cindex @samp{Q} packet
35411General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}).  These packets are
35412described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35413
35414@item r
35415@cindex @samp{r} packet
35416Reset the entire system.
35417
35418Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35419
35420@item R @var{XX}
35421@cindex @samp{R} packet
35422Restart the program being debugged.  The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35423This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35424
35425The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35426
35427@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35428@cindex @samp{s} packet
35429Single step, resuming at @var{addr}.  If
35430@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35431
35432This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35433packet}.
35434
35435Reply:
35436@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35437
35438@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35439@anchor{step with signal packet}
35440@cindex @samp{S} packet
35441Step with signal.  This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35442requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35443
35444This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support.  @xref{vCont
35445packet}.
35446
35447Reply:
35448@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35449
35450@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35451@cindex @samp{t} packet
35452Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35453@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35454There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35455
35456@item T @var{thread-id}
35457@cindex @samp{T} packet
35458Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive.  @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35459
35460Reply:
35461@table @samp
35462@item OK
35463thread is still alive
35464@item E @var{NN}
35465thread is dead
35466@end table
35467
35468@item v
35469Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35470up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35471
35472@item vAttach;@var{pid}
35473@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35474Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35475The process ID is a
35476hexadecimal integer identifying the process.  In all-stop mode, all
35477threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35478attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35479
35480@c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35481@c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process.  After
35482@c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35483@c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35484@c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35485@c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35486@c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35487@c stopping or restarting threads.
35488
35489This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35490
35491Reply:
35492@table @samp
35493@item E @var{nn}
35494for an error
35495@item @r{Any stop packet}
35496for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35497@item OK
35498for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35499@end table
35500
35501@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35502@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35503@anchor{vCont packet}
35504Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35505If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35506threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35507specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35508in their current state in non-stop mode.
35509Specifying multiple
35510default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35511Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35512
35513Currently supported actions are:
35514
35515@table @samp
35516@item c
35517Continue.
35518@item C @var{sig}
35519Continue with signal @var{sig}.  The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35520@item s
35521Step.
35522@item S @var{sig}
35523Step with signal @var{sig}.  The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35524@item t
35525Stop.
35526@item r @var{start},@var{end}
35527Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35528addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35529The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35530of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35531a breakpoint.  @xref{range stepping}.
35532
35533If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35534becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action.  In other words,
35535single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35536jumps to @var{start}).
35537
35538(A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35539the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35540in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35541
35542@end table
35543
35544The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35545@samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35546not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35547
35548The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35549(@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35550A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35551When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35552the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35553signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35554as an implementation detail.
35555
35556The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35557multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).  Note that in
35558this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35559in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35560@var{thread-id}.
35561
35562Reply:
35563@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35564
35565@item vCont?
35566@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35567Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35568
35569Reply:
35570@table @samp
35571@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35572The @samp{vCont} packet is supported.  Each @var{action} is a supported
35573command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35574@item @w{}
35575The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35576@end table
35577
35578@anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35579@item vCtrlC
35580@cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35581Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35582terminal.  This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35583(@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35584while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35585@xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35586variant.
35587
35588Reply:
35589@table @samp
35590@item E @var{nn}
35591for an error
35592@item OK
35593for success
35594@end table
35595
35596@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35597@cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35598Perform a file operation on the target system.  For details,
35599see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35600
35601@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35602@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35603Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35604@var{addr}.  The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35605its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35606flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35607Format}).  @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35608together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35609stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35610packet is received.
35611
35612Reply:
35613@table @samp
35614@item OK
35615for success
35616@item E @var{NN}
35617for an error
35618@end table
35619
35620@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35621@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35622Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}.  The data
35623is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35624packet (@pxref{Binary Data}).  The memory ranges specified by
35625@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35626not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35627(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35628have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35629@samp{vFlashWrite} packets).  If a packet writes to an address that was
35630neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35631target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35632
35633
35634Reply:
35635@table @samp
35636@item OK
35637for success
35638@item E.memtype
35639for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35640@item E @var{NN}
35641for an error
35642@end table
35643
35644@item vFlashDone
35645@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35646Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35647The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35648@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35649@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received.  The contents of the affected
35650regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35651request is completed.
35652
35653@item vKill;@var{pid}
35654@cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35655@anchor{vKill packet}
35656Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35657hexadecimal integer identifying the process.  This packet is used in
35658preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35659supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35660
35661Reply:
35662@table @samp
35663@item E @var{nn}
35664for an error
35665@item OK
35666for success
35667@end table
35668
35669@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35670@cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35671Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35672command line.  The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings.  If
35673@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35674(e.g.@: the last program run).  The program is created in the stopped
35675state.
35676
35677@c FIXME:  What about non-stop mode?
35678
35679This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35680
35681Reply:
35682@table @samp
35683@item E @var{nn}
35684for an error
35685@item @r{Any stop packet}
35686for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35687@end table
35688
35689@item vStopped
35690@cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35691@xref{Notification Packets}.
35692
35693@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35694@anchor{X packet}
35695@cindex @samp{X} packet
35696Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35697Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35698units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35699@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35700
35701Reply:
35702@table @samp
35703@item OK
35704for success
35705@item E @var{NN}
35706for an error
35707@end table
35708
35709@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35710@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35711@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35712@cindex @samp{z} packet
35713@cindex @samp{Z} packets
35714Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35715watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35716
35717Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35718separately.
35719
35720@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35721for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}.  A
35722remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35723@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair.  To
35724avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35725be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35726
35727@item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35728@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35729@cindex @samp{z0} packet
35730@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35731Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35732@var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35733
35734A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35735@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction.  The
35736@var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35737the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted.  E.g., the @sc{arm}
35738and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint.  Some
35739architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35740@var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35741form that should be evaluated on the target's side.  These are the
35742conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35743the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35744
35745See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35746for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35747
35748The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35749concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35750
35751@table @samp
35752
35753@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35754@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35755actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35756
35757@end table
35758
35759The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35760run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35761The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35762nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35763continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35764Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35765separators.  Each expression has the following form:
35766
35767@table @samp
35768
35769@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35770@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35771actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35772
35773@end table
35774
35775see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35776
35777@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35778code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35779overlays).  The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35780target, is not defined.}
35781
35782Reply:
35783@table @samp
35784@item OK
35785success
35786@item @w{}
35787not supported
35788@item E @var{NN}
35789for an error
35790@end table
35791
35792@item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35793@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35794@cindex @samp{z1} packet
35795@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35796Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35797address @var{addr}.
35798
35799A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35800dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.  The @var{kind}
35801and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35802
35803@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35804movement.}
35805
35806Reply:
35807@table @samp
35808@item OK
35809success
35810@item @w{}
35811not supported
35812@item E @var{NN}
35813for an error
35814@end table
35815
35816@item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35817@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35818@cindex @samp{z2} packet
35819@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35820Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35821The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35822
35823Reply:
35824@table @samp
35825@item OK
35826success
35827@item @w{}
35828not supported
35829@item E @var{NN}
35830for an error
35831@end table
35832
35833@item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35834@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35835@cindex @samp{z3} packet
35836@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35837Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35838The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35839
35840Reply:
35841@table @samp
35842@item OK
35843success
35844@item @w{}
35845not supported
35846@item E @var{NN}
35847for an error
35848@end table
35849
35850@item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35851@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35852@cindex @samp{z4} packet
35853@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35854Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35855The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35856
35857Reply:
35858@table @samp
35859@item OK
35860success
35861@item @w{}
35862not supported
35863@item E @var{NN}
35864for an error
35865@end table
35866
35867@end table
35868
35869@node Stop Reply Packets
35870@section Stop Reply Packets
35871@cindex stop reply packets
35872
35873The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35874@samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35875receive any of the below as a reply.  Except for @samp{?}
35876and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35877when the target halts.  In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35878number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35879@value{GDBN} source code.
35880
35881As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35882reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35883syntax.  No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35884components.
35885
35886@table @samp
35887
35888@item S @var{AA}
35889The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35890number).  This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35891@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35892
35893@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35894@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35895The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35896number).  This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35897@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35898and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35899round-trip latency.  Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35900this way.  Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35901
35902@itemize @bullet
35903@item
35904If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35905corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value.  The data @var{r} is a
35906series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35907two-digit hex number.
35908
35909@item
35910If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35911the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35912
35913@item
35914If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35915the core on which the stop event was detected.
35916
35917@item
35918If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35919specific event that stopped the target.  The currently defined stop
35920reasons are listed below.  The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35921signal.  At most one stop reason should be present.
35922
35923@item
35924Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35925and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35926future.
35927@end itemize
35928
35929The currently defined stop reasons are:
35930
35931@table @samp
35932@item watch
35933@itemx rwatch
35934@itemx awatch
35935The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35936hex.
35937
35938@item syscall_entry
35939@itemx syscall_return
35940The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35941syscall number, in hex.
35942
35943@cindex shared library events, remote reply
35944@item library
35945The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35946@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35947list of loaded libraries.  The @var{r} part is ignored.
35948
35949@cindex replay log events, remote reply
35950@item replaylog
35951The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35952logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35953beginning when executing backward) of the log.  The value of @var{r}
35954will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}.  @xref{Reverse Execution},
35955for more information.
35956
35957@item swbreak
35958@anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35959The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35960irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35961breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program.  The @var{r}
35962part must be left empty.
35963
35964On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35965breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35966breakpoint address plus an offset.  On such targets, the stub is
35967responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35968address.
35969
35970This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35971did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35972appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
35973remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35974indicating support.
35975
35976This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35977
35978@item hwbreak
35979The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35980The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35981
35982The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35983apply.
35984
35985@cindex fork events, remote reply
35986@item fork
35987The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35988is the thread ID of the new child process.  Refer to
35989@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35990field.  This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35991fork events.
35992
35993This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35994did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35995appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
35996remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35997indicating support.
35998
35999@cindex vfork events, remote reply
36000@item vfork
36001The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36002is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36003@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36004field.  This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36005vfork events.
36006
36007This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36008did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36009appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36010remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36011indicating support.
36012
36013@cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36014@item vforkdone
36015The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36016has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36017address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36018shared. The @var{r} part is ignored.  This packet is only
36019applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36020
36021This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36022did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36023appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36024remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36025indicating support.
36026
36027@cindex exec events, remote reply
36028@item exec
36029The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36030is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36031This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36032
36033This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36034did not support it.  @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36035appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The
36036remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36037indicating support.
36038
36039@cindex thread create event, remote reply
36040@anchor{thread create event}
36041@item create
36042The packet indicates that the thread was just created.  The new thread
36043is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36044(@pxref{vCont packet}).  This packet should not be sent by default;
36045@value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet.  See
36046also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
36047
36048@end table
36049
36050@item W @var{AA}
36051@itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36052The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status.  This is only
36053applicable to certain targets.
36054
36055The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
36056process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
36057multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36058The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36059
36060@item X @var{AA}
36061@itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36062The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36063
36064The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36065terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36066support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36067extensions}.  The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
36068
36069@anchor{thread exit event}
36070@cindex thread exit event, remote reply
36071@item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
36072
36073The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status.  This response
36074should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
36075@ref{QThreadEvents} packet.  See also @ref{thread create event} above.
36076
36077@item N
36078There are no resumed threads left in the target.  In other words, even
36079though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited.  For
36080example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
360812.  The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
36082subsequently exits.  At this point, even though the process is still
36083alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
36084executing either.  The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
36085that it can stop waiting for stop replies.  This packet should not be
36086sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
36087@value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
36088@samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}).  The remote stub must
36089also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
36090support.
36091
36092@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
36093@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
36094written as the program's console output.  This can happen at any time
36095while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
36096for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.  This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
36097
36098@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
36099@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
36100be called.  This is just the name of the function.  Translation into the
36101correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
36102@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
36103system calls.
36104
36105@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
36106this very system call.
36107
36108The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
36109call a host system call on behalf of the target.  @value{GDBN} replies
36110with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
36111reply packet from the target.  The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36112or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued.  @xref{File-I/O Remote
36113Protocol Extension}, for more details.
36114
36115@end table
36116
36117@node General Query Packets
36118@section General Query Packets
36119@cindex remote query requests
36120
36121Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
36122packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}.  General
36123query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
36124sending information to and from the stub.
36125
36126The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
36127indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to.  For example,
36128@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
36129definitions with the stub.  These packet names follow some
36130conventions:
36131
36132@itemize @bullet
36133@item
36134The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
36135@item
36136Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
36137letter.
36138@item
36139The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
36140lower case, followed by a period.  For example, packets designed at
36141the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
36142foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
36143@end itemize
36144
36145The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
36146parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
36147separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}.  Stubs must be careful to match the
36148full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
36149in case two packet names share a common prefix.  New packets should not begin
36150with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
36151packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
36152for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
36153are difficult to upgrade.  The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
36154existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
36155packet.}.
36156
36157Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
36158has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
36159explanation of the packet's meaning.  We include spaces in some of the
36160templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax.  No
36161@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
36162
36163Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
36164
36165@table @samp
36166
36167@item QAgent:1
36168@itemx QAgent:0
36169Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
36170delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
36171
36172@item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
36173@cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
36174Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
36175target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
36176pairs.  Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
36177@samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
36178@samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
36179indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
36180indicating that it may.  (The target can then use this to set up its
36181own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
36182insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
36183
36184@item qC
36185@cindex current thread, remote request
36186@cindex @samp{qC} packet
36187Return the current thread ID.
36188
36189Reply:
36190@table @samp
36191@item QC @var{thread-id}
36192Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
36193@ref{thread-id syntax}.
36194@item @r{(anything else)}
36195Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
36196@end table
36197
36198@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
36199@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
36200@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
36201@anchor{qCRC packet}
36202Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
36203IEEE 802.3.  The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
36204significant bit of each byte first.  The initial pattern code
36205@code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
36206
36207@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
36208files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
36209Files}).  However the algorithm is slightly different.  When validating
36210separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
36211significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
36212detect trailing zeros.
36213
36214Reply:
36215@table @samp
36216@item E @var{NN}
36217An error (such as memory fault)
36218@item C @var{crc32}
36219The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
36220@end table
36221
36222@item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
36223@cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
36224@cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
36225Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
36226of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
36227to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
36228debugging experience.  On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
36229of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
36230processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
36231with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
36232randomization.
36233
36234This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36235
36236Reply:
36237@table @samp
36238@item OK
36239The request succeeded.
36240
36241@item E @var{nn}
36242An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36243
36244@item @w{}
36245An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
36246by the stub.
36247@end table
36248
36249This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36250by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36251This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
36252address space randomization.
36253
36254@item qfThreadInfo
36255@itemx qsThreadInfo
36256@cindex list active threads, remote request
36257@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
36258@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
36259Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS).  Since there
36260may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
36261works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
36262obtain the entire list of threads.  The first query of the sequence will
36263be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
36264sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
36265
36266NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
36267
36268Reply:
36269@table @samp
36270@item m @var{thread-id}
36271A single thread ID
36272@item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
36273a comma-separated list of thread IDs
36274@item l
36275(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36276@end table
36277
36278In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36279more thread IDs, separated by commas.
36280@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
36281ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
36282with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
36283Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36284fields.
36285
36286@emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
36287initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
36288mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
36289message.  Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
36290the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
36291
36292@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
36293@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
36294@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
36295Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
36296by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
36297
36298@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
36299thread for which to fetch the TLS address.  @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36300
36301@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
36302thread local variable.  (This offset is obtained from the debug
36303information associated with the variable.)
36304
36305@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
36306load module associated with the thread local storage.  For example,
36307a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
36308object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
36309Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
36310differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
36311
36312Reply:
36313@table @samp
36314@item @var{XX}@dots{}
36315Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
36316local storage requested.
36317
36318@item E @var{nn}
36319An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36320
36321@item @w{}
36322An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36323@end table
36324
36325@item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
36326@cindex get thread information block address
36327@cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
36328Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
36329
36330@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
36331
36332Reply:
36333@table @samp
36334@item @var{XX}@dots{}
36335Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
36336thread information block.
36337
36338@item E @var{nn}
36339An error occured.  This means that either the thread was not found, or the
36340address could not be retrieved.
36341
36342@item @w{}
36343An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
36344@end table
36345
36346@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
36347Obtain thread information from RTOS.  Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
36348digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
36349subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
36350number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36351(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36352returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36353
36354Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36355
36356Reply:
36357@table @samp
36358@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36359Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36360returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36361and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36362digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36363is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36364digits), from the target.  See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36365@end table
36366
36367@item qOffsets
36368@cindex section offsets, remote request
36369@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36370Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36371image.
36372
36373Reply:
36374@table @samp
36375@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36376Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36377Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36378If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36379@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36380segments by the supplied offsets.
36381
36382@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36383@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36384to the @code{Bss} section.}
36385
36386@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36387Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36388contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}.  If
36389@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36390conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36391@var{yyy}.  @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36392does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36393as many segments as mentioned in the reply.  Extra segments are
36394kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36395@end table
36396
36397@item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36398@cindex thread information, remote request
36399@cindex @samp{qP} packet
36400Returns information on @var{thread-id}.  Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36401encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36402(@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36403
36404Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36405(see below).
36406
36407Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36408
36409@item QNonStop:1
36410@itemx QNonStop:0
36411@cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36412@cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36413@anchor{QNonStop}
36414Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36415@xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36416
36417Reply:
36418@table @samp
36419@item OK
36420The request succeeded.
36421
36422@item E @var{nn}
36423An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36424
36425@item @w{}
36426An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36427the stub.
36428@end table
36429
36430This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36431by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36432Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36433@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36434
36435@item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36436@itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36437@cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36438@cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36439@anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36440Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36441catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36442
36443For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36444in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}.  If no syscall @var{sysno}
36445is listed, every system call should be reported.
36446
36447Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36448still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36449@code{catch syscall} commands.  However, it is more efficient to only
36450report the requested syscalls.
36451
36452Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36453@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36454
36455If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36456kept for the new process too.  On targets where exec may affect syscall
36457numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36458client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36459
36460Reply:
36461@table @samp
36462@item OK
36463The request succeeded.
36464
36465@item E @var{nn}
36466An error occurred.  @var{nn} are hex digits.
36467
36468@item @w{}
36469An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36470the stub.
36471@end table
36472
36473Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36474command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36475This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36476by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36477
36478@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36479@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36480@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36481@anchor{QPassSignals}
36482Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36483Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36484(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}).  Each @var{signal} list item should be
36485strictly greater than the previous item.  These signals do not need to stop
36486the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}.  All other signals should be
36487reported to @value{GDBN}.  Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36488combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36489new list.  This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36490@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36491
36492Reply:
36493@table @samp
36494@item OK
36495The request succeeded.
36496
36497@item E @var{nn}
36498An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36499
36500@item @w{}
36501An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36502the stub.
36503@end table
36504
36505Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36506command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36507This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36508by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36509
36510@item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36511@cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36512@cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36513@anchor{QProgramSignals}
36514Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36515Others should be silently discarded.
36516
36517In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36518signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement.  One
36519example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36520stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36521@value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36522by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36523signals.
36524
36525This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36526resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36527
36528Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36529(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}).  Each @var{signal} list item should be
36530strictly greater than the previous item.  Multiple
36531@samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36532@samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36533
36534Reply:
36535@table @samp
36536@item OK
36537The request succeeded.
36538
36539@item E @var{nn}
36540An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36541
36542@item @w{}
36543An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36544by the stub.
36545@end table
36546
36547Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36548command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36549This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36550by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36551
36552@anchor{QThreadEvents}
36553@item QThreadEvents:1
36554@itemx QThreadEvents:0
36555@cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36556@cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36557
36558Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36559reporting of thread create and exit events.  @xref{thread create
36560event}, for the reply specifications.  For example, this is used in
36561non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36562synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies.  Without
36563exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36564forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36565same thread.  @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36566stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36567its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36568
36569Reply:
36570@table @samp
36571@item OK
36572The request succeeded.
36573
36574@item E @var{nn}
36575An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36576
36577@item @w{}
36578An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36579the stub.
36580@end table
36581
36582Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36583command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36584
36585@item qRcmd,@var{command}
36586@cindex execute remote command, remote request
36587@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36588@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36589execution.  Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36590string.  Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36591with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36592packets.  @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36593stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36594
36595Reply:
36596@table @samp
36597@item OK
36598A command response with no output.
36599@item @var{OUTPUT}
36600A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36601@item E @var{NN}
36602Indicate a badly formed request.
36603@item @w{}
36604An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36605@end table
36606
36607(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36608command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36609conventions above.  Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36610packets.)
36611
36612@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36613@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36614@ifnotinfo
36615@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36616@end ifnotinfo
36617@cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36618@anchor{qSearch memory}
36619Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36620Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36621@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36622
36623Reply:
36624@table @samp
36625@item 0
36626The pattern was not found.
36627@item 1,address
36628The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36629@item E @var{NN}
36630A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36631@item @w{}
36632An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36633@end table
36634
36635@item QStartNoAckMode
36636@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36637@anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36638Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36639protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36640
36641Reply:
36642@table @samp
36643@item OK
36644The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36645@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36646but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36647@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36648@item @w{}
36649An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36650@end table
36651
36652@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36653@cindex supported packets, remote query
36654@cindex features of the remote protocol
36655@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36656@anchor{qSupported}
36657Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36658query the stub for features it supports.  This packet allows
36659@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36660features.  @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36661at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36662packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36663high-latency links.  Some features may enable behavior which must not
36664be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36665stubs.  Other features may describe packets which could be
36666automatically probed for, but are not.  These features must be
36667reported before @value{GDBN} will use them.  This ``default
36668unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36669helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36670versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36671
36672Reply:
36673@table @samp
36674@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36675The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36676depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36677possible forms).
36678@item @w{}
36679An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36680or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36681@end table
36682
36683The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36684@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36685are:
36686
36687@table @samp
36688@item @var{name}=@var{value}
36689The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36690with the specified @var{value}.  The format of @var{value} depends
36691on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36692@item @var{name}+
36693The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36694need an associated value.
36695@item @var{name}-
36696The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36697@item @var{name}?
36698The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36699@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36700needed.  This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36701but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36702@end table
36703
36704Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36705supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36706request.  This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36707state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36708a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36709
36710The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36711are defined:
36712
36713@table @samp
36714@item multiprocess
36715This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36716extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36717extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36718including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36719@xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36720
36721@item xmlRegisters
36722This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36723description.  If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36724specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36725description.
36726
36727@item qRelocInsn
36728This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36729@samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36730instruction reply packet}).
36731
36732@item swbreak
36733This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36734reason in stop replies.  @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36735
36736@item hwbreak
36737This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36738reason in stop replies.  @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36739
36740@item fork-events
36741This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36742extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36743extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36744including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36745
36746@item vfork-events
36747This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36748extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36749extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36750including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36751
36752@item exec-events
36753This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36754extensions to the remote protocol.  @value{GDBN} does not use such
36755extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36756including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36757
36758@item vContSupported
36759This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36760supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36761@end table
36762
36763Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36764@var{gdbfeature}.  Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36765packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36766versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses).  Additional values
36767for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36768advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36769improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36770an example of such a feature.  The stub's reply should be independent
36771of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36772describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36773all the features it supports.
36774
36775Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36776responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36777
36778Some features are flags.  A stub which supports a flag feature
36779should respond with a @samp{+} form response.  Other features
36780require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36781form response.
36782
36783Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36784@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36785in the @samp{qSupported} response.  The default values are fixed; a
36786stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36787
36788Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36789mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36790architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36791about the underlying target in advance.  This is especially common in
36792stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36793
36794These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36795
36796@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36797@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36798@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36799@item Feature Name
36800@tab Value Required
36801@tab Default
36802@tab Probe Allowed
36803
36804@item @samp{PacketSize}
36805@tab Yes
36806@tab @samp{-}
36807@tab No
36808
36809@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36810@tab No
36811@tab @samp{-}
36812@tab Yes
36813
36814@item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36815@tab No
36816@tab @samp{-}
36817@tab Yes
36818
36819@item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36820@tab No
36821@tab @samp{-}
36822@tab Yes
36823
36824@item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36825@tab No
36826@tab @samp{-}
36827@tab Yes
36828
36829@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36830@tab No
36831@tab @samp{-}
36832@tab Yes
36833
36834@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36835@tab No
36836@tab @samp{-}
36837@tab Yes
36838
36839@item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36840@tab No
36841@tab @samp{-}
36842@tab Yes
36843
36844@item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36845@tab No
36846@tab @samp{-}
36847@tab No
36848
36849@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36850@tab No
36851@tab @samp{-}
36852@tab Yes
36853
36854@item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36855@tab No
36856@tab @samp{-}
36857@tab Yes
36858
36859@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36860@tab No
36861@tab @samp{-}
36862@tab Yes
36863
36864@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36865@tab No
36866@tab @samp{-}
36867@tab Yes
36868
36869@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36870@tab No
36871@tab @samp{-}
36872@tab Yes
36873
36874@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36875@tab No
36876@tab @samp{-}
36877@tab Yes
36878
36879@item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36880@tab No
36881@tab @samp{-}
36882@tab Yes
36883
36884@item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36885@tab No
36886@tab @samp{-}
36887@tab Yes
36888
36889@item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36890@tab No
36891@tab @samp{-}
36892@tab Yes
36893
36894@item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36895@tab No
36896@tab @samp{-}
36897@tab Yes
36898
36899@item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36900@tab Yes
36901@tab @samp{-}
36902@tab Yes
36903
36904@item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36905@tab Yes
36906@tab @samp{-}
36907@tab Yes
36908
36909@item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36910@tab Yes
36911@tab @samp{-}
36912@tab Yes
36913
36914@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36915@tab Yes
36916@tab @samp{-}
36917@tab Yes
36918
36919@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36920@tab Yes
36921@tab @samp{-}
36922@tab Yes
36923
36924@item @samp{QNonStop}
36925@tab No
36926@tab @samp{-}
36927@tab Yes
36928
36929@item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36930@tab No
36931@tab @samp{-}
36932@tab Yes
36933
36934@item @samp{QPassSignals}
36935@tab No
36936@tab @samp{-}
36937@tab Yes
36938
36939@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36940@tab No
36941@tab @samp{-}
36942@tab Yes
36943
36944@item @samp{multiprocess}
36945@tab No
36946@tab @samp{-}
36947@tab No
36948
36949@item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36950@tab No
36951@tab @samp{-}
36952@tab No
36953
36954@item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36955@tab No
36956@tab @samp{-}
36957@tab No
36958
36959@item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36960@tab No
36961@tab @samp{-}
36962@tab No
36963
36964@item @samp{ReverseStep}
36965@tab No
36966@tab @samp{-}
36967@tab No
36968
36969@item @samp{TracepointSource}
36970@tab No
36971@tab @samp{-}
36972@tab No
36973
36974@item @samp{QAgent}
36975@tab No
36976@tab @samp{-}
36977@tab No
36978
36979@item @samp{QAllow}
36980@tab No
36981@tab @samp{-}
36982@tab No
36983
36984@item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36985@tab No
36986@tab @samp{-}
36987@tab No
36988
36989@item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36990@tab No
36991@tab @samp{-}
36992@tab No
36993
36994@item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36995@tab No
36996@tab @samp{-}
36997@tab No
36998
36999@item @samp{tracenz}
37000@tab No
37001@tab @samp{-}
37002@tab No
37003
37004@item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
37005@tab No
37006@tab @samp{-}
37007@tab No
37008
37009@item @samp{swbreak}
37010@tab No
37011@tab @samp{-}
37012@tab No
37013
37014@item @samp{hwbreak}
37015@tab No
37016@tab @samp{-}
37017@tab No
37018
37019@item @samp{fork-events}
37020@tab No
37021@tab @samp{-}
37022@tab No
37023
37024@item @samp{vfork-events}
37025@tab No
37026@tab @samp{-}
37027@tab No
37028
37029@item @samp{exec-events}
37030@tab No
37031@tab @samp{-}
37032@tab No
37033
37034@item @samp{QThreadEvents}
37035@tab No
37036@tab @samp{-}
37037@tab No
37038
37039@item @samp{no-resumed}
37040@tab No
37041@tab @samp{-}
37042@tab No
37043
37044@end multitable
37045
37046These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
37047
37048@table @samp
37049@cindex packet size, remote protocol
37050@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
37051The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
37052length.  @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
37053transfers, and will never send larger packets.  This is a limit on the
37054data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
37055There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
37056stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
37057byte in its buffer for the NUL.  If this stub feature is not supported,
37058@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
37059
37060@item qXfer:auxv:read
37061The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
37062(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
37063
37064@item qXfer:btrace:read
37065The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37066packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
37067
37068@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
37069The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37070packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
37071
37072@item qXfer:exec-file:read
37073The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
37074(@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
37075
37076@item qXfer:features:read
37077The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
37078(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
37079
37080@item qXfer:libraries:read
37081The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
37082(@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
37083
37084@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
37085The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37086(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37087
37088@item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
37089The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
37090@samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
37091(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
37092
37093@item qXfer:memory-map:read
37094The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
37095(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
37096
37097@item qXfer:sdata:read
37098The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
37099(@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
37100
37101@item qXfer:spu:read
37102The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
37103(@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
37104
37105@item qXfer:spu:write
37106The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
37107(@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
37108
37109@item qXfer:siginfo:read
37110The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
37111(@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
37112
37113@item qXfer:siginfo:write
37114The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
37115(@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
37116
37117@item qXfer:threads:read
37118The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37119(@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
37120
37121@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
37122The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37123packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
37124
37125@item qXfer:uib:read
37126The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37127packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
37128
37129@item qXfer:fdpic:read
37130The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37131packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
37132
37133@item QNonStop
37134The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
37135(@pxref{QNonStop}).
37136
37137@item QCatchSyscalls
37138The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37139(@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
37140
37141@item QPassSignals
37142The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37143(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
37144
37145@item QStartNoAckMode
37146The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
37147prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode.  @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
37148
37149@item multiprocess
37150@anchor{multiprocess extensions}
37151@cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
37152The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
37153protocol syntax.  The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
37154thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
37155add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
37156replies.  Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
37157syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
37158debugging of more than one process at a time.  The stub must not use
37159multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
37160indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
37161
37162@item qXfer:osdata:read
37163The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
37164((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
37165
37166@item ConditionalBreakpoints
37167The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
37168defined for breakpoints.  The target will only report breakpoint triggers
37169when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
37170
37171@item ConditionalTracepoints
37172The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
37173for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
37174
37175@item ReverseContinue
37176The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
37177(@pxref{bc}).
37178
37179@item ReverseStep
37180The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
37181(@pxref{bs}).
37182
37183@item TracepointSource
37184The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
37185the source form of tracepoint definitions.
37186
37187@item QAgent
37188The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
37189
37190@item QAllow
37191The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
37192
37193@item QDisableRandomization
37194The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
37195
37196@item StaticTracepoint
37197@cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
37198The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
37199
37200@item InstallInTrace
37201@anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
37202The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
37203
37204@item EnableDisableTracepoints
37205The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
37206@samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
37207to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
37208
37209@item QTBuffer:size
37210The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
37211packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
37212
37213@item tracenz
37214@cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
37215The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
37216See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
37217
37218@item BreakpointCommands
37219@cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
37220The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
37221rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
37222
37223@item Qbtrace:off
37224The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
37225
37226@item Qbtrace:bts
37227The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
37228
37229@item Qbtrace:pt
37230The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
37231
37232@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
37233The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
37234
37235@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
37236The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
37237
37238@item swbreak
37239The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
37240breakpoints.
37241
37242@item hwbreak
37243The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
37244breakpoints.
37245
37246@item fork-events
37247The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
37248
37249@item vfork-events
37250The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
37251and vforkdone events.
37252
37253@item exec-events
37254The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
37255
37256@item vContSupported
37257The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
37258@samp{vCont?} packet.
37259
37260@item QThreadEvents
37261The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
37262
37263@item no-resumed
37264The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
37265
37266@end table
37267
37268@item qSymbol::
37269@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
37270@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
37271Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
37272requests.  Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
37273
37274Reply:
37275@table @samp
37276@item OK
37277The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37278@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37279The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
37280@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
37281@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
37282below.
37283@end table
37284
37285@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
37286Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
37287
37288@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
37289target has previously requested.
37290
37291@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.  If
37292@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
37293will be empty.
37294
37295Reply:
37296@table @samp
37297@item OK
37298The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
37299@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
37300The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
37301encoded).  @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
37302(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
37303@end table
37304
37305@item qTBuffer
37306@itemx QTBuffer
37307@itemx QTDisconnected
37308@itemx QTDP
37309@itemx QTDPsrc
37310@itemx QTDV
37311@itemx qTfP
37312@itemx qTfV
37313@itemx QTFrame
37314@itemx qTMinFTPILen
37315
37316@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37317
37318@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
37319@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
37320@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
37321Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
37322attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
37323for the forms of @var{thread-id}.  This
37324string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
37325for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.  The string is
37326displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display.  Some
37327examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
37328@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
37329
37330Reply:
37331@table @samp
37332@item @var{XX}@dots{}
37333Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
37334comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
37335the thread's attributes.
37336@end table
37337
37338(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
37339the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37340conventions above.  Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37341packets.)
37342
37343@item QTNotes
37344@itemx qTP
37345@itemx QTSave
37346@itemx qTsP
37347@itemx qTsV
37348@itemx QTStart
37349@itemx QTStop
37350@itemx QTEnable
37351@itemx QTDisable
37352@itemx QTinit
37353@itemx QTro
37354@itemx qTStatus
37355@itemx qTV
37356@itemx qTfSTM
37357@itemx qTsSTM
37358@itemx qTSTMat
37359@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37360
37361@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37362@cindex read special object, remote request
37363@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37364@anchor{qXfer read}
37365Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37366identified by the keyword @var{object}.  Request @var{length} bytes
37367starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data.  The content and
37368encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37369additional details about what data to access.
37370
37371Reply:
37372@table @samp
37373@item m @var{data}
37374Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37375target.  There may be more data at a higher address (although
37376it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37377block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37378It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37379request.
37380
37381@item l @var{data}
37382Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37383There is no more data to be read.  It is possible for @var{data} to
37384have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37385
37386@item l
37387The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37388There is no more data to be read.
37389
37390@item E00
37391The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37392
37393@item E @var{nn}
37394The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37395The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37396
37397@item @w{}
37398An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37399the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37400@end table
37401
37402Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far.  All the
37403@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37404formats, listed above.
37405
37406@table @samp
37407@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37408@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37409Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}.  @xref{OS Information,
37410auxiliary vector}.  Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37411
37412This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37413by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37414
37415@item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37416@anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37417
37418Return a description of the current branch trace.
37419@xref{Branch Trace Format}.  The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37420packet may have one of the following values:
37421
37422@table @code
37423@item all
37424Returns all available branch trace.
37425
37426@item new
37427Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37428the last read request.
37429
37430@item delta
37431Returns the new branch trace since the last read request.  Adds a new
37432block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37433location of the first branch in the trace buffer.  This extra block is
37434used to stitch traces together.
37435
37436If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37437@end table
37438
37439This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37440by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37441
37442@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37443@anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37444
37445Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37446@xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37447
37448This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37449by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37450
37451@item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37452@anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37453Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37454a process running on the remote system.  The annex specifies the
37455numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37456number.  If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37457filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37458
37459This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37460by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37461
37462@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37463@anchor{qXfer target description read}
37464Access the @dfn{target description}.  @xref{Target Descriptions}.  The
37465annex specifies which XML document to access.  The main description is
37466always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37467
37468This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37469by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37470
37471@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37472@anchor{qXfer library list read}
37473Access the target's list of loaded libraries.  @xref{Library List Format}.
37474The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37475(@pxref{qXfer read}).
37476
37477Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37478not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37479the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37480
37481This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37482by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37483
37484@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37485@anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37486Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37487platform.  @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}.  The annex part
37488of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37489stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37490by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37491(@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37492
37493This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37494@value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37495
37496This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37497by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37498
37499If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37500packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37501contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37502arguments.  The currently supported arguments are:
37503
37504@table @code
37505@item start=@var{address}
37506A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37507link_map} to start reading the library list from.  If unset or zero
37508then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37509chosen as the starting point.
37510
37511@item prev=@var{address}
37512A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37513link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37514specified by the @samp{start} argument.  If unset or zero then
37515the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37516exists prior to the starting point.
37517
37518@end table
37519
37520Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37521ignored.
37522
37523@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37524@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37525Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}.  @xref{Memory Map Format}.  The
37526annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37527(@pxref{qXfer read}).
37528
37529This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37530by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37531
37532@item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37533@anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37534
37535Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37536information.  The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37537be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).  @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37538Action Lists}.
37539
37540This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37541by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37542(@pxref{qSupported}).
37543
37544@item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37545@anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37546Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37547system.  The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37548empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37549
37550This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37551by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37552(@pxref{qSupported}).
37553
37554@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37555@anchor{qXfer spu read}
37556Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system.  The
37557annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37558@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37559in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37560in that context to be accessed.
37561
37562This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37563by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37564(@pxref{qSupported}).
37565
37566@item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37567@anchor{qXfer threads read}
37568Access the list of threads on target.  @xref{Thread List Format}.  The
37569annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37570(@pxref{qXfer read}).
37571
37572This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37573by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37574
37575@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37576@anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37577
37578Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37579@xref{Traceframe Info Format}.  The annex part of the generic
37580@samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37581
37582This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37583by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37584
37585@item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37586@anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37587
37588Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}.  This packet is used
37589on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37590
37591This packet is not probed by default.
37592
37593@item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37594@anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37595Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system.  The
37596annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37597executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37598
37599This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37600by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37601
37602@item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37603@anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37604Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37605@xref{Operating System Information}.
37606
37607@end table
37608
37609@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37610@cindex write data into object, remote request
37611@anchor{qXfer write}
37612Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37613identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37614into the data.  The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37615written is given by @var{data}@dots{}.  The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37616is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37617to access.
37618
37619Reply:
37620@table @samp
37621@item @var{nn}
37622@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37623This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37624
37625@item E00
37626The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37627
37628@item E @var{nn}
37629The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37630The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37631
37632@item @w{}
37633An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37634recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37635@end table
37636
37637Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far.  All the
37638@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37639formats, listed above.
37640
37641@table @samp
37642@item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37643@anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37644Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37645The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37646empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37647
37648This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37649by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37650(@pxref{qSupported}).
37651
37652@item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37653@anchor{qXfer spu write}
37654Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system.  The
37655annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37656@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37657in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37658in that context to be accessed.
37659
37660This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37661by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37662@end table
37663
37664@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37665Requests of this form may be added in the future.  When a stub does
37666not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37667@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37668must respond with an empty packet.
37669
37670@item qAttached:@var{pid}
37671@cindex query attached, remote request
37672@cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37673Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37674existing process or created a new process.  When the multiprocess
37675protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37676@var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37677process.  Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37678the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37679
37680This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37681should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37682the @code{quit} command.
37683
37684Reply:
37685@table @samp
37686@item 1
37687The remote server attached to an existing process.
37688@item 0
37689The remote server created a new process.
37690@item E @var{NN}
37691A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37692@end table
37693
37694@item Qbtrace:bts
37695Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37696
37697Reply:
37698@table @samp
37699@item OK
37700Branch tracing has been enabled.
37701@item E.errtext
37702A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37703@end table
37704
37705@item Qbtrace:pt
37706Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37707
37708Reply:
37709@table @samp
37710@item OK
37711Branch tracing has been enabled.
37712@item E.errtext
37713A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37714@end table
37715
37716@item Qbtrace:off
37717Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37718
37719Reply:
37720@table @samp
37721@item OK
37722Branch tracing has been disabled.
37723@item E.errtext
37724A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37725@end table
37726
37727@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37728Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37729btrace recording method in bts format.
37730
37731Reply:
37732@table @samp
37733@item OK
37734The ring buffer size has been set.
37735@item E.errtext
37736A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37737@end table
37738
37739@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37740Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37741btrace recording method in pt format.
37742
37743Reply:
37744@table @samp
37745@item OK
37746The ring buffer size has been set.
37747@item E.errtext
37748A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37749@end table
37750
37751@end table
37752
37753@node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37754@section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37755
37756This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37757target architectures.  Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37758details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37759
37760@menu
37761* ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37762* MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37763@end menu
37764
37765@node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37766@subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37767
37768@menu
37769* ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37770@end menu
37771
37772@node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37773@subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37774@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37775
37776These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37777
37778@table @r
37779
37780@item 2
3778116-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37782
37783@item 3
3778432-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37785
37786@item 4
3778732-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37788
37789@end table
37790
37791@node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37792@subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37793
37794@menu
37795* MIPS Register packet Format::
37796* MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37797@end menu
37798
37799@node MIPS Register packet Format
37800@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37801@cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37802
37803The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37804In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37805sixty-four bits.  Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37806to fill the space allocated.  Register bytes are transferred in target
37807byte order.  The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37808most-significant -- least-significant.
37809
37810@table @r
37811
37812@item MIPS32
37813All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
3781432 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37815registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37816
37817@item MIPS64
37818All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37819thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}).  The ordering is the same
37820as @code{MIPS32}.
37821
37822@end table
37823
37824@node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37825@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37826@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37827
37828These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37829
37830@table @r
37831
37832@item 2
3783316-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37834
37835@item 3
3783616-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37837
37838@item 4
3783932-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37840
37841@item 5
3784232-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37843
37844@end table
37845
37846@node Tracepoint Packets
37847@section Tracepoint Packets
37848@cindex tracepoint packets
37849@cindex packets, tracepoint
37850
37851Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37852tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37853
37854@table @samp
37855
37856@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37857@cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37858Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}.  If @var{ena}
37859is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37860the tracepoint is disabled.  The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37861count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count.  If an @samp{F} is present,
37862then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37863the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37864for the tracepoint.  If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37865tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37866by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37867encodings as described below.  If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37868further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37869actions.
37870
37871Replies:
37872@table @samp
37873@item OK
37874The packet was understood and carried out.
37875@item qRelocInsn
37876@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37877@item  @w{}
37878The packet was not recognized.
37879@end table
37880
37881@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37882Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit.  The @var{n} and
37883@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37884this tracepoint.  This packet may only be sent immediately after
37885another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}.  If the
37886trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37887specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37888
37889In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37890can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}.  If such a packet
37891is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37892actions.  Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37893taken when the tracepoint is first hit.  If no action packet has an
37894@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37895tracepoint actions.
37896
37897The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37898actions, concatenated without separators.  Each action has one of the
37899following forms:
37900
37901@table @samp
37902
37903@item R @var{mask}
37904Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37905a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37906@var{i} should be collected.  (The least significant bit is numbered
37907zero.)  Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37908not fit in a 32-bit word.
37909
37910@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37911Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37912number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}.  If @var{basereg} is
37913@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37914address of the lowest byte to collect.  The @var{basereg},
37915@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37916values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37917
37918@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37919Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37920it directs.  The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37921@ref{Agent Expressions}.  Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37922two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37923in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37924packet).
37925
37926@end table
37927
37928Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37929packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37930length (400 bytes, for many stubs).  There may be only one @samp{R}
37931action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37932actions.  Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37933must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action.  (The
37934``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37935separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37936
37937Replies:
37938@table @samp
37939@item OK
37940The packet was understood and carried out.
37941@item qRelocInsn
37942@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37943@item  @w{}
37944The packet was not recognized.
37945@end table
37946
37947@item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37948@cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37949Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37950This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37951originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run.  The @var{type}
37952is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37953tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37954@var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37955
37956@var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37957string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37958This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37959fit in a single packet.
37960@c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37961@c tracepoint descriptions section.
37962
37963The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37964@samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37965@value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37966list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37967
37968The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37969report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37970query packets.
37971
37972Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37973if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37974Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37975much easier to use.  Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37976tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37977the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37978could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37979be found.
37980
37981@item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37982@cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37983@cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37984Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37985value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer.  Both @var{n}
37986and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37987the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37988target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37989mentioned in expressions.  The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37990if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37991@value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37992@samp{qTsV} packet had it set.  The contents of @var{name} is the
37993hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37994variable.
37995
37996@item QTFrame:@var{n}
37997@cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37998Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37999register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
38000request packets from @value{GDBN}.
38001
38002A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
38003requested frame.  The response is a series of parts, concatenated
38004without separators, describing the frame we selected.  Each part has
38005one of the following forms:
38006
38007@table @samp
38008@item F @var{f}
38009The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
38010@var{f} is a hexadecimal number.  If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
38011was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
38012
38013@item T @var{t}
38014The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
38015@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
38016
38017@end table
38018
38019@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
38020Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38021currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
38022@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
38023
38024@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
38025Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38026currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
38027is a hexadecimal number.
38028
38029@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
38030Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
38031currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
38032and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
38033numbers.
38034
38035@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
38036Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
38037frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
38038
38039@item qTMinFTPILen
38040@cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
38041This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
38042tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed.  For instance, on
38043the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
38044it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
38045the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
38046system.  So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
38047arrange for that.
38048
38049Replies:
38050
38051@table @samp
38052@item 0
38053The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
38054@item @var{length}
38055The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
38056is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1.  A reply
38057of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
38058regardless of size.
38059@item E
38060An error has occurred.
38061@item @w{}
38062An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
38063@end table
38064
38065@item QTStart
38066@cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
38067Begin the tracepoint experiment.  Begin collecting data from
38068tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer.  This packet supports the
38069@samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38070instruction reply packet}).
38071
38072@item QTStop
38073@cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
38074End the tracepoint experiment.  Stop collecting trace frames.
38075
38076@item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38077@anchor{QTEnable}
38078@cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
38079Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38080experiment.  If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
38081of data from it will resume.
38082
38083@item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
38084@anchor{QTDisable}
38085@cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
38086Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
38087experiment.  No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
38088@samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
38089
38090@item QTinit
38091@cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
38092Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
38093
38094@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
38095@cindex @samp{QTro} packet
38096Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''.  The stub
38097will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
38098if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
38099
38100@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
38101containing program code.  Since these areas never change, they should
38102still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
38103there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
38104
38105@item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
38106@cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
38107Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
38108disconnects from the target.  A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
38109continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
38110@value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
38111
38112@item qTStatus
38113@cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
38114Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
38115
38116The reply has the form:
38117
38118@table @samp
38119
38120@item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
38121@var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
38122running, or @code{0} if not.  It is followed by semicolon-separated
38123optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
38124
38125@end table
38126
38127If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
38128explanations as one of the optional fields:
38129
38130@table @samp
38131
38132@item tnotrun:0
38133No trace has been run yet.
38134
38135@item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
38136The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.  The optional
38137@var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
38138stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
38139stopped manually).  It is hex-encoded.
38140
38141@item tfull:0
38142The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
38143
38144@item tdisconnected:0
38145The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
38146
38147@item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
38148The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
38149
38150@item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
38151The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error.  The
38152string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
38153(for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
38154is hex encoded.
38155
38156@item tunknown:0
38157The trace stopped for some other reason.
38158
38159@end table
38160
38161Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
38162Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
38163the progress of a trace run.  If a trace has stopped, and these
38164numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
38165trace.
38166
38167@table @samp
38168
38169@item tframes:@var{n}
38170The number of trace frames in the buffer.
38171
38172@item tcreated:@var{n}
38173The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
38174be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
38175
38176@item tsize:@var{n}
38177The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
38178
38179@item tfree:@var{n}
38180The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
38181
38182@item circular:@var{n}
38183The value of the circular trace buffer flag.  @code{1} means that the
38184trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
38185necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
38186and may fill up.
38187
38188@item disconn:@var{n}
38189The value of the disconnected tracing flag.  @code{1} means that
38190tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
38191that the trace run will stop.
38192
38193@end table
38194
38195@item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
38196@cindex tracepoint status, remote request
38197@cindex @samp{qTP} packet
38198Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
38199address @var{addr}.
38200
38201Replies:
38202@table @samp
38203@item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
38204The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
38205run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer.  Note that
38206@code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
38207steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
38208
38209@end table
38210
38211@item qTV:@var{var}
38212@cindex trace state variable value, remote request
38213@cindex @samp{qTV} packet
38214Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
38215
38216Replies:
38217@table @samp
38218@item V@var{value}
38219The value of the variable is @var{value}.  This will be the current
38220value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
38221saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
38222user is looking at.  Note that multiple requests may result in
38223different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
38224program is running.
38225
38226@item U
38227The value of the variable is unknown.  This would occur, for example,
38228if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
38229was not collected.
38230@end table
38231
38232@item qTfP
38233@cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
38234@itemx qTsP
38235@cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
38236These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
38237the target.  @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
38238of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces.  Replies
38239to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
38240that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
38241
38242@item qTfV
38243@cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
38244@itemx qTsV
38245@cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
38246These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
38247target.  @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
38248and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables.  Replies to
38249these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
38250trace state variables.
38251
38252@item qTfSTM
38253@itemx qTsSTM
38254@anchor{qTfSTM}
38255@anchor{qTsSTM}
38256@cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
38257@cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
38258These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
38259in the target program.  @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
38260first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
38261pieces.  Replies to these packets take the following form:
38262
38263Reply:
38264@table @samp
38265@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
38266A single marker
38267@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
38268a comma-separated list of markers
38269@item l
38270(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
38271@item E @var{nn}
38272An error occurred.  The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38273@item @w{}
38274An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
38275stub.
38276@end table
38277
38278The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
38279@var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
38280
38281In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
38282more markers, separated by commas.  @value{GDBN} will respond to each
38283reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
38284query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
38285@dfn{last}).
38286
38287@item qTSTMat:@var{address}
38288@anchor{qTSTMat}
38289@cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
38290This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
38291target program at @var{address}.  Replies to this packet follow the
38292syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
38293tracepoint markers.
38294
38295@item QTSave:@var{filename}
38296@cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
38297This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
38298@var{filename} in the target's filesystem.  The @var{filename} is encoded
38299as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
38300absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
38301
38302@item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
38303@cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
38304Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
38305starting at @var{offset}.  The trace buffer is treated as if it were
38306a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
38307The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
38308in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
38309A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
38310available.
38311
38312@item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
38313This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
38314@var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
38315
38316@item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
38317@anchor{QTBuffer-size}
38318@cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
38319This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
38320@var{size} if possible.  A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
38321use whatever size it prefers.
38322
38323@item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
38324@cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
38325This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run.  Allowable
38326types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
38327@var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
38328
38329@end table
38330
38331@subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
38332When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
38333relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
38334different address in memory.  For most instructions, a simple copy is
38335enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
38336return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
38337PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
38338of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
38339it had executed in the original location.
38340
38341In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
38342respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
38343packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
38344this relocation operation.  If a packet supports this mechanism, its
38345documentation will explicitly say so.  See for example the above
38346descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets.  The
38347format of the request is:
38348
38349@table @samp
38350@item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38351
38352This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38353to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38354instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38355@var{from}.  @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38356memory starting at @var{to}.
38357@end table
38358
38359Replies:
38360@table @samp
38361@item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38362Informs the stub the relocation is complete.  The @var{adjusted_size} is
38363the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38364@item E @var{NN}
38365A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38366relocating the instruction.
38367@end table
38368
38369@node Host I/O Packets
38370@section Host I/O Packets
38371@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38372@cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38373
38374The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38375operations on the far side of a remote link.  For example, Host I/O is
38376used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38377filesystem.  Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38378layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol.  However, the
38379Host I/O packets are structured differently.  The target-initiated
38380protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38381Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38382target's memory is not involved.  @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38383Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38384
38385The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38386its arguments.  They have this format:
38387
38388@table @samp
38389
38390@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38391@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38392should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38393for a supported operation.  The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38394the operation.  Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal.  Negative
38395numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38396used).  Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38397hexadecimal bytes.  The last argument to a system call may be a
38398buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38399
38400@end table
38401
38402The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38403
38404@table @samp
38405
38406@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38407@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38408non-negative for success and -1 for errors.  If an error has occured,
38409@var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38410value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}).  For
38411operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38412binary buffer.  Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38413normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}).  See the individual packet
38414documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38415@var{attachment}.
38416
38417@item @w{}
38418An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38419
38420@end table
38421
38422These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38423
38424@table @samp
38425@item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38426Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38427return -1 if an error occurs.  The @var{filename} is a string,
38428@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38429(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38430of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38431@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38432
38433@item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38434Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38435-1 if an error occurs.
38436
38437@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38438Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.  Up to
38439@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38440relative to the start of the file.  The target may read fewer bytes;
38441common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38442condition.  The number of bytes read is returned.  Zero should only be
38443returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38444@var{count} was zero.
38445
38446The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38447If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38448attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon).  The return value is the
38449number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38450some characters were escaped.
38451
38452@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38453Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38454to @var{fd}.  Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38455file.  Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38456separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38457packet is used.  @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38458which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38459error occurred.
38460
38461@item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38462Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38463On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38464and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38465If an error occurs the return value is -1.  The format of the
38466returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38467
38468@item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38469Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target.  Return 0,
38470or -1 if an error occurs.  The @var{filename} is a string.
38471
38472@item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38473Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target.  Return
38474the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38475
38476The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38477If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38478attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon).  The return value is the
38479number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38480some characters were escaped.
38481
38482@item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38483Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38484@var{filename} arguments will operate.  This is required for
38485@value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38486the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38487inferior(s).
38488
38489If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38490@var{pid}.  If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38491the remote stub.  Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38492If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38493remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38494operation.
38495
38496@end table
38497
38498@node Interrupts
38499@section Interrupts
38500@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38501@anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38502
38503In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38504@value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38505@code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38506is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38507
38508The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38509mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined.  @value{GDBN} does not
38510currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38511interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38512@code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38513
38514@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38515transport mechanisms.  It is represented by sending the single byte
38516@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38517the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}).  When a @code{0x03} byte is
38518transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38519and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt.  E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38520(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38521@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38522
38523@code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38524When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38525it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38526
38527In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38528(@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38529command to the remote stub, even when the target is running.  For that
38530reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38531packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38532@code{0x03}.
38533
38534Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38535precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38536implementation defined.  If the target supports debugging of multiple
38537threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38538currently-executing threads and processes.
38539If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38540running program, it should send one of the stop
38541reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38542of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38543for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38544Interrupts received while the
38545program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38546it is resumed next time.
38547
38548@node Notification Packets
38549@section Notification Packets
38550@cindex notification packets
38551@cindex packets, notification
38552
38553The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38554packets that require no acknowledgment.  Both the GDB and the stub
38555may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38556present are sent by the stub).  Notifications carry information
38557without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38558are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38559is not a problem.
38560
38561A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38562@var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38563and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38564as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets.  A notification's @var{data}
38565never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters.  Upon
38566receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38567to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38568
38569Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38570colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38571
38572Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38573notifications they do not understand.  Recipients should restart
38574timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38575not they understand it.
38576
38577Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38578protocol description specifies that they are permitted.  In the
38579future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38580new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38581recipients.
38582
38583(Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38584the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38585transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients.  There
38586are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38587assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38588
38589Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38590@table @samp
38591@item @var{name}:@var{event}
38592The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38593exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38594carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38595@var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38596@item @var{ack}
38597The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38598acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38599@end table
38600
38601The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38602@value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38603
38604The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38605at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38606appropriate.  The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38607acknowledges.  Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38608additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38609previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38610synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38611@value{GDBN}.  Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38612the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38613@value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38614
38615Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38616otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38617expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38618@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38619Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38620the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38621
38622After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38623sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38624stub.  Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38625@value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38626stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38627
38628Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38629events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38630normal @var{event}.  @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38631packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38632other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38633normally.
38634
38635If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38636@var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38637At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38638and the stub has completed sending any queued events.  @value{GDBN}
38639won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38640received .  If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38641a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38642the process shall be repeated.
38643
38644The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38645following example:
38646@smallexample
38647<- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38648@code{...}
38649-> @code{vStopped}
38650<- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38651-> @code{vStopped}
38652<- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38653-> @code{vStopped}
38654<- @code{OK}
38655@end smallexample
38656
38657The following notifications are defined:
38658@multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38659
38660@item Notification
38661@tab Ack
38662@tab Event
38663@tab Description
38664
38665@item Stop
38666@tab vStopped
38667@tab @var{reply}.  The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38668described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}.  Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38669for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38670@value{GDBN}.
38671@tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38672
38673@end multitable
38674
38675@node Remote Non-Stop
38676@section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38677
38678@value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38679multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.  If the stub
38680supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38681@samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38682
38683@value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38684establishing a new connection with the stub.  Entering non-stop mode
38685does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38686must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38687all-stop mode.  @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38688probe the target state after a mode change.
38689
38690In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38691would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38692asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38693inform @value{GDBN}.  In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38694in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38695mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped.  That is,
38696when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38697of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38698affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38699to run.  When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38700threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38701
38702In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38703follows.  First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38704sequence in progress is abandoned.  The target must begin a new
38705sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38706it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}.  The first
38707stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38708subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38709using the mechanism described above.  The target must not send
38710asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38711If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38712or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38713@samp{OK}.
38714
38715If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38716@samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38717the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38718(@pxref{swbreak stop reason}).  This is because given the asynchronous
38719nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38720and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38721breakpoint may have already been removed from the target.  Due to
38722this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38723caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38724opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38725Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38726for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38727necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38728
38729@node Packet Acknowledgment
38730@section Packet Acknowledgment
38731
38732@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38733@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38734By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38735the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38736the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38737This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38738unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38739
38740In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38741TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38742It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38743overhead, or for other reasons.  This can be accomplished by means of the
38744@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38745
38746When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38747expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments.  The packet
38748and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38749@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38750
38751If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38752no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38753by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38754@pxref{qSupported}.
38755If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38756disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38757(@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38758@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38759Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38760@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38761response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38762
38763Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38764between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38765it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38766connection.
38767Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38768new connection is established,
38769there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38770for the current connection, once disabled.
38771
38772@node Examples
38773@section Examples
38774
38775Example sequence of a target being re-started.  Notice how the restart
38776does not get any direct output:
38777
38778@smallexample
38779-> @code{R00}
38780<- @code{+}
38781@emph{target restarts}
38782-> @code{?}
38783<- @code{+}
38784<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38785-> @code{+}
38786@end smallexample
38787
38788Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38789
38790@smallexample
38791-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38792<- @code{+}
38793-> @code{s}
38794<- @code{+}
38795@emph{time passes}
38796<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38797-> @code{+}
38798-> @code{g}
38799<- @code{+}
38800<- @code{1455@dots{}}
38801-> @code{+}
38802@end smallexample
38803
38804@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38805@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38806@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38807
38808@menu
38809* File-I/O Overview::
38810* Protocol Basics::
38811* The F Request Packet::
38812* The F Reply Packet::
38813* The Ctrl-C Message::
38814* Console I/O::
38815* List of Supported Calls::
38816* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38817* Constants::
38818* File-I/O Examples::
38819@end menu
38820
38821@node File-I/O Overview
38822@subsection File-I/O Overview
38823@cindex file-i/o overview
38824
38825The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38826target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38827system calls.  System calls on the target system are translated into a
38828remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38829actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38830This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38831
38832The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38833It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values.  Both
38834@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38835translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38836protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38837
38838The communication is synchronous.  A system call is possible only when
38839@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38840or @samp{s} packets.  While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38841the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38842memory.  Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals.  On
38843the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38844(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38845
38846The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38847the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action.  That means,
38848after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38849previous activity (continue, step).  No additional continue or step
38850request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38851
38852@smallexample
38853(@value{GDBP}) continue
38854  <- target requests 'system call X'
38855  target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38856  -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38857  ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38858  <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38859@end smallexample
38860
38861The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38862the host file system.  Character or block special devices, pipes,
38863named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38864system are not supported by this protocol.
38865
38866File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38867
38868@node Protocol Basics
38869@subsection Protocol Basics
38870@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38871
38872The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38873as reply packet.  Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38874@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38875the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38876of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38877This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38878to call the appropriate host system call:
38879
38880@itemize @bullet
38881@item
38882A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38883
38884@item
38885All parameters to the system call.  Pointers are given as addresses
38886in the target memory address space.  Pointers to strings are given as
38887pointer/length pair.  Numerical values are given as they are.
38888Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38889
38890@end itemize
38891
38892At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38893
38894@itemize @bullet
38895@item
38896If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38897system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38898standard @code{m} packet request.  This additional communication has to be
38899expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38900packet.
38901
38902@item
38903@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38904representation as needed.  Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38905
38906@item
38907@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38908
38909@item
38910It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38911
38912@item
38913If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38914by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38915target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet.  This packet has to be expected
38916by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38917packet.
38918
38919@end itemize
38920
38921Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38922necessary information for the target to continue.  This at least contains
38923
38924@itemize @bullet
38925@item
38926Return value.
38927
38928@item
38929@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38930
38931@item
38932``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38933
38934@end itemize
38935
38936After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38937the latest continue or step action.
38938
38939@node The F Request Packet
38940@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38941@cindex file-i/o request packet
38942@cindex @code{F} request packet
38943
38944The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38945
38946@table @samp
38947@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38948
38949@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38950This is just the name of the function.
38951
38952@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38953Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38954of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38955datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38956of string parameters.  These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38957comma-delimited list.  All values are transmitted in ASCII
38958string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38959
38960@end table
38961
38962
38963
38964@node The F Reply Packet
38965@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38966@cindex file-i/o reply packet
38967@cindex @code{F} reply packet
38968
38969The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38970
38971@table @samp
38972
38973@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38974
38975@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38976
38977@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38978representation.
38979This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38980
38981@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break.  In this
38982case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38983The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38984
38985@smallexample
38986F0,0,C
38987@end smallexample
38988
38989@noindent
38990or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38991
38992@smallexample
38993F-1,4,C
38994@end smallexample
38995
38996@noindent
38997assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38998
38999@end table
39000
39001
39002@node The Ctrl-C Message
39003@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
39004@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
39005
39006If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
39007reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
39008the target should behave as if it had
39009gotten a break message.  The meaning for the target is ``system call
39010interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''.  Consequentially, the target should actually stop
39011(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
39012packet.
39013
39014It's important for the target to know in which
39015state the system call was interrupted.  There are two possible cases:
39016
39017@itemize @bullet
39018@item
39019The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
39020
39021@item
39022The system call on the host has been finished.
39023
39024@end itemize
39025
39026These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
39027returned @code{errno}.  If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
39028call hasn't been performed.  This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
39029on POSIX systems.  In any other case, the target may presume that the
39030system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
39031as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
39032
39033@value{GDBN} must behave reliably.  If the system call has not been called
39034yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
39035@code{errno} in the packet.  If the system call on the host has been finished
39036before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
39037@value{GDBN}.  This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
39038The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
39039or the full action has been completed.
39040
39041@node Console I/O
39042@subsection Console I/O
39043@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
39044
39045By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
39046descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console.  Output
39047on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
39048(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}).  Console input is handled
39049by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
390500 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
39051conditions is met:
39052
39053@itemize @bullet
39054@item
39055The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}.  The behaviour is as explained above, and the
39056@code{read}
39057system call is treated as finished.
39058
39059@item
39060The user presses @key{RET}.  This is treated as end of input with a trailing
39061newline.
39062
39063@item
39064The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}.  This is treated as end of input.  No trailing
39065character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
39066
39067@end itemize
39068
39069If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
39070the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
39071either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
39072is stopped at the user's request.
39073
39074
39075@node List of Supported Calls
39076@subsection List of Supported Calls
39077@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
39078
39079@menu
39080* open::
39081* close::
39082* read::
39083* write::
39084* lseek::
39085* rename::
39086* unlink::
39087* stat/fstat::
39088* gettimeofday::
39089* isatty::
39090* system::
39091@end menu
39092
39093@node open
39094@unnumberedsubsubsec open
39095@cindex open, file-i/o system call
39096
39097@table @asis
39098@item Synopsis:
39099@smallexample
39100int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
39101int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
39102@end smallexample
39103
39104@item Request:
39105@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
39106
39107@noindent
39108@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39109
39110@table @code
39111@item O_CREAT
39112If the file does not exist it will be created.  The host
39113rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
39114are concerned.
39115
39116@item O_EXCL
39117When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
39118an error and open() fails.
39119
39120@item O_TRUNC
39121If the file already exists and the open mode allows
39122writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
39123truncated to zero length.
39124
39125@item O_APPEND
39126The file is opened in append mode.
39127
39128@item O_RDONLY
39129The file is opened for reading only.
39130
39131@item O_WRONLY
39132The file is opened for writing only.
39133
39134@item O_RDWR
39135The file is opened for reading and writing.
39136@end table
39137
39138@noindent
39139Other bits are silently ignored.
39140
39141
39142@noindent
39143@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
39144
39145@table @code
39146@item S_IRUSR
39147User has read permission.
39148
39149@item S_IWUSR
39150User has write permission.
39151
39152@item S_IRGRP
39153Group has read permission.
39154
39155@item S_IWGRP
39156Group has write permission.
39157
39158@item S_IROTH
39159Others have read permission.
39160
39161@item S_IWOTH
39162Others have write permission.
39163@end table
39164
39165@noindent
39166Other bits are silently ignored.
39167
39168
39169@item Return value:
39170@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
39171occurred.
39172
39173@item Errors:
39174
39175@table @code
39176@item EEXIST
39177@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
39178
39179@item EISDIR
39180@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
39181
39182@item EACCES
39183The requested access is not allowed.
39184
39185@item ENAMETOOLONG
39186@var{pathname} was too long.
39187
39188@item ENOENT
39189A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39190
39191@item ENODEV
39192@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
39193
39194@item EROFS
39195@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
39196write access was requested.
39197
39198@item EFAULT
39199@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
39200
39201@item ENOSPC
39202No space on device to create the file.
39203
39204@item EMFILE
39205The process already has the maximum number of files open.
39206
39207@item ENFILE
39208The limit on the total number of files open on the system
39209has been reached.
39210
39211@item EINTR
39212The call was interrupted by the user.
39213@end table
39214
39215@end table
39216
39217@node close
39218@unnumberedsubsubsec close
39219@cindex close, file-i/o system call
39220
39221@table @asis
39222@item Synopsis:
39223@smallexample
39224int close(int fd);
39225@end smallexample
39226
39227@item Request:
39228@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
39229
39230@item Return value:
39231@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
39232
39233@item Errors:
39234
39235@table @code
39236@item EBADF
39237@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
39238
39239@item EINTR
39240The call was interrupted by the user.
39241@end table
39242
39243@end table
39244
39245@node read
39246@unnumberedsubsubsec read
39247@cindex read, file-i/o system call
39248
39249@table @asis
39250@item Synopsis:
39251@smallexample
39252int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
39253@end smallexample
39254
39255@item Request:
39256@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39257
39258@item Return value:
39259On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
39260Zero indicates end of file.  If count is zero, read
39261returns zero as well.  On error, -1 is returned.
39262
39263@item Errors:
39264
39265@table @code
39266@item EBADF
39267@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39268reading.
39269
39270@item EFAULT
39271@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39272
39273@item EINTR
39274The call was interrupted by the user.
39275@end table
39276
39277@end table
39278
39279@node write
39280@unnumberedsubsubsec write
39281@cindex write, file-i/o system call
39282
39283@table @asis
39284@item Synopsis:
39285@smallexample
39286int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
39287@end smallexample
39288
39289@item Request:
39290@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
39291
39292@item Return value:
39293On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
39294Zero indicates nothing was written.  On error, -1
39295is returned.
39296
39297@item Errors:
39298
39299@table @code
39300@item EBADF
39301@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
39302writing.
39303
39304@item EFAULT
39305@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39306
39307@item EFBIG
39308An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
39309host-specific maximum file size allowed.
39310
39311@item ENOSPC
39312No space on device to write the data.
39313
39314@item EINTR
39315The call was interrupted by the user.
39316@end table
39317
39318@end table
39319
39320@node lseek
39321@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
39322@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
39323
39324@table @asis
39325@item Synopsis:
39326@smallexample
39327long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
39328@end smallexample
39329
39330@item Request:
39331@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
39332
39333@var{flag} is one of:
39334
39335@table @code
39336@item SEEK_SET
39337The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
39338
39339@item SEEK_CUR
39340The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
39341bytes.
39342
39343@item SEEK_END
39344The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
39345bytes.
39346@end table
39347
39348@item Return value:
39349On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
39350the beginning of the file is returned.  Otherwise, a
39351value of -1 is returned.
39352
39353@item Errors:
39354
39355@table @code
39356@item EBADF
39357@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39358
39359@item ESPIPE
39360@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39361
39362@item EINVAL
39363@var{flag} is not a proper value.
39364
39365@item EINTR
39366The call was interrupted by the user.
39367@end table
39368
39369@end table
39370
39371@node rename
39372@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39373@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39374
39375@table @asis
39376@item Synopsis:
39377@smallexample
39378int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39379@end smallexample
39380
39381@item Request:
39382@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39383
39384@item Return value:
39385On success, zero is returned.  On error, -1 is returned.
39386
39387@item Errors:
39388
39389@table @code
39390@item EISDIR
39391@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39392directory.
39393
39394@item EEXIST
39395@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39396
39397@item EBUSY
39398@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39399process.
39400
39401@item EINVAL
39402An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39403of itself.
39404
39405@item ENOTDIR
39406A  component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39407path is not a directory.  Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39408and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39409
39410@item EFAULT
39411@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39412
39413@item EACCES
39414No access to the file or the path of the file.
39415
39416@item ENAMETOOLONG
39417
39418@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39419
39420@item ENOENT
39421A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39422
39423@item EROFS
39424The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39425
39426@item ENOSPC
39427The device containing the file has no room for the new
39428directory entry.
39429
39430@item EINTR
39431The call was interrupted by the user.
39432@end table
39433
39434@end table
39435
39436@node unlink
39437@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39438@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39439
39440@table @asis
39441@item Synopsis:
39442@smallexample
39443int unlink(const char *pathname);
39444@end smallexample
39445
39446@item Request:
39447@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39448
39449@item Return value:
39450On success, zero is returned.  On error, -1 is returned.
39451
39452@item Errors:
39453
39454@table @code
39455@item EACCES
39456No access to the file or the path of the file.
39457
39458@item EPERM
39459The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39460
39461@item EBUSY
39462The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39463being used by another process.
39464
39465@item EFAULT
39466@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39467
39468@item ENAMETOOLONG
39469@var{pathname} was too long.
39470
39471@item ENOENT
39472A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39473
39474@item ENOTDIR
39475A component of the path is not a directory.
39476
39477@item EROFS
39478The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39479
39480@item EINTR
39481The call was interrupted by the user.
39482@end table
39483
39484@end table
39485
39486@node stat/fstat
39487@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39488@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39489@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39490
39491@table @asis
39492@item Synopsis:
39493@smallexample
39494int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39495int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39496@end smallexample
39497
39498@item Request:
39499@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39500@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39501
39502@item Return value:
39503On success, zero is returned.  On error, -1 is returned.
39504
39505@item Errors:
39506
39507@table @code
39508@item EBADF
39509@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39510
39511@item ENOENT
39512A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39513path is an empty string.
39514
39515@item ENOTDIR
39516A component of the path is not a directory.
39517
39518@item EFAULT
39519@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39520
39521@item EACCES
39522No access to the file or the path of the file.
39523
39524@item ENAMETOOLONG
39525@var{pathname} was too long.
39526
39527@item EINTR
39528The call was interrupted by the user.
39529@end table
39530
39531@end table
39532
39533@node gettimeofday
39534@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39535@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39536
39537@table @asis
39538@item Synopsis:
39539@smallexample
39540int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39541@end smallexample
39542
39543@item Request:
39544@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39545
39546@item Return value:
39547On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39548
39549@item Errors:
39550
39551@table @code
39552@item EINVAL
39553@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39554
39555@item EFAULT
39556@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39557@end table
39558
39559@end table
39560
39561@node isatty
39562@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39563@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39564
39565@table @asis
39566@item Synopsis:
39567@smallexample
39568int isatty(int fd);
39569@end smallexample
39570
39571@item Request:
39572@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39573
39574@item Return value:
39575Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39576
39577@item Errors:
39578
39579@table @code
39580@item EINTR
39581The call was interrupted by the user.
39582@end table
39583
39584@end table
39585
39586Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
395871 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39588to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.  Implementing through system calls
39589would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39590needed.
39591
39592
39593@node system
39594@unnumberedsubsubsec system
39595@cindex system, file-i/o system call
39596
39597@table @asis
39598@item Synopsis:
39599@smallexample
39600int system(const char *command);
39601@end smallexample
39602
39603@item Request:
39604@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39605
39606@item Return value:
39607If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39608available.  A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39609For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39610return status of the command otherwise.  Only the exit status of the
39611command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39612return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}.  In case
39613@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39614
39615@item Errors:
39616
39617@table @code
39618@item EINTR
39619The call was interrupted by the user.
39620@end table
39621
39622@end table
39623
39624@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39625to perform the @code{system} call.  The return value of @code{system} on
39626the host is simplified before it's returned
39627to the target.  Any termination signal information from the child process
39628is discarded, and the return value consists
39629entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39630
39631Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39632by @value{GDBN}.  The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39633@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39634
39635@table @code
39636@item set remote system-call-allowed
39637@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39638Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39639protocol for the remote target.  The default is zero (disabled).
39640
39641@item show remote system-call-allowed
39642@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39643Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39644protocol.
39645@end table
39646
39647@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39648@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39649@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39650
39651@menu
39652* Integral Datatypes::
39653* Pointer Values::
39654* Memory Transfer::
39655* struct stat::
39656* struct timeval::
39657@end menu
39658
39659@node Integral Datatypes
39660@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39661@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39662
39663The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39664@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39665@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39666
39667@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39668implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39669
39670@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39671
39672@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39673in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39674
39675@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39676
39677All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39678structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39679byte order.
39680
39681@node Pointer Values
39682@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39683@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39684
39685Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are.  An exception
39686is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39687transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings.  Strings
39688are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39689
39690@smallexample
39691@code{1aaf/12}
39692@end smallexample
39693
39694@noindent
39695which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39696The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39697the trailing null byte.  For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39698at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39699
39700@smallexample
39701@code{123456/d}
39702@end smallexample
39703
39704@node Memory Transfer
39705@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39706@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39707
39708Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39709example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39710with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian.  Translation to
39711this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39712packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39713it transfers memory to the target.  Transferred pointers to structured
39714data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39715
39716
39717@node struct stat
39718@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39719@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39720
39721The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39722is defined as follows:
39723
39724@smallexample
39725struct stat @{
39726    unsigned int  st_dev;      /* device */
39727    unsigned int  st_ino;      /* inode */
39728    mode_t        st_mode;     /* protection */
39729    unsigned int  st_nlink;    /* number of hard links */
39730    unsigned int  st_uid;      /* user ID of owner */
39731    unsigned int  st_gid;      /* group ID of owner */
39732    unsigned int  st_rdev;     /* device type (if inode device) */
39733    unsigned long st_size;     /* total size, in bytes */
39734    unsigned long st_blksize;  /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39735    unsigned long st_blocks;   /* number of blocks allocated */
39736    time_t        st_atime;    /* time of last access */
39737    time_t        st_mtime;    /* time of last modification */
39738    time_t        st_ctime;    /* time of last change */
39739@};
39740@end smallexample
39741
39742The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39743appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39744structure is of size 64 bytes.
39745
39746The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39747range of values.
39748
39749@table @code
39750
39751@item st_dev
39752A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39753
39754@item st_ino
39755No valid meaning for the target.  Transmitted unchanged.
39756
39757@item st_mode
39758Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}.  Any other
39759bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39760
39761@item st_uid
39762@itemx st_gid
39763@itemx st_rdev
39764No valid meaning for the target.  Transmitted unchanged.
39765
39766@item st_atime
39767@itemx st_mtime
39768@itemx st_ctime
39769These values have a host and file system dependent
39770accuracy.  Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39771support exact timing values.
39772@end table
39773
39774The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39775responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39776continuing.
39777
39778Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39779representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39780get truncated on the target.
39781
39782@node struct timeval
39783@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39784@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39785
39786The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39787is defined as follows:
39788
39789@smallexample
39790struct timeval @{
39791    time_t tv_sec;  /* second */
39792    long   tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39793@};
39794@end smallexample
39795
39796The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39797appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39798structure is of size 8 bytes.
39799
39800@node Constants
39801@subsection Constants
39802@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39803
39804The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39805protocol.  @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39806values before and after the call as needed.
39807
39808@menu
39809* Open Flags::
39810* mode_t Values::
39811* Errno Values::
39812* Lseek Flags::
39813* Limits::
39814@end menu
39815
39816@node Open Flags
39817@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39818@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39819
39820All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39821
39822@smallexample
39823  O_RDONLY        0x0
39824  O_WRONLY        0x1
39825  O_RDWR          0x2
39826  O_APPEND        0x8
39827  O_CREAT       0x200
39828  O_TRUNC       0x400
39829  O_EXCL        0x800
39830@end smallexample
39831
39832@node mode_t Values
39833@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39834@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39835
39836All values are given in octal representation.
39837
39838@smallexample
39839  S_IFREG       0100000
39840  S_IFDIR        040000
39841  S_IRUSR          0400
39842  S_IWUSR          0200
39843  S_IXUSR          0100
39844  S_IRGRP           040
39845  S_IWGRP           020
39846  S_IXGRP           010
39847  S_IROTH            04
39848  S_IWOTH            02
39849  S_IXOTH            01
39850@end smallexample
39851
39852@node Errno Values
39853@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39854@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39855
39856All values are given in decimal representation.
39857
39858@smallexample
39859  EPERM           1
39860  ENOENT          2
39861  EINTR           4
39862  EBADF           9
39863  EACCES         13
39864  EFAULT         14
39865  EBUSY          16
39866  EEXIST         17
39867  ENODEV         19
39868  ENOTDIR        20
39869  EISDIR         21
39870  EINVAL         22
39871  ENFILE         23
39872  EMFILE         24
39873  EFBIG          27
39874  ENOSPC         28
39875  ESPIPE         29
39876  EROFS          30
39877  ENAMETOOLONG   91
39878  EUNKNOWN       9999
39879@end smallexample
39880
39881  @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39882  any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39883
39884@node Lseek Flags
39885@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39886@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39887
39888@smallexample
39889  SEEK_SET      0
39890  SEEK_CUR      1
39891  SEEK_END      2
39892@end smallexample
39893
39894@node Limits
39895@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39896@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39897
39898All values are given in decimal representation.
39899
39900@smallexample
39901  INT_MIN       -2147483648
39902  INT_MAX        2147483647
39903  UINT_MAX       4294967295
39904  LONG_MIN      -9223372036854775808
39905  LONG_MAX       9223372036854775807
39906  ULONG_MAX      18446744073709551615
39907@end smallexample
39908
39909@node File-I/O Examples
39910@subsection File-I/O Examples
39911@cindex file-i/o examples
39912
39913Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39914address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39915
39916@smallexample
39917<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39918@emph{request memory read from target}
39919-> @code{m1234,6}
39920<- XXXXXX
39921@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39922-> @code{F6}
39923@end smallexample
39924
39925Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39926address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39927
39928@smallexample
39929<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39930@emph{request memory write to target}
39931-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39932@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39933-> @code{F6}
39934@end smallexample
39935
39936Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39937file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39938
39939@smallexample
39940<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39941-> @code{F-1,9}
39942@end smallexample
39943
39944Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39945host is called:
39946
39947@smallexample
39948<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39949-> @code{F-1,4,C}
39950<- @code{T02}
39951@end smallexample
39952
39953Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39954host is called:
39955
39956@smallexample
39957<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39958-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39959<- @code{T02}
39960@end smallexample
39961
39962@node Library List Format
39963@section Library List Format
39964@cindex library list format, remote protocol
39965
39966On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39967same process as your application to manage libraries.  In this case,
39968@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39969operations to maintain a list of shared libraries.  On other
39970platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39971@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39972through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39973packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead.  The remote stub
39974queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39975are loaded.
39976
39977The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39978lists loaded libraries and their offsets.  Each library has an
39979associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39980which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39981
39982For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39983library should have a list of segments.  If the target supports
39984dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39985should instead include a list of allocated sections.  The segment or
39986section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39987depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39988
39989@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39990library lists.  @xref{Expat}.
39991
39992A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39993offset, looks like this:
39994
39995@smallexample
39996<library-list>
39997  <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39998    <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39999  </library>
40000</library-list>
40001@end smallexample
40002
40003Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
40004allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
40005
40006@smallexample
40007<library-list>
40008  <library name="sharedlib.o">
40009    <section address="0x10000000"/>
40010    <section address="0x20000000"/>
40011    <section address="0x30000000"/>
40012  </library>
40013</library-list>
40014@end smallexample
40015
40016The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
40017
40018@smallexample
40019<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
40020<!ELEMENT library-list  (library)*>
40021<!ATTLIST library-list  version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0">
40022<!ELEMENT library       (segment*, section*)>
40023<!ATTLIST library       name    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40024<!ELEMENT segment       EMPTY>
40025<!ATTLIST segment       address CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40026<!ELEMENT section       EMPTY>
40027<!ATTLIST section       address CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40028@end smallexample
40029
40030In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
40031single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
40032section for each library.
40033
40034@node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40035@section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
40036@cindex library list format, remote protocol
40037
40038On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
40039(e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
40040shared libraries.  Still a special library list provided by this packet is
40041more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
40042
40043The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
40044loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters.  For each library on SVR4
40045target, the following parameters are reported:
40046
40047@itemize @minus
40048@item
40049@code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
40050@code{struct link_map}.
40051@item
40052@code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
40053(Thread Local Storage) access.
40054@item
40055@code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
40056@code{struct link_map}.  For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
40057memory address.  It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
40058address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
40059@item
40060@code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
40061@end itemize
40062
40063Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
40064@code{struct link_map} used for the main executable.  This parameter is used
40065for TLS access and its presence is optional.
40066
40067@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40068SVR4 library lists.  @xref{Expat}.
40069
40070A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
40071looks like this:
40072
40073@smallexample
40074<library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
40075  <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
40076           l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
40077  <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
40078           l_ld="0x152350"/>
40079</library-list-svr>
40080@end smallexample
40081
40082The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
40083
40084@smallexample
40085<!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
40086<!ELEMENT library-list-svr4  (library)*>
40087<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4  version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0">
40088<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4  main-lm CDATA   #IMPLIED>
40089<!ELEMENT library            EMPTY>
40090<!ATTLIST library            name    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40091<!ATTLIST library            lm      CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40092<!ATTLIST library            l_addr  CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40093<!ATTLIST library            l_ld    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40094@end smallexample
40095
40096@node Memory Map Format
40097@section Memory Map Format
40098@cindex memory map format
40099
40100To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
40101memory map from the target.  This section describes the format of the
40102memory map.
40103
40104The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40105(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
40106lists memory regions.
40107
40108@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40109memory maps.  @xref{Expat}.
40110
40111The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40112
40113@smallexample
40114<?xml version="1.0"?>
40115<!DOCTYPE memory-map
40116          PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40117                 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
40118<memory-map>
40119    region...
40120</memory-map>
40121@end smallexample
40122
40123Each region can be either:
40124
40125@itemize
40126
40127@item
40128A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
40129bytes from there:
40130
40131@smallexample
40132<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40133@end smallexample
40134
40135
40136@item
40137A region of read-only memory:
40138
40139@smallexample
40140<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40141@end smallexample
40142
40143
40144@item
40145A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
40146bytes in length:
40147
40148@smallexample
40149<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
40150  <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
40151</memory>
40152@end smallexample
40153
40154@end itemize
40155
40156Regions must not overlap.  @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
40157by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
40158packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
40159
40160The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
40161
40162@smallexample
40163<!-- ................................................... -->
40164<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
40165<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
40166<!-- .................................... .............. -->
40167<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
40168<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
40169<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
40170<!ATTLIST memory-map    version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0.0">
40171<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
40172<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
40173             and its type, or device. -->
40174<!ATTLIST memory        type    CDATA   #REQUIRED
40175                        start   CDATA   #REQUIRED
40176                        length  CDATA   #REQUIRED
40177                        device  CDATA   #IMPLIED>
40178<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
40179<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
40180<!ATTLIST property      name    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40181@end smallexample
40182
40183@node Thread List Format
40184@section Thread List Format
40185@cindex thread list format
40186
40187To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
40188@value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40189(@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
40190the following structure:
40191
40192@smallexample
40193<?xml version="1.0"?>
40194<threads>
40195    <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
40196    ... description ...
40197    </thread>
40198</threads>
40199@end smallexample
40200
40201Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
40202identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).  The
40203@samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
40204the thread was last executing on.  The @samp{name} attribute, if
40205present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread.  The content
40206of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
40207auxiliary information.
40208
40209@node Traceframe Info Format
40210@section Traceframe Info Format
40211@cindex traceframe info format
40212
40213To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
40214inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
40215memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
40216collected in a traceframe.
40217
40218This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40219(@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
40220
40221@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40222traceframe info discovery.  @xref{Expat}.
40223
40224The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40225
40226@smallexample
40227<?xml version="1.0"?>
40228<!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
40229          PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
40230                 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
40231<traceframe-info>
40232   block...
40233</traceframe-info>
40234@end smallexample
40235
40236Each traceframe block can be either:
40237
40238@itemize
40239
40240@item
40241A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
40242@var{length} bytes from there:
40243
40244@smallexample
40245<memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
40246@end smallexample
40247
40248@item
40249A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
40250collected:
40251
40252@smallexample
40253<tvar id="@var{number}"/>
40254@end smallexample
40255
40256@end itemize
40257
40258The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
40259
40260@smallexample
40261<!ELEMENT traceframe-info  (memory | tvar)* >
40262<!ATTLIST traceframe-info  version CDATA   #FIXED  "1.0">
40263
40264<!ELEMENT memory        EMPTY>
40265<!ATTLIST memory        start   CDATA   #REQUIRED
40266                        length  CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40267<!ELEMENT tvar>
40268<!ATTLIST tvar          id      CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40269@end smallexample
40270
40271@node Branch Trace Format
40272@section Branch Trace Format
40273@cindex branch trace format
40274
40275In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
40276@value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches.  This list is
40277represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
40278branches.  The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
40279
40280This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40281(@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
40282
40283@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40284traceframe info discovery.  @xref{Expat}.
40285
40286The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
40287
40288@smallexample
40289<?xml version="1.0"?>
40290<!DOCTYPE btrace
40291          PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
40292                 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
40293<btrace>
40294   block...
40295</btrace>
40296@end smallexample
40297
40298@itemize
40299
40300@item
40301A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
40302and ending at @var{end}:
40303
40304@smallexample
40305<block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
40306@end smallexample
40307
40308@end itemize
40309
40310The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
40311
40312@smallexample
40313<!ELEMENT btrace  (block* | pt) >
40314<!ATTLIST btrace  version CDATA   #FIXED "1.0">
40315
40316<!ELEMENT block        EMPTY>
40317<!ATTLIST block        begin  CDATA   #REQUIRED
40318                       end    CDATA   #REQUIRED>
40319
40320<!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
40321
40322<!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
40323
40324<!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
40325<!ATTLIST cpu vendor   CDATA #REQUIRED
40326              family   CDATA #REQUIRED
40327              model    CDATA #REQUIRED
40328              stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
40329
40330<!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
40331@end smallexample
40332
40333@node Branch Trace Configuration Format
40334@section Branch Trace Configuration Format
40335@cindex branch trace configuration format
40336
40337For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
40338configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40339(@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
40340
40341The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
40342settings for that format.  The following information is described:
40343
40344@table @code
40345@item bts
40346This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
40347@table @code
40348@item size
40349The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
40350@end table
40351@item pt
40352This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40353PT}) format.
40354@table @code
40355@item size
40356The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40357@end table
40358@end table
40359
40360@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40361branch trace configuration discovery.  @xref{Expat}.
40362
40363The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40364
40365@smallexample
40366<!ELEMENT btrace-conf	(bts?, pt?)>
40367<!ATTLIST btrace-conf	version	CDATA	#FIXED "1.0">
40368
40369<!ELEMENT bts	EMPTY>
40370<!ATTLIST bts	size	CDATA	#IMPLIED>
40371
40372<!ELEMENT pt	EMPTY>
40373<!ATTLIST pt	size	CDATA	#IMPLIED>
40374@end smallexample
40375
40376@include agentexpr.texi
40377
40378@node Target Descriptions
40379@appendix Target Descriptions
40380@cindex target descriptions
40381
40382One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40383is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40384architecture in use.  It is common practice for vendors to start with
40385a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40386and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche.  Some
40387architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40388vendors.  This leads to a number of problems:
40389
40390@itemize @bullet
40391@item
40392With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40393the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40394@item
40395Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40396audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40397variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40398@item
40399When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40400at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40401@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40402@end itemize
40403
40404To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40405target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40406actually describe its own features.  This lets @value{GDBN} support
40407processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40408descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40409
40410@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40411target descriptions.  @xref{Expat}.
40412
40413@menu
40414* Retrieving Descriptions::         How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40415* Target Description Format::       The contents of a target description.
40416* Predefined Target Types::         Standard types available for target
40417                                    descriptions.
40418* Enum Target Types::               How to define enum target types.
40419* Standard Target Features::        Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40420@end menu
40421
40422@node Retrieving Descriptions
40423@section Retrieving Descriptions
40424
40425Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40426specified by the user manually.  The default behavior is to read the
40427description from the target.  @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40428protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40429qXfer}).  The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40430@samp{target.xml}.  The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40431XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40432Format}.
40433
40434Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40435If a file is set, the target will not be queried.  The commands to
40436specify a file are:
40437
40438@table @code
40439@cindex set tdesc filename
40440@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40441Read the target description from @var{path}.
40442
40443@cindex unset tdesc filename
40444@item unset tdesc filename
40445Do not read the XML target description from a file.  @value{GDBN}
40446will use the description supplied by the current target.
40447
40448@cindex show tdesc filename
40449@item show tdesc filename
40450Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40451@end table
40452
40453
40454@node Target Description Format
40455@section Target Description Format
40456@cindex target descriptions, XML format
40457
40458A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40459document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40460the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}.  This
40461means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40462check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40463However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40464their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40465
40466Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40467and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40468sets.  They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40469@value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40470target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40471
40472Here is a simple target description:
40473
40474@smallexample
40475<target version="1.0">
40476  <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40477</target>
40478@end smallexample
40479
40480@noindent
40481This minimal description only says that the target uses
40482the x86-64 architecture.
40483
40484A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40485optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements.  The elements
40486are explained further below.
40487
40488@smallexample
40489<?xml version="1.0"?>
40490<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40491<target version="1.0">
40492  @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40493  @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40494  @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40495  @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40496</target>
40497@end smallexample
40498
40499@noindent
40500The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40501breaks, under the usual common-sense rules.  The XML version
40502declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40503(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40504useful for XML validation tools.  The @samp{version} attribute for
40505@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40506including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40507revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40508the version mismatch.
40509
40510@subsection Inclusion
40511@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40512@cindex XInclude
40513@ifnotinfo
40514@cindex <xi:include>
40515@end ifnotinfo
40516
40517It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40518several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40519share files between different possible target descriptions.  You can
40520divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40521the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40522
40523@smallexample
40524<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40525@end smallexample
40526
40527@noindent
40528When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40529the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40530the contents of that document.  If the current description was read
40531using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40532@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex.  If the
40533current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40534@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40535original description.
40536
40537@subsection Architecture
40538@cindex <architecture>
40539
40540An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40541
40542@smallexample
40543  <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40544@end smallexample
40545
40546@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40547@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40548
40549@subsection OS ABI
40550@cindex @code{<osabi>}
40551
40552This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40553Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40554
40555An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40556
40557@smallexample
40558  <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40559@end smallexample
40560
40561@var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40562@w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40563
40564@subsection Compatible Architecture
40565@cindex @code{<compatible>}
40566
40567This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40568Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40569
40570A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40571
40572@smallexample
40573  <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40574@end smallexample
40575
40576@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40577@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40578
40579A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40580is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40581given by the @samp{<architecture>} element.  For example, on the
40582Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40583or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40584in the @code{spu} architecture as well.  The way to describe this
40585capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40586
40587@smallexample
40588  <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40589  <compatible>spu</compatible>
40590@end smallexample
40591
40592@subsection Features
40593@cindex <feature>
40594
40595Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40596system.  Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40597registers and the types of their contents.  A @samp{<feature>} element
40598has this form:
40599
40600@smallexample
40601<feature name="@var{name}">
40602  @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40603  @var{reg}@dots{}
40604</feature>
40605@end smallexample
40606
40607@noindent
40608Each feature's name should be unique within the description.  The name
40609of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40610knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40611should have its standard name.  @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40612
40613@subsection Types
40614
40615Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40616interpret.  The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40617but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40618Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40619Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
40620and enum types.
40621
40622Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40623a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40624Types must be defined before they are used.
40625
40626@cindex <vector>
40627Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40628of scalar elements.  These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40629specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40630@var{count}:
40631
40632@smallexample
40633<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40634@end smallexample
40635
40636@cindex <union>
40637If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40638with a union type containing the useful representations.  The
40639@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40640each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40641
40642@smallexample
40643<union id="@var{id}">
40644  <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40645  @dots{}
40646</union>
40647@end smallexample
40648
40649@cindex <struct>
40650@cindex <flags>
40651If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40652it with either a structure type or a flags type.
40653A flags type may only contain bitfields.
40654A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
40655If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
40656specified.
40657
40658Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
40659
40660@smallexample
40661<struct id="@var{id}">
40662  <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40663  @dots{}
40664</struct>
40665@end smallexample
40666
40667Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
40668No implicit padding is added.
40669
40670Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
40671
40672@smallexample
40673<struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40674  <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40675  @dots{}
40676</struct>
40677@end smallexample
40678
40679@smallexample
40680<flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40681  <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
40682  @dots{}
40683</flags>
40684@end smallexample
40685
40686The @var{name} value is required.
40687Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
40688in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
40689Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
40690
40691The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
40692is optional.
40693The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
40694and zero represents the least significant bit.
40695
40696The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
40697and an unsigned integer otherwise.
40698
40699Which to choose?  Structures or flags?
40700
40701Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
40702defining them with @samp{struct}:
40703
40704@itemize @bullet
40705@item
40706Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
40707@item
40708They are printed in a more readable fashion.
40709@end itemize
40710
40711Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
40712defining them with @samp{flags}:
40713
40714@itemize @bullet
40715@item
40716One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
40717
40718@smallexample
40719(gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
40720$1 = 42
40721@end smallexample
40722
40723@end itemize
40724
40725@subsection Registers
40726@cindex <reg>
40727
40728Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40729
40730@smallexample
40731<reg name="@var{name}"
40732     bitsize="@var{size}"
40733     @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40734     @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40735     @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40736     @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40737@end smallexample
40738
40739@noindent
40740The components are as follows:
40741
40742@table @var
40743
40744@item name
40745The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40746
40747@item bitsize
40748The register's size, in bits.
40749
40750@item regnum
40751The register's number.  If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40752than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40753a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40754defaults to zero.  This register number is used to read or write
40755the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40756packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40757in order of increasing register number.
40758
40759@item save-restore
40760Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40761calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}.  The default is
40762@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40763some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40764ABI.
40765
40766@item type
40767The type of the register.  It may be a predefined type, a type
40768defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40769and @code{float}.  @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40770for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40771architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40772@var{bitsize}.  The default is @code{int}.
40773
40774@item group
40775The register group to which this register belongs.  It must
40776be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}.  If no
40777@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40778in @code{info registers}.
40779
40780@end table
40781
40782@node Predefined Target Types
40783@section Predefined Target Types
40784@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40785
40786Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40787from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types.  Instead,
40788standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40789types.  The currently supported types are:
40790
40791@table @code
40792
40793@item bool
40794Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
40795
40796@item int8
40797@itemx int16
40798@itemx int32
40799@itemx int64
40800@itemx int128
40801Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40802
40803@item uint8
40804@itemx uint16
40805@itemx uint32
40806@itemx uint64
40807@itemx uint128
40808Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40809
40810@item code_ptr
40811@itemx data_ptr
40812Pointers to unspecified code and data.  The program counter and
40813any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40814pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40815address.  The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40816may be marked as data pointers.
40817
40818@item ieee_single
40819Single precision IEEE floating point.
40820
40821@item ieee_double
40822Double precision IEEE floating point.
40823
40824@item arm_fpa_ext
40825The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40826
40827@item i387_ext
40828The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40829
40830@item i386_eflags
4083132bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40832
40833@item i386_mxcsr
4083432bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40835
40836@end table
40837
40838@node Enum Target Types
40839@section Enum Target Types
40840@cindex target descriptions, enum types
40841
40842Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
40843register descriptions.  @xref{Target Description Format}.
40844
40845Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
40846
40847@smallexample
40848<enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40849  <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
40850  @dots{}
40851</enum>
40852@end smallexample
40853
40854Enums must be defined before they are used.
40855
40856@smallexample
40857<enum id="levels_type" size="4">
40858  <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
40859  <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
40860</enum>
40861<flags id="flags_type" size="4">
40862  <field name="X" start="0"/>
40863  <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
40864</flags>
40865<reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
40866@end smallexample
40867
40868Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
40869would be printed as:
40870
40871@smallexample
40872(gdb) info register flags
40873flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
40874@end smallexample
40875
40876@node Standard Target Features
40877@section Standard Target Features
40878@cindex target descriptions, standard features
40879
40880A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40881target's registers.  If the description contains no registers, then
40882@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40883the architecture.  If the description contains any registers, the
40884default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40885described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40886can recognize them.
40887
40888This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40889which contain standard registers.  @value{GDBN} will look for features
40890with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40891if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40892feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40893description.  You can add additional registers to any of the
40894standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40895they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40896
40897This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40898Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40899@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40900
40901Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40902company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40903architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40904containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40905
40906The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40907of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40908registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40909
40910@menu
40911* AArch64 Features::
40912* ARM Features::
40913* i386 Features::
40914* MicroBlaze Features::
40915* MIPS Features::
40916* M68K Features::
40917* NDS32 Features::
40918* Nios II Features::
40919* PowerPC Features::
40920* S/390 and System z Features::
40921* TIC6x Features::
40922@end menu
40923
40924
40925@node AArch64 Features
40926@subsection AArch64 Features
40927@cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40928
40929The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40930targets.  It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40931@samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40932
40933The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional.  If present,
40934it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40935and @samp{fpcr}.
40936
40937@node ARM Features
40938@subsection ARM Features
40939@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40940
40941The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40942ARM targets.
40943It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40944@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40945
40946For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40947feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}.  It should contain
40948registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40949and @samp{xpsr}.
40950
40951The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional.  If present, it
40952should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40953
40954The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional.  If present,
40955it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40956@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}.  The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40957@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40958
40959The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional.  If present, it
40960should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}.  If
40961they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40962@value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40963halves of the double-precision registers.
40964
40965The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional.  It does not
40966need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40967VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40968quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40969If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40970be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40971
40972@node i386 Features
40973@subsection i386 Features
40974@cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40975
40976The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40977targets.  It should describe the following registers:
40978
40979@itemize @minus
40980@item
40981@samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40982@item
40983@samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40984@item
40985@samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40986@samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40987@item
40988@samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40989@item
40990@samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40991@samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40992@end itemize
40993
40994The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40995
40996The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional.  It should
40997describe registers:
40998
40999@itemize @minus
41000@item
41001@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
41002@item
41003@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
41004@item
41005@samp{mxcsr}
41006@end itemize
41007
41008The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
41009@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature.  It should
41010describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
41011
41012@itemize @minus
41013@item
41014@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
41015@item
41016@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
41017@end itemize
41018
41019The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
41020Memory Protection Extension (MPX).  It should describe the following registers:
41021
41022@itemize @minus
41023@item
41024@samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
41025@item
41026@samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
41027@end itemize
41028
41029The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional.  It should
41030describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
41031
41032The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
41033@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature.  It should
41034describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
41035
41036@itemize @minus
41037@item
41038@samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41039@end itemize
41040
41041It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
41042
41043@itemize @minus
41044@item
41045@samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41046@end itemize
41047
41048It should
41049describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
41050
41051@itemize @minus
41052@item
41053@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
41054@item
41055@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
41056@end itemize
41057
41058It should
41059describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
41060
41061@itemize @minus
41062@item
41063@samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
41064@end itemize
41065
41066@node MicroBlaze Features
41067@subsection MicroBlaze Features
41068@cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
41069
41070The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
41071targets.  It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41072@samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
41073@samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
41074@samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
41075
41076The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
41077If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
41078
41079@node MIPS Features
41080@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
41081@cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
41082
41083The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
41084It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
41085@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
41086on the target.
41087
41088The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required.  It should
41089contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
41090registers.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41091
41092The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
41093it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}.  It should
41094contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
41095@samp{fir}.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41096
41097The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional.  It should
41098contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
41099@samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}.  The @samp{dspctl} register should
41100be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41101
41102The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional.  It should
41103contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
41104Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
41105
41106@node M68K Features
41107@subsection M68K Features
41108@cindex target descriptions, M68K features
41109
41110@table @code
41111@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
41112@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
41113@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
41114One of those features must be always present.
41115The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
41116used.  The feature that is present should contain registers
41117@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
41118@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
41119
41120@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
41121This feature is optional.  If present, it should contain registers
41122@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
41123@samp{fpiaddr}.
41124@end table
41125
41126@node NDS32 Features
41127@subsection NDS32 Features
41128@cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
41129
41130The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
41131targets.  It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
41132@samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
41133and @samp{pc}.
41134
41135The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional.  If present,
41136it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
41137@samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
41138@samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
41139
41140@emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
41141registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
41142floating-point registers.  The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
41143not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
41144overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers.  Listing 32-bit
41145single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
41146support to it could be totally removed some day.
41147
41148@node Nios II Features
41149@subsection Nios II Features
41150@cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
41151
41152The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
41153targets.  It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
41154@samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
41155@samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
41156@samp{mpuacc}).
41157
41158@node PowerPC Features
41159@subsection PowerPC Features
41160@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
41161
41162The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
41163targets.  It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
41164@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
41165@samp{xer}.  They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
41166
41167The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional.  It should
41168contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
41169
41170The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional.  It should
41171contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
41172and @samp{vrsave}.
41173
41174The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional.  It should
41175contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}.  @value{GDBN}
41176will combine these registers with the floating point registers
41177(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
41178through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
41179through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
41180
41181The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional.  It should
41182contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
41183@samp{spefscr}.  SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
41184@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
41185@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}.  @value{GDBN} will combine
41186these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
41187user.
41188
41189@node S/390 and System z Features
41190@subsection S/390 and System z Features
41191@cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
41192@cindex target descriptions, System z features
41193
41194The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
41195System z targets.  It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
41196registers.  In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
41197registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
41198S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
41199A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
4120032-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
41201register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
41202lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
41203
41204The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required.  It should
41205contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
41206@samp{fpc}.
41207
41208The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required.  It should
41209contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
41210
41211The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional.  It should
41212contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
41213targets and 32-bit otherwise.  In addition, the feature may contain
41214the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
41215mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
4121632-bit wide.
41217
41218The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional.  It should
41219contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
41220@samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
41221
41222The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional.  It should contain
4122364-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
41224combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
41225through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
41226@samp{v0} through @samp{v15}.  In addition, this feature should
41227contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
41228@samp{v31}.
41229
41230@node TIC6x Features
41231@subsection TMS320C6x Features
41232@cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
41233@cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
41234The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
41235targets.  It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
41236registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
41237
41238The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional.  It should
41239contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
41240through @samp{B31}.
41241
41242The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional.  It should
41243contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
41244
41245@node Operating System Information
41246@appendix Operating System Information
41247@cindex operating system information
41248
41249@menu
41250* Process list::
41251@end menu
41252
41253Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
41254the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
41255processes, or the list of open files.  This section describes the
41256mechanism that makes it possible.  This mechanism is similar to the
41257target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
41258on a different aspect of target.
41259
41260Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
41261remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
41262read}).  The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
41263the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
41264
41265@node Process list
41266@appendixsection Process list
41267@cindex operating system information, process list
41268
41269When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
41270@samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}.  The returned data is
41271an XML document.  The formal syntax of this document is defined in
41272@file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
41273
41274An example document is:
41275
41276@smallexample
41277<?xml version="1.0"?>
41278<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
41279<osdata type="processes">
41280  <item>
41281    <column name="pid">1</column>
41282    <column name="user">root</column>
41283    <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
41284    <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
41285  </item>
41286</osdata>
41287@end smallexample
41288
41289Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}.  The value
41290of that column should identify the process on the target.  The
41291@samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
41292displayed by @value{GDBN}.  The @samp{cores} column, if present,
41293should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
41294is running on.  Target may provide additional columns,
41295which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
41296
41297@node Trace File Format
41298@appendix Trace File Format
41299@cindex trace file format
41300
41301The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
41302section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
41303
41304The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}.  The first byte is
41305@code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
41306while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
41307in the future.
41308
41309The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
41310separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}).  The lines may include a
41311variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
41312as tracepoint definitions or register set size.  @value{GDBN} will
41313ignore any line that it does not recognize.  An empty line marks the end
41314of this section.
41315
41316@table @code
41317@item R @var{size}
41318Specifies the size of a register block in bytes.  This is equal to the
41319size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol.  @var{size}
41320is an ascii decimal number.  There should be only one such line in
41321a single trace file.
41322
41323@item status @var{status}
41324Trace status.  @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
41325remote packet reply.  There should be only one such line in a single trace
41326file.
41327
41328@item tp @var{payload}
41329Tracepoint definition.  The @var{payload} has the same format as
41330@code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload.  A single tracepoint
41331may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41332reply packets.
41333
41334@item tsv @var{payload}
41335Trace state variable definition.  The @var{payload} has the same format as
41336@code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload.  A single variable
41337may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
41338reply packets.
41339
41340@item tdesc @var{payload}
41341Target description in XML format.  The @var{payload} is a single line of
41342the XML file.  All such lines should be concatenated together to get
41343the original XML file.  This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
41344@code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
41345file.  Includes are not allowed.
41346
41347@end table
41348
41349The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
41350Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
41351four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame.  The data in
41352the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
41353character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
41354state variable).  The data in this section is raw binary, not a
41355hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
41356endianness.
41357
41358@c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
41359
41360@table @code
41361@item R @var{bytes}
41362Register block.  The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
41363@code{g} packet in the remote protocol.  Note that these are the
41364actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
41365
41366@item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
41367Memory block.  This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
41368address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
41369@var{length} bytes.
41370
41371@item V @var{number} @var{value}
41372Trace state variable block.  This records the 8-byte signed value
41373@var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
41374
41375@end table
41376
41377Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
41378of blocks.
41379
41380@node Index Section Format
41381@appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
41382@cindex .gdb_index section format
41383@cindex index section format
41384
41385This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
41386gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}).  The index section is
41387DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
41388description.
41389
41390The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
41391@code{mmap}able on any architecture.  In most cases, a datum is
41392represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
41393@code{offset_type}.  Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
41394before using them.  Exceptions to this rule are noted.  The data is
41395laid out such that alignment is always respected.
41396
41397A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
41398
41399@enumerate
41400@item
41401The file header.  This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
41402unless otherwise noted:
41403
41404@enumerate
41405@item
41406The version number, currently 8.  Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
41407Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
41408Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
41409and 5 do not.  Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
41410symbol table.  Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
41411(@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
41412compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
41413
41414@value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
41415by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
41416GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
41417currently not flagged as deprecated.
41418
41419@item
41420The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
41421
41422@item
41423The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list.  Note
41424that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
41425to the next offset.
41426
41427@item
41428The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
41429
41430@item
41431The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
41432
41433@item
41434The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
41435@end enumerate
41436
41437@item
41438The CU list.  This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
41439values, sorted by the CU offset.  The first element in each pair is
41440the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section.  The second
41441element in each pair is the length of that CU.  References to a CU
41442elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
414430-based index into this table.  Note that if there are type CUs, then
41444conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
41445CU indices.
41446
41447@item
41448The types CU list.  This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
41449little-endian values.  In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
41450the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
41451the type signature.  The types CU list is not sorted.
41452
41453@item
41454The address area.  The address area consists of a sequence of address
41455entries.  Each address entry has three elements:
41456
41457@enumerate
41458@item
41459The low address.  This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
41460
41461@item
41462The high address.  This is a 64-bit little-endian value.  Like
41463@code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
41464
41465@item
41466The CU index.  This is an @code{offset_type} value.
41467@end enumerate
41468
41469@item
41470The symbol table.  This is an open-addressed hash table.  The size of
41471the hash table is always a power of 2.
41472
41473Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
41474values.  The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
41475constant pool.  The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
41476constant pool.
41477
41478If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty.  This
41479is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
41480valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
41481
41482The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41483iterative hash function to the symbol's name.  Starting with an
41484initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41485the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41486index version:
41487
41488@table @asis
41489@item Version 4
41490The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41491
41492@item Versions 5 to 7
41493The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41494@end table
41495
41496The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41497
41498The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41499@code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41500value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table.  The step size
41501is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41502collision.
41503
41504The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized.  We
41505don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41506algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41507the code.
41508
41509@item
41510The constant pool.  This is simply a bunch of bytes.  It is organized
41511so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41512strings.
41513
41514A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41515values.  The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41516Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41517the CU list.  This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41518CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41519See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41520
41521A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41522@end enumerate
41523
41524Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41525If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41526CU index+attributes value for each use.
41527
41528The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41529(bit 0 = LSB):
41530
41531@table @asis
41532
41533@item Bits 0-23
41534This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41535@item Bits 24-27
41536These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41537@item Bits 28-30
41538The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41539
41540@table @asis
41541@item 0
41542This value is reserved and should not be used.
41543By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41544with previous versions of the index.
41545@item 1
41546The symbol is a type.
41547@item 2
41548The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41549@item 3
41550The symbol is a function.
41551@item 4
41552Any other kind of symbol.
41553@item 5,6,7
41554These values are reserved.
41555@end table
41556
41557@item Bit 31
41558This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41559
41560The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41561The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41562@value{GDBN} sources.
41563
41564@end table
41565
41566This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41567global/static attributes in the index.
41568
41569@smallexample
41570is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41571language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41572switch (die->tag)
41573  @{
41574  case DW_TAG_typedef:
41575  case DW_TAG_base_type:
41576  case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41577    kind = TYPE;
41578    is_static = 1;
41579    break;
41580  case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41581    kind = VARIABLE;
41582    is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41583    break;
41584  case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41585    kind = FUNCTION;
41586    is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41587    break;
41588  case DW_TAG_constant:
41589    kind = VARIABLE;
41590    is_static = ! is_external;
41591    break;
41592  case DW_TAG_variable:
41593    kind = VARIABLE;
41594    is_static = ! is_external;
41595    break;
41596  case DW_TAG_namespace:
41597    kind = TYPE;
41598    is_static = 0;
41599    break;
41600  case DW_TAG_class_type:
41601  case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41602  case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41603  case DW_TAG_union_type:
41604  case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41605    kind = TYPE;
41606    is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41607    break;
41608  default:
41609    assert (0);
41610  @}
41611@end smallexample
41612
41613@node Man Pages
41614@appendix Manual pages
41615@cindex Man pages
41616
41617@menu
41618* gdb man::                     The GNU Debugger man page
41619* gdbserver man::               Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41620* gcore man::                   Generate a core file of a running program
41621* gdbinit man::                 gdbinit scripts
41622@end menu
41623
41624@node gdb man
41625@heading gdb man
41626
41627@c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41628
41629@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41630gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41631[@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41632[@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41633    [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41634[@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41635[@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41636    [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41637[@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41638@c man end
41639
41640@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41641The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41642going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41643program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41644
41645@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41646these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41647
41648@itemize @bullet
41649@item
41650Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41651
41652@item
41653Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41654
41655@item
41656Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41657
41658@item
41659Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41660effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41661@end itemize
41662
41663You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41664Modula-2.
41665
41666@value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}.  Once started, it reads
41667commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41668command @code{quit}.  You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41669by using the command @code{help}.
41670
41671You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41672usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41673executable program as the argument:
41674
41675@smallexample
41676gdb program
41677@end smallexample
41678
41679You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41680
41681@smallexample
41682gdb program core
41683@end smallexample
41684
41685You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41686to debug a running process:
41687
41688@smallexample
41689gdb program 1234
41690gdb -p 1234
41691@end smallexample
41692
41693@noindent
41694would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41695named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41696With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41697
41698Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41699
41700@c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41701@table @env
41702@item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41703Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41704
41705@item run [@var{arglist}]
41706Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41707
41708@item bt
41709Backtrace: display the program stack.
41710
41711@item print @var{expr}
41712Display the value of an expression.
41713
41714@item c
41715Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41716
41717@item next
41718Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41719function calls in the line.
41720
41721@item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41722look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41723
41724@item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41725type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41726
41727@item step
41728Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41729function calls in the line.
41730
41731@item help [@var{name}]
41732Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41733about using @value{GDBN}.
41734
41735@item quit
41736Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41737@end table
41738
41739@ifset man
41740For full details on @value{GDBN},
41741see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41742by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch.  The same text is available online
41743as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41744@end ifset
41745@c man end
41746
41747@c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41748Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41749file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41750encountered with no
41751associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41752if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41753Many options have
41754both long and short forms; both are shown here.  The long forms are also
41755recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41756present to be unambiguous.  (If you prefer, you can flag option
41757arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41758more usual convention.)
41759
41760All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41761in sequential order.  The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41762option is used.
41763
41764@table @env
41765@item -help
41766@itemx -h
41767List all options, with brief explanations.
41768
41769@item -symbols=@var{file}
41770@itemx -s @var{file}
41771Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41772
41773@item -write
41774Enable writing into executable and core files.
41775
41776@item -exec=@var{file}
41777@itemx -e @var{file}
41778Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41779appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41780dump.
41781
41782@item -se=@var{file}
41783Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41784file.
41785
41786@item -core=@var{file}
41787@itemx -c @var{file}
41788Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41789
41790@item -command=@var{file}
41791@itemx -x @var{file}
41792Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41793
41794@item -ex @var{command}
41795Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41796
41797@item -directory=@var{directory}
41798@itemx -d @var{directory}
41799Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41800
41801@item -nh
41802Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41803
41804@item -nx
41805@itemx -n
41806Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41807
41808@item -quiet
41809@itemx -q
41810``Quiet''.  Do not print the introductory and copyright messages.  These
41811messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41812
41813@item -batch
41814Run in batch mode.  Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41815files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41816Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41817commands in the command files.
41818
41819Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41820download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41821more useful, the message
41822
41823@smallexample
41824Program exited normally.
41825@end smallexample
41826
41827@noindent
41828(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41829terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41830
41831@item -cd=@var{directory}
41832Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41833instead of the current directory.
41834
41835@item -fullname
41836@itemx -f
41837Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess.  It tells
41838@value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41839recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41840includes each time the program stops).  This recognizable format looks
41841like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41842and character position separated by colons, and a newline.  The
41843Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41844characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41845
41846@item -b @var{bps}
41847Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41848interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41849
41850@item -tty=@var{device}
41851Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41852@end table
41853@c man end
41854
41855@c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41856@ifset man
41857The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41858If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41859documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41860
41861@smallexample
41862info gdb
41863@end smallexample
41864
41865@noindent
41866should give you access to the complete manual.
41867
41868@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41869Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41870@end ifset
41871@c man end
41872
41873@node gdbserver man
41874@heading gdbserver man
41875
41876@c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41877@format
41878@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41879gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41880
41881gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41882
41883gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41884@c man end
41885@end format
41886
41887@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41888@command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41889than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41890
41891@ifclear man
41892@subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41893@end ifclear
41894@ifset man
41895Usage (server (target) side):
41896@end ifset
41897
41898First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41899the target system.  The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41900@command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols.  All symbol handling is taken care of by
41901the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41902
41903To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41904program.  You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41905your program, and (c) its arguments.  The general syntax is:
41906
41907@smallexample
41908target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41909@end smallexample
41910
41911For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41912
41913@smallexample
41914@ifset man
41915@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41916target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41917@end ifset
41918@ifclear man
41919target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41920@end ifclear
41921@end smallexample
41922
41923This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41924to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}.  @command{gdbserver} now
41925waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41926
41927To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41928
41929@smallexample
41930target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41931@end smallexample
41932
41933This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41934going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP.  The @code{host:2345} argument means
41935that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
419362345.  (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.)  You can choose any number you
41937want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41938ports on the target system.  This same port number must be used in the host
41939@value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly.  Note that if
41940you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41941print an error message and exit.
41942
41943@command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41944This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument.  The syntax is:
41945
41946@smallexample
41947target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41948@end smallexample
41949
41950@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.  It isn't
41951necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41952
41953To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41954or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41955In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41956the program you want to debug.
41957
41958@smallexample
41959target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41960@end smallexample
41961
41962@ifclear man
41963@subheading Usage (host side)
41964@end ifclear
41965@ifset man
41966Usage (host side):
41967@end ifset
41968
41969You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41970@value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such.  Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41971would, with the target program as the first argument.  (You may need to use the
41972@option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41973That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}.  After that, the only
41974new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41975(or @code{target extended-remote}).  Its argument is either
41976a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41977descriptor.  For example:
41978
41979@smallexample
41980@ifset man
41981@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41982(gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41983@end ifset
41984@ifclear man
41985(gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41986@end ifclear
41987@end smallexample
41988
41989@noindent
41990communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41991
41992@smallexample
41993(gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41994@end smallexample
41995
41996@noindent
41997communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41998you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number.  Note that for
41999TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
42000command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
42001`Connection refused'.
42002
42003@command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
42004described in
42005@ifset man
42006the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
42007-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
42008@end ifset
42009@ifclear man
42010@ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
42011@end ifclear
42012In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
42013
42014@smallexample
42015(gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
42016@end smallexample
42017
42018The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
42019case.
42020@c man end
42021
42022@c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
42023There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
42024
42025@itemize @bullet
42026
42027@item
42028Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
42029
42030@smallexample
42031gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
42032@end smallexample
42033
42034The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
42035with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
42036a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
42037stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.  Specify the name of the program to
42038debug in @var{prog}.  Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
42039program verbatim.  When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
42040connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42041
42042@item
42043Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
42044program:
42045
42046@smallexample
42047gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42048@end smallexample
42049
42050The @var{comm} parameter is as described above.  Supply the process ID
42051of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
42052else.  Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
42053@value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
42054
42055@item
42056Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
42057
42058@smallexample
42059gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42060@end smallexample
42061
42062In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
42063command(s) to run.  Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
42064close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
42065debug several processes in the same session.
42066@end itemize
42067
42068In each of the modes you may specify these options:
42069
42070@table @env
42071
42072@item --help
42073List all options, with brief explanations.
42074
42075@item --version
42076This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
42077
42078@item --attach
42079@command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program.  The syntax is:
42080
42081@smallexample
42082target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
42083@end smallexample
42084
42085@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.  It isn't
42086necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
42087
42088@item --multi
42089To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
42090or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
42091Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
42092the program you want to debug.  The syntax is:
42093
42094@smallexample
42095target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
42096@end smallexample
42097
42098@item --debug
42099Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
42100process.
42101This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42102the developers.
42103
42104@item --remote-debug
42105Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
42106This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
42107the developers.
42108
42109@item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
42110Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
42111of debugging output.
42112@xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
42113
42114@item --wrapper
42115Specify a wrapper to launch programs
42116for debugging.  The option should be followed by the name of the
42117wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
42118@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
42119
42120@item --once
42121By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
42122additional connections are possible.  However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
42123with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
42124connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
42125
42126@c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
42127
42128@c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
42129@c QDisableRandomization.
42130
42131@end table
42132@c man end
42133
42134@c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
42135@ifset man
42136The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42137If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42138documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42139
42140@smallexample
42141info gdb
42142@end smallexample
42143
42144should give you access to the complete manual.
42145
42146@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42147Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42148@end ifset
42149@c man end
42150
42151@node gcore man
42152@heading gcore
42153
42154@c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
42155
42156@format
42157@c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
42158gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
42159@c man end
42160@end format
42161
42162@c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
42163Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
42164Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
42165crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
42166limit).  Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
42167running without any change.
42168@c man end
42169
42170@c man begin OPTIONS gcore
42171@table @env
42172@item -o @var{filename}
42173The optional argument
42174@var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
42175If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
42176where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
42177@end table
42178@c man end
42179
42180@c man begin SEEALSO gcore
42181@ifset man
42182The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42183If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42184documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42185
42186@smallexample
42187info gdb
42188@end smallexample
42189
42190@noindent
42191should give you access to the complete manual.
42192
42193@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42194Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42195@end ifset
42196@c man end
42197
42198@node gdbinit man
42199@heading gdbinit
42200
42201@c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
42202
42203@format
42204@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
42205@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42206@value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42207@end ifset
42208
42209~/.gdbinit
42210
42211./.gdbinit
42212@c man end
42213@end format
42214
42215@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
42216These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
42217@value{GDBN} startup.  The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
42218described in
42219@ifset man
42220the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
42221-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
42222@end ifset
42223@ifclear man
42224@ref{Sequences}.
42225@end ifclear
42226
42227Please read more in
42228@ifset man
42229the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
42230-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
42231@end ifset
42232@ifclear man
42233@ref{Startup}.
42234@end ifclear
42235
42236@table @env
42237@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42238@item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
42239@end ifset
42240@ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
42241@item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
42242@end ifclear
42243System-wide initialization file.  It is executed unless user specified
42244@value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
42245See more in
42246@ifset man
42247the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
42248-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
42249@end ifset
42250@ifclear man
42251@ref{System-wide configuration}.
42252@end ifclear
42253
42254@item ~/.gdbinit
42255User initialization file.  It is executed unless user specified
42256@value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
42257
42258@item ./.gdbinit
42259Initialization file for current directory.  It may need to be enabled with
42260@value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
42261See more in
42262@ifset man
42263the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
42264-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
42265@end ifset
42266@ifclear man
42267@ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
42268@end ifclear
42269@end table
42270@c man end
42271
42272@c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
42273@ifset man
42274gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
42275
42276The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
42277If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
42278documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
42279
42280@smallexample
42281info gdb
42282@end smallexample
42283
42284should give you access to the complete manual.
42285
42286@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42287Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
42288@end ifset
42289@c man end
42290
42291@include gpl.texi
42292
42293@node GNU Free Documentation License
42294@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
42295@include fdl.texi
42296
42297@node Concept Index
42298@unnumbered Concept Index
42299
42300@printindex cp
42301
42302@node Command and Variable Index
42303@unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
42304
42305@printindex fn
42306
42307@tex
42308% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo.  In the
42309% meantime:
42310\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
42311\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
42312\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
42313\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
42314\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
42315\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
42316\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
42317\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
42318\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
42319\page\colophon
42320% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
42321@end tex
42322
42323@bye
42324